\input texinfo @c -*- texinfo -*- @c %**start of header @setfilename org.info @settitle The Org Manual @documentencoding UTF-8 @documentlanguage en @set txicodequoteundirected @set txicodequotebacktick @set MAINTAINERSITE @uref{https://orgmode.org,maintainers webpage} @set MAINTAINER Bastien Guerry @set MAINTAINEREMAIL @email{bzg@gnu.org} @set MAINTAINERCONTACT @uref{mailto:bzg@gnu.org,contact the maintainer} @c %**end of header @copying This manual is for Org version 9.4. Copyright @copyright{} 2004--2021 Free Software Foundation, Inc. @quotation Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.3 or any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with no Invariant Sections, with the Front-Cover Texts being ``A GNU Manual,'' and with the Back-Cover Texts as in (a) below. A copy of the license is included in the section entitled ``GNU Free Documentation License.'' (a) The FSF's Back-Cover Text is: ``You have the freedom to copy and modify this GNU manual.'' @end quotation @end copying @dircategory Emacs editing modes @direntry * Org Mode: (org). Outline-based notes management and organizer. @end direntry @finalout @titlepage @title The Org Manual @subtitle Release 9.4 @author The Org Mode Developers @page @vskip 0pt plus 1filll @insertcopying @end titlepage @contents @ifnottex @node Top @top The Org Manual @insertcopying @end ifnottex @menu * Introduction:: Getting started. * Document Structure:: A tree works like your brain. * Tables:: Pure magic for quick formatting. * Hyperlinks:: Notes in context. * TODO Items:: Every tree branch can be a TODO item. * Tags:: Tagging headlines and matching sets of tags. * Properties and Columns:: Storing information about an entry. * Dates and Times:: Making items useful for planning. * Refiling and Archiving:: Moving and copying information with ease. * Capture and Attachments:: Dealing with external data. * Agenda Views:: Collecting information into views. * Markup for Rich Contents:: Compose beautiful documents. * Exporting:: Sharing and publishing notes. * Publishing:: Create a web site of linked Org files. * Working with Source Code:: Export, evaluate, and tangle code blocks. * Miscellaneous:: All the rest which did not fit elsewhere. * Hacking:: How to hack your way around. * History and Acknowledgments:: How Org came into being. * GNU Free Documentation License:: The license for this documentation. * Main Index:: An index of Org's concepts and features. * Key Index:: Key bindings and where they are described. * Command and Function Index:: Command names and some internal functions. * Variable Index:: Variables mentioned in the manual. @detailmenu --- The Detailed Node Listing --- Introduction * Summary:: Brief summary of what Org does. * Installation:: Installing Org. * Activation:: How to activate Org for certain buffers. * Feedback:: Bug reports, ideas, patches, etc. * Conventions:: Typesetting conventions used in this manual. Document Structure * Headlines:: How to typeset Org tree headlines. * Visibility Cycling:: Show and hide, much simplified. * Motion:: Jumping to other headlines. * Structure Editing:: Changing sequence and level of headlines. * Sparse Trees:: Matches embedded in context. * Plain Lists:: Additional structure within an entry. * Drawers:: Tucking stuff away. * Blocks:: Folding blocks. Visibility Cycling * Global and local cycling:: Cycling through various visibility states. * Initial visibility:: Setting the initial visibility state. * Catching invisible edits:: Preventing mistakes when editing invisible parts. Tables * Built-in Table Editor:: Simple tables. * Column Width and Alignment:: Overrule the automatic settings. * Column Groups:: Grouping to trigger vertical lines. * Orgtbl Mode:: The table editor as minor mode. * The Spreadsheet:: The table editor has spreadsheet capabilities. * Org Plot:: Plotting from Org tables. The Spreadsheet * References:: How to refer to another field or range. * Formula syntax for Calc:: Using Calc to compute stuff. * Formula syntax for Lisp:: Writing formulas in Emacs Lisp. * Durations and time values:: How to compute durations and time values. * Field and range formulas:: Formula for specific (ranges of) fields. * Column formulas:: Formulas valid for an entire column. * Lookup functions:: Lookup functions for searching tables. * Editing and debugging formulas:: Fixing formulas. * Updating the table:: Recomputing all dependent fields. * Advanced features:: Field and column names, automatic recalculation... Hyperlinks * Link Format:: How links in Org are formatted. * Internal Links:: Links to other places in the current file. * Radio Targets:: Make targets trigger links in plain text. * External Links:: URL-like links to the world. * Handling Links:: Creating, inserting and following. * Using Links Outside Org:: Linking from my C source code? * Link Abbreviations:: Shortcuts for writing complex links. * Search Options:: Linking to a specific location. * Custom Searches:: When the default search is not enough. TODO Items * TODO Basics:: Marking and displaying TODO entries. * TODO Extensions:: Workflow and assignments. * Progress Logging:: Dates and notes for progress. * Priorities:: Some things are more important than others. * Breaking Down Tasks:: Splitting a task into manageable pieces. * Checkboxes:: Tick-off lists. TODO Extensions * Workflow states:: From TODO to DONE in steps. * TODO types:: I do this, Fred does the rest. * Multiple sets in one file:: Mixing it all, still finding your way. * Fast access to TODO states:: Single letter selection of state. * Per-file keywords:: Different files, different requirements. * Faces for TODO keywords:: Highlighting states. * TODO dependencies:: When one task needs to wait for others. Progress Logging * Closing items:: When was this entry marked as done? * Tracking TODO state changes:: When did the status change? * Tracking your habits:: How consistent have you been? Tags * Tag Inheritance:: Tags use the tree structure of an outline. * Setting Tags:: How to assign tags to a headline. * Tag Hierarchy:: Create a hierarchy of tags. * Tag Searches:: Searching for combinations of tags. Properties and Columns * Property Syntax:: How properties are spelled out. * Special Properties:: Access to other Org mode features. * Property Searches:: Matching property values. * Property Inheritance:: Passing values down a tree. * Column View:: Tabular viewing and editing. Column View * Defining columns:: The COLUMNS format property. * Using column view:: How to create and use column view. * Capturing column view:: A dynamic block for column view. Defining columns * Scope of column definitions:: Where defined, where valid? * Column attributes:: Appearance and content of a column. Dates and Times * Timestamps:: Assigning a time to a tree entry. * Creating Timestamps:: Commands to insert timestamps. * Deadlines and Scheduling:: Planning your work. * Clocking Work Time:: Tracking how long you spend on a task. * Effort Estimates:: Planning work effort in advance. * Timers:: Notes with a running timer. Creating Timestamps * The date/time prompt:: How Org mode helps you enter dates and times. * Custom time format:: Making dates look different. Deadlines and Scheduling * Inserting deadline/schedule:: Planning items. * Repeated tasks:: Items that show up again and again. Clocking Work Time * Clocking commands:: Starting and stopping a clock. * The clock table:: Detailed reports. * Resolving idle time:: Resolving time when you've been idle. Refiling and Archiving * Refile and Copy:: Moving/copying a tree from one place to another. * Archiving:: What to do with finished products. Archiving * Moving subtrees:: Moving a tree to an archive file. * Internal archiving:: Switch off a tree but keep it in the file. Capture and Attachments * Capture:: Capturing new stuff. * Attachments:: Attach files to outlines. * RSS Feeds:: Getting input from RSS feeds. Capture * Setting up capture:: Where notes will be stored. * Using capture:: Commands to invoke and terminate capture. * Capture templates:: Define the outline of different note types. Capture templates * Template elements:: What is needed for a complete template entry. * Template expansion:: Filling in information about time and context. * Templates in contexts:: Only show a template in a specific context. Attachments * Attachment defaults and dispatcher:: How to access attachment commands * Attachment options:: Configuring the attachment system * Attachment links:: Hyperlink access to attachments * Automatic version-control with Git:: Everything safely stored away * Attach from Dired:: Using dired to select an attachment Agenda Views * Agenda Files:: Files being searched for agenda information. * Agenda Dispatcher:: Keyboard access to agenda views. * Built-in Agenda Views:: What is available out of the box? * Presentation and Sorting:: How agenda items are prepared for display. * Agenda Commands:: Remote editing of Org trees. * Custom Agenda Views:: Defining special searches and views. * Exporting Agenda Views:: Writing a view to a file. * Agenda Column View:: Using column view for collected entries. Built-in Agenda Views * Weekly/daily agenda:: The calendar page with current tasks. * Global TODO list:: All unfinished action items. * Matching tags and properties:: Structured information with fine-tuned search. * Search view:: Find entries by searching for text. * Stuck projects:: Find projects you need to review. Presentation and Sorting * Categories:: Not all tasks are equal. * Time-of-day specifications:: How the agenda knows the time. * Sorting of agenda items:: The order of things. * Filtering/limiting agenda items:: Dynamically narrow the agenda. Custom Agenda Views * Storing searches:: Type once, use often. * Block agenda:: All the stuff you need in a single buffer. * Setting options:: Changing the rules. Markup for Rich Contents * Paragraphs:: The basic unit of text. * Emphasis and Monospace:: Bold, italic, etc. * Subscripts and Superscripts:: Simple syntax for raising/lowering text. * Special Symbols:: Greek letters and other symbols. * Embedded @LaTeX{}:: LaTeX can be freely used inside Org documents. * Literal Examples:: Source code examples with special formatting. * Images:: Display an image. * Captions:: Describe tables, images... * Horizontal Rules:: Make a line. * Creating Footnotes:: Edit and read footnotes. Embedded @LaTeX{} * @LaTeX{} fragments:: Complex formulas made easy. * Previewing @LaTeX{} fragments:: What will this snippet look like? * CD@LaTeX{} mode:: Speed up entering of formulas. Exporting * The Export Dispatcher:: The main interface. * Export Settings:: Common export settings. * Table of Contents:: The if and where of the table of contents. * Include Files:: Include additional files into a document. * Macro Replacement:: Use macros to create templates. * Comment Lines:: What will not be exported. * ASCII/Latin-1/UTF-8 export:: Exporting to flat files with encoding. * Beamer Export:: Producing presentations and slides. * HTML Export:: Exporting to HTML. * @LaTeX{} Export:: Exporting to @LaTeX{} and processing to PDF. * Markdown Export:: Exporting to Markdown. * OpenDocument Text Export:: Exporting to OpenDocument Text. * Org Export:: Exporting to Org. * Texinfo Export:: Exporting to Texinfo. * iCalendar Export:: Exporting to iCalendar. * Other Built-in Back-ends:: Exporting to a man page. * Advanced Export Configuration:: Fine-tuning the export output. * Export in Foreign Buffers:: Author tables and lists in Org syntax. Beamer Export * Beamer export commands:: For creating Beamer documents. * Beamer specific export settings:: For customizing Beamer export. * Frames and Blocks in Beamer:: For composing Beamer slides. * Beamer specific syntax:: For using in Org documents. * Editing support:: Editing support. * A Beamer example:: A complete presentation. HTML Export * HTML export commands:: Invoking HTML export. * HTML specific export settings:: Settings for HTML export. * HTML doctypes:: Exporting various (X)HTML flavors. * HTML preamble and postamble:: Inserting preamble and postamble. * Quoting HTML tags:: Using direct HTML in Org files. * Headlines in HTML export:: Formatting headlines. * Links in HTML export:: Inserting and formatting links. * Tables in HTML export:: How to modify the formatting of tables. * Images in HTML export:: How to insert figures into HTML output. * Math formatting in HTML export:: Beautiful math also on the web. * Text areas in HTML export:: An alternate way to show an example. * CSS support:: Changing the appearance of the output. * JavaScript support:: Info and folding in a web browser. @LaTeX{} Export * @LaTeX{}/PDF export commands:: For producing @LaTeX{} and PDF documents. * @LaTeX{} specific export settings:: Unique to this @LaTeX{} back-end. * @LaTeX{} header and sectioning:: Setting up the export file structure. * Quoting @LaTeX{} code:: Incorporating literal @LaTeX{} code. * Tables in @LaTeX{} export:: Options for exporting tables to @LaTeX{}. * Images in @LaTeX{} export:: How to insert figures into @LaTeX{} output. * Plain lists in @LaTeX{} export:: Attributes specific to lists. * Source blocks in @LaTeX{} export:: Attributes specific to source code blocks. * Example blocks in @LaTeX{} export:: Attributes specific to example blocks. * Special blocks in @LaTeX{} export:: Attributes specific to special blocks. * Horizontal rules in @LaTeX{} export:: Attributes specific to horizontal rules. OpenDocument Text Export * Pre-requisites for ODT export:: Required packages. * ODT export commands:: Invoking export. * ODT specific export settings:: Configuration options. * Extending ODT export:: Producing DOC, PDF files. * Applying custom styles:: Styling the output. * Links in ODT export:: Handling and formatting links. * Tables in ODT export:: Org tables conversions. * Images in ODT export:: Inserting images. * Math formatting in ODT export:: Formatting @LaTeX{} fragments. * Labels and captions in ODT export:: Rendering objects. * Literal examples in ODT export:: For source code and example blocks. * Advanced topics in ODT export:: For power users. Math formatting in ODT export * @LaTeX{} math snippets:: Embedding in @LaTeX{} format. * MathML and OpenDocument formula files:: Embedding in native format. Texinfo Export * Texinfo export commands:: Invoking commands. * Texinfo specific export settings:: Setting the environment. * Texinfo file header:: Generating the header. * Texinfo title and copyright page:: Creating preamble pages. * Info directory file:: Installing a manual in Info file hierarchy. * Headings and sectioning structure:: Building document structure. * Indices:: Creating indices. * Quoting Texinfo code:: Incorporating literal Texinfo code. * Plain lists in Texinfo export:: List attributes. * Tables in Texinfo export:: Table attributes. * Images in Texinfo export:: Image attributes. * Quotations in Texinfo export:: Quote block attributes. * Special blocks in Texinfo export:: Special block attributes. * A Texinfo example:: Processing Org to Texinfo. Export in Foreign Buffers * Bare HTML:: Exporting HTML without CSS, Javascript, etc. Publishing * Configuration:: Defining projects. * Uploading Files:: How to get files up on the server. * Sample Configuration:: Example projects. * Triggering Publication:: Publication commands. Configuration * Project alist:: The central configuration variable. * Sources and destinations:: From here to there. * Selecting files:: What files are part of the project? * Publishing action:: Setting the function doing the publishing. * Publishing options:: Tweaking HTML/@LaTeX{} export. * Publishing links:: Which links keep working after publishing? * Site map:: Generating a list of all pages. * Generating an index:: An index that reaches across pages. Sample Configuration * Simple example:: One-component publishing. * Complex example:: A multi-component publishing example. Working with Source Code * Features Overview:: Enjoy the versatility of source blocks. * Structure of Code Blocks:: Code block syntax described. * Using Header Arguments:: Different ways to set header arguments. * Environment of a Code Block:: Arguments, sessions, working directory... * Evaluating Code Blocks:: Place results of evaluation in the Org buffer. * Results of Evaluation:: Choosing a results type, post-processing... * Exporting Code Blocks:: Export contents and/or results. * Extracting Source Code:: Create pure source code files. * Languages:: List of supported code block languages. * Editing Source Code:: Language major-mode editing. * Noweb Reference Syntax:: Literate programming in Org mode. * Library of Babel:: Use and contribute to a library of useful code blocks. * Key bindings and Useful Functions:: Work quickly with code blocks. * Batch Execution:: Call functions from the command line. Miscellaneous * Completion:: @kbd{M-@key{TAB}} guesses completions. * Structure Templates:: Quick insertion of structural elements. * Speed Keys:: Electric commands at the beginning of a headline. * Clean View:: Getting rid of leading stars in the outline. * Execute commands in the active region:: Execute commands on multiple items in Org or agenda view. * Dynamic Headline Numbering:: Display and update outline numbering. * The Very Busy @kbd{C-c C-c} Key:: When in doubt, press @kbd{C-c C-c}. * In-buffer Settings:: Overview of keywords. * Org Syntax:: Formal description of Org's syntax. * Documentation Access:: Read documentation about current syntax. * Escape Character:: Prevent Org from interpreting your writing. * Code Evaluation Security:: Org files evaluate in-line code. * Interaction:: With other Emacs packages. * TTY Keys:: Using Org on a tty. * Protocols:: External access to Emacs and Org. * Org Crypt:: Encrypting Org files. * Org Mobile:: Viewing and capture on a mobile device. Clean View * Org Indent Mode:: * Hard indentation:: Interaction * Cooperation:: Packages Org cooperates with. * Conflicts:: Packages that lead to conflicts. Protocols * The @code{store-link} protocol:: Store a link, push URL to kill-ring. * The @code{capture} protocol:: Fill a buffer with external information. * The @code{open-source} protocol:: Edit published contents. Org Mobile * Setting up the staging area:: For the mobile device. * Pushing to the mobile application:: Uploading Org files and agendas. * Pulling from the mobile application:: Integrating captured and flagged items. Hacking * Hooks: Hooks (2). How to reach into Org's internals. * Add-on Packages:: Available extensions. * Adding Hyperlink Types:: New custom link types. * Adding Export Back-ends:: How to write new export back-ends. * Tables in Arbitrary Syntax:: Orgtbl for LaTeX and other programs. * Dynamic Blocks:: Automatically filled blocks. * Special Agenda Views:: Customized views. * Speeding Up Your Agendas:: Tips on how to speed up your agendas. * Extracting Agenda Information:: Post-processing agenda information. * Using the Property API:: Writing programs that use entry properties. * Using the Mapping API:: Mapping over all or selected entries. Tables in Arbitrary Syntax * Radio tables:: Sending and receiving radio tables. * A @LaTeX{} example:: Step by step, almost a tutorial. * Translator functions:: Copy and modify. @end detailmenu @end menu @node Introduction @chapter Introduction @cindex introduction @menu * Summary:: Brief summary of what Org does. * Installation:: Installing Org. * Activation:: How to activate Org for certain buffers. * Feedback:: Bug reports, ideas, patches, etc. * Conventions:: Typesetting conventions used in this manual. @end menu @node Summary @section Summary @cindex summary Org is a mode for keeping notes, maintaining TODO lists, and project planning with a fast and effective plain-text markup language. It also is an authoring system with unique support for literate programming and reproducible research. Org is implemented on top of Outline mode, which makes it possible to keep the content of large files well structured. Visibility cycling and structure editing help to work with the tree. Tables are easily created with a built-in table editor. Plain text URL-like links connect to websites, emails, Usenet messages, BBDB entries, and any files related to the projects. Org develops organizational tasks around notes files that contain lists or information about projects as plain text. Project planning and task management make use of metadata which is part of an outline node. Based on this data, specific entries can be extracted in queries and create dynamic @emph{agenda views} that also integrate the Emacs calendar and diary. Org can be used to implement many different project planning schemes, such as David Allen's GTD system. Org files can serve as a single source authoring system with export to many different formats such as HTML, @LaTeX{}, Open Document, and Markdown. New export backends can be derived from existing ones, or defined from scratch. Org files can include source code blocks, which makes Org uniquely suited for authoring technical documents with code examples. Org source code blocks are fully functional; they can be evaluated in place and their results can be captured in the file. This makes it possible to create a single file reproducible research compendium. Org keeps simple things simple. When first fired up, it should feel like a straightforward, easy to use outliner. Complexity is not imposed, but a large amount of functionality is available when needed. Org is a toolbox. Many users actually run only a---very personal---fraction of Org's capabilities, and know that there is more whenever they need it. All of this is achieved with strictly plain text files, the most portable and future-proof file format. Org runs in Emacs. Emacs is one of the most widely ported programs, so that Org mode is available on every major platform. @cindex FAQ There is a website for Org which provides links to the newest version of Org, as well as additional information, frequently asked questions (FAQ), links to tutorials, etc. This page is located at @uref{https://orgmode.org}. @cindex print edition An earlier version (7.3) of this manual is available as a @uref{http://www.network-theory.co.uk/org/manual/, paperback book from Network Theory Ltd.}. @node Installation @section Installation @cindex installation Org is included in all recent distributions of GNU Emacs, so you probably do not need to install it. Most users will simply activate Org and begin exploring its many features. If, for one reason or another, you want to install Org on top of this pre-packaged version, there are three ways to do it: @itemize @item by using the Emacs package system; @item by downloading Org as an archive; or @item by using Org's git repository. @end itemize We @strong{strongly recommend} sticking to a single installation method. @anchor{Using Emacs packaging system} @subheading Using Emacs packaging system Recent Emacs distributions include a packaging system which lets you install Elisp libraries. You can install Org from the ``package menu'', with @kbd{M-x list-packages}. See @ref{Package Menu,Package Menu,,emacs,}. @quotation Important You need to do this in a session where no @samp{.org} file has been visited, i.e., where no Org built-in function have been loaded. Otherwise autoload Org functions will mess up the installation. @end quotation If you want to use Org's package repository, check out the @uref{https://orgmode.org/elpa.html, Org ELPA page}. @anchor{Downloading Org as an archive} @subheading Downloading Org as an archive You can download Org latest release from @uref{https://orgmode.org/, Org's website}. In this case, make sure you set the load path correctly in your Emacs init file: @lisp (add-to-list 'load-path "~/path/to/orgdir/lisp") @end lisp The downloaded archive contains contributed libraries that are not included in Emacs. If you want to use them, add the @samp{contrib/} directory to your load path: @lisp (add-to-list 'load-path "~/path/to/orgdir/contrib/lisp" t) @end lisp Optionally, you can compile the files and/or install them in your system. Run @samp{make help} to list compilation and installation options. @anchor{Using Org's git repository} @subheading Using Org's git repository You can clone Org's repository and install Org like this: @example $ cd ~/src/ $ git clone https://code.orgmode.org/bzg/org-mode.git $ cd org-mode/ $ make autoloads @end example Note that in this case, @samp{make autoloads} is mandatory: it defines Org's version in @samp{org-version.el} and Org's autoloads in @samp{org-loaddefs.el}. Remember to add the correct load path as described in the method above. You can also compile with @samp{make}, generate the documentation with @samp{make doc}, create a local configuration with @samp{make config} and install Org with @samp{make install}. Please run @samp{make help} to get the list of compilation/installation options. For more detailed explanations on Org's build system, please check the Org Build System page on @uref{https://orgmode.org/worg/dev/org-build-system.html, Worg}. @node Activation @section Activation @cindex activation @cindex autoload @cindex ELPA @cindex global key bindings @cindex key bindings, global Org mode buffers need Font Lock to be turned on: this is the default in Emacs@footnote{If you do not use Font Lock globally turn it on in Org buffer with @samp{(add-hook 'org-mode-hook 'turn-on-font-lock)}.}. There are compatibility issues between Org mode and some other Elisp packages (see @ref{Conflicts}). Please take the time to check the list. @findex org-agenda @findex org-capture @findex org-store-link For a better experience, the three Org commands @code{org-store-link}, @code{org-capture} and @code{org-agenda} ought to be accessible anywhere in Emacs, not just in Org buffers. To that effect, you need to bind them to globally available keys, like the ones reserved for users (see @ref{Key Binding Conventions,,,elisp,}). Here are suggested bindings, please modify the keys to your own liking. @lisp (global-set-key (kbd "C-c l") 'org-store-link) (global-set-key (kbd "C-c a") 'org-agenda) (global-set-key (kbd "C-c c") 'org-capture) @end lisp @cindex Org mode, turning on Files with the @samp{.org} extension use Org mode by default. To turn on Org mode in a file that does not have the extension @samp{.org}, make the first line of a file look like this: @example MY PROJECTS -*- mode: org; -*- @end example @vindex org-insert-mode-line-in-empty-file @noindent which selects Org mode for this buffer no matter what the file's name is. See also the variable @code{org-insert-mode-line-in-empty-file}. Many commands in Org work on the region if the region is @emph{active}. To make use of this, you need to have Transient Mark mode turned on, which is the default. If you do not like it, you can create an active region by using the mouse to select a region, or pressing @kbd{C-@key{SPC}} twice before moving point. @node Feedback @section Feedback @cindex feedback @cindex bug reports @cindex reporting a bug @cindex maintainer @cindex author If you find problems with Org, or if you have questions, remarks, or ideas about it, please send an email to the Org mailing list @email{emacs-orgmode@@gnu.org}. You can subscribe to the list @uref{https://lists.gnu.org/mailman/listinfo/emacs-orgmode, from this web page}. If you are not a member of the mailing list, your mail will be passed to the list after a moderator has approved it@footnote{Please consider subscribing to the mailing list in order to minimize the work the mailing list moderators have to do.}. We ask you to read and respect the @uref{https://www.gnu.org/philosophy/kind-communication.html, GNU Kind Communications Guidelines} when sending messages on this mailing list. @findex org-version @findex org-submit-bug-report For bug reports, please first try to reproduce the bug with the latest version of Org available---if you are running an outdated version, it is quite possible that the bug has been fixed already. If the bug persists, prepare a report and provide as much information as possible, including the version information of Emacs (@kbd{M-x emacs-version}) and Org (@kbd{M-x org-version}), as well as the Org related setup in the Emacs init file. The easiest way to do this is to use the command @example M-x org-submit-bug-report @end example @noindent which puts all this information into an Emacs mail buffer so that you only need to add your description. If you are not sending the Email from within Emacs, please copy and paste the content into your Email program. Sometimes you might face a problem due to an error in your Emacs or Org mode setup. Before reporting a bug, it is very helpful to start Emacs with minimal customizations and reproduce the problem. Doing so often helps you determine if the problem is with your customization or with Org mode itself. You can start a typical minimal session with a command like the example below. @example $ emacs -Q -l /path/to/minimal-org.el @end example However if you are using Org mode as distributed with Emacs, a minimal setup is not necessary. In that case it is sufficient to start Emacs as @samp{emacs -Q}. The @samp{minimal-org.el} setup file can have contents as shown below. @lisp ;;; Minimal setup to load latest `org-mode'. ;; Activate debugging. (setq debug-on-error t debug-on-signal nil debug-on-quit nil) ;; Add latest Org mode to load path. (add-to-list 'load-path (expand-file-name "/path/to/org-mode/lisp")) (add-to-list 'load-path (expand-file-name "/path/to/org-mode/contrib/lisp" t)) @end lisp If an error occurs, a ``backtrace'' can be very useful---see below on how to create one. Often a small example file helps, along with clear information about: @enumerate @item What exactly did you do? @item What did you expect to happen? @item What happened instead? @end enumerate Thank you for helping to improve this program. @anchor{How to create a useful backtrace} @subheading How to create a useful backtrace @cindex backtrace of an error If working with Org produces an error with a message you do not understand, you may have hit a bug. The best way to report this is by providing, in addition to what was mentioned above, a backtrace. This is information from the built-in debugger about where and how the error occurred. Here is how to produce a useful backtrace: @enumerate @item Reload uncompiled versions of all Org mode Lisp files. The backtrace contains much more information if it is produced with uncompiled code. To do this, use @example C-u M-x org-reload @end example @noindent or, from the menu: Org @arrow{} Refresh/Reload @arrow{} Reload Org uncompiled. @item Then, activate the debugger: @example M-x toggle-debug-on-error @end example @noindent or, from the menu: Options @arrow{} Enter Debugger on Error. @item Do whatever you have to do to hit the error. Do not forget to document the steps you take. @item When you hit the error, a @samp{*Backtrace*} buffer appears on the screen. Save this buffer to a file---for example using @kbd{C-x C-w}---and attach it to your bug report. @end enumerate @node Conventions @section Typesetting Conventions Used in this Manual @anchor{TODO keywords tags properties etc} @subheading TODO keywords, tags, properties, etc. Org uses various syntactical elements: TODO keywords, tags, property names, keywords, blocks, etc. In this manual we use the following conventions: @table @asis @item @samp{TODO} @itemx @samp{WAITING} TODO keywords are written with all capitals, even if they are user-defined. @item @samp{boss} @itemx @samp{ARCHIVE} Tags are case-sensitive. User-defined tags are written in lowercase; built-in tags with special meaning are written as they should appear in the document, usually with all capitals. @item @samp{Release} @itemx @samp{PRIORITY} User-defined properties are capitalized; built-in properties with special meaning are written with all capitals. @item @samp{TITLE} @itemx @samp{BEGIN} @dots{} @samp{END} Keywords and blocks are written in uppercase to enhance their readability, but you can use lowercase in your Org files. @end table @anchor{Key bindings and commands} @subheading Key bindings and commands The manual lists both the keys and the corresponding commands for accessing a functionality. Org mode often uses the same key for different functions, depending on context. The command that is bound to such keys has a generic name, like @code{org-metaright}. In the manual we will, wherever possible, give the function that is internally called by the generic command. For example, in the chapter on document structure, @kbd{M-@key{RIGHT}} will be listed to call @code{org-do-demote}, while in the chapter on tables, it will be listed to call @code{org-table-move-column-right}. @node Document Structure @chapter Document Structure @cindex document structure @cindex structure of document Org is an outliner. Outlines allow a document to be organized in a hierarchical structure, which, least for me, is the best representation of notes and thoughts. An overview of this structure is achieved by folding, i.e., hiding large parts of the document to show only the general document structure and the parts currently being worked on. Org greatly simplifies the use of outlines by compressing the entire show and hide functionalities into a single command, @code{org-cycle}, which is bound to the @kbd{@key{TAB}} key. @menu * Headlines:: How to typeset Org tree headlines. * Visibility Cycling:: Show and hide, much simplified. * Motion:: Jumping to other headlines. * Structure Editing:: Changing sequence and level of headlines. * Sparse Trees:: Matches embedded in context. * Plain Lists:: Additional structure within an entry. * Drawers:: Tucking stuff away. * Blocks:: Folding blocks. @end menu @node Headlines @section Headlines @cindex headlines @cindex outline tree @vindex org-special-ctrl-a/e @vindex org-special-ctrl-k @vindex org-ctrl-k-protect-subtree Headlines define the structure of an outline tree. Org headlines start on the left margin@footnote{See the variables @code{org-special-ctrl-a/e}, @code{org-special-ctrl-k}, and @code{org-ctrl-k-protect-subtree} to configure special behavior of @kbd{C-a}, @kbd{C-e}, and @kbd{C-k} in headlines. Note also that clocking only works with headings indented less than 30 stars.} with one or more stars followed by a space. For example: @example * Top level headline ** Second level *** Third level some text *** Third level more text * Another top level headline @end example @vindex org-footnote-section The name defined in @code{org-footnote-section} is reserved. Do not use it as a title for your own headings. Some people find the many stars too noisy and would prefer an outline that has whitespace followed by a single star as headline starters. This can be achieved using a Org Indent minor mode. See @ref{Clean View} for more information. Headlines are not numbered. However, you may want to dynamically number some, or all, of them. See @ref{Dynamic Headline Numbering}. @vindex org-cycle-separator-lines An empty line after the end of a subtree is considered part of it and is hidden when the subtree is folded. However, if you leave at least two empty lines, one empty line remains visible after folding the subtree, in order to structure the collapsed view. See the variable @code{org-cycle-separator-lines} to modify this behavior. @node Visibility Cycling @section Visibility Cycling @cindex cycling, visibility @cindex visibility cycling @cindex trees, visibility @cindex show hidden text @cindex hide text @menu * Global and local cycling:: Cycling through various visibility states. * Initial visibility:: Setting the initial visibility state. * Catching invisible edits:: Preventing mistakes when editing invisible parts. @end menu @node Global and local cycling @subsection Global and local cycling @cindex subtree visibility states @cindex subtree cycling @cindex folded, subtree visibility state @cindex children, subtree visibility state @cindex subtree, subtree visibility state Outlines make it possible to hide parts of the text in the buffer. Org uses just two commands, bound to @kbd{@key{TAB}} and @kbd{S-@key{TAB}} to change the visibility in the buffer. @table @asis @item @kbd{@key{TAB}} (@code{org-cycle}) @kindex TAB @findex org-cycle @emph{Subtree cycling}: Rotate current subtree among the states @example ,-> FOLDED -> CHILDREN -> SUBTREE --. '-----------------------------------' @end example @vindex org-cycle-emulate-tab Point must be on a headline for this to work@footnote{See, however, the option @code{org-cycle-emulate-tab}.}. @item @kbd{S-@key{TAB}} (@code{org-global-cycle}) @itemx @kbd{C-u @key{TAB}} @cindex global visibility states @cindex global cycling @cindex overview, global visibility state @cindex contents, global visibility state @cindex show all, global visibility state @kindex C-u TAB @kindex S-TAB @findex org-global-cycle @emph{Global cycling}: Rotate the entire buffer among the states @example ,-> OVERVIEW -> CONTENTS -> SHOW ALL --. '--------------------------------------' @end example When @kbd{S-@key{TAB}} is called with a numeric prefix argument @var{N}, view contents only up to headlines of level @var{N}. Note that inside tables (see @ref{Tables}), @kbd{S-@key{TAB}} jumps to the previous field instead. @vindex org-cycle-global-at-bob You can run global cycling using @kbd{@key{TAB}} only if point is at the very beginning of the buffer, but not on a headline, and @code{org-cycle-global-at-bob} is set to a non-@code{nil} value. @item @kbd{C-u C-u @key{TAB}} (@code{org-set-startup-visibility}) @cindex startup visibility @kindex C-u C-u TAB @findex org-set-startup-visibility Switch back to the startup visibility of the buffer (see @ref{Initial visibility}). @item @kbd{C-u C-u C-u @key{TAB}} (@code{outline-show-all}) @cindex show all, command @kindex C-u C-u C-u TAB @findex outline-show-all Show all, including drawers. @item @kbd{C-c C-r} (@code{org-reveal}) @cindex revealing context @kindex C-c C-r @findex org-reveal Reveal context around point, showing the current entry, the following heading and the hierarchy above. It is useful for working near a location that has been exposed by a sparse tree command (see @ref{Sparse Trees}) or an agenda command (see @ref{Agenda Commands}). With a prefix argument, show, on each level, all sibling headings. With a double prefix argument, also show the entire subtree of the parent. @item @kbd{C-c C-k} (@code{outline-show-branches}) @cindex show branches, command @kindex C-c C-k @findex outline-show-branches Expose all the headings of the subtree, but not their bodies. @item @kbd{C-c @key{TAB}} (@code{outline-show-children}) @cindex show children, command @kindex C-c TAB @findex outline-show-children Expose all direct children of the subtree. With a numeric prefix argument @var{N}, expose all children down to level @var{N}. @item @kbd{C-c C-x b} (@code{org-tree-to-indirect-buffer}) @kindex C-c C-x b @findex org-tree-to-indirect-buffer Show the current subtree in an indirect buffer@footnote{The indirect buffer contains the entire buffer, but is narrowed to the current tree. Editing the indirect buffer also changes the original buffer, but without affecting visibility in that buffer. For more information about indirect buffers, see @ref{Indirect Buffers,GNU Emacs Manual,,emacs,}.}. With a numeric prefix argument @var{N}, go up to level @var{N} and then take that tree. If @var{N} is negative then go up that many levels. With a @kbd{C-u} prefix, do not remove the previously used indirect buffer. @item @kbd{C-c C-x v} (@code{org-copy-visible}) @kindex C-c C-x v @findex org-copy-visible Copy the @emph{visible} text in the region into the kill ring. @end table @node Initial visibility @subsection Initial visibility @vindex org-startup-folded When Emacs first visits an Org file, the global state is set to @code{showeverything}, i.e., all file content is visible@footnote{When @code{org-agenda-inhibit-startup} is non-@code{nil}, Org does not honor the default visibility state when first opening a file for the agenda (see @ref{Speeding Up Your Agendas}).}. This can be configured through the variable @code{org-startup-folded}, or on a per-file basis by adding one of the following lines anywhere in the buffer: @cindex @samp{STARTUP}, keyword @example #+STARTUP: overview #+STARTUP: content #+STARTUP: showall #+STARTUP: showeverything @end example @cindex @samp{VISIBILITY}, property Furthermore, any entries with a @samp{VISIBILITY} property (see @ref{Properties and Columns}) get their visibility adapted accordingly. Allowed values for this property are @samp{folded}, @samp{children}, @samp{content}, and @samp{all}. @table @asis @item @kbd{C-u C-u @key{TAB}} (@code{org-set-startup-visibility}) @kindex C-u C-u TAB @findex org-set-startup-visibility Switch back to the startup visibility of the buffer, i.e., whatever is requested by startup options and @samp{VISIBILITY} properties in individual entries. @end table @node Catching invisible edits @subsection Catching invisible edits @cindex edits, catching invisible @vindex org-catch-invisible-edits Sometimes you may inadvertently edit an invisible part of the buffer and be confused on what has been edited and how to undo the mistake. Setting @code{org-catch-invisible-edits} to non-@code{nil} helps preventing this. See the docstring of this option on how Org should catch invisible edits and process them. @node Motion @section Motion @cindex motion, between headlines @cindex jumping, to headlines @cindex headline navigation The following commands jump to other headlines in the buffer. @table @asis @item @kbd{C-c C-n} (@code{org-next-visible-heading}) @kindex C-c C-n @findex org-next-visible-heading Next heading. @item @kbd{C-c C-p} (@code{org-previous-visible-heading}) @kindex C-c C-p @findex org-previous-visible-heading Previous heading. @item @kbd{C-c C-f} (@code{org-forward-heading-same-level}) @kindex C-c C-f @findex org-forward-heading-same-level Next heading same level. @item @kbd{C-c C-b} (@code{org-backward-heading-same-level}) @kindex C-c C-b @findex org-backward-heading-same-level Previous heading same level. @item @kbd{C-c C-u} (@code{outline-up-heading}) @kindex C-c C-u @findex outline-up-heading Backward to higher level heading. @item @kbd{C-c C-j} (@code{org-goto}) @kindex C-c C-j @findex org-goto @vindex org-goto-auto-isearch Jump to a different place without changing the current outline visibility. Shows the document structure in a temporary buffer, where you can use the following keys to find your destination: @multitable @columnfractions 0.3 0.7 @item @kbd{@key{TAB}} @tab Cycle visibility. @item @kbd{@key{DOWN}} / @kbd{@key{UP}} @tab Next/previous visible headline. @item @kbd{@key{RET}} @tab Select this location. @item @kbd{/} @tab Do a Sparse-tree search @end multitable @noindent The following keys work if you turn off @code{org-goto-auto-isearch} @multitable @columnfractions 0.3 0.7 @item @kbd{n} / @kbd{p} @tab Next/previous visible headline. @item @kbd{f} / @kbd{b} @tab Next/previous headline same level. @item @kbd{u} @tab One level up. @item @kbd{0} @dots{} @kbd{9} @tab Digit argument. @item @kbd{q} @tab Quit. @end multitable @vindex org-goto-interface @noindent See also the variable @code{org-goto-interface}. @end table @node Structure Editing @section Structure Editing @cindex structure editing @cindex headline, promotion and demotion @cindex promotion, of subtrees @cindex demotion, of subtrees @cindex subtree, cut and paste @cindex pasting, of subtrees @cindex cutting, of subtrees @cindex copying, of subtrees @cindex sorting, of subtrees @cindex subtrees, cut and paste @table @asis @item @kbd{M-@key{RET}} (@code{org-meta-return}) @kindex M-RET @findex org-meta-return @vindex org-M-RET-may-split-line Insert a new heading, item or row. If the command is used at the @emph{beginning} of a line, and if there is a heading or a plain list item (see @ref{Plain Lists}) at point, the new heading/item is created @emph{before} the current line. When used at the beginning of a regular line of text, turn that line into a heading. When this command is used in the middle of a line, the line is split and the rest of the line becomes the new item or headline. If you do not want the line to be split, customize @code{org-M-RET-may-split-line}. Calling the command with a @kbd{C-u} prefix unconditionally inserts a new heading at the end of the current subtree, thus preserving its contents. With a double @kbd{C-u C-u} prefix, the new heading is created at the end of the parent subtree instead. @item @kbd{C-@key{RET}} (@code{org-insert-heading-respect-content}) @kindex C-RET @findex org-insert-heading-respect-content Insert a new heading at the end of the current subtree. @item @kbd{M-S-@key{RET}} (@code{org-insert-todo-heading}) @kindex M-S-RET @findex org-insert-todo-heading @vindex org-treat-insert-todo-heading-as-state-change Insert new TODO entry with same level as current heading. See also the variable @code{org-treat-insert-todo-heading-as-state-change}. @item @kbd{C-S-@key{RET}} (@code{org-insert-todo-heading-respect-content}) @kindex C-S-RET @findex org-insert-todo-heading-respect-content Insert new TODO entry with same level as current heading. Like @kbd{C-@key{RET}}, the new headline is inserted after the current subtree. @item @kbd{@key{TAB}} (@code{org-cycle}) @kindex TAB @findex org-cycle In a new entry with no text yet, the first @kbd{@key{TAB}} demotes the entry to become a child of the previous one. The next @kbd{@key{TAB}} makes it a parent, and so on, all the way to top level. Yet another @kbd{@key{TAB}}, and you are back to the initial level. @item @kbd{M-@key{LEFT}} (@code{org-do-promote}) @itemx @kbd{M-@key{RIGHT}} (@code{org-do-demote}) @kindex M-LEFT @findex org-do-promote @kindex M-RIGHT @findex org-do-demote Promote or demote current heading by one level. @cindex region, active @cindex active region @cindex transient mark mode When there is an active region---i.e., when Transient Mark mode is active---promotion and demotion work on all headlines in the region. To select a region of headlines, it is best to place both point and mark at the beginning of a line, mark at the beginning of the first headline, and point at the line just after the last headline to change. @item @kbd{M-S-@key{LEFT}} (@code{org-promote-subtree}) @kindex M-S-LEFT @findex org-promote-subtree Promote the current subtree by one level. @item @kbd{M-S-@key{RIGHT}} (@code{org-demote-subtree}) @kindex M-S-RIGHT @findex org-demote-subtree Demote the current subtree by one level. @item @kbd{M-@key{UP}} (@code{org-move-subtree-up}) @kindex M-UP @findex org-move-subtree-up Move subtree up, i.e., swap with previous subtree of same level. @item @kbd{M-@key{DOWN}} (@code{org-move-subtree-down}) @kindex M-DOWN @findex org-move-subtree-down Move subtree down, i.e., swap with next subtree of same level. @item @kbd{C-c @@} (@code{org-mark-subtree}) @kindex C-c @@ @findex org-mark-subtree Mark the subtree at point. Hitting repeatedly marks subsequent subtrees of the same level as the marked subtree. @item @kbd{C-c C-x C-w} (@code{org-cut-subtree}) @kindex C-c C-x C-w @findex org-cut-subtree Kill subtree, i.e., remove it from buffer but save in kill ring. With a numeric prefix argument N, kill N sequential subtrees. @item @kbd{C-c C-x M-w} (@code{org-copy-subtree}) @kindex C-c C-x M-w @findex org-copy-subtree Copy subtree to kill ring. With a numeric prefix argument N, copy the N sequential subtrees. @item @kbd{C-c C-x C-y} (@code{org-paste-subtree}) @kindex C-c C-x C-y @findex org-paste-subtree Yank subtree from kill ring. This does modify the level of the subtree to make sure the tree fits in nicely at the yank position. The yank level can also be specified with a numeric prefix argument, or by yanking after a headline marker like @samp{****}. @item @kbd{C-y} (@code{org-yank}) @kindex C-y @findex org-yank @vindex org-yank-adjusted-subtrees @vindex org-yank-folded-subtrees Depending on the variables @code{org-yank-adjusted-subtrees} and @code{org-yank-folded-subtrees}, Org's internal @code{yank} command pastes subtrees folded and in a clever way, using the same command as @kbd{C-c C-x C-y}. With the default settings, no level adjustment takes place, but the yanked tree is folded unless doing so would swallow text previously visible. Any prefix argument to this command forces a normal @code{yank} to be executed, with the prefix passed along. A good way to force a normal yank is @kbd{C-u C-y}. If you use @code{yank-pop} after a yank, it yanks previous kill items plainly, without adjustment and folding. @item @kbd{C-c C-x c} (@code{org-clone-subtree-with-time-shift}) @kindex C-c C-x c @findex org-clone-subtree-with-time-shift Clone a subtree by making a number of sibling copies of it. You are prompted for the number of copies to make, and you can also specify if any timestamps in the entry should be shifted. This can be useful, for example, to create a number of tasks related to a series of lectures to prepare. For more details, see the docstring of the command @code{org-clone-subtree-with-time-shift}. @item @kbd{C-c C-w} (@code{org-refile}) @kindex C-c C-w @findex org-refile Refile entry or region to a different location. See @ref{Refile and Copy}. @item @kbd{C-c ^} (@code{org-sort}) @kindex C-c ^ @findex org-sort Sort same-level entries. When there is an active region, all entries in the region are sorted. Otherwise the children of the current headline are sorted. The command prompts for the sorting method, which can be alphabetically, numerically, by time---first timestamp with active preferred, creation time, scheduled time, deadline time---by priority, by TODO keyword---in the sequence the keywords have been defined in the setup---or by the value of a property. Reverse sorting is possible as well. You can also supply your own function to extract the sorting key. With a @kbd{C-u} prefix, sorting is case-sensitive. @item @kbd{C-x n s} (@code{org-narrow-to-subtree}) @kindex C-x n s @findex org-narrow-to-subtree Narrow buffer to current subtree. @item @kbd{C-x n b} (@code{org-narrow-to-block}) @kindex C-x n b @findex org-narrow-to-block Narrow buffer to current block. @item @kbd{C-x n w} (@code{widen}) @kindex C-x n w @findex widen Widen buffer to remove narrowing. @item @kbd{C-c *} (@code{org-toggle-heading}) @kindex C-c * @findex org-toggle-heading Turn a normal line or plain list item into a headline---so that it becomes a subheading at its location. Also turn a headline into a normal line by removing the stars. If there is an active region, turn all lines in the region into headlines. If the first line in the region was an item, turn only the item lines into headlines. Finally, if the first line is a headline, remove the stars from all headlines in the region. @end table Note that when point is inside a table (see @ref{Tables}), the Meta-Cursor keys have different functionality. @node Sparse Trees @section Sparse Trees @cindex sparse trees @cindex trees, sparse @cindex folding, sparse trees @cindex occur, command @vindex org-show-context-detail An important feature of Org mode is the ability to construct @emph{sparse trees} for selected information in an outline tree, so that the entire document is folded as much as possible, but the selected information is made visible along with the headline structure above it@footnote{See also the variable @code{org-show-context-detail} to decide how much context is shown around each match.}. Just try it out and you will see immediately how it works. Org mode contains several commands creating such trees, all these commands can be accessed through a dispatcher: @table @asis @item @kbd{C-c /} (@code{org-sparse-tree}) @kindex C-c / @findex org-sparse-tree This prompts for an extra key to select a sparse-tree creating command. @item @kbd{C-c / r} or @kbd{C-c / /} (@code{org-occur}) @kindex C-c / r @kindex C-c / / @findex org-occur @vindex org-remove-highlights-with-change Prompts for a regexp and shows a sparse tree with all matches. If the match is in a headline, the headline is made visible. If the match is in the body of an entry, headline and body are made visible. In order to provide minimal context, also the full hierarchy of headlines above the match is shown, as well as the headline following the match. Each match is also highlighted; the highlights disappear when the buffer is changed by an editing command, or by pressing @kbd{C-c C-c}@footnote{This depends on the option @code{org-remove-highlights-with-change}.}. When called with a @kbd{C-u} prefix argument, previous highlights are kept, so several calls to this command can be stacked. @item @kbd{M-g n} or @kbd{M-g M-n} (@code{next-error}) @kindex M-g n @kindex M-g M-n @findex next-error Jump to the next sparse tree match in this buffer. @item @kbd{M-g p} or @kbd{M-g M-p} (@code{previous-error}) @kindex M-g p @kindex M-g M-p @findex previous-error Jump to the previous sparse tree match in this buffer. @end table @vindex org-agenda-custom-commands For frequently used sparse trees of specific search strings, you can use the variable @code{org-agenda-custom-commands} to define fast keyboard access to specific sparse trees. These commands will then be accessible through the agenda dispatcher (see @ref{Agenda Dispatcher}). For example: @lisp (setq org-agenda-custom-commands '(("f" occur-tree "FIXME"))) @end lisp @noindent defines the key @kbd{f} as a shortcut for creating a sparse tree matching the string @samp{FIXME}. The other sparse tree commands select headings based on TODO keywords, tags, or properties and are discussed later in this manual. @kindex C-c C-e C-v @cindex printing sparse trees @cindex visible text, printing To print a sparse tree, you can use the Emacs command @code{ps-print-buffer-with-faces} which does not print invisible parts of the document. Or you can use the command @kbd{C-c C-e C-v} to export only the visible part of the document and print the resulting file. @node Plain Lists @section Plain Lists @cindex plain lists @cindex lists, plain @cindex lists, ordered @cindex ordered lists Within an entry of the outline tree, hand-formatted lists can provide additional structure. They also provide a way to create lists of checkboxes (see @ref{Checkboxes}). Org supports editing such lists, and every exporter (see @ref{Exporting}) can parse and format them. Org knows ordered lists, unordered lists, and description lists. @itemize @item @emph{Unordered} list items start with @samp{-}, @samp{+}, or @samp{*}@footnote{When using @samp{*} as a bullet, lines must be indented so that they are not interpreted as headlines. Also, when you are hiding leading stars to get a clean outline view, plain list items starting with a star may be hard to distinguish from true headlines. In short: even though @samp{*} is supported, it may be better to not use it for plain list items.} as bullets. @item @vindex org-plain-list-ordered-item-terminator @vindex org-alphabetical-lists @emph{Ordered} list items start with a numeral followed by either a period or a right parenthesis@footnote{You can filter out any of them by configuring @code{org-plain-list-ordered-item-terminator}.}, such as @samp{1.} or @samp{1)}@footnote{You can also get @samp{a.}, @samp{A.}, @samp{a)} and @samp{A)} by configuring @code{org-list-allow-alphabetical}. To minimize confusion with normal text, those are limited to one character only. Beyond that limit, bullets automatically become numbers.} If you want a list to start with a different value---e.g., 20---start the text of the item with @samp{[@@20]}@footnote{If there's a checkbox in the item, the cookie must be put @emph{before} the checkbox. If you have activated alphabetical lists, you can also use counters like @samp{[@@b]}.}. Those constructs can be used in any item of the list in order to enforce a particular numbering. @item @emph{Description} list items are unordered list items, and contain the separator @samp{::} to distinguish the description @emph{term} from the description. @end itemize Items belonging to the same list must have the same indentation on the first line. In particular, if an ordered list reaches number @samp{10.}, then the 2-digit numbers must be written left-aligned with the other numbers in the list. An item ends before the next line that is less or equally indented than its bullet/number. A list ends whenever every item has ended, which means before any line less or equally indented than items at top level. It also ends before two blank lines. In that case, all items are closed. Here is an example: @example * Lord of the Rings My favorite scenes are (in this order) 1. The attack of the Rohirrim 2. Eowyn's fight with the witch king + this was already my favorite scene in the book + I really like Miranda Otto. 3. Peter Jackson being shot by Legolas - on DVD only He makes a really funny face when it happens. But in the end, no individual scenes matter but the film as a whole. Important actors in this film are: - Elijah Wood :: He plays Frodo - Sean Astin :: He plays Sam, Frodo's friend. I still remember him very well from his role as Mikey Walsh in /The Goonies/. @end example Org supports these lists by tuning filling and wrapping commands to deal with them correctly, and by exporting them properly (see @ref{Exporting}). Since indentation is what governs the structure of these lists, many structural constructs like @samp{#+BEGIN_} blocks can be indented to signal that they belong to a particular item. @vindex org-list-demote-modify-bullet @vindex org-list-indent-offset If you find that using a different bullet for a sub-list---than that used for the current list-level---improves readability, customize the variable @code{org-list-demote-modify-bullet}. To get a greater difference of indentation between items and theirs sub-items, customize @code{org-list-indent-offset}. @vindex org-list-automatic-rules The following commands act on items when point is in the first line of an item---the line with the bullet or number. Some of them imply the application of automatic rules to keep list structure intact. If some of these actions get in your way, configure @code{org-list-automatic-rules} to disable them individually. @table @asis @item @kbd{@key{TAB}} (@code{org-cycle}) @cindex cycling, in plain lists @kindex TAB @findex org-cycle @vindex org-cycle-include-plain-lists Items can be folded just like headline levels. Normally this works only if point is on a plain list item. For more details, see the variable @code{org-cycle-include-plain-lists}. If this variable is set to @code{integrate}, plain list items are treated like low-level headlines. The level of an item is then given by the indentation of the bullet/number. Items are always subordinate to real headlines, however; the hierarchies remain completely separated. In a new item with no text yet, the first @kbd{@key{TAB}} demotes the item to become a child of the previous one. Subsequent @kbd{@key{TAB}}s move the item to meaningful levels in the list and eventually get it back to its initial position. @item @kbd{M-@key{RET}} (@code{org-insert-heading}) @kindex M-RET @findex org-insert-heading @vindex org-M-RET-may-split-line Insert new item at current level. With a prefix argument, force a new heading (see @ref{Structure Editing}). If this command is used in the middle of an item, that item is @emph{split} in two, and the second part becomes the new item@footnote{If you do not want the item to be split, customize the variable @code{org-M-RET-may-split-line}.}. If this command is executed @emph{before item's body}, the new item is created @emph{before} the current one. @item @kbd{M-S-@key{RET}} @kindex M-S-RET Insert a new item with a checkbox (see @ref{Checkboxes}). @item @kbd{S-@key{UP}} @itemx @kbd{S-@key{DOWN}} @kindex S-UP @kindex S-DOWN @cindex shift-selection-mode @vindex org-support-shift-select @vindex org-list-use-circular-motion Jump to the previous/next item in the current list, but only if @code{org-support-shift-select} is off@footnote{If you want to cycle around items that way, you may customize @code{org-list-use-circular-motion}.}. If not, you can still use paragraph jumping commands like @kbd{C-@key{UP}} and @kbd{C-@key{DOWN}} to quite similar effect. @item @kbd{M-@key{UP}} @itemx @kbd{M-@key{DOWN}} @kindex M-UP @kindex M-DOWN Move the item including subitems up/down@footnote{See @code{org-list-use-circular-motion} for a cyclic behavior.}, i.e., swap with previous/next item of same indentation. If the list is ordered, renumbering is automatic. @item @kbd{M-@key{LEFT}} @itemx @kbd{M-@key{RIGHT}} @kindex M-LEFT @kindex M-RIGHT Decrease/increase the indentation of an item, leaving children alone. @item @kbd{M-S-@key{LEFT}} @itemx @kbd{M-S-@key{RIGHT}} @kindex M-S-LEFT @kindex M-S-RIGHT Decrease/increase the indentation of the item, including subitems. Initially, the item tree is selected based on current indentation. When these commands are executed several times in direct succession, the initially selected region is used, even if the new indentation would imply a different hierarchy. To use the new hierarchy, break the command chain by moving point. As a special case, using this command on the very first item of a list moves the whole list. This behavior can be disabled by configuring @code{org-list-automatic-rules}. The global indentation of a list has no influence on the text @emph{after} the list. @item @kbd{C-c C-c} @kindex C-c C-c If there is a checkbox (see @ref{Checkboxes}) in the item line, toggle the state of the checkbox. In any case, verify bullets and indentation consistency in the whole list. @item @kbd{C-c -} @kindex C-c - @vindex org-plain-list-ordered-item-terminator Cycle the entire list level through the different itemize/enumerate bullets (@samp{-}, @samp{+}, @samp{*}, @samp{1.}, @samp{1)}) or a subset of them, depending on @code{org-plain-list-ordered-item-terminator}, the type of list, and its indentation. With a numeric prefix argument N, select the Nth bullet from this list. If there is an active region when calling this, all lines are converted to list items. With a prefix argument, the selected text is changed into a single item. If the first line already was a list item, any item marker is removed from the list. Finally, even without an active region, a normal line is converted into a list item. @item @kbd{C-c *} @kindex C-c * Turn a plain list item into a headline---so that it becomes a subheading at its location. See @ref{Structure Editing}, for a detailed explanation. @item @kbd{C-c C-*} @kindex C-c C-* Turn the whole plain list into a subtree of the current heading. Checkboxes (see @ref{Checkboxes}) become @samp{TODO}, respectively @samp{DONE}, keywords when unchecked, respectively checked. @item @kbd{S-@key{LEFT}} @itemx @kbd{S-@key{RIGHT}} @vindex org-support-shift-select @kindex S-LEFT @kindex S-RIGHT This command also cycles bullet styles when point is in on the bullet or anywhere in an item line, details depending on @code{org-support-shift-select}. @item @kbd{C-c ^} @kindex C-c ^ @cindex sorting, of plain list Sort the plain list. Prompt for the sorting method: numerically, alphabetically, by time, or by custom function. @end table @node Drawers @section Drawers @cindex drawers @cindex visibility cycling, drawers Sometimes you want to keep information associated with an entry, but you normally do not want to see it. For this, Org mode has @emph{drawers}. They can contain anything but a headline and another drawer. Drawers look like this: @example ** This is a headline Still outside the drawer :DRAWERNAME: This is inside the drawer. :END: After the drawer. @end example @kindex C-c C-x d @findex org-insert-drawer You can interactively insert a drawer at point by calling @code{org-insert-drawer}, which is bound to @kbd{C-c C-x d}. With an active region, this command puts the region inside the drawer. With a prefix argument, this command calls @code{org-insert-property-drawer}, which creates a @samp{PROPERTIES} drawer right below the current headline. Org mode uses this special drawer for storing properties (see @ref{Properties and Columns}). You cannot use it for anything else. Completion over drawer keywords is also possible using @kbd{M-@key{TAB}}@footnote{Many desktops intercept @kbd{M-@key{TAB}} to switch windows. Use @kbd{C-M-i} or @kbd{@key{ESC} @key{TAB}} instead.}. Visibility cycling (see @ref{Visibility Cycling}) on the headline hides and shows the entry, but keep the drawer collapsed to a single line. In order to look inside the drawer, you need to move point to the drawer line and press @kbd{@key{TAB}} there. You can also arrange for state change notes (see @ref{Tracking TODO state changes}) and clock times (see @ref{Clocking Work Time}) to be stored in a @samp{LOGBOOK} drawer. If you want to store a quick note there, in a similar way to state changes, use @table @asis @item @kbd{C-c C-z} @kindex C-c C-z Add a time-stamped note to the @samp{LOGBOOK} drawer. @end table @node Blocks @section Blocks @vindex org-hide-block-startup @cindex blocks, folding Org mode uses @samp{#+BEGIN} @dots{} @samp{#+END} blocks for various purposes from including source code examples (see @ref{Literal Examples}) to capturing time logging information (see @ref{Clocking Work Time}). These blocks can be folded and unfolded by pressing @kbd{@key{TAB}} in the @samp{#+BEGIN} line. You can also get all blocks folded at startup by configuring the variable @code{org-hide-block-startup} or on a per-file basis by using @cindex STARTUP, keyword @example #+STARTUP: hideblocks #+STARTUP: nohideblocks @end example @node Tables @chapter Tables @cindex tables @cindex editing tables Org comes with a fast and intuitive table editor. Spreadsheet-like calculations are supported using the Emacs Calc package (see @ref{Top,GNU Emacs Calculator Manual,,calc,}). @menu * Built-in Table Editor:: Simple tables. * Column Width and Alignment:: Overrule the automatic settings. * Column Groups:: Grouping to trigger vertical lines. * Orgtbl Mode:: The table editor as minor mode. * The Spreadsheet:: The table editor has spreadsheet capabilities. * Org Plot:: Plotting from Org tables. @end menu @node Built-in Table Editor @section Built-in Table Editor @cindex table editor, built-in @cindex header lines, in tables @cindex horizontal rule, in tables @cindex row separator, in tables @cindex table syntax Org makes it easy to format tables in plain ASCII@. Any line with @samp{|} as the first non-whitespace character is considered part of a table. @samp{|} is also the column separator@footnote{To insert a vertical bar into a table field, use @samp{\vert} or, inside a word @samp{abc\vert@{@}def}.}. Moreover, a line starting with @samp{|-} is a horizontal rule. It separates rows explicitly. Rows before the first horizontal rule are header lines. A table might look like this: @example | Name | Phone | Age | |-------+-------+-----| | Peter | 1234 | 17 | | Anna | 4321 | 25 | @end example A table is re-aligned automatically each time you press @kbd{@key{TAB}}, @kbd{@key{RET}} or @kbd{C-c C-c} inside the table. @kbd{@key{TAB}} also moves to the next field---@kbd{@key{RET}} to the next row---and creates new table rows at the end of the table or before horizontal lines. The indentation of the table is set by the first line. Horizontal rules are automatically expanded on every re-align to span the whole table width. So, to create the above table, you would only type @example |Name|Phone|Age| |- @end example @noindent and then press @kbd{@key{TAB}} to align the table and start filling in fields. Even faster would be to type @samp{|Name|Phone|Age} followed by @kbd{C-c @key{RET}}. When typing text into a field, Org treats @kbd{DEL}, @kbd{Backspace}, and all character keys in a special way, so that inserting and deleting avoids shifting other fields. Also, when typing @emph{immediately} after point was moved into a new field with @kbd{@key{TAB}}, @kbd{S-@key{TAB}} or @kbd{@key{RET}}, the field is automatically made blank. If this behavior is too unpredictable for you, configure the option @code{org-table-auto-blank-field}. @anchor{Creation and conversion} @subheading Creation and conversion @table @asis @item @kbd{C-c |} (@code{org-table-create-or-convert-from-region}) @kindex C-c | @findex org-table-create-or-convert-from-region Convert the active region to table. If every line contains at least one @kbd{@key{TAB}} character, the function assumes that the material is tab separated. If every line contains a comma, comma-separated values (CSV) are assumed. If not, lines are split at whitespace into fields. You can use a prefix argument to force a specific separator: @kbd{C-u} forces CSV, @kbd{C-u C-u} forces @kbd{@key{TAB}}, @kbd{C-u C-u C-u} prompts for a regular expression to match the separator, and a numeric argument N indicates that at least N consecutive spaces, or alternatively a @kbd{@key{TAB}} will be the separator. If there is no active region, this command creates an empty Org table. But it is easier just to start typing, like @kbd{| N a m e | P h o n e | A g e @key{RET} | - @key{TAB}}. @end table @anchor{Re-aligning and field motion} @subheading Re-aligning and field motion @table @asis @item @kbd{C-c C-c} (@code{org-table-align}) @kindex C-c C-c @findex org-table-align Re-align the table without moving point. @item @kbd{@key{TAB}} (@code{org-table-next-field}) @kindex TAB @findex org-table-next-field Re-align the table, move to the next field. Creates a new row if necessary. @item @kbd{C-c @key{SPC}} (@code{org-table-blank-field}) @kindex C-c SPC @findex org-table-blank-field Blank the field at point. @item @kbd{S-@key{TAB}} (@code{org-table-previous-field}) @kindex S-TAB @findex org-table-previous-field Re-align, move to previous field. @item @kbd{@key{RET}} (@code{org-table-next-row}) @kindex RET @findex org-table-next-row Re-align the table and move down to next row. Creates a new row if necessary. At the beginning or end of a line, @kbd{@key{RET}} still inserts a new line, so it can be used to split a table. @item @kbd{M-a} (@code{org-table-beginning-of-field}) @kindex M-a @findex org-table-beginning-of-field Move to beginning of the current table field, or on to the previous field. @item @kbd{M-e} (@code{org-table-end-of-field}) @kindex M-e @findex org-table-end-of-field Move to end of the current table field, or on to the next field. @end table @anchor{Column and row editing} @subheading Column and row editing @table @asis @item @kbd{M-@key{LEFT}} (@code{org-table-move-column-left}) @kindex M-LEFT @findex org-table-move-column-left Move the current column left. @item @kbd{M-@key{RIGHT}} (@code{org-table-move-column-right}) @kindex M-RIGHT @findex org-table-move-column-right Move the current column right. @item @kbd{M-S-@key{LEFT}} (@code{org-table-delete-column}) @kindex M-S-LEFT @findex org-table-delete-column Kill the current column. @item @kbd{M-S-@key{RIGHT}} (@code{org-table-insert-column}) @kindex M-S-RIGHT @findex org-table-insert-column Insert a new column at point position. Move the recent column and all cells to the right of this column to the right. @item @kbd{M-@key{UP}} (@code{org-table-move-row-up}) @kindex M-UP @findex org-table-move-row-up Move the current row up. @item @kbd{M-@key{DOWN}} (@code{org-table-move-row-down}) @kindex M-DOWN @findex org-table-move-row-down Move the current row down. @item @kbd{M-S-@key{UP}} (@code{org-table-kill-row}) @kindex M-S-UP @findex org-table-kill-row Kill the current row or horizontal line. @item @kbd{S-@key{UP}} (@code{org-table-move-cell-up}) @kindex S-UP @findex org-table-move-cell-up Move cell up by swapping with adjacent cell. @item @kbd{S-@key{DOWN}} (@code{org-table-move-cell-down}) @kindex S-DOWN @findex org-table-move-cell-down Move cell down by swapping with adjacent cell. @item @kbd{S-@key{LEFT}} (@code{org-table-move-cell-left}) @kindex S-LEFT @findex org-table-move-cell-left Move cell left by swapping with adjacent cell. @item @kbd{S-@key{RIGHT}} (@code{org-table-move-cell-right}) @kindex S-RIGHT @findex org-table-move-cell-right Move cell right by swapping with adjacent cell. @item @kbd{M-S-@key{DOWN}} (@code{org-table-insert-row}) @kindex M-S-DOWN @findex org-table-insert-row Insert a new row above the current row. With a prefix argument, the line is created below the current one. @item @kbd{C-c -} (@code{org-table-insert-hline}) @kindex C-c - @findex org-table-insert-hline Insert a horizontal line below current row. With a prefix argument, the line is created above the current line. @item @kbd{C-c @key{RET}} (@code{org-table-hline-and-move}) @kindex C-c RET @findex org-table-hline-and-move Insert a horizontal line below current row, and move point into the row below that line. @item @kbd{C-c ^} (@code{org-table-sort-lines}) @kindex C-c ^ @findex org-table-sort-lines Sort the table lines in the region. The position of point indicates the column to be used for sorting, and the range of lines is the range between the nearest horizontal separator lines, or the entire table. If point is before the first column, you are prompted for the sorting column. If there is an active region, the mark specifies the first line and the sorting column, while point should be in the last line to be included into the sorting. The command prompts for the sorting type, alphabetically, numerically, or by time. You can sort in normal or reverse order. You can also supply your own key extraction and comparison functions. When called with a prefix argument, alphabetic sorting is case-sensitive. @end table @anchor{Regions} @subheading Regions @table @asis @item @kbd{C-c C-x M-w} (@code{org-table-copy-region}) @kindex C-c C-x M-w @findex org-table-copy-region Copy a rectangular region from a table to a special clipboard. Point and mark determine edge fields of the rectangle. If there is no active region, copy just the current field. The process ignores horizontal separator lines. @item @kbd{C-c C-x C-w} (@code{org-table-cut-region}) @kindex C-c C-x C-w @findex org-table-cut-region Copy a rectangular region from a table to a special clipboard, and blank all fields in the rectangle. So this is the ``cut'' operation. @item @kbd{C-c C-x C-y} (@code{org-table-paste-rectangle}) @kindex C-c C-x C-y @findex org-table-paste-rectangle Paste a rectangular region into a table. The upper left corner ends up in the current field. All involved fields are overwritten. If the rectangle does not fit into the present table, the table is enlarged as needed. The process ignores horizontal separator lines. @item @kbd{M-@key{RET}} (@code{org-table-wrap-region}) @kindex M-RET @findex org-table-wrap-region Split the current field at point position and move the rest to the line below. If there is an active region, and both point and mark are in the same column, the text in the column is wrapped to minimum width for the given number of lines. A numeric prefix argument may be used to change the number of desired lines. If there is no region, but you specify a prefix argument, the current field is made blank, and the content is appended to the field above. @end table @anchor{Calculations} @subheading Calculations @cindex formula, in tables @cindex calculations, in tables @table @asis @item @kbd{C-c +} (@code{org-table-sum}) @kindex C-c + @findex org-table-sum Sum the numbers in the current column, or in the rectangle defined by the active region. The result is shown in the echo area and can be inserted with @kbd{C-y}. @item @kbd{S-@key{RET}} (@code{org-table-copy-down}) @kindex S-RET @findex org-table-copy-down @vindex org-table-copy-increment When current field is empty, copy from first non-empty field above. When not empty, copy current field down to next row and move point along with it. Depending on the variable @code{org-table-copy-increment}, integer and time stamp field values, and fields prefixed or suffixed with a whole number, can be incremented during copy. Also, a @code{0} prefix argument temporarily disables the increment. This key is also used by shift-selection and related modes (see @ref{Conflicts}). @end table @anchor{Miscellaneous (1)} @subheading Miscellaneous @table @asis @item @kbd{C-c `} (@code{org-table-edit-field}) @kindex C-c ` @findex org-table-edit-field Edit the current field in a separate window. This is useful for fields that are not fully visible (see @ref{Column Width and Alignment}). When called with a @kbd{C-u} prefix, just make the full field visible, so that it can be edited in place. When called with two @kbd{C-u} prefixes, make the editor window follow point through the table and always show the current field. The follow mode exits automatically when point leaves the table, or when you repeat this command with @kbd{C-u C-u C-c `}. @item @kbd{M-x org-table-import} @findex org-table-import Import a file as a table. The table should be TAB or whitespace separated. Use, for example, to import a spreadsheet table or data from a database, because these programs generally can write TAB-separated text files. This command works by inserting the file into the buffer and then converting the region to a table. Any prefix argument is passed on to the converter, which uses it to determine the separator. @item @kbd{C-c |} (@code{org-table-create-or-convert-from-region}) @kindex C-c | @findex org-table-create-or-convert-from-region Tables can also be imported by pasting tabular text into the Org buffer, selecting the pasted text with @kbd{C-x C-x} and then using the @kbd{C-c |} command (see @ref{Creation and conversion}). @item @kbd{M-x org-table-export} @findex org-table-export @vindex org-table-export-default-format Export the table, by default as a TAB-separated file. Use for data exchange with, for example, spreadsheet or database programs. The format used to export the file can be configured in the variable @code{org-table-export-default-format}. You may also use properties @samp{TABLE_EXPORT_FILE} and @samp{TABLE_EXPORT_FORMAT} to specify the file name and the format for table export in a subtree. Org supports quite general formats for exported tables. The exporter format is the same as the format used by Orgtbl radio tables, see @ref{Translator functions}, for a detailed description. @item @kbd{M-x org-table-header-line-mode} @findex org-table-header-line-mode @vindex org-table-header-line-p Turn on the display of the first data row of the table at point in the window header line when this first row is not visible anymore in the buffer. You can activate this minor mode by default by setting the option @code{org-table-header-line-p} to @code{t}. @item @kbd{M-x org-table-transpose-table-at-point} @findex org-table-transpose-table-at-point Transpose the table at point and eliminate hlines. @end table @node Column Width and Alignment @section Column Width and Alignment @cindex narrow columns in tables @cindex alignment in tables The width of columns is automatically determined by the table editor. The alignment of a column is determined automatically from the fraction of number-like versus non-number fields in the column. @vindex org-table-automatic-realign Editing a field may modify alignment of the table. Moving a contiguous row or column---i.e., using @kbd{@key{TAB}} or @kbd{@key{RET}}---automatically re-aligns it. If you want to disable this behavior, set @code{org-table-automatic-realign} to @code{nil}. In any case, you can always align manually a table: @table @asis @item @kbd{C-c C-c} (@code{org-table-align}) @kindex C-c C-c @findex org-table-align Align the current table. @end table @vindex org-startup-align-all-tables Setting the option @code{org-startup-align-all-tables} re-aligns all tables in a file upon visiting it. You can also set this option on a per-file basis with: @example #+STARTUP: align #+STARTUP: noalign @end example Sometimes a single field or a few fields need to carry more text, leading to inconveniently wide columns. Maybe you want to hide away several columns or display them with a fixed width, regardless of content, as shown in the following example. @example |---+---------------------+--------| |---+-------…+…| | | <6> | | | | <6> …|…| | 1 | one | some | ----\ | 1 | one …|…| | 2 | two | boring | ----/ | 2 | two …|…| | 3 | This is a long text | column | | 3 | This i…|…| |---+---------------------+--------| |---+-------…+…| @end example To set the width of a column, one field anywhere in the column may contain just the string @samp{} where @var{N} specifies the width as a number of characters. You control displayed width of columns with the following tools: @table @asis @item @kbd{C-c @key{TAB}} (@code{org-table-toggle-column-width}) @kindex C-c TAB @findex org-table-toggle-column-width Shrink or expand current column. If a width cookie specifies a width W for the column, shrinking it displays the first W visible characters only. Otherwise, the column is shrunk to a single character. When called before the first column or after the last one, ask for a list of column ranges to operate on. @item @kbd{C-u C-c @key{TAB}} (@code{org-table-shrink}) @kindex C-u C-c TAB @findex org-table-shrink Shrink all columns with a column width. Expand the others. @item @kbd{C-u C-u C-c @key{TAB}} (@code{org-table-expand}) @kindex C-u C-u C-c TAB @findex org-table-expand Expand all columns. @end table To see the full text of a shrunk field, hold the mouse over it: a tool-tip window then shows the full contents of the field. Alternatively, @kbd{C-h .} (@code{display-local-help}) reveals them, too. For convenience, any change near the shrunk part of a column expands it. @vindex org-startup-shrink-all-tables Setting the option @code{org-startup-shrink-all-tables} shrinks all columns containing a width cookie in a file the moment it is visited. You can also set this option on a per-file basis with: @example #+STARTUP: shrink @end example If you would like to overrule the automatic alignment of number-rich columns to the right and of string-rich columns to the left, you can use @samp{}, @samp{} or @samp{} in a similar fashion. You may also combine alignment and field width like this: @samp{}. Lines which only contain these formatting cookies are removed automatically upon exporting the document. @node Column Groups @section Column Groups @cindex grouping columns in tables When Org exports tables, it does so by default without vertical lines because that is visually more satisfying in general. Occasionally however, vertical lines can be useful to structure a table into groups of columns, much like horizontal lines can do for groups of rows. In order to specify column groups, you can use a special row where the first field contains only @samp{/}. The further fields can either contain @samp{<} to indicate that this column should start a group, @samp{>} to indicate the end of a column, or @samp{<>} (no space between @samp{<} and @samp{>}) to make a column a group of its own. Upon export, boundaries between column groups are marked with vertical lines. Here is an example: @example | N | N^2 | N^3 | N^4 | sqrt(n) | sqrt[4](N) | |---+-----+-----+-----+---------+------------| | / | < | | > | < | > | | 1 | 1 | 1 | 1 | 1 | 1 | | 2 | 4 | 8 | 16 | 1.4142 | 1.1892 | | 3 | 9 | 27 | 81 | 1.7321 | 1.3161 | |---+-----+-----+-----+---------+------------| #+TBLFM: $2=$1^2::$3=$1^3::$4=$1^4::$5=sqrt($1)::$6=sqrt(sqrt(($1))) @end example It is also sufficient to just insert the column group starters after every vertical line you would like to have: @example | N | N^2 | N^3 | N^4 | sqrt(n) | sqrt[4](N) | |---+-----+-----+-----+---------+------------| | / | < | | | < | | @end example @node Orgtbl Mode @section The Orgtbl Minor Mode @cindex Orgtbl mode @cindex minor mode for tables @findex orgtbl-mode If you like the intuitive way the Org table editor works, you might also want to use it in other modes like Text mode or Mail mode. The minor mode Orgtbl mode makes this possible. You can always toggle the mode with @kbd{M-x orgtbl-mode}. To turn it on by default, for example in Message mode, use @lisp (add-hook 'message-mode-hook 'turn-on-orgtbl) @end lisp Furthermore, with some special setup, it is possible to maintain tables in arbitrary syntax with Orgtbl mode. For example, it is possible to construct @LaTeX{} tables with the underlying ease and power of Orgtbl mode, including spreadsheet capabilities. For details, see @ref{Tables in Arbitrary Syntax}. @node The Spreadsheet @section The Spreadsheet @cindex calculations, in tables @cindex spreadsheet capabilities @cindex Calc package The table editor makes use of the Emacs Calc package to implement spreadsheet-like capabilities. It can also evaluate Emacs Lisp forms to derive fields from other fields. While fully featured, Org's implementation is not identical to other spreadsheets. For example, Org knows the concept of a @emph{column formula} that will be applied to all non-header fields in a column without having to copy the formula to each relevant field. There is also a formula debugger, and a formula editor with features for highlighting fields in the table corresponding to the references at point in the formula, moving these references by arrow keys. @menu * References:: How to refer to another field or range. * Formula syntax for Calc:: Using Calc to compute stuff. * Formula syntax for Lisp:: Writing formulas in Emacs Lisp. * Durations and time values:: How to compute durations and time values. * Field and range formulas:: Formula for specific (ranges of) fields. * Column formulas:: Formulas valid for an entire column. * Lookup functions:: Lookup functions for searching tables. * Editing and debugging formulas:: Fixing formulas. * Updating the table:: Recomputing all dependent fields. * Advanced features:: Field and column names, automatic recalculation... @end menu @node References @subsection References @cindex references To compute fields in the table from other fields, formulas must reference other fields or ranges. In Org, fields can be referenced by name, by absolute coordinates, and by relative coordinates. To find out what the coordinates of a field are, press @kbd{C-c ?} in that field, or press @kbd{C-c @}} to toggle the display of a grid. @anchor{Field references} @subsubheading Field references @cindex field references @cindex references, to fields Formulas can reference the value of another field in two ways. Like in any other spreadsheet, you may reference fields with a letter/number combination like @samp{B3}, meaning the second field in the third row. However, Org prefers to use another, more general representation that looks like this:@footnote{Org understands references typed by the user as @samp{B4}, but it does not use this syntax when offering a formula for editing. You can customize this behavior using the variable @code{org-table-use-standard-references}.} @example @@ROW$COLUMN @end example Column specifications can be absolute like @samp{$1}, @samp{$2}, @dots{}, @samp{$N}, or relative to the current column, i.e., the column of the field which is being computed, like @samp{$+1} or @samp{$-2}. @samp{$<} and @samp{$>} are immutable references to the first and last column, respectively, and you can use @samp{$>>>} to indicate the third column from the right. The row specification only counts data lines and ignores horizontal separator lines, or ``hlines''. Like with columns, you can use absolute row numbers @samp{@@1}, @samp{@@2}, @dots{}, @samp{@@N}, and row numbers relative to the current row like @samp{@@+3} or @samp{@@-1}. @samp{@@<} and @samp{@@>} are immutable references the first and last row in the table, respectively. You may also specify the row relative to one of the hlines: @samp{@@I} refers to the first hline, @samp{@@II} to the second, etc. @samp{@@-I} refers to the first such line above the current line, @samp{@@+I} to the first such line below the current line. You can also write @samp{@@III+2} which is the second data line after the third hline in the table. @samp{@@0} and @samp{$0} refer to the current row and column, respectively, i.e., to the row/column for the field being computed. Also, if you omit either the column or the row part of the reference, the current row/column is implied. Org's references with @emph{unsigned} numbers are fixed references in the sense that if you use the same reference in the formula for two different fields, the same field is referenced each time. Org's references with @emph{signed} numbers are floating references because the same reference operator can reference different fields depending on the field being calculated by the formula. Here are a few examples: @multitable @columnfractions 0.2 0.8 @item @samp{@@2$3} @tab 2nd row, 3rd column (same as @samp{C2}) @item @samp{$5} @tab column 5 in the current row (same as @samp{E&}) @item @samp{@@2} @tab current column, row 2 @item @samp{@@-1$-3} @tab field one row up, three columns to the left @item @samp{@@-I$2} @tab field just under hline above current row, column 2 @item @samp{@@>$5} @tab field in the last row, in column 5 @end multitable @anchor{Range references} @subsubheading Range references @cindex range references @cindex references, to ranges You may reference a rectangular range of fields by specifying two field references connected by two dots @samp{..}. The ends are included in the range. If both fields are in the current row, you may simply use @samp{$2..$7}, but if at least one field is in a different row, you need to use the general @samp{@@ROW$COLUMN} format at least for the first field, i.e., the reference must start with @samp{@@} in order to be interpreted correctly. Examples: @multitable @columnfractions 0.2 0.8 @item @samp{$1..$3} @tab first three fields in the current row @item @samp{$P..$Q} @tab range, using column names (see @ref{Advanced features}) @item @samp{$<<<..$>>} @tab start in third column, continue to the last but one @item @samp{@@2$1..@@4$3} @tab nine fields between these two fields (same as @samp{A2..C4}) @item @samp{@@-1$-2..@@-1} @tab 3 fields in the row above, starting from 2 columns on the left @item @samp{@@I..II} @tab between first and second hline, short for @samp{@@I..@@II} @end multitable @noindent Range references return a vector of values that can be fed into Calc vector functions. Empty fields in ranges are normally suppressed, so that the vector contains only the non-empty fields. For other options with the mode switches @samp{E}, @samp{N} and examples, see @ref{Formula syntax for Calc}. @anchor{Field coordinates in formulas} @subsubheading Field coordinates in formulas @cindex field coordinates @cindex coordinates, of field @cindex row, of field coordinates @cindex column, of field coordinates @vindex org-table-current-column @vindex org-table-current-dline One of the very first actions during evaluation of Calc formulas and Lisp formulas is to substitute @samp{@@#} and @samp{$#} in the formula with the row or column number of the field where the current result will go to. The traditional Lisp formula equivalents are @code{org-table-current-dline} and @code{org-table-current-column}. Examples: @table @asis @item @samp{if(@@# % 2, $#, string(""))} Insert column number on odd rows, set field to empty on even rows. @item @samp{$2 = '(identity remote(FOO, @@@@#$1))} Copy text or values of each row of column 1 of the table named @var{FOO} into column 2 of the current table. @item @samp{@@3 = 2 * remote(FOO, @@1$$#)} Insert the doubled value of each column of row 1 of the table named @var{FOO} into row 3 of the current table. @end table @noindent For the second and third examples, table @var{FOO} must have at least as many rows or columns as the current table. Note that this is inefficient@footnote{The computation time scales as O(N^2) because table @var{FOO} is parsed for each field to be copied.} for large number of rows. @anchor{Named references} @subsubheading Named references @cindex named references @cindex references, named @cindex name, of column or field @cindex constants, in calculations @cindex @samp{CONSTANTS}, keyword @vindex org-table-formula-constants @samp{$name} is interpreted as the name of a column, parameter or constant. Constants are defined globally through the variable @code{org-table-formula-constants}, and locally---for the file---through a line like this example: @example #+CONSTANTS: c=299792458. pi=3.14 eps=2.4e-6 @end example @vindex constants-unit-system @pindex constants.el Also, properties (see @ref{Properties and Columns}) can be used as constants in table formulas: for a property @samp{Xyz} use the name @samp{$PROP_Xyz}, and the property will be searched in the current outline entry and in the hierarchy above it. If you have the @samp{constants.el} package, it will also be used to resolve constants, including natural constants like @samp{$h} for Planck's constant, and units like @samp{$km} for kilometers@footnote{The file @samp{constants.el} can supply the values of constants in two different unit systems, @samp{SI} and @samp{cgs}. Which one is used depends on the value of the variable @code{constants-unit-system}. You can use the @samp{STARTUP} options @samp{constSI} and @samp{constcgs} to set this value for the current buffer.}. Column names and parameters can be specified in special table lines. These are described below, see @ref{Advanced features}. All names must start with a letter, and further consist of letters and numbers. @anchor{Remote references} @subsubheading Remote references @cindex remote references @cindex references, remote @cindex references, to a different table @cindex name, of column or field @cindex @samp{NAME}, keyword You may also reference constants, fields and ranges from a different table, either in the current file or even in a different file. The syntax is @example remote(NAME,REF) @end example @noindent where @var{NAME} can be the name of a table in the current file as set by a @samp{#+NAME:} line before the table. It can also be the ID of an entry, even in a different file, and the reference then refers to the first table in that entry. @var{REF} is an absolute field or range reference as described above for example @samp{@@3$3} or @samp{$somename}, valid in the referenced table. @cindex table indirection When @var{NAME} has the format @samp{@@ROW$COLUMN}, it is substituted with the name or ID found in this field of the current table. For example @samp{remote($1, @@@@>$2)} @result{} @samp{remote(year_2013, @@@@>$1)}. The format @samp{B3} is not supported because it can not be distinguished from a plain table name or ID@. @node Formula syntax for Calc @subsection Formula syntax for Calc @cindex formula syntax, Calc @cindex syntax, of formulas A formula can be any algebraic expression understood by the Emacs Calc package. Note that Calc has the non-standard convention that @samp{/} has lower precedence than @samp{*}, so that @samp{a/b*c} is interpreted as @samp{(a/(b*c))}. Before evaluation by @code{calc-eval} (see @ref{Calling Calc from Your Programs,Calling Calc from Your Lisp Programs,,calc,}), variable substitution takes place according to the rules described above. @cindex vectors, in table calculations The range vectors can be directly fed into the Calc vector functions like @code{vmean} and @code{vsum}. @cindex format specifier, in spreadsheet @cindex mode, for Calc @vindex org-calc-default-modes A formula can contain an optional mode string after a semicolon. This string consists of flags to influence Calc and other modes during execution. By default, Org uses the standard Calc modes (precision 12, angular units degrees, fraction and symbolic modes off). The display format, however, has been changed to @samp{(float 8)} to keep tables compact. The default settings can be configured using the variable @code{org-calc-default-modes}. @table @asis @item @samp{p20} Set the internal Calc calculation precision to 20 digits. @item @samp{n3}, @samp{s3}, @samp{e2}, @samp{f4} Normal, scientific, engineering or fixed format of the result of Calc passed back to Org. Calc formatting is unlimited in precision as long as the Calc calculation precision is greater. @item @samp{D}, @samp{R} Degree and radian angle modes of Calc. @item @samp{F}, @samp{S} Fraction and symbolic modes of Calc. @item @samp{T}, @samp{t}, @samp{U} Duration computations in Calc or Lisp, @ref{Durations and time values}. @item @samp{E} If and how to consider empty fields. Without @samp{E} empty fields in range references are suppressed so that the Calc vector or Lisp list contains only the non-empty fields. With @samp{E} the empty fields are kept. For empty fields in ranges or empty field references the value @samp{nan} (not a number) is used in Calc formulas and the empty string is used for Lisp formulas. Add @samp{N} to use 0 instead for both formula types. For the value of a field the mode @samp{N} has higher precedence than @samp{E}. @item @samp{N} Interpret all fields as numbers, use 0 for non-numbers. See the next section to see how this is essential for computations with Lisp formulas. In Calc formulas it is used only occasionally because there number strings are already interpreted as numbers without @samp{N}. @item @samp{L} Literal, for Lisp formulas only. See the next section. @end table Unless you use large integer numbers or high-precision calculation and display for floating point numbers you may alternatively provide a @code{printf} format specifier to reformat the Calc result after it has been passed back to Org instead of letting Calc already do the formatting@footnote{The printf reformatting is limited in precision because the value passed to it is converted into an ``integer'' or ``double''. The ``integer'' is limited in size by truncating the signed value to 32 bits. The ``double'' is limited in precision to 64 bits overall which leaves approximately 16 significant decimal digits.}. A few examples: @multitable {aaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaa} {aaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaa} @item @samp{$1+$2} @tab Sum of first and second field @item @samp{$1+$2;%.2f} @tab Same, format result to two decimals @item @samp{exp($2)+exp($1)} @tab Math functions can be used @item @samp{$0;%.1f} @tab Reformat current cell to 1 decimal @item @samp{($3-32)*5/9} @tab Degrees F @arrow{} C conversion @item @samp{$c/$1/$cm} @tab Hz @arrow{} cm conversion, using @samp{constants.el} @item @samp{tan($1);Dp3s1} @tab Compute in degrees, precision 3, display SCI 1 @item @samp{sin($1);Dp3%.1e} @tab Same, but use @code{printf} specifier for display @item @samp{vmean($2..$7)} @tab Compute column range mean, using vector function @item @samp{vmean($2..$7);EN} @tab Same, but treat empty fields as 0 @item @samp{taylor($3,x=7,2)} @tab Taylor series of $3, at x=7, second degree @end multitable Calc also contains a complete set of logical operations (see @ref{Logical Operations,Logical Operations,,calc,}). For example @table @asis @item @samp{if($1 < 20, teen, string(""))} @samp{"teen"} if age @samp{$1} is less than 20, else the Org table result field is set to empty with the empty string. @item @samp{if("$1" =​= "nan" || "$2" =​= "nan", string(""), $1 + $2); E f-1} Sum of the first two columns. When at least one of the input fields is empty the Org table result field is set to empty. @samp{E} is required to not convert empty fields to 0. @samp{f-1} is an optional Calc format string similar to @samp{%.1f} but leaves empty results empty. @item @samp{if(typeof(vmean($1..$7)) =​= 12, string(""), vmean($1..$7); E} Mean value of a range unless there is any empty field. Every field in the range that is empty is replaced by @samp{nan} which lets @samp{vmean} result in @samp{nan}. Then @samp{typeof =} 12= detects the @samp{nan} from @code{vmean} and the Org table result field is set to empty. Use this when the sample set is expected to never have missing values. @item @samp{if("$1..$7" =​= "[]", string(""), vmean($1..$7))} Mean value of a range with empty fields skipped. Every field in the range that is empty is skipped. When all fields in the range are empty the mean value is not defined and the Org table result field is set to empty. Use this when the sample set can have a variable size. @item @samp{vmean($1..$7); EN} To complete the example before: Mean value of a range with empty fields counting as samples with value 0. Use this only when incomplete sample sets should be padded with 0 to the full size. @end table You can add your own Calc functions defined in Emacs Lisp with @code{defmath} and use them in formula syntax for Calc. @node Formula syntax for Lisp @subsection Emacs Lisp forms as formulas @cindex Lisp forms, as table formulas It is also possible to write a formula in Emacs Lisp. This can be useful for string manipulation and control structures, if Calc's functionality is not enough. If a formula starts with a single-quote followed by an opening parenthesis, then it is evaluated as a Lisp form. The evaluation should return either a string or a number. Just as with Calc formulas, you can specify modes and a @code{printf} format after a semicolon. With Emacs Lisp forms, you need to be conscious about the way field references are interpolated into the form. By default, a reference is interpolated as a Lisp string (in double-quotes) containing the field. If you provide the @samp{N} mode switch, all referenced elements are numbers---non-number fields will be zero---and interpolated as Lisp numbers, without quotes. If you provide the @samp{L} flag, all fields are interpolated literally, without quotes. For example, if you want a reference to be interpreted as a string by the Lisp form, enclose the reference operator itself in double-quotes, like @samp{"$3"}. Ranges are inserted as space-separated fields, so you can embed them in list or vector syntax. Here are a few examples---note how the @samp{N} mode is used when we do computations in Lisp: @table @asis @item @samp{'(concat (substring $1 1 2) (substring $1 0 1) (substring $1 2))} Swap the first two characters of the content of column 1. @item @samp{'(+ $1 $2);N} Add columns 1 and 2, equivalent to Calc's @samp{$1+$2}. @item @samp{'(apply '+ '($1..$4));N} Compute the sum of columns 1 to 4, like Calc's @samp{vsum($1..$4)}. @end table @node Durations and time values @subsection Durations and time values @cindex duration, computing @cindex time, computing @vindex org-table-duration-custom-format If you want to compute time values use the @samp{T}, @samp{t}, or @samp{U} flag, either in Calc formulas or Elisp formulas: @example | Task 1 | Task 2 | Total | |---------+----------+----------| | 2:12 | 1:47 | 03:59:00 | | 2:12 | 1:47 | 03:59 | | 3:02:20 | -2:07:00 | 0.92 | #+TBLFM: @@2$3=$1+$2;T::@@3$3=$1+$2;U::@@4$3=$1+$2;t @end example Input duration values must be of the form @samp{HH:MM[:SS]}, where seconds are optional. With the @samp{T} flag, computed durations are displayed as @samp{HH:MM:SS} (see the first formula above). With the @samp{U} flag, seconds are omitted so that the result is only @samp{HH:MM} (see second formula above). Zero-padding of the hours field depends upon the value of the variable @code{org-table-duration-hour-zero-padding}. With the @samp{t} flag, computed durations are displayed according to the value of the option @code{org-table-duration-custom-format}, which defaults to @code{hours} and displays the result as a fraction of hours (see the third formula in the example above). Negative duration values can be manipulated as well, and integers are considered as seconds in addition and subtraction. @node Field and range formulas @subsection Field and range formulas @cindex field formula @cindex range formula @cindex formula, for individual table field @cindex formula, for range of fields To assign a formula to a particular field, type it directly into the field, preceded by @samp{:=}, for example @samp{vsum(@@II..III)}. When you press @kbd{@key{TAB}} or @kbd{@key{RET}} or @kbd{C-c C-c} with point still in the field, the formula is stored as the formula for this field, evaluated, and the current field is replaced with the result. @cindex @samp{TBLFM}, keyword Formulas are stored in a special @samp{TBLFM} keyword located directly below the table. If you type the equation in the fourth field of the third data line in the table, the formula looks like @samp{@@3$4=$1+$2}. When inserting/deleting/swapping column and rows with the appropriate commands, @emph{absolute references} (but not relative ones) in stored formulas are modified in order to still reference the same field. To avoid this from happening, in particular in range references, anchor ranges at the table borders (using @samp{@@<}, @samp{@@>}, @samp{$<}, @samp{$>}), or at hlines using the @samp{@@I} notation. Automatic adaptation of field references does not happen if you edit the table structure with normal editing commands---you must fix the formulas yourself. Instead of typing an equation into the field, you may also use the following command @table @asis @item @kbd{C-u C-c =} (@code{org-table-eval-formula}) @kindex C-u C-c = @findex org-table-eval-formula Install a new formula for the current field. The command prompts for a formula with default taken from the @samp{TBLFM} keyword, applies it to the current field, and stores it. @end table The left-hand side of a formula can also be a special expression in order to assign the formula to a number of different fields. There is no keyboard shortcut to enter such range formulas. To add them, use the formula editor (see @ref{Editing and debugging formulas}) or edit the @samp{TBLFM} keyword directly. @table @asis @item @samp{$2=} Column formula, valid for the entire column. This is so common that Org treats these formulas in a special way, see @ref{Column formulas}. @item @samp{@@3=} Row formula, applies to all fields in the specified row. @samp{@@>=} means the last row. @item @samp{@@1$2..@@4$3=} Range formula, applies to all fields in the given rectangular range. This can also be used to assign a formula to some but not all fields in a row. @item @samp{$NAME=} Named field, see @ref{Advanced features}. @end table @node Column formulas @subsection Column formulas @cindex column formula @cindex formula, for table column When you assign a formula to a simple column reference like @samp{$3=}, the same formula is used in all fields of that column, with the following very convenient exceptions: (i) If the table contains horizontal separator hlines with rows above and below, everything before the first such hline is considered part of the table @emph{header} and is not modified by column formulas. Therefore a header is mandatory when you use column formulas and want to add hlines to group rows, like for example to separate a total row at the bottom from the summand rows above. (ii) Fields that already get a value from a field/range formula are left alone by column formulas. These conditions make column formulas very easy to use. To assign a formula to a column, type it directly into any field in the column, preceded by an equal sign, like @samp{=$1+$2}. When you press @kbd{@key{TAB}} or @kbd{@key{RET}} or @kbd{C-c C-c} with point still in the field, the formula is stored as the formula for the current column, evaluated and the current field replaced with the result. If the field contains only @samp{=}, the previously stored formula for this column is used. For each column, Org only remembers the most recently used formula. In the @samp{TBLFM} keyword, column formulas look like @samp{$4=$1+$2}. The left-hand side of a column formula can not be the name of column, it must be the numeric column reference or @samp{$>}. Instead of typing an equation into the field, you may also use the following command: @table @asis @item @kbd{C-c =} (@code{org-table-eval-formula}) @kindex C-c = @findex org-table-eval-formula Install a new formula for the current column and replace current field with the result of the formula. The command prompts for a formula, with default taken from the @samp{TBLFM} keyword, applies it to the current field and stores it. With a numeric prefix argument, e.g., @kbd{C-5 C-c =}, the command applies it to that many consecutive fields in the current column. @end table @node Lookup functions @subsection Lookup functions @cindex lookup functions in tables @cindex table lookup functions Org has three predefined Emacs Lisp functions for lookups in tables. @table @asis @item @samp{(org-lookup-first VAL S-LIST R-LIST &optional PREDICATE)} @findex org-lookup-first Searches for the first element @var{S} in list @var{S-LIST} for which @lisp (PREDICATE VAL S) @end lisp is non-@code{nil}; returns the value from the corresponding position in list @var{R-LIST}. The default @var{PREDICATE} is @code{equal}. Note that the parameters @var{VAL} and @var{S} are passed to @var{PREDICATE} in the same order as the corresponding parameters are in the call to @code{org-lookup-first}, where @var{VAL} precedes @var{S-LIST}. If @var{R-LIST} is @code{nil}, the matching element @var{S} of @var{S-LIST} is returned. @item @samp{(org-lookup-last VAL S-LIST R-LIST &optional PREDICATE)} @findex org-lookup-last Similar to @code{org-lookup-first} above, but searches for the @emph{last} element for which @var{PREDICATE} is non-@code{nil}. @item @samp{(org-lookup-all VAL S-LIST R-LIST &optional PREDICATE)} @findex org-lookup-all Similar to @code{org-lookup-first}, but searches for @emph{all} elements for which @var{PREDICATE} is non-@code{nil}, and returns @emph{all} corresponding values. This function can not be used by itself in a formula, because it returns a list of values. However, powerful lookups can be built when this function is combined with other Emacs Lisp functions. @end table If the ranges used in these functions contain empty fields, the @samp{E} mode for the formula should usually be specified: otherwise empty fields are not included in @var{S-LIST} and/or @var{R-LIST} which can, for example, result in an incorrect mapping from an element of @var{S-LIST} to the corresponding element of @var{R-LIST}. These three functions can be used to implement associative arrays, count matching cells, rank results, group data, etc. For practical examples see @uref{https://orgmode.org/worg/org-tutorials/org-lookups.html, this tutorial on Worg}. @node Editing and debugging formulas @subsection Editing and debugging formulas @cindex formula editing @cindex editing, of table formulas @vindex org-table-use-standard-references You can edit individual formulas in the minibuffer or directly in the field. Org can also prepare a special buffer with all active formulas of a table. When offering a formula for editing, Org converts references to the standard format (like @samp{B3} or @samp{D&}) if possible. If you prefer to only work with the internal format (like @samp{@@3$2} or @samp{$4}), configure the variable @code{org-table-use-standard-references}. @table @asis @item @kbd{C-c =} or @kbd{C-u C-c =} (@code{org-table-eval-formula}) @kindex C-c = @kindex C-u C-c = @findex org-table-eval-formula Edit the formula associated with the current column/field in the minibuffer. See @ref{Column formulas}, and @ref{Field and range formulas}. @item @kbd{C-u C-u C-c =} (@code{org-table-eval-formula}) @kindex C-u C-u C-c = @findex org-table-eval-formula Re-insert the active formula (either a field formula, or a column formula) into the current field, so that you can edit it directly in the field. The advantage over editing in the minibuffer is that you can use the command @kbd{C-c ?}. @item @kbd{C-c ?} (@code{org-table-field-info}) @kindex C-c ? @findex org-table-field-info While editing a formula in a table field, highlight the field(s) referenced by the reference at point position in the formula. @item @kbd{C-c @}} (@code{org-table-toggle-coordinate-overlays}) @kindex C-c @} @findex org-table-toggle-coordinate-overlays Toggle the display of row and column numbers for a table, using overlays. These are updated each time the table is aligned; you can force it with @kbd{C-c C-c}. @item @kbd{C-c @{} (@code{org-table-toggle-formula-debugger}) @kindex C-c @{ @findex org-table-toggle-formula-debugger Toggle the formula debugger on and off. See below. @item @kbd{C-c '} (@code{org-table-edit-formulas}) @kindex C-c ' @findex org-table-edit-formulas Edit all formulas for the current table in a special buffer, where the formulas are displayed one per line. If the current field has an active formula, point in the formula editor marks it. While inside the special buffer, Org automatically highlights any field or range reference at point position. You may edit, remove and add formulas, and use the following commands: @table @asis @item @kbd{C-c C-c} or @kbd{C-x C-s} (@code{org-table-fedit-finish}) @kindex C-x C-s @kindex C-c C-c @findex org-table-fedit-finish Exit the formula editor and store the modified formulas. With @kbd{C-u} prefix, also apply the new formulas to the entire table. @item @kbd{C-c C-q} (@code{org-table-fedit-abort}) @kindex C-c C-q @findex org-table-fedit-abort Exit the formula editor without installing changes. @item @kbd{C-c C-r} (@code{org-table-fedit-toggle-ref-type}) @kindex C-c C-r @findex org-table-fedit-toggle-ref-type Toggle all references in the formula editor between standard (like @samp{B3}) and internal (like @samp{@@3$2}). @item @kbd{@key{TAB}} (@code{org-table-fedit-lisp-indent}) @kindex TAB @findex org-table-fedit-lisp-indent Pretty-print or indent Lisp formula at point. When in a line containing a Lisp formula, format the formula according to Emacs Lisp rules. Another @kbd{@key{TAB}} collapses the formula back again. In the open formula, @kbd{@key{TAB}} re-indents just like in Emacs Lisp mode. @item @kbd{M-@key{TAB}} (@code{lisp-complete-symbol}) @kindex M-TAB @findex lisp-complete-symbol Complete Lisp symbols, just like in Emacs Lisp mode. @item @kbd{S-@key{UP}}, @kbd{S-@key{DOWN}}, @kbd{S-@key{LEFT}}, @kbd{S-@key{RIGHT}} @kindex S-UP @kindex S-DOWN @kindex S-LEFT @kindex S-RIGHT @findex org-table-fedit-ref-up @findex org-table-fedit-ref-down @findex org-table-fedit-ref-left @findex org-table-fedit-ref-right Shift the reference at point. For example, if the reference is @samp{B3} and you press @kbd{S-@key{RIGHT}}, it becomes @samp{C3}. This also works for relative references and for hline references. @item @kbd{M-S-@key{UP}} (@code{org-table-fedit-line-up}) @kindex M-S-UP @findex org-table-fedit-line-up Move the test line for column formulas up in the Org buffer. @item @kbd{M-S-@key{DOWN}} (@code{org-table-fedit-line-down}) @kindex M-S-DOWN @findex org-table-fedit-line-down Move the test line for column formulas down in the Org buffer. @item @kbd{M-@key{UP}} (@code{org-table-fedit-scroll-up}) @kindex M-UP @findex org-table-fedit-scroll-up Scroll up the window displaying the table. @item @kbd{M-@key{DOWN}} (@code{org-table-fedit-scroll-down}) @kindex M-DOWN @findex org-table-fedit-scroll-down Scroll down the window displaying the table. @item @kbd{C-c @}} @kindex C-c @} @findex org-table-toggle-coordinate-overlays Turn the coordinate grid in the table on and off. @end table @end table Making a table field blank does not remove the formula associated with the field, because that is stored in a different line---the @samp{TBLFM} keyword line. During the next recalculation, the field will be filled again. To remove a formula from a field, you have to give an empty reply when prompted for the formula, or to edit the @samp{TBLFM} keyword. @kindex C-c C-c You may edit the @samp{TBLFM} keyword directly and re-apply the changed equations with @kbd{C-c C-c} in that line or with the normal recalculation commands in the table. @anchor{Using multiple @samp{TBLFM} lines} @subsubheading Using multiple @samp{TBLFM} lines @cindex multiple formula lines @cindex @samp{TBLFM} keywords, multiple @cindex @samp{TBLFM}, switching @kindex C-c C-c You may apply the formula temporarily. This is useful when you want to switch the formula applied to the table. Place multiple @samp{TBLFM} keywords right after the table, and then press @kbd{C-c C-c} on the formula to apply. Here is an example: @example | x | y | |---+---| | 1 | | | 2 | | #+TBLFM: $2=$1*1 #+TBLFM: $2=$1*2 @end example @noindent Pressing @kbd{C-c C-c} in the line of @samp{#+TBLFM: $2=$1*2} yields: @example | x | y | |---+---| | 1 | 2 | | 2 | 4 | #+TBLFM: $2=$1*1 #+TBLFM: $2=$1*2 @end example @noindent If you recalculate this table, with @kbd{C-u C-c *}, for example, you get the following result from applying only the first @samp{TBLFM} keyword. @example | x | y | |---+---| | 1 | 1 | | 2 | 2 | #+TBLFM: $2=$1*1 #+TBLFM: $2=$1*2 @end example @anchor{Debugging formulas} @subsubheading Debugging formulas @cindex formula debugging @cindex debugging, of table formulas When the evaluation of a formula leads to an error, the field content becomes the string @samp{#ERROR}. If you would like to see what is going on during variable substitution and calculation in order to find a bug, turn on formula debugging in the Tbl menu and repeat the calculation, for example by pressing @kbd{C-u C-u C-c = @key{RET}} in a field. Detailed information are displayed. @node Updating the table @subsection Updating the table @cindex recomputing table fields @cindex updating, table Recalculation of a table is normally not automatic, but needs to be triggered by a command. To make recalculation at least semi-automatic, see @ref{Advanced features}. In order to recalculate a line of a table or the entire table, use the following commands: @table @asis @item @kbd{C-c *} (@code{org-table-recalculate}) @kindex C-c * @findex org-table-recalculate Recalculate the current row by first applying the stored column formulas from left to right, and all field/range formulas in the current row. @item @kbd{C-u C-c *} or @kbd{C-u C-c C-c} @kindex C-u C-c * @kindex C-u C-c C-c Recompute the entire table, line by line. Any lines before the first hline are left alone, assuming that these are part of the table header. @item @kbd{C-u C-u C-c *} or @kbd{C-u C-u C-c C-c} (@code{org-table-iterate}) @kindex C-u C-u C-c * @kindex C-u C-u C-c C-c @findex org-table-iterate Iterate the table by recomputing it until no further changes occur. This may be necessary if some computed fields use the value of other fields that are computed @emph{later} in the calculation sequence. @item @kbd{M-x org-table-recalculate-buffer-tables} @findex org-table-recalculate-buffer-tables Recompute all tables in the current buffer. @item @kbd{M-x org-table-iterate-buffer-tables} @findex org-table-iterate-buffer-tables Iterate all tables in the current buffer, in order to converge table-to-table dependencies. @end table @node Advanced features @subsection Advanced features If you want the recalculation of fields to happen automatically, or if you want to be able to assign @emph{names}@footnote{Such names must start with an alphabetic character and use only alphanumeric/underscore characters.} to fields and columns, you need to reserve the first column of the table for special marking characters. @table @asis @item @kbd{C-#} (@code{org-table-rotate-recalc-marks}) @kindex C-# @findex org-table-rotate-recalc-marks Rotate the calculation mark in first column through the states @samp{#}, @samp{*}, @samp{!}, @samp{$}. When there is an active region, change all marks in the region. @end table Here is an example of a table that collects exam results of students and makes use of these features: @example |---+---------+--------+--------+--------+-------+------| | | Student | Prob 1 | Prob 2 | Prob 3 | Total | Note | |---+---------+--------+--------+--------+-------+------| | ! | | P1 | P2 | P3 | Tot | | | # | Maximum | 10 | 15 | 25 | 50 | 10.0 | | ^ | | m1 | m2 | m3 | mt | | |---+---------+--------+--------+--------+-------+------| | # | Peter | 10 | 8 | 23 | 41 | 8.2 | | # | Sam | 2 | 4 | 3 | 9 | 1.8 | |---+---------+--------+--------+--------+-------+------| | | Average | | | | 25.0 | | | ^ | | | | | at | | | $ | max=50 | | | | | | |---+---------+--------+--------+--------+-------+------| #+TBLFM: $6=vsum($P1..$P3)::$7=10*$Tot/$max;%.1f::$at=vmean(@@-II..@@-I);%.1f @end example @quotation Important Please note that for these special tables, recalculating the table with @kbd{C-u C-c *} only affects rows that are marked @samp{#} or @samp{*}, and fields that have a formula assigned to the field itself. The column formulas are not applied in rows with empty first field. @end quotation @cindex marking characters, tables The marking characters have the following meaning: @table @asis @item @samp{!} The fields in this line define names for the columns, so that you may refer to a column as @samp{$Tot} instead of @samp{$6}. @item @samp{^} This row defines names for the fields @emph{above} the row. With such a definition, any formula in the table may use @samp{$m1} to refer to the value @samp{10}. Also, if you assign a formula to a names field, it is stored as @samp{$name = ...}. @item @samp{_} Similar to @samp{^}, but defines names for the fields in the row @emph{below}. @item @samp{$} Fields in this row can define @emph{parameters} for formulas. For example, if a field in a @samp{$} row contains @samp{max=50}, then formulas in this table can refer to the value 50 using @samp{$max}. Parameters work exactly like constants, only that they can be defined on a per-table basis. @item @samp{#} Fields in this row are automatically recalculated when pressing @kbd{@key{TAB}} or @kbd{@key{RET}} or @kbd{S-@key{TAB}} in this row. Also, this row is selected for a global recalculation with @kbd{C-u C-c *}. Unmarked lines are left alone by this command. @item @samp{*} Selects this line for global recalculation with @kbd{C-u C-c *}, but not for automatic recalculation. Use this when automatic recalculation slows down editing too much. @item @samp{/} Do not export this line. Useful for lines that contain the narrowing @samp{} markers or column group markers. @end table Finally, just to whet your appetite for what can be done with the fantastic Calc package, here is a table that computes the Taylor series of degree n at location x for a couple of functions. @example |---+-------------+---+-----+--------------------------------------| | | Func | n | x | Result | |---+-------------+---+-----+--------------------------------------| | # | exp(x) | 1 | x | 1 + x | | # | exp(x) | 2 | x | 1 + x + x^2 / 2 | | # | exp(x) | 3 | x | 1 + x + x^2 / 2 + x^3 / 6 | | # | x^2+sqrt(x) | 2 | x=0 | x*(0.5 / 0) + x^2 (2 - 0.25 / 0) / 2 | | # | x^2+sqrt(x) | 2 | x=1 | 2 + 2.5 x - 2.5 + 0.875 (x - 1)^2 | | * | tan(x) | 3 | x | 0.0175 x + 1.77e-6 x^3 | |---+-------------+---+-----+--------------------------------------| #+TBLFM: $5=taylor($2,$4,$3);n3 @end example @node Org Plot @section Org Plot @cindex graph, in tables @cindex plot tables using Gnuplot Org Plot can produce graphs of information stored in Org tables, either graphically or in ASCII art. @anchor{Graphical plots using Gnuplot} @subheading Graphical plots using Gnuplot @cindex @samp{PLOT}, keyword Org Plot can produce 2D and 3D graphs of information stored in Org tables using @uref{http://www.gnuplot.info/, Gnuplot} and @uref{http://cars9.uchicago.edu/~ravel/software/gnuplot-mode.html, Gnuplot mode}. To see this in action, ensure that you have both Gnuplot and Gnuplot mode installed on your system, then call @kbd{C-c " g} or @kbd{M-x org-plot/gnuplot} on the following table. @example #+PLOT: title:"Citas" ind:1 deps:(3) type:2d with:histograms set:"yrange [0:]" | Sede | Max cites | H-index | |-----------+-----------+---------| | Chile | 257.72 | 21.39 | | Leeds | 165.77 | 19.68 | | Sao Paolo | 71.00 | 11.50 | | Stockholm | 134.19 | 14.33 | | Morelia | 257.56 | 17.67 | @end example Notice that Org Plot is smart enough to apply the table's headers as labels. Further control over the labels, type, content, and appearance of plots can be exercised through the @samp{PLOT} keyword preceding a table. See below for a complete list of Org Plot options. For more information and examples see the @uref{https://orgmode.org/worg/org-tutorials/org-plot.html, Org Plot tutorial}. @anchor{Plot options} @subsubheading Plot options @table @asis @item @samp{set} Specify any Gnuplot option to be set when graphing. @item @samp{title} Specify the title of the plot. @item @samp{ind} Specify which column of the table to use as the @samp{x} axis. @item @samp{deps} Specify the columns to graph as a Lisp style list, surrounded by parentheses and separated by spaces for example @samp{dep:(3 4)} to graph the third and fourth columns. Defaults to graphing all other columns aside from the @samp{ind} column. @item @samp{type} Specify whether the plot is @samp{2d}, @samp{3d}, or @samp{grid}. @item @samp{with} Specify a @samp{with} option to be inserted for every column being plotted, e.g., @samp{lines}, @samp{points}, @samp{boxes}, @samp{impulses}. Defaults to @samp{lines}. @item @samp{file} If you want to plot to a file, specify @samp{"path/to/desired/output-file"}. @item @samp{labels} List of labels to be used for the @samp{deps}. Defaults to the column headers if they exist. @item @samp{line} Specify an entire line to be inserted in the Gnuplot script. @item @samp{map} When plotting @samp{3d} or @samp{grid} types, set this to @samp{t} to graph a flat mapping rather than a @samp{3d} slope. @item @samp{timefmt} Specify format of Org mode timestamps as they will be parsed by Gnuplot. Defaults to @samp{%Y-%m-%d-%H:%M:%S}. @item @samp{script} If you want total control, you can specify a script file---place the file name between double-quotes---which will be used to plot. Before plotting, every instance of @samp{$datafile} in the specified script will be replaced with the path to the generated data file. Note: even if you set this option, you may still want to specify the plot type, as that can impact the content of the data file. @end table @anchor{ASCII bar plots} @subheading ASCII bar plots While point is on a column, typing @kbd{C-c `` a} or @kbd{M-x orgtbl-ascii-plot} create a new column containing an ASCII-art bars plot. The plot is implemented through a regular column formula. When the source column changes, the bar plot may be updated by refreshing the table, for example typing @kbd{C-u C-c *}. @example | Sede | Max cites | | |---------------+-----------+--------------| | Chile | 257.72 | WWWWWWWWWWWW | | Leeds | 165.77 | WWWWWWWh | | Sao Paolo | 71.00 | WWW; | | Stockholm | 134.19 | WWWWWW: | | Morelia | 257.56 | WWWWWWWWWWWH | | Rochefourchat | 0.00 | | #+TBLFM: $3='(orgtbl-ascii-draw $2 0.0 257.72 12) @end example The formula is an Elisp call. @defun orgtbl-ascii-draw value min max &optional width Draw an ASCII bar in a table. @var{VALUE} is the value to plot. @var{MIN} is the value displayed as an empty bar. @var{MAX} is the value filling all the @var{WIDTH}. Sources values outside this range are displayed as @samp{too small} or @samp{too large}. @var{WIDTH} is the number of characters of the bar plot. It defaults to @samp{12}. @end defun @node Hyperlinks @chapter Hyperlinks @cindex hyperlinks Like HTML, Org provides support for links inside a file, external links to other files, Usenet articles, emails, and much more. @menu * Link Format:: How links in Org are formatted. * Internal Links:: Links to other places in the current file. * Radio Targets:: Make targets trigger links in plain text. * External Links:: URL-like links to the world. * Handling Links:: Creating, inserting and following. * Using Links Outside Org:: Linking from my C source code? * Link Abbreviations:: Shortcuts for writing complex links. * Search Options:: Linking to a specific location. * Custom Searches:: When the default search is not enough. @end menu @node Link Format @section Link Format @cindex link format @cindex format, of links @cindex angle bracket links @cindex plain links Org recognizes plain URIs, possibly wrapped within angle brackets@footnote{Plain URIs are recognized only for a well-defined set of schemes. See @ref{External Links}. Unlike URI syntax, they cannot contain parenthesis or white spaces, either. URIs within angle brackets have no such limitation.}, and activate them as clickable links. @cindex bracket links The general link format, however, looks like this: @example [[LINK][DESCRIPTION]] @end example @noindent or alternatively @example [[LINK]] @end example @cindex escape syntax, for links @cindex backslashes, in links Some @samp{\}, @samp{[} and @samp{]} characters in the @var{LINK} part need to be ``escaped'', i.e., preceded by another @samp{\} character. More specifically, the following characters, and only them, must be escaped: @enumerate @item all @samp{[} and @samp{]} characters, @item every @samp{\} character preceding either @samp{]} or @samp{[}, @item every @samp{\} character at the end of the link. @end enumerate @findex org-link-escape Functions inserting links (see @ref{Handling Links}) properly escape ambiguous characters. You only need to bother about the rules above when inserting directly, or yanking, a URI within square brackets. When in doubt, you may use the function @code{org-link-escape}, which turns a link string into its escaped form. Once a link in the buffer is complete, with all brackets present, Org changes the display so that @samp{DESCRIPTION} is displayed instead of @samp{[[LINK][DESCRIPTION]]} and @samp{LINK} is displayed instead of @samp{[[LINK]]}. Links are highlighted in the @code{org-link} face, which, by default, is an underlined face. You can directly edit the visible part of a link. This can be either the @var{LINK} part, if there is no description, or the @var{DESCRIPTION} part otherwise. To also edit the invisible @var{LINK} part, use @kbd{C-c C-l} with point on the link (see @ref{Handling Links}). If you place point at the beginning or just behind the end of the displayed text and press @kbd{@key{BS}}, you remove the---invisible---bracket at that location@footnote{More accurately, the precise behavior depends on how point arrived there---see @ref{Invisible Text,Invisible Text,,elisp,}.}. This makes the link incomplete and the internals are again displayed as plain text. Inserting the missing bracket hides the link internals again. To show the internal structure of all links, use the menu: Org @arrow{} Hyperlinks @arrow{} Literal links. @node Internal Links @section Internal Links @cindex internal links @cindex links, internal A link that does not look like a URL---i.e., does not start with a known scheme or a file name---refers to the current document. You can follow it with @kbd{C-c C-o} when point is on the link, or with a mouse click (see @ref{Handling Links}). @cindex @samp{CUSTOM_ID}, property Org provides several refinements to internal navigation within a document. Most notably, a construct like @samp{[[#my-custom-id]]} specifically targets the entry with the @samp{CUSTOM_ID} property set to @samp{my-custom-id}. Also, an internal link looking like @samp{[[*Some section]]} points to a headline with the name @samp{Some section}@footnote{To insert a link targeting a headline, in-buffer completion can be used. Just type a star followed by a few optional letters into the buffer and press @kbd{M-@key{TAB}}. All headlines in the current buffer are offered as completions.}. @cindex targets, for links When the link does not belong to any of the cases above, Org looks for a @emph{dedicated target}: the same string in double angular brackets, like @samp{<>}. @cindex @samp{NAME}, keyword If no dedicated target exists, the link tries to match the exact name of an element within the buffer. Naming is done, unsurprisingly, with the @samp{NAME} keyword, which has to be put in the line before the element it refers to, as in the following example @example #+NAME: My Target | a | table | |----+------------| | of | four cells | @end example @vindex org-link-search-must-match-exact-headline Ultimately, if none of the above succeeds, Org searches for a headline that is exactly the link text but may also include a TODO keyword and tags, or initiates a plain text search, according to the value of @code{org-link-search-must-match-exact-headline}. Note that you must make sure custom IDs, dedicated targets, and names are unique throughout the document. Org provides a linter to assist you in the process, if needed. See @ref{Org Syntax}. During export, internal links are used to mark objects and assign them a number. Marked objects are then referenced by links pointing to them. In particular, links without a description appear as the number assigned to the marked object@footnote{When targeting a @samp{NAME} keyword, the @samp{CAPTION} keyword is mandatory in order to get proper numbering (see @ref{Captions}).}. In the following excerpt from an Org buffer @example 1. one item 2. <>another item Here we refer to item [[target]]. @end example @noindent The last sentence will appear as @samp{Here we refer to item 2} when exported. In non-Org files, the search looks for the words in the link text. In the above example the search would be for @samp{target}. Following a link pushes a mark onto Org's own mark ring. You can return to the previous position with @kbd{C-c &}. Using this command several times in direct succession goes back to positions recorded earlier. @node Radio Targets @section Radio Targets @cindex radio targets @cindex targets, radio @cindex links, radio targets Org can automatically turn any occurrences of certain target names in normal text into a link. So without explicitly creating a link, the text connects to the target radioing its position. Radio targets are enclosed by triple angular brackets. For example, a target @samp{<<>>} causes each occurrence of @samp{my target} in normal text to become activated as a link. The Org file is scanned automatically for radio targets only when the file is first loaded into Emacs. To update the target list during editing, press @kbd{C-c C-c} with point on or at a target. @node External Links @section External Links @cindex links, external @cindex external links @cindex attachment links @cindex BBDB links @cindex Elisp links @cindex file links @cindex Gnus links @cindex Help links @cindex IRC links @cindex Info links @cindex MH-E links @cindex Rmail links @cindex shell links @cindex URL links @cindex Usenet links Org supports links to files, websites, Usenet and email messages, BBDB database entries and links to both IRC conversations and their logs. External links are URL-like locators. They start with a short identifying string followed by a colon. There can be no space after the colon. Here is the full set of built-in link types: @table @asis @item @samp{file} File links. File name may be remote, absolute, or relative. Additionally, you can specify a line number, or a text search. In Org files, you may link to a headline name, a custom ID, or a code reference instead. As a special case, ``file'' prefix may be omitted if the file name is complete, e.g., it starts with @samp{./}, or @samp{/}. @item @samp{attachment} Same as file links but for files and folders attached to the current node (see @ref{Attachments}). Attachment links are intended to behave exactly as file links but for files relative to the attachment directory. @item @samp{bbdb} Link to a BBDB record, with possible regexp completion. @item @samp{docview} Link to a document opened with DocView mode. You may specify a page number. @item @samp{doi} Link to an electronic resource, through its handle. @item @samp{elisp} Execute an Elisp command upon activation. @item @samp{gnus}, @samp{rmail}, @samp{mhe} Link to messages or folders from a given Emacs' MUA@. @item @samp{help} Display documentation of a symbol in @samp{*Help*} buffer. @item @samp{http}, @samp{https} Web links. @item @samp{id} Link to a specific headline by its ID property, in an Org file. @item @samp{info} Link to an Info manual, or to a specific node. @item @samp{irc} Link to an IRC channel. @item @samp{mailto} Link to message composition. @item @samp{news} Usenet links. @item @samp{shell} Execute a shell command upon activation. @end table The following table illustrates the link types above, along with their options: @multitable {aaaaaaaaaa} {aaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaa} @headitem Link Type @tab Example @item http @tab @samp{http://staff.science.uva.nl/c.dominik/} @item https @tab @samp{https://orgmode.org/} @item doi @tab @samp{doi:10.1000/182} @item file @tab @samp{file:/home/dominik/images/jupiter.jpg} @item @tab @samp{/home/dominik/images/jupiter.jpg} (same as above) @item @tab @samp{file:papers/last.pdf} @item @tab @samp{./papers/last.pdf} (same as above) @item @tab @samp{file:/ssh:me@@some.where:papers/last.pdf} (remote) @item @tab @samp{/ssh:me@@some.where:papers/last.pdf} (same as above) @item @tab @samp{file:sometextfile::NNN} (jump to line number) @item @tab @samp{file:projects.org} @item @tab @samp{file:projects.org::some words} (text search)@footnote{The actual behavior of the search depends on the value of the variable @code{org-link-search-must-match-exact-headline}. If its value is @code{nil}, then a fuzzy text search is done. If it is @code{t}, then only the exact headline is matched, ignoring spaces and statistic cookies. If the value is @code{query-to-create}, then an exact headline is searched; if it is not found, then the user is queried to create it.} @item @tab @samp{file:projects.org::*task title} (headline search) @item @tab @samp{file:projects.org::#custom-id} (headline search) @item attachment @tab @samp{attachment:projects.org} @item @tab @samp{attachment:projects.org::some words} (text search) @item docview @tab @samp{docview:papers/last.pdf::NNN} @item id @tab @samp{id:B7423F4D-2E8A-471B-8810-C40F074717E9} @item news @tab @samp{news:comp.emacs} @item mailto @tab @samp{mailto:adent@@galaxy.net} @item mhe @tab @samp{mhe:folder} (folder link) @item @tab @samp{mhe:folder#id} (message link) @item rmail @tab @samp{rmail:folder} (folder link) @item @tab @samp{rmail:folder#id} (message link) @item gnus @tab @samp{gnus:group} (group link) @item @tab @samp{gnus:group#id} (article link) @item bbdb @tab @samp{bbdb:R.*Stallman} (record with regexp) @item irc @tab @samp{irc:/irc.com/#emacs/bob} @item help @tab @samp{help:org-store-link} @item info @tab @samp{info:org#External links} @item shell @tab @samp{shell:ls *.org} @item elisp @tab @samp{elisp:(find-file "Elisp.org")} (Elisp form to evaluate) @item @tab @samp{elisp:org-agenda} (interactive Elisp command) @end multitable @cindex VM links @cindex Wanderlust links On top of these built-in link types, additional ones are available through the @samp{contrib/} directory (see @ref{Installation}). For example, these links to VM or Wanderlust messages are available when you load the corresponding libraries from the @samp{contrib/} directory: @multitable {aaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaa} {aaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaa} @item @samp{vm:folder} @tab VM folder link @item @samp{vm:folder#id} @tab VM message link @item @samp{vm://myself@@some.where.org/folder#id} @tab VM on remote machine @item @samp{vm-imap:account:folder} @tab VM IMAP folder link @item @samp{vm-imap:account:folder#id} @tab VM IMAP message link @item @samp{wl:folder} @tab Wanderlust folder link @item @samp{wl:folder#id} @tab Wanderlust message link @end multitable For information on customizing Org to add new link types, see @ref{Adding Hyperlink Types}. A link should be enclosed in double brackets and may contain descriptive text to be displayed instead of the URL (see @ref{Link Format}), for example: @example [[https://www.gnu.org/software/emacs/][GNU Emacs]] @end example If the description is a file name or URL that points to an image, HTML export (see @ref{HTML Export}) inlines the image as a clickable button. If there is no description at all and the link points to an image, that image is inlined into the exported HTML file. @cindex square brackets, around links @cindex angular brackets, around links @cindex plain text external links Org also recognizes external links amid normal text and activates them as links. If spaces must be part of the link (for example in @samp{bbdb:R.*Stallman}), or if you need to remove ambiguities about the end of the link, enclose the link in square or angular brackets. @node Handling Links @section Handling Links @cindex links, handling Org provides methods to create a link in the correct syntax, to insert it into an Org file, and to follow the link. @findex org-store-link @cindex storing links The main function is @code{org-store-link}, called with @kbd{M-x org-store-link}. Because of its importance, we suggest to bind it to a widely available key (see @ref{Activation}). It stores a link to the current location. The link is stored for later insertion into an Org buffer---see below. The kind of link that is created depends on the current buffer: @table @asis @item @emph{Org mode buffers} For Org files, if there is a @samp{<>} at point, the link points to the target. Otherwise it points to the current headline, which is also the description@footnote{If the headline contains a timestamp, it is removed from the link, which results in a wrong link---you should avoid putting a timestamp in the headline.}. @vindex org-id-link-to-org-use-id @cindex @samp{CUSTOM_ID}, property @cindex @samp{ID}, property If the headline has a @samp{CUSTOM_ID} property, store a link to this custom ID@. In addition or alternatively, depending on the value of @code{org-id-link-to-org-use-id}, create and/or use a globally unique @samp{ID} property for the link@footnote{The Org Id library must first be loaded, either through @code{org-customize}, by enabling @code{id} in @code{org-modules}, or by adding @samp{(require 'org-id)} in your Emacs init file.}. So using this command in Org buffers potentially creates two links: a human-readable link from the custom ID, and one that is globally unique and works even if the entry is moved from file to file. Later, when inserting the link, you need to decide which one to use. @item @emph{Email/News clients: VM, Rmail, Wanderlust, MH-E, Gnus} @vindex org-link-email-description-format Pretty much all Emacs mail clients are supported. The link points to the current article, or, in some Gnus buffers, to the group. The description is constructed according to the variable @code{org-link-email-description-format}. By default, it refers to the addressee and the subject. @item @emph{Web browsers: W3, W3M and EWW} Here the link is the current URL, with the page title as the description. @item @emph{Contacts: BBDB} Links created in a BBDB buffer point to the current entry. @item @emph{Chat: IRC} @vindex org-irc-links-to-logs For IRC links, if the variable @code{org-irc-link-to-logs} is non-@code{nil}, create a @samp{file} style link to the relevant point in the logs for the current conversation. Otherwise store an @samp{irc} style link to the user/channel/server under the point. @item @emph{Other files} For any other file, the link points to the file, with a search string (see @ref{Search Options}) pointing to the contents of the current line. If there is an active region, the selected words form the basis of the search string. You can write custom Lisp functions to select the search string and perform the search for particular file types (see @ref{Custom Searches}). You can also define dedicated links to other files. See @ref{Adding Hyperlink Types}. @item @emph{Agenda view} When point is in an agenda view, the created link points to the entry referenced by the current line. @end table From an Org buffer, the following commands create, navigate or, more generally, act on links. @table @asis @item @kbd{C-c C-l} (@code{org-insert-link}) @kindex C-c C-l @findex org-insert-link @cindex link completion @cindex completion, of links @cindex inserting links @vindex org-link-keep-stored-after-insertion Insert a link@footnote{Note that you do not have to use this command to insert a link. Links in Org are plain text, and you can type or paste them straight into the buffer. By using this command, the links are automatically enclosed in double brackets, and you will be asked for the optional descriptive text.}. This prompts for a link to be inserted into the buffer. You can just type a link, using text for an internal link, or one of the link type prefixes mentioned in the examples above. The link is inserted into the buffer, along with a descriptive text@footnote{After insertion of a stored link, the link will be removed from the list of stored links. To keep it in the list for later use, use a triple @kbd{C-u} prefix argument to @kbd{C-c C-l}, or configure the option @code{org-link-keep-stored-after-insertion}.}. If some text was selected at this time, it becomes the default description. @table @asis @item @emph{Inserting stored links} All links stored during the current session are part of the history for this prompt, so you can access them with @kbd{@key{UP}} and @kbd{@key{DOWN}} (or @kbd{M-p}, @kbd{M-n}). @item @emph{Completion support} Completion with @kbd{@key{TAB}} helps you to insert valid link prefixes like @samp{http} or @samp{ftp}, including the prefixes defined through link abbreviations (see @ref{Link Abbreviations}). If you press @kbd{@key{RET}} after inserting only the prefix, Org offers specific completion support for some link types@footnote{This works if a function has been defined in the @code{:complete} property of a link in @code{org-link-parameters}.}. For example, if you type @kbd{f i l e @key{RET}}---alternative access: @kbd{C-u C-c C-l}, see below---Org offers file name completion, and after @kbd{b b d b @key{RET}} you can complete contact names. @end table @item @kbd{C-u C-c C-l} @cindex file name completion @cindex completion, of file names @kindex C-u C-c C-l When @kbd{C-c C-l} is called with a @kbd{C-u} prefix argument, insert a link to a file. You may use file name completion to select the name of the file. The path to the file is inserted relative to the directory of the current Org file, if the linked file is in the current directory or in a sub-directory of it, or if the path is written relative to the current directory using @samp{../}. Otherwise an absolute path is used, if possible with @samp{~/} for your home directory. You can force an absolute path with two @kbd{C-u} prefixes. @item @kbd{C-c C-l} (with point on existing link) @cindex following links When point is on an existing link, @kbd{C-c C-l} allows you to edit the link and description parts of the link. @item @kbd{C-c C-o} (@code{org-open-at-point}) @kindex C-c C-o @findex org-open-at-point @vindex org-file-apps Open link at point. This launches a web browser for URL (using @code{browse-url-at-point}), run VM/MH-E/Wanderlust/Rmail/Gnus/BBDB for the corresponding links, and execute the command in a shell link. When point is on an internal link, this command runs the corresponding search. When point is on the tags part of a headline, it creates the corresponding tags view (see @ref{Matching tags and properties}). If point is on a timestamp, it compiles the agenda for that date. Furthermore, it visits text and remote files in @samp{file} links with Emacs and select a suitable application for local non-text files. Classification of files is based on file extension only. See option @code{org-file-apps}. If you want to override the default application and visit the file with Emacs, use a @kbd{C-u} prefix. If you want to avoid opening in Emacs, use a @kbd{C-u C-u} prefix. @vindex org-link-frame-setup If point is on a headline, but not on a link, offer all links in the headline and entry text. If you want to setup the frame configuration for following links, customize @code{org-link-frame-setup}. @item @kbd{@key{RET}} @vindex org-return-follows-link @kindex RET When @code{org-return-follows-link} is set, @kbd{@key{RET}} also follows the link at point. @item @kbd{mouse-2} or @kbd{mouse-1} @kindex mouse-2 @kindex mouse-1 On links, @kbd{mouse-1} and @kbd{mouse-2} opens the link just as @kbd{C-c C-o} does. @item @kbd{mouse-3} @vindex org-link-use-indirect-buffer-for-internals @kindex mouse-3 Like @kbd{mouse-2}, but force file links to be opened with Emacs, and internal links to be displayed in another window@footnote{See the variable @code{org-link-use-indirect-buffer-for-internals}.}. @item @kbd{C-c %} (@code{org-mark-ring-push}) @kindex C-c % @findex org-mark-ring-push @cindex mark ring Push the current position onto the Org mark ring, to be able to return easily. Commands following an internal link do this automatically. @item @kbd{C-c &} (@code{org-mark-ring-goto}) @kindex C-c & @findex org-mark-ring-goto @cindex links, returning to Jump back to a recorded position. A position is recorded by the commands following internal links, and by @kbd{C-c %}. Using this command several times in direct succession moves through a ring of previously recorded positions. @item @kbd{C-c C-x C-n} (@code{org-next-link}) @itemx @kbd{C-c C-x C-p} (@code{org-previous-link}) @kindex C-c C-x C-p @findex org-previous-link @kindex C-c C-x C-n @findex org-next-link @cindex links, finding next/previous Move forward/backward to the next link in the buffer. At the limit of the buffer, the search fails once, and then wraps around. The key bindings for this are really too long; you might want to bind this also to @kbd{M-n} and @kbd{M-p}. @lisp (with-eval-after-load 'org (define-key org-mode-map (kbd "M-n") 'org-next-link) (define-key org-mode-map (kbd "M-p") 'org-previous-link)) @end lisp @end table @node Using Links Outside Org @section Using Links Outside Org @findex org-insert-link-global @findex org-open-at-point-global You can insert and follow links that have Org syntax not only in Org, but in any Emacs buffer. For this, Org provides two functions: @code{org-insert-link-global} and @code{org-open-at-point-global}. You might want to bind them to globally available keys. See @ref{Activation} for some advice. @node Link Abbreviations @section Link Abbreviations @cindex link abbreviations @cindex abbreviation, links Long URL can be cumbersome to type, and often many similar links are needed in a document. For this you can use link abbreviations. An abbreviated link looks like this @example [[linkword:tag][description]] @end example @noindent @vindex org-link-abbrev-alist where the tag is optional. The @emph{linkword} must be a word, starting with a letter, followed by letters, numbers, @samp{-}, and @samp{_}. Abbreviations are resolved according to the information in the variable @code{org-link-abbrev-alist} that relates the linkwords to replacement text. Here is an example: @lisp (setq org-link-abbrev-alist '(("bugzilla" . "http://10.1.2.9/bugzilla/show_bug.cgi?id=") ("Nu Html Checker" . "https://validator.w3.org/nu/?doc=%h") ("duckduckgo" . "https://duckduckgo.com/?q=%s") ("omap" . "http://nominatim.openstreetmap.org/search?q=%s&polygon=1") ("ads" . "https://ui.adsabs.harvard.edu/search/q=%20author%3A\"%s\""))) @end lisp If the replacement text contains the string @samp{%s}, it is replaced with the tag. Using @samp{%h} instead of @samp{%s} percent-encodes the tag (see the example above, where we need to encode the URL parameter). Using @samp{%(my-function)} passes the tag to a custom Lisp function, and replace it by the resulting string. If the replacement text do not contain any specifier, it is simply appended to the string in order to create the link. Instead of a string, you may also specify a Lisp function to create the link. Such a function will be called with the tag as the only argument. With the above setting, you could link to a specific bug with @samp{[[bugzilla:129]]}, search the web for @samp{OrgMode} with @samp{[[duckduckgo:OrgMode]]}, show the map location of the Free Software Foundation @samp{[[gmap:51 Franklin Street, Boston]]} or of Carsten office @samp{[[omap:Science Park 904, Amsterdam, The Netherlands]]} and find out what the Org author is doing besides Emacs hacking with @samp{[[ads:Dominik,C]]}. If you need special abbreviations just for a single Org buffer, you can define them in the file with @cindex @samp{LINK}, keyword @example #+LINK: bugzilla http://10.1.2.9/bugzilla/show_bug.cgi?id= #+LINK: duckduckgo https://duckduckgo.com/?q=%s @end example In-buffer completion (see @ref{Completion}) can be used after @samp{[} to complete link abbreviations. You may also define a Lisp function that implements special (e.g., completion) support for inserting such a link with @kbd{C-c C-l}. Such a function should not accept any arguments, and should return the full link with a prefix. You can set the link completion function like this: @lisp (org-link-set-parameter "type" :complete #'some-completion-function) @end lisp @node Search Options @section Search Options in File Links @cindex search option in file links @cindex file links, searching @cindex attachment links, searching File links can contain additional information to make Emacs jump to a particular location in the file when following a link. This can be a line number or a search option after a double colon@footnote{For backward compatibility, line numbers can also follow a single colon.}. For example, when the command @code{org-store-link} creates a link (see @ref{Handling Links}) to a file, it encodes the words in the current line as a search string that can be used to find this line back later when following the link with @kbd{C-c C-o}. Note that all search options apply for Attachment links in the same way that they apply for File links. Here is the syntax of the different ways to attach a search to a file link, together with explanations for each: @example [[file:~/code/main.c::255]] [[file:~/xx.org::My Target]] [[file:~/xx.org::*My Target]] [[file:~/xx.org::#my-custom-id]] [[file:~/xx.org::/regexp/]] [[attachment:main.c::255]] @end example @table @asis @item @samp{255} Jump to line 255. @item @samp{My Target} Search for a link target @samp{<>}, or do a text search for @samp{my target}, similar to the search in internal links, see @ref{Internal Links}. In HTML export (see @ref{HTML Export}), such a file link becomes a HTML reference to the corresponding named anchor in the linked file. @item @samp{*My Target} In an Org file, restrict search to headlines. @item @samp{#my-custom-id} Link to a heading with a @samp{CUSTOM_ID} property @item @samp{/REGEXP/} Do a regular expression search for @var{REGEXP}. This uses the Emacs command @code{occur} to list all matches in a separate window. If the target file is in Org mode, @code{org-occur} is used to create a sparse tree with the matches. @end table As a degenerate case, a file link with an empty file name can be used to search the current file. For example, @samp{[[file:::find me]]} does a search for @samp{find me} in the current file, just as @samp{[[find me]]} would. @node Custom Searches @section Custom Searches @cindex custom search strings @cindex search strings, custom The default mechanism for creating search strings and for doing the actual search related to a file link may not work correctly in all cases. For example, Bib@TeX{} database files have many entries like @code{year="1993"} which would not result in good search strings, because the only unique identification for a Bib@TeX{} entry is the citation key. @vindex org-create-file-search-functions @vindex org-execute-file-search-functions If you come across such a problem, you can write custom functions to set the right search string for a particular file type, and to do the search for the string in the file. Using @code{add-hook}, these functions need to be added to the hook variables @code{org-create-file-search-functions} and @code{org-execute-file-search-functions}. See the docstring for these variables for more information. Org actually uses this mechanism for Bib@TeX{} database files, and you can use the corresponding code as an implementation example. See the file @samp{ol-bibtex.el}. @node TODO Items @chapter TODO Items @cindex TODO items Org mode does not maintain TODO lists as separate documents@footnote{Of course, you can make a document that contains only long lists of TODO items, but this is not required.}. Instead, TODO items are an integral part of the notes file, because TODO items usually come up while taking notes! With Org mode, simply mark any entry in a tree as being a TODO item. In this way, information is not duplicated, and the entire context from which the TODO item emerged is always present. Of course, this technique for managing TODO items scatters them throughout your notes file. Org mode compensates for this by providing methods to give you an overview of all the things that you have to do. @menu * TODO Basics:: Marking and displaying TODO entries. * TODO Extensions:: Workflow and assignments. * Progress Logging:: Dates and notes for progress. * Priorities:: Some things are more important than others. * Breaking Down Tasks:: Splitting a task into manageable pieces. * Checkboxes:: Tick-off lists. @end menu @node TODO Basics @section Basic TODO Functionality Any headline becomes a TODO item when it starts with the word @samp{TODO}, for example: @example *** TODO Write letter to Sam Fortune @end example The most important commands to work with TODO entries are: @table @asis @item @kbd{C-c C-t} (@code{org-todo}) @kindex C-c C-t @cindex cycling, of TODO states Rotate the TODO state of the current item among @example ,-> (unmarked) -> TODO -> DONE --. '--------------------------------' @end example If TODO keywords have fast access keys (see @ref{Fast access to TODO states}), prompt for a TODO keyword through the fast selection interface; this is the default behavior when @code{org-use-fast-todo-selection} is non-@code{nil}. The same state changing can also be done ``remotely'' from the agenda buffer with the @kbd{t} command key (see @ref{Agenda Commands}). @item @kbd{S-@key{RIGHT}} @kbd{S-@key{LEFT}} @kindex S-RIGHT @kindex S-LEFT @vindex org-treat-S-cursor-todo-selection-as-state-change Select the following/preceding TODO state, similar to cycling. Useful mostly if more than two TODO states are possible (see @ref{TODO Extensions}). See also @ref{Conflicts}, for a discussion of the interaction with shift-selection. See also the variable @code{org-treat-S-cursor-todo-selection-as-state-change}. @item @kbd{C-c / t} (@code{org-show-todo-tree}) @kindex C-c / t @cindex sparse tree, for TODO @vindex org-todo-keywords @findex org-show-todo-tree View TODO items in a @emph{sparse tree} (see @ref{Sparse Trees}). Folds the entire buffer, but shows all TODO items---with not-DONE state---and the headings hierarchy above them. With a prefix argument, or by using @kbd{C-c / T}, search for a specific TODO@. You are prompted for the keyword, and you can also give a list of keywords like @samp{KWD1|KWD2|...} to list entries that match any one of these keywords. With a numeric prefix argument N, show the tree for the Nth keyword in the variable @code{org-todo-keywords}. With two prefix arguments, find all TODO states, both un-done and done. @item @kbd{M-x org-agenda t} (@code{org-todo-list}) @kindex t @r{(Agenda dispatcher)} Show the global TODO list. Collects the TODO items (with not-DONE states) from all agenda files (see @ref{Agenda Views}) into a single buffer. The new buffer is in Org Agenda mode, which provides commands to examine and manipulate the TODO entries from the new buffer (see @ref{Agenda Commands}). See @ref{Global TODO list}, for more information. @item @kbd{S-M-@key{RET}} (@code{org-insert-todo-heading}) @kindex S-M-RET @findex org-insert-todo-heading Insert a new TODO entry below the current one. @end table @vindex org-todo-state-tags-triggers Changing a TODO state can also trigger tag changes. See the docstring of the option @code{org-todo-state-tags-triggers} for details. @node TODO Extensions @section Extended Use of TODO Keywords @cindex extended TODO keywords @vindex org-todo-keywords By default, marked TODO entries have one of only two states: TODO and DONE@. Org mode allows you to classify TODO items in more complex ways with @emph{TODO keywords} (stored in @code{org-todo-keywords}). With special setup, the TODO keyword system can work differently in different files. Note that @emph{tags} are another way to classify headlines in general and TODO items in particular (see @ref{Tags}). @menu * Workflow states:: From TODO to DONE in steps. * TODO types:: I do this, Fred does the rest. * Multiple sets in one file:: Mixing it all, still finding your way. * Fast access to TODO states:: Single letter selection of state. * Per-file keywords:: Different files, different requirements. * Faces for TODO keywords:: Highlighting states. * TODO dependencies:: When one task needs to wait for others. @end menu @node Workflow states @subsection TODO keywords as workflow states @cindex TODO workflow @cindex workflow states as TODO keywords You can use TODO keywords to indicate different, possibly @emph{sequential} states in the process of working on an item, for example@footnote{Changing the variable @code{org-todo-keywords} only becomes effective after restarting Org mode in a buffer.}: @lisp (setq org-todo-keywords '((sequence "TODO" "FEEDBACK" "VERIFY" "|" "DONE" "DELEGATED"))) @end lisp The vertical bar separates the TODO keywords (states that @emph{need action}) from the DONE states (which need @emph{no further action}). If you do not provide the separator bar, the last state is used as the DONE state. @cindex completion, of TODO keywords With this setup, the command @kbd{C-c C-t} cycles an entry from @samp{TODO} to @samp{FEEDBACK}, then to @samp{VERIFY}, and finally to @samp{DONE} and @samp{DELEGATED}. You may also use a numeric prefix argument to quickly select a specific state. For example @kbd{C-3 C-c C-t} changes the state immediately to @samp{VERIFY}. Or you can use @kbd{S-@key{RIGHT}} and @kbd{S-@key{LEFT}} to go forward and backward through the states. If you define many keywords, you can use in-buffer completion (see @ref{Completion}) or a special one-key selection scheme (see @ref{Fast access to TODO states}) to insert these words into the buffer. Changing a TODO state can be logged with a timestamp, see @ref{Tracking TODO state changes}, for more information. @node TODO types @subsection TODO keywords as types @cindex TODO types @cindex names as TODO keywords @cindex types as TODO keywords The second possibility is to use TODO keywords to indicate different @emph{types} of action items. For example, you might want to indicate that items are for ``work'' or ``home''. Or, when you work with several people on a single project, you might want to assign action items directly to persons, by using their names as TODO keywords. This type of functionality is actually much better served by using tags (see @ref{Tags}), so the TODO implementation is kept just for backward compatibility. Using TODO types, it would be set up like this: @lisp (setq org-todo-keywords '((type "Fred" "Sara" "Lucy" "|" "DONE"))) @end lisp In this case, different keywords do not indicate states, but rather different types. So the normal work flow would be to assign a task to a person, and later to mark it DONE@. Org mode supports this style by adapting the workings of the command @kbd{C-c C-t}@footnote{This is also true for the @kbd{t} command in the agenda buffer.}. When used several times in succession, it still cycles through all names, in order to first select the right type for a task. But when you return to the item after some time and execute @kbd{C-c C-t} again, it will switch from any name directly to @samp{DONE}. Use prefix arguments or completion to quickly select a specific name. You can also review the items of a specific TODO type in a sparse tree by using a numeric prefix to @kbd{C-c / t}. For example, to see all things Lucy has to do, you would use @kbd{C-3 C-c / t}. To collect Lucy's items from all agenda files into a single buffer, you would use the numeric prefix argument as well when creating the global TODO list: @kbd{C-3 M-x org-agenda t}. @node Multiple sets in one file @subsection Multiple keyword sets in one file @cindex TODO keyword sets Sometimes you may want to use different sets of TODO keywords in parallel. For example, you may want to have the basic TODO/DONE, but also a workflow for bug fixing, and a separate state indicating that an item has been canceled---so it is not DONE, but also does not require action. Your setup would then look like this: @lisp (setq org-todo-keywords '((sequence "TODO" "|" "DONE") (sequence "REPORT" "BUG" "KNOWNCAUSE" "|" "FIXED") (sequence "|" "CANCELED"))) @end lisp The keywords should all be different, this helps Org mode keep track of which subsequence should be used for a given entry. In this setup, @kbd{C-c C-t} only operates within a sub-sequence, so it switches from @samp{DONE} to (nothing) to @samp{TODO}, and from @samp{FIXED} to (nothing) to @samp{REPORT}. Therefore you need a mechanism to initially select the correct sequence. In addition to typing a keyword or using completion (see @ref{Completion}), you may also apply the following commands: @table @asis @item @kbd{C-u C-u C-c C-t} @itemx @kbd{C-S-@key{RIGHT}} @itemx @kbd{C-S-@key{LEFT}} @kindex C-S-RIGHT @kindex C-S-LEFT @kindex C-u C-u C-c C-t These keys jump from one TODO sub-sequence to the next. In the above example, @kbd{C-u C-u C-c C-t} or @kbd{C-S-@key{RIGHT}} would jump from @samp{TODO} or @samp{DONE} to @samp{REPORT}, and any of the words in the second row to @samp{CANCELED}. Note that the @kbd{C-S-} key binding conflict with shift-selection (see @ref{Conflicts}). @item @kbd{S-@key{RIGHT}} @itemx @kbd{S-@key{LEFT}} @kindex S-RIGHT @kindex S-LEFT @kbd{S-@key{LEFT}} and @kbd{S-@key{RIGHT}} walk through @emph{all} keywords from all sub-sequences, so for example @kbd{S-@key{RIGHT}} would switch from @samp{DONE} to @samp{REPORT} in the example above. For a discussion of the interaction with shift-selection, see @ref{Conflicts}. @end table @node Fast access to TODO states @subsection Fast access to TODO states If you would like to quickly change an entry to an arbitrary TODO state instead of cycling through the states, you can set up keys for single-letter access to the states. This is done by adding the selection character after each keyword, in parentheses@footnote{All characters are allowed except @samp{@@}, @samp{^} and @samp{!}, which have a special meaning here.}. For example: @lisp (setq org-todo-keywords '((sequence "TODO(t)" "|" "DONE(d)") (sequence "REPORT(r)" "BUG(b)" "KNOWNCAUSE(k)" "|" "FIXED(f)") (sequence "|" "CANCELED(c)"))) @end lisp @vindex org-fast-tag-selection-include-todo If you then press @kbd{C-c C-t} followed by the selection key, the entry is switched to this state. @kbd{@key{SPC}} can be used to remove any TODO keyword from an entry@footnote{Check also the variable @code{org-fast-tag-selection-include-todo}, it allows you to change the TODO state through the tags interface (see @ref{Setting Tags}), in case you like to mingle the two concepts. Note that this means you need to come up with unique keys across both sets of keywords.}. @node Per-file keywords @subsection Setting up keywords for individual files @cindex keyword options @cindex per-file keywords @cindex @samp{TODO}, keyword @cindex @samp{TYP_TODO}, keyword @cindex @samp{SEQ_TODO}, keyword It can be very useful to use different aspects of the TODO mechanism in different files. For file-local settings, you need to add special lines to the file which set the keywords and interpretation for that file only. For example, to set one of the two examples discussed above, you need one of the following lines, starting in column zero anywhere in the file: @example #+TODO: TODO FEEDBACK VERIFY | DONE CANCELED @end example You may also write @samp{#+SEQ_TODO} to be explicit about the interpretation, but it means the same as @samp{#+TODO}, or @example #+TYP_TODO: Fred Sara Lucy Mike | DONE @end example A setup for using several sets in parallel would be: @example #+TODO: TODO | DONE #+TODO: REPORT BUG KNOWNCAUSE | FIXED #+TODO: | CANCELED @end example @cindex completion, of option keywords @kindex M-TAB To make sure you are using the correct keyword, type @samp{#+} into the buffer and then use @kbd{M-@key{TAB}} to complete it (see @ref{Completion}). @cindex DONE, final TODO keyword Remember that the keywords after the vertical bar---or the last keyword if no bar is there---must always mean that the item is DONE, although you may use a different word. After changing one of these lines, use @kbd{C-c C-c} with point still in the line to make the changes known to Org mode@footnote{Org mode parses these lines only when Org mode is activated after visiting a file. @kbd{C-c C-c} with point in a line starting with @samp{#+} is simply restarting Org mode for the current buffer.}. @node Faces for TODO keywords @subsection Faces for TODO keywords @cindex faces, for TODO keywords @vindex org-todo, face @vindex org-done, face @vindex org-todo-keyword-faces Org mode highlights TODO keywords with special faces: @code{org-todo} for keywords indicating that an item still has to be acted upon, and @code{org-done} for keywords indicating that an item is finished. If you are using more than two different states, you might want to use special faces for some of them. This can be done using the variable @code{org-todo-keyword-faces}. For example: @lisp (setq org-todo-keyword-faces '(("TODO" . org-warning) ("STARTED" . "yellow") ("CANCELED" . (:foreground "blue" :weight bold)))) @end lisp @vindex org-faces-easy-properties While using a list with face properties as shown for @samp{CANCELED} @emph{should} work, this does not always seem to be the case. If necessary, define a special face and use that. A string is interpreted as a color. The variable @code{org-faces-easy-properties} determines if that color is interpreted as a foreground or a background color. @node TODO dependencies @subsection TODO dependencies @cindex TODO dependencies @cindex dependencies, of TODO states @vindex org-enforce-todo-dependencies @cindex @samp{ORDERED}, property The structure of Org files---hierarchy and lists---makes it easy to define TODO dependencies. Usually, a parent TODO task should not be marked as done until all TODO subtasks, or children tasks, are marked as done. Sometimes there is a logical sequence to (sub)tasks, so that one subtask cannot be acted upon before all siblings above it have been marked as done. If you customize the variable @code{org-enforce-todo-dependencies}, Org blocks entries from changing state to DONE while they have TODO children that are not DONE@. Furthermore, if an entry has a property @samp{ORDERED}, each of its TODO children is blocked until all earlier siblings are marked as done. Here is an example: @example * TODO Blocked until (two) is done ** DONE one ** TODO two * Parent :PROPERTIES: :ORDERED: t :END: ** TODO a ** TODO b, needs to wait for (a) ** TODO c, needs to wait for (a) and (b) @end example @cindex TODO dependencies, @samp{NOBLOCKING} @cindex @samp{NOBLOCKING}, property You can ensure an entry is never blocked by using the @samp{NOBLOCKING} property (see @ref{Properties and Columns}): @example * This entry is never blocked :PROPERTIES: :NOBLOCKING: t :END: @end example @table @asis @item @kbd{C-c C-x o} (@code{org-toggle-ordered-property}) @kindex C-c C-x o @findex org-toggle-ordered-property @vindex org-track-ordered-property-with-tag Toggle the @samp{ORDERED} property of the current entry. A property is used for this behavior because this should be local to the current entry, not inherited from entries above like a tag (see @ref{Tags}). However, if you would like to @emph{track} the value of this property with a tag for better visibility, customize the variable @code{org-track-ordered-property-with-tag}. @item @kbd{C-u C-u C-u C-c C-t} @kindex C-u C-u C-u C-u C-c C-t Change TODO state, regardless of any state blocking. @end table @vindex org-agenda-dim-blocked-tasks If you set the variable @code{org-agenda-dim-blocked-tasks}, TODO entries that cannot be marked as done because of unmarked children are shown in a dimmed font or even made invisible in agenda views (see @ref{Agenda Views}). @cindex checkboxes and TODO dependencies @vindex org-enforce-todo-dependencies You can also block changes of TODO states by using checkboxes (see @ref{Checkboxes}). If you set the variable @code{org-enforce-todo-checkbox-dependencies}, an entry that has unchecked checkboxes is blocked from switching to DONE@. If you need more complex dependency structures, for example dependencies between entries in different trees or files, check out the contributed module @samp{org-depend.el}. @node Progress Logging @section Progress Logging @cindex progress logging @cindex logging, of progress To record a timestamp and a note when changing a TODO state, call the command @code{org-todo} with a prefix argument. @table @asis @item @kbd{C-u C-c C-t} (@code{org-todo}) @kindex C-u C-c C-t Prompt for a note and record a the time of the TODO state change. The note is inserted as a list item below the headline, but can also be placed into a drawer, see @ref{Tracking TODO state changes}. @end table If you want to be more systematic, Org mode can automatically record a timestamp and optionally a note when you mark a TODO item as DONE, or even each time you change the state of a TODO item. This system is highly configurable, settings can be on a per-keyword basis and can be localized to a file or even a subtree. For information on how to clock working time for a task, see @ref{Clocking Work Time}. @menu * Closing items:: When was this entry marked as done? * Tracking TODO state changes:: When did the status change? * Tracking your habits:: How consistent have you been? @end menu @node Closing items @subsection Closing items The most basic automatic logging is to keep track of @emph{when} a certain TODO item was marked as done. This can be achieved with@footnote{The corresponding in-buffer setting is: @samp{#+STARTUP: logdone}.} @lisp (setq org-log-done 'time) @end lisp @vindex org-closed-keep-when-no-todo @noindent Then each time you turn an entry from a TODO (not-done) state into any of the DONE states, a line @samp{CLOSED: [timestamp]} is inserted just after the headline. If you turn the entry back into a TODO item through further state cycling, that line is removed again. If you turn the entry back to a non-TODO state (by pressing @kbd{C-c C-t @key{SPC}} for example), that line is also removed, unless you set @code{org-closed-keep-when-no-todo} to non-@code{nil}. If you want to record a note along with the timestamp, use@footnote{The corresponding in-buffer setting is: @samp{#+STARTUP: lognotedone}.} @lisp (setq org-log-done 'note) @end lisp @noindent You are then prompted for a note, and that note is stored below the entry with a @samp{Closing Note} heading. @node Tracking TODO state changes @subsection Tracking TODO state changes @cindex drawer, for state change recording @vindex org-log-states-order-reversed @vindex org-log-into-drawer @cindex @samp{LOG_INTO_DRAWER}, property You might want to automatically keep track of when a state change occurred and maybe take a note about this change. You can either record just a timestamp, or a time-stamped note. These records are inserted after the headline as an itemized list, newest first@footnote{See the variable @code{org-log-states-order-reversed}.}. When taking a lot of notes, you might want to get the notes out of the way into a drawer (see @ref{Drawers}). Customize the variable @code{org-log-into-drawer} to get this behavior---the recommended drawer for this is called @samp{LOGBOOK}@footnote{Note that the @samp{LOGBOOK} drawer is unfolded when pressing @kbd{@key{SPC}} in the agenda to show an entry---use @kbd{C-u @key{SPC}} to keep it folded here.}. You can also overrule the setting of this variable for a subtree by setting a @samp{LOG_INTO_DRAWER} property. Since it is normally too much to record a note for every state, Org mode expects configuration on a per-keyword basis for this. This is achieved by adding special markers @samp{!} (for a timestamp) or @samp{@@} (for a note with timestamp) in parentheses after each keyword. For example, with the setting @lisp (setq org-todo-keywords '((sequence "TODO(t)" "WAIT(w@@/!)" "|" "DONE(d!)" "CANCELED(c@@)"))) @end lisp @noindent To record a timestamp without a note for TODO keywords configured with @samp{@@}, just type @kbd{C-c C-c} to enter a blank note when prompted. @vindex org-log-done You not only define global TODO keywords and fast access keys, but also request that a time is recorded when the entry is set to @samp{DONE}, and that a note is recorded when switching to @samp{WAIT} or @samp{CANCELED}@footnote{It is possible that Org mode records two timestamps when you are using both @code{org-log-done} and state change logging. However, it never prompts for two notes: if you have configured both, the state change recording note takes precedence and cancel the closing note.}. The setting for @samp{WAIT} is even more special: the @samp{!} after the slash means that in addition to the note taken when entering the state, a timestamp should be recorded when @emph{leaving} the @samp{WAIT} state, if and only if the @emph{target} state does not configure logging for entering it. So it has no effect when switching from @samp{WAIT} to @samp{DONE}, because @samp{DONE} is configured to record a timestamp only. But when switching from @samp{WAIT} back to @samp{TODO}, the @samp{/!} in the @samp{WAIT} setting now triggers a timestamp even though @samp{TODO} has no logging configured. You can use the exact same syntax for setting logging preferences local to a buffer: @example #+TODO: TODO(t) WAIT(w@@/!) | DONE(d!) CANCELED(c@@) @end example @cindex @samp{LOGGING}, property In order to define logging settings that are local to a subtree or a single item, define a @samp{LOGGING} property in this entry. Any non-empty @samp{LOGGING} property resets all logging settings to @code{nil}. You may then turn on logging for this specific tree using @samp{STARTUP} keywords like @samp{lognotedone} or @samp{logrepeat}, as well as adding state specific settings like @samp{TODO(!)}. For example: @example * TODO Log each state with only a time :PROPERTIES: :LOGGING: TODO(!) WAIT(!) DONE(!) CANCELED(!) :END: * TODO Only log when switching to WAIT, and when repeating :PROPERTIES: :LOGGING: WAIT(@@) logrepeat :END: * TODO No logging at all :PROPERTIES: :LOGGING: nil :END: @end example @node Tracking your habits @subsection Tracking your habits @cindex habits @cindex @samp{STYLE}, property Org has the ability to track the consistency of a special category of TODO, called ``habits.'' To use habits, you have to enable the @code{habits} module by customizing the variable @code{org-modules}. A habit has the following properties: @enumerate @item The habit is a TODO item, with a TODO keyword representing an open state. @item The property @samp{STYLE} is set to the value @samp{habit} (see @ref{Properties and Columns}). @item The TODO has a scheduled date, usually with a @samp{.+} style repeat interval. A @samp{++} style may be appropriate for habits with time constraints, e.g., must be done on weekends, or a @samp{+} style for an unusual habit that can have a backlog, e.g., weekly reports. @item The TODO may also have minimum and maximum ranges specified by using the syntax @samp{.+2d/3d}, which says that you want to do the task at least every three days, but at most every two days. @item State logging for the DONE state is enabled (see @ref{Tracking TODO state changes}), in order for historical data to be represented in the consistency graph. If it is not enabled it is not an error, but the consistency graphs are largely meaningless. @end enumerate To give you an idea of what the above rules look like in action, here's an actual habit with some history: @example ** TODO Shave SCHEDULED: <2009-10-17 Sat .+2d/4d> :PROPERTIES: :STYLE: habit :LAST_REPEAT: [2009-10-19 Mon 00:36] :END: - State "DONE" from "TODO" [2009-10-15 Thu] - State "DONE" from "TODO" [2009-10-12 Mon] - State "DONE" from "TODO" [2009-10-10 Sat] - State "DONE" from "TODO" [2009-10-04 Sun] - State "DONE" from "TODO" [2009-10-02 Fri] - State "DONE" from "TODO" [2009-09-29 Tue] - State "DONE" from "TODO" [2009-09-25 Fri] - State "DONE" from "TODO" [2009-09-19 Sat] - State "DONE" from "TODO" [2009-09-16 Wed] - State "DONE" from "TODO" [2009-09-12 Sat] @end example What this habit says is: I want to shave at most every 2 days---given by the @samp{SCHEDULED} date and repeat interval---and at least every 4 days. If today is the 15th, then the habit first appears in the agenda (see @ref{Agenda Views}) on Oct 17, after the minimum of 2 days has elapsed, and will appear overdue on Oct 19, after four days have elapsed. What's really useful about habits is that they are displayed along with a consistency graph, to show how consistent you've been at getting that task done in the past. This graph shows every day that the task was done over the past three weeks, with colors for each day. The colors used are: @table @asis @item Blue If the task was not to be done yet on that day. @item Green If the task could have been done on that day. @item Yellow If the task was going to be overdue the next day. @item Red If the task was overdue on that day. @end table In addition to coloring each day, the day is also marked with an asterisk if the task was actually done that day, and an exclamation mark to show where the current day falls in the graph. There are several configuration variables that can be used to change the way habits are displayed in the agenda. @table @asis @item @code{org-habit-graph-column} @vindex org-habit-graph-column The buffer column at which the consistency graph should be drawn. This overwrites any text in that column, so it is a good idea to keep your habits' titles brief and to the point. @item @code{org-habit-preceding-days} @vindex org-habit-preceding-days The amount of history, in days before today, to appear in consistency graphs. @item @code{org-habit-following-days} @vindex org-habit-following-days The number of days after today that appear in consistency graphs. @item @code{org-habit-show-habits-only-for-today} @vindex org-habit-show-habits-only-for-today If non-@code{nil}, only show habits in today's agenda view. The default value is @code{t}. Pressing @kbd{C-u K} in the agenda toggles this variable. @end table Lastly, pressing @kbd{K} in the agenda buffer causes habits to temporarily be disabled and do not appear at all. Press @kbd{K} again to bring them back. They are also subject to tag filtering, if you have habits which should only be done in certain contexts, for example. @node Priorities @section Priorities @cindex priorities @cindex priority cookie If you use Org mode extensively, you may end up with enough TODO items that it starts to make sense to prioritize them. Prioritizing can be done by placing a @emph{priority cookie} into the headline of a TODO item right after the TODO keyword, like this: @example *** TODO [#A] Write letter to Sam Fortune @end example @vindex org-priority-faces By default, Org mode supports three priorities: @samp{A}, @samp{B}, and @samp{C}. @samp{A} is the highest priority. An entry without a cookie is treated as equivalent if it had priority @samp{B}. Priorities make a difference only for sorting in the agenda (see @ref{Weekly/daily agenda}). Outside the agenda, they have no inherent meaning to Org mode. The cookies are displayed with the face defined by the variable @code{org-priority-faces}, which can be customized. You can also use numeric values for priorities, such as @example *** TODO [#1] Write letter to Sam Fortune @end example When using numeric priorities, you need to set @code{org-priority-highest}, @code{org-priority-lowest} and @code{org-priority-default} to integers, which must all be strictly inferior to 65. Priorities can be attached to any outline node; they do not need to be TODO items. @table @asis @item @kbd{C-c ,} (@code{org-priority}) @kindex C-c , @findex org-priority Set the priority of the current headline. The command prompts for a priority character @samp{A}, @samp{B} or @samp{C}. When you press @kbd{@key{SPC}} instead, the priority cookie, if one is set, is removed from the headline. The priorities can also be changed ``remotely'' from the agenda buffer with the @kbd{,} command (see @ref{Agenda Commands}). @item @kbd{S-@key{UP}} (@code{org-priority-up}) @itemx @kbd{S-@key{DOWN}} (@code{org-priority-down}) @kindex S-UP @kindex S-DOWN @findex org-priority-up @findex org-priority-down @vindex org-priority-start-cycle-with-default Increase/decrease the priority of the current headline@footnote{See also the option @code{org-priority-start-cycle-with-default}.}. Note that these keys are also used to modify timestamps (see @ref{Creating Timestamps}). See also @ref{Conflicts}, for a discussion of the interaction with shift-selection. @end table @vindex org-priority-highest @vindex org-priority-lowest @vindex org-priority-default You can change the range of allowed priorities by setting the variables @code{org-priority-highest}, @code{org-priority-lowest}, and @code{org-priority-default}. For an individual buffer, you may set these values (highest, lowest, default) like this (please make sure that the highest priority is earlier in the alphabet than the lowest priority): @cindex @samp{PRIORITIES}, keyword @example #+PRIORITIES: A C B @end example Or, using numeric values: @example #+PRIORITIES: 1 10 5 @end example @node Breaking Down Tasks @section Breaking Down Tasks into Subtasks @cindex tasks, breaking down @cindex statistics, for TODO items @vindex org-agenda-todo-list-sublevels It is often advisable to break down large tasks into smaller, manageable subtasks. You can do this by creating an outline tree below a TODO item, with detailed subtasks on the tree@footnote{To keep subtasks out of the global TODO list, see the option @code{org-agenda-todo-list-sublevels}.}. To keep an overview of the fraction of subtasks that have already been marked as done, insert either @samp{[/]} or @samp{[%]} anywhere in the headline. These cookies are updated each time the TODO status of a child changes, or when pressing @kbd{C-c C-c} on the cookie. For example: @example * Organize Party [33%] ** TODO Call people [1/2] *** TODO Peter *** DONE Sarah ** TODO Buy food ** DONE Talk to neighbor @end example @cindex @samp{COOKIE_DATA}, property If a heading has both checkboxes and TODO children below it, the meaning of the statistics cookie become ambiguous. Set the property @samp{COOKIE_DATA} to either @samp{checkbox} or @samp{todo} to resolve this issue. @vindex org-hierarchical-todo-statistics If you would like to have the statistics cookie count any TODO entries in the subtree (not just direct children), configure the variable @code{org-hierarchical-todo-statistics}. To do this for a single subtree, include the word @samp{recursive} into the value of the @samp{COOKIE_DATA} property. @example * Parent capturing statistics [2/20] :PROPERTIES: :COOKIE_DATA: todo recursive :END: @end example If you would like a TODO entry to automatically change to DONE when all children are done, you can use the following setup: @lisp (defun org-summary-todo (n-done n-not-done) "Switch entry to DONE when all subentries are done, to TODO otherwise." (let (org-log-done org-log-states) ; turn off logging (org-todo (if (= n-not-done 0) "DONE" "TODO")))) (add-hook 'org-after-todo-statistics-hook 'org-summary-todo) @end lisp Another possibility is the use of checkboxes to identify (a hierarchy of) a large number of subtasks (see @ref{Checkboxes}). @node Checkboxes @section Checkboxes @cindex checkboxes @vindex org-list-automatic-rules Every item in a plain list@footnote{With the exception of description lists. But you can allow it by modifying @code{org-list-automatic-rules} accordingly.} (see @ref{Plain Lists}) can be made into a checkbox by starting it with the string @samp{[ ]}. This feature is similar to TODO items (see @ref{TODO Items}), but is more lightweight. Checkboxes are not included into the global TODO list, so they are often great to split a task into a number of simple steps. Or you can use them in a shopping list. Here is an example of a checkbox list. @example * TODO Organize party [2/4] - [-] call people [1/3] - [ ] Peter - [X] Sarah - [ ] Sam - [X] order food - [ ] think about what music to play - [X] talk to the neighbors @end example Checkboxes work hierarchically, so if a checkbox item has children that are checkboxes, toggling one of the children checkboxes makes the parent checkbox reflect if none, some, or all of the children are checked. @cindex statistics, for checkboxes @cindex checkbox statistics @cindex @samp{COOKIE_DATA}, property @vindex org-hierarchical-checkbox-statistics The @samp{[2/4]} and @samp{[1/3]} in the first and second line are cookies indicating how many checkboxes present in this entry have been checked off, and the total number of checkboxes present. This can give you an idea on how many checkboxes remain, even without opening a folded entry. The cookies can be placed into a headline or into (the first line of) a plain list item. Each cookie covers checkboxes of direct children structurally below the headline/item on which the cookie appears@footnote{Set the variable @code{org-hierarchical-checkbox-statistics} if you want such cookies to count all checkboxes below the cookie, not just those belonging to direct children.}. You have to insert the cookie yourself by typing either @samp{[/]} or @samp{[%]}. With @samp{[/]} you get an @samp{n out of m} result, as in the examples above. With @samp{[%]} you get information about the percentage of checkboxes checked (in the above example, this would be @samp{[50%]} and @samp{[33%]}, respectively). In a headline, a cookie can count either checkboxes below the heading or TODO states of children, and it displays whatever was changed last. Set the property @samp{COOKIE_DATA} to either @samp{checkbox} or @samp{todo} to resolve this issue. @cindex blocking, of checkboxes @cindex checkbox blocking @cindex @samp{ORDERED}, property If the current outline node has an @samp{ORDERED} property, checkboxes must be checked off in sequence, and an error is thrown if you try to check off a box while there are unchecked boxes above it. The following commands work with checkboxes: @table @asis @item @kbd{C-c C-c} (@code{org-toggle-checkbox}) @kindex C-c C-c @findex org-toggle-checkbox Toggle checkbox status or---with prefix argument---checkbox presence at point. With a single prefix argument, add an empty checkbox or remove the current one@footnote{@kbd{C-u C-c C-c} on the @emph{first} item of a list with no checkbox adds checkboxes to the rest of the list.}. With a double prefix argument, set it to @samp{[-]}, which is considered to be an intermediate state. @item @kbd{C-c C-x C-b} (@code{org-toggle-checkbox}) @kindex C-c C-x C-b Toggle checkbox status or---with prefix argument---checkbox presence at point. With double prefix argument, set it to @samp{[-]}, which is considered to be an intermediate state. @itemize @item If there is an active region, toggle the first checkbox in the region and set all remaining boxes to the same status as the first. With a prefix argument, add or remove the checkbox for all items in the region. @item If point is in a headline, toggle checkboxes in the region between this headline and the next---so @emph{not} the entire subtree. @item If there is no active region, just toggle the checkbox at point. @end itemize @item @kbd{C-c C-x C-r} (@code{org-toggle-radio-button}) @kindex C-c C-x C-r @findex org-toggle-radio-button @cindex radio button, checkbox as Toggle checkbox status by using the checkbox of the item at point as a radio button: when the checkbox is turned on, all other checkboxes on the same level will be turned off. With a universal prefix argument, toggle the presence of the checkbox. With a double prefix argument, set it to @samp{[-]}. @findex org-list-checkbox-radio-mode @kbd{C-c C-c} can be told to consider checkboxes as radio buttons by setting @samp{#+ATTR_ORG: :radio t} right before the list or by calling @kbd{M-x org-list-checkbox-radio-mode} to activate this minor mode. @item @kbd{M-S-@key{RET}} (@code{org-insert-todo-heading}) @kindex M-S-RET @findex org-insert-todo-heading Insert a new item with a checkbox. This works only if point is already in a plain list item (see @ref{Plain Lists}). @item @kbd{C-c C-x o} (@code{org-toggle-ordered-property}) @kindex C-c C-x o @findex org-toggle-ordered-property @vindex org-track-ordered-property-with-tag Toggle the @samp{ORDERED} property of the entry, to toggle if checkboxes must be checked off in sequence. A property is used for this behavior because this should be local to the current entry, not inherited like a tag. However, if you would like to @emph{track} the value of this property with a tag for better visibility, customize @code{org-track-ordered-property-with-tag}. @item @kbd{C-c #} (@code{org-update-statistics-cookies}) @kindex C-c # @findex org-update-statistics-cookies Update the statistics cookie in the current outline entry. When called with a @kbd{C-u} prefix, update the entire file. Checkbox statistic cookies are updated automatically if you toggle checkboxes with @kbd{C-c C-c} and make new ones with @kbd{M-S-@key{RET}}. TODO statistics cookies update when changing TODO states. If you delete boxes/entries or add/change them by hand, use this command to get things back into sync. @end table @node Tags @chapter Tags @cindex tags @cindex headline tagging @cindex matching, tags @cindex sparse tree, tag based An excellent way to implement labels and contexts for cross-correlating information is to assign @emph{tags} to headlines. Org mode has extensive support for tags. @vindex org-tag-faces Every headline can contain a list of tags; they occur at the end of the headline. Tags are normal words containing letters, numbers, @samp{_}, and @samp{@@}. Tags must be preceded and followed by a single colon, e.g., @samp{:work:}. Several tags can be specified, as in @samp{:work:urgent:}. Tags by default are in bold face with the same color as the headline. You may specify special faces for specific tags using the variable @code{org-tag-faces}, in much the same way as you can for TODO keywords (see @ref{Faces for TODO keywords}). @menu * Tag Inheritance:: Tags use the tree structure of an outline. * Setting Tags:: How to assign tags to a headline. * Tag Hierarchy:: Create a hierarchy of tags. * Tag Searches:: Searching for combinations of tags. @end menu @node Tag Inheritance @section Tag Inheritance @cindex tag inheritance @cindex inheritance, of tags @cindex sublevels, inclusion into tags match @emph{Tags} make use of the hierarchical structure of outline trees. If a heading has a certain tag, all subheadings inherit the tag as well. For example, in the list @example * Meeting with the French group :work: ** Summary by Frank :boss:notes: *** TODO Prepare slides for him :action: @end example @noindent the final heading has the tags @samp{work}, @samp{boss}, @samp{notes}, and @samp{action} even though the final heading is not explicitly marked with those tags. You can also set tags that all entries in a file should inherit just as if these tags were defined in a hypothetical level zero that surrounds the entire file. Use a line like this@footnote{As with all these in-buffer settings, pressing @kbd{C-c C-c} activates any changes in the line.} @cindex @samp{FILETAGS}, keyword @example #+FILETAGS: :Peter:Boss:Secret: @end example @vindex org-use-tag-inheritance @vindex org-tags-exclude-from-inheritance To limit tag inheritance to specific tags, or to turn it off entirely, use the variables @code{org-use-tag-inheritance} and @code{org-tags-exclude-from-inheritance}. @vindex org-tags-match-list-sublevels When a headline matches during a tags search while tag inheritance is turned on, all the sublevels in the same tree---for a simple match form---match as well@footnote{This is only true if the search does not involve more complex tests including properties (see @ref{Property Searches}).}. The list of matches may then become very long. If you only want to see the first tags match in a subtree, configure the variable @code{org-tags-match-list-sublevels} (not recommended). @vindex org-agenda-use-tag-inheritance Tag inheritance is relevant when the agenda search tries to match a tag, either in the @code{tags} or @code{tags-todo} agenda types. In other agenda types, @code{org-use-tag-inheritance} has no effect. Still, you may want to have your tags correctly set in the agenda, so that tag filtering works fine, with inherited tags. Set @code{org-agenda-use-tag-inheritance} to control this: the default value includes all agenda types, but setting this to @code{nil} can really speed up agenda generation. @node Setting Tags @section Setting Tags @cindex setting tags @cindex tags, setting @kindex M-TAB Tags can simply be typed into the buffer at the end of a headline. After a colon, @kbd{M-@key{TAB}} offers completion on tags. There is also a special command for inserting tags: @table @asis @item @kbd{C-c C-q} (@code{org-set-tags-command}) @kindex C-c C-q @findex org-set-tags-command @cindex completion, of tags @vindex org-tags-column Enter new tags for the current headline. Org mode either offers completion or a special single-key interface for setting tags, see below. After pressing @kbd{@key{RET}}, the tags are inserted and aligned to @code{org-tags-column}. When called with a @kbd{C-u} prefix, all tags in the current buffer are aligned to that column, just to make things look nice. Tags are automatically realigned after promotion, demotion, and TODO state changes (see @ref{TODO Basics}). @item @kbd{C-c C-c} (@code{org-set-tags-command}) @kindex C-c C-c When point is in a headline, this does the same as @kbd{C-c C-q}. @end table @vindex org-complete-tags-always-offer-all-agenda-tags @vindex org-tag-alist @cindex @samp{TAGS}, keyword Org supports tag insertion based on a @emph{list of tags}. By default this list is constructed dynamically, containing all tags currently used in the buffer@footnote{To extend this default list to all tags used in all agenda files (see @ref{Agenda Views}), customize the variable @code{org-complete-tags-always-offer-all-agenda-tags}.}. You may also globally specify a hard list of tags with the variable @code{org-tag-alist}. Finally you can set the default tags for a given file using the @samp{TAGS} keyword, like @example #+TAGS: @@work @@home @@tennisclub #+TAGS: laptop car pc sailboat @end example If you have globally defined your preferred set of tags using the variable @code{org-tag-alist}, but would like to use a dynamic tag list in a specific file, add an empty @samp{TAGS} keyword to that file: @example #+TAGS: @end example @vindex org-tag-persistent-alist If you have a preferred set of tags that you would like to use in every file, in addition to those defined on a per-file basis by @samp{TAGS} keyword, then you may specify a list of tags with the variable @code{org-tag-persistent-alist}. You may turn this off on a per-file basis by adding a @samp{STARTUP} keyword to that file: @example #+STARTUP: noptag @end example By default Org mode uses the standard minibuffer completion facilities for entering tags. However, it also implements another, quicker, tag selection method called @emph{fast tag selection}. This allows you to select and deselect tags with just a single key press. For this to work well you should assign unique letters to most of your commonly used tags. You can do this globally by configuring the variable @code{org-tag-alist} in your Emacs init file. For example, you may find the need to tag many items in different files with @samp{@@home}. In this case you can set something like: @lisp (setq org-tag-alist '(("@@work" . ?w) ("@@home" . ?h) ("laptop" . ?l))) @end lisp If the tag is only relevant to the file you are working on, then you can instead set the @samp{TAGS} keyword as: @example #+TAGS: @@work(w) @@home(h) @@tennisclub(t) laptop(l) pc(p) @end example The tags interface shows the available tags in a splash window. If you want to start a new line after a specific tag, insert @samp{\n} into the tag list @example #+TAGS: @@work(w) @@home(h) @@tennisclub(t) \n laptop(l) pc(p) @end example @noindent or write them in two lines: @example #+TAGS: @@work(w) @@home(h) @@tennisclub(t) #+TAGS: laptop(l) pc(p) @end example You can also group together tags that are mutually exclusive by using braces, as in: @example #+TAGS: @{ @@work(w) @@home(h) @@tennisclub(t) @} laptop(l) pc(p) @end example @noindent you indicate that at most one of @samp{@@work}, @samp{@@home}, and @samp{@@tennisclub} should be selected. Multiple such groups are allowed. Do not forget to press @kbd{C-c C-c} with point in one of these lines to activate any changes. To set these mutually exclusive groups in the variable @code{org-tags-alist}, you must use the dummy tags @code{:startgroup} and @code{:endgroup} instead of the braces. Similarly, you can use @code{:newline} to indicate a line break. The previous example would be set globally by the following configuration: @lisp (setq org-tag-alist '((:startgroup . nil) ("@@work" . ?w) ("@@home" . ?h) ("@@tennisclub" . ?t) (:endgroup . nil) ("laptop" . ?l) ("pc" . ?p))) @end lisp If at least one tag has a selection key then pressing @kbd{C-c C-c} automatically presents you with a special interface, listing inherited tags, the tags of the current headline, and a list of all valid tags with corresponding keys@footnote{Keys are automatically assigned to tags that have no configured keys.}. Pressing keys assigned to tags adds or removes them from the list of tags in the current line. Selecting a tag in a group of mutually exclusive tags turns off any other tag from that group. In this interface, you can also use the following special keys: @table @asis @item @kbd{@key{TAB}} @kindex TAB Enter a tag in the minibuffer, even if the tag is not in the predefined list. You can complete on all tags present in the buffer. You can also add several tags: just separate them with a comma. @item @kbd{@key{SPC}} @kindex SPC Clear all tags for this line. @item @kbd{@key{RET}} @kindex RET Accept the modified set. @item @kbd{C-g} @kindex C-g Abort without installing changes. @item @kbd{q} @kindex q If @kbd{q} is not assigned to a tag, it aborts like @kbd{C-g}. @item @kbd{!} @kindex ! Turn off groups of mutually exclusive tags. Use this to (as an exception) assign several tags from such a group. @item @kbd{C-c} @kindex C-c C-c Toggle auto-exit after the next change (see below). If you are using expert mode, the first @kbd{C-c} displays the selection window. @end table This method lets you assign tags to a headline with very few keys. With the above setup, you could clear the current tags and set @samp{@@home}, @samp{laptop} and @samp{pc} tags with just the following keys: @kbd{C-c C-c @key{SPC} h l p @key{RET}}. Switching from @samp{@@home} to @samp{@@work} would be done with @kbd{C-c C-c w @key{RET}} or alternatively with @kbd{C-c C-c C-c w}. Adding the non-predefined tag @samp{sarah} could be done with @kbd{C-c C-c @key{TAB} s a r a h @key{RET}}. @vindex org-fast-tag-selection-single-key If you find that most of the time you need only a single key press to modify your list of tags, set the variable @code{org-fast-tag-selection-single-key}. Then you no longer have to press @kbd{@key{RET}} to exit fast tag selection---it exits after the first change. If you then occasionally need more keys, press @kbd{C-c} to turn off auto-exit for the current tag selection process (in effect: start selection with @kbd{C-c C-c C-c} instead of @kbd{C-c C-c}). If you set the variable to the value @code{expert}, the special window is not even shown for single-key tag selection, it comes up only when you press an extra @kbd{C-c}. @node Tag Hierarchy @section Tag Hierarchy @cindex group tags @cindex tags, groups @cindex tags hierarchy Tags can be defined in hierarchies. A tag can be defined as a @emph{group tag} for a set of other tags. The group tag can be seen as the ``broader term'' for its set of tags. Defining multiple group tags and nesting them creates a tag hierarchy. One use-case is to create a taxonomy of terms (tags) that can be used to classify nodes in a document or set of documents. When you search for a group tag, it return matches for all members in the group and its subgroups. In an agenda view, filtering by a group tag displays or hide headlines tagged with at least one of the members of the group or any of its subgroups. This makes tag searches and filters even more flexible. You can set group tags by using brackets and inserting a colon between the group tag and its related tags---beware that all whitespaces are mandatory so that Org can parse this line correctly: @example #+TAGS: [ GTD : Control Persp ] @end example In this example, @samp{GTD} is the group tag and it is related to two other tags: @samp{Control}, @samp{Persp}. Defining @samp{Control} and @samp{Persp} as group tags creates a hierarchy of tags: @example #+TAGS: [ Control : Context Task ] #+TAGS: [ Persp : Vision Goal AOF Project ] @end example That can conceptually be seen as a hierarchy of tags: @itemize @item @samp{GTD} @itemize @item @samp{Persp} @itemize @item @samp{Vision} @item @samp{Goal} @item @samp{AOF} @item @samp{Project} @end itemize @item @samp{Control} @itemize @item @samp{Context} @item @samp{Task} @end itemize @end itemize @end itemize You can use the @code{:startgrouptag}, @code{:grouptags} and @code{:endgrouptag} keyword directly when setting @code{org-tag-alist} directly: @lisp (setq org-tag-alist '((:startgrouptag) ("GTD") (:grouptags) ("Control") ("Persp") (:endgrouptag) (:startgrouptag) ("Control") (:grouptags) ("Context") ("Task") (:endgrouptag))) @end lisp The tags in a group can be mutually exclusive if using the same group syntax as is used for grouping mutually exclusive tags together; using curly brackets. @example #+TAGS: @{ Context : @@Home @@Work @@Call @} @end example When setting @code{org-tag-alist} you can use @code{:startgroup} and @code{:endgroup} instead of @code{:startgrouptag} and @code{:endgrouptag} to make the tags mutually exclusive. Furthermore, the members of a group tag can also be regular expressions, creating the possibility of a more dynamic and rule-based tag structure. The regular expressions in the group must be specified within curly brackets. Here is an expanded example: @example #+TAGS: [ Vision : @{V@@.+@} ] #+TAGS: [ Goal : @{G@@.+@} ] #+TAGS: [ AOF : @{AOF@@.+@} ] #+TAGS: [ Project : @{P@@.+@} ] @end example Searching for the tag @samp{Project} now lists all tags also including regular expression matches for @samp{P@@.+}, and similarly for tag searches on @samp{Vision}, @samp{Goal} and @samp{AOF}. For example, this would work well for a project tagged with a common project-identifier, e.g., @samp{P@@2014_OrgTags}. @kindex C-c C-x q @findex org-toggle-tags-groups @vindex org-group-tags If you want to ignore group tags temporarily, toggle group tags support with @code{org-toggle-tags-groups}, bound to @kbd{C-c C-x q}. If you want to disable tag groups completely, set @code{org-group-tags} to @code{nil}. @node Tag Searches @section Tag Searches @cindex tag searches @cindex searching for tags Once a system of tags has been set up, it can be used to collect related information into special lists. @table @asis @item @kbd{C-c / m} or @kbd{C-c \} (@code{org-match-sparse-tree}) @kindex C-c / m @kindex C-c \ @findex org-match-sparse-tree Create a sparse tree with all headlines matching a tags search. With a @kbd{C-u} prefix argument, ignore headlines that are not a TODO line. @item @kbd{M-x org-agenda m} (@code{org-tags-view}) @kindex m @r{(Agenda dispatcher)} @findex org-tags-view Create a global list of tag matches from all agenda files. See @ref{Matching tags and properties}. @item @kbd{M-x org-agenda M} (@code{org-tags-view}) @kindex M @r{(Agenda dispatcher)} @vindex org-tags-match-list-sublevels Create a global list of tag matches from all agenda files, but check only TODO items and force checking subitems (see the option @code{org-tags-match-list-sublevels}). @end table These commands all prompt for a match string which allows basic Boolean logic like @samp{+boss+urgent-project1}, to find entries with tags @samp{boss} and @samp{urgent}, but not @samp{project1}, or @samp{Kathy|Sally} to find entries which are tagged, like @samp{Kathy} or @samp{Sally}. The full syntax of the search string is rich and allows also matching against TODO keywords, entry levels and properties. For a complete description with many examples, see @ref{Matching tags and properties}. @node Properties and Columns @chapter Properties and Columns @cindex properties A property is a key-value pair associated with an entry. Properties can be set so they are associated with a single entry, with every entry in a tree, or with the whole buffer. There are two main applications for properties in Org mode. First, properties are like tags, but with a value. Imagine maintaining a file where you document bugs and plan releases for a piece of software. Instead of using tags like @samp{release_1}, @samp{release_2}, you can use a property, say @samp{Release}, that in different subtrees has different values, such as @samp{1.0} or @samp{2.0}. Second, you can use properties to implement (very basic) database capabilities in an Org buffer. Imagine keeping track of your music CDs, where properties could be things such as the album, artist, date of release, number of tracks, and so on. Properties can be conveniently edited and viewed in column view (see @ref{Column View}). @menu * Property Syntax:: How properties are spelled out. * Special Properties:: Access to other Org mode features. * Property Searches:: Matching property values. * Property Inheritance:: Passing values down a tree. * Column View:: Tabular viewing and editing. @end menu @node Property Syntax @section Property Syntax @cindex property syntax @cindex drawer, for properties Properties are key--value pairs. When they are associated with a single entry or with a tree they need to be inserted into a special drawer (see @ref{Drawers}) with the name @samp{PROPERTIES}, which has to be located right below a headline, and its planning line (see @ref{Deadlines and Scheduling}) when applicable. Each property is specified on a single line, with the key---surrounded by colons---first, and the value after it. Keys are case-insensitive. Here is an example: @example * CD collection ** Classic *** Goldberg Variations :PROPERTIES: :Title: Goldberg Variations :Composer: J.S. Bach :Artist: Glenn Gould :Publisher: Deutsche Grammophon :NDisks: 1 :END: @end example Depending on the value of @code{org-use-property-inheritance}, a property set this way is associated either with a single entry, or with the sub-tree defined by the entry, see @ref{Property Inheritance}. You may define the allowed values for a particular property @samp{Xyz} by setting a property @samp{Xyz_ALL}. This special property is @emph{inherited}, so if you set it in a level 1 entry, it applies to the entire tree. When allowed values are defined, setting the corresponding property becomes easier and is less prone to typing errors. For the example with the CD collection, we can pre-define publishers and the number of disks in a box like this: @example * CD collection :PROPERTIES: :NDisks_ALL: 1 2 3 4 :Publisher_ALL: "Deutsche Grammophon" Philips EMI :END: @end example Properties can be inserted on buffer level. That means they apply before the first headline and can be inherited by all entries in a file. Property blocks defined before first headline needs to be located at the top of the buffer, allowing only comments above. Properties can also be defined using lines like: @cindex @samp{_ALL} suffix, in properties @cindex @samp{PROPERTY}, keyword @example #+PROPERTY: NDisks_ALL 1 2 3 4 @end example @cindex @samp{+} suffix, in properties If you want to add to the value of an existing property, append a @samp{+} to the property name. The following results in the property @samp{var} having the value @samp{foo=1 bar=2}. @example #+PROPERTY: var foo=1 #+PROPERTY: var+ bar=2 @end example It is also possible to add to the values of inherited properties. The following results in the @samp{Genres} property having the value @samp{Classic Baroque} under the @samp{Goldberg Variations} subtree. @example * CD collection ** Classic :PROPERTIES: :Genres: Classic :END: *** Goldberg Variations :PROPERTIES: :Title: Goldberg Variations :Composer: J.S. Bach :Artist: Glenn Gould :Publisher: Deutsche Grammophon :NDisks: 1 :Genres+: Baroque :END: @end example Note that a property can only have one entry per drawer. @vindex org-global-properties Property values set with the global variable @code{org-global-properties} can be inherited by all entries in all Org files. The following commands help to work with properties: @table @asis @item @kbd{M-@key{TAB}} (@code{pcomplete}) @kindex M-TAB @findex pcomplete After an initial colon in a line, complete property keys. All keys used in the current file are offered as possible completions. @item @kbd{C-c C-x p} (@code{org-set-property}) @kindex C-c C-x p @findex org-set-property Set a property. This prompts for a property name and a value. If necessary, the property drawer is created as well. @item @kbd{C-u M-x org-insert-drawer} @findex org-insert-drawer Insert a property drawer into the current entry. The drawer is inserted early in the entry, but after the lines with planning information like deadlines. If before first headline the drawer is inserted at the top of the drawer after any potential comments. @item @kbd{C-c C-c} (@code{org-property-action}) @kindex C-c C-c @findex org-property-action With point in a property drawer, this executes property commands. @item @kbd{C-c C-c s} (@code{org-set-property}) @kindex C-c C-c s @findex org-set-property Set a property in the current entry. Both the property and the value can be inserted using completion. @item @kbd{S-@key{RIGHT}} (@code{org-property-next-allowed-values}) @itemx @kbd{S-@key{LEFT}} (@code{org-property-previous-allowed-value}) @kindex S-RIGHT @kindex S-LEFT Switch property at point to the next/previous allowed value. @item @kbd{C-c C-c d} (@code{org-delete-property}) @kindex C-c C-c d @findex org-delete-property Remove a property from the current entry. @item @kbd{C-c C-c D} (@code{org-delete-property-globally}) @kindex C-c C-c D @findex org-delete-property-globally Globally remove a property, from all entries in the current file. @item @kbd{C-c C-c c} (@code{org-compute-property-at-point}) @kindex C-c C-c c @findex org-compute-property-at-point Compute the property at point, using the operator and scope from the nearest column format definition. @end table @node Special Properties @section Special Properties @cindex properties, special Special properties provide an alternative access method to Org mode features, like the TODO state or the priority of an entry, discussed in the previous chapters. This interface exists so that you can include these states in a column view (see @ref{Column View}), or to use them in queries. The following property names are special and should not be used as keys in the properties drawer: @cindex @samp{ALLTAGS}, special property @cindex @samp{BLOCKED}, special property @cindex @samp{CLOCKSUM}, special property @cindex @samp{CLOCKSUM_T}, special property @cindex @samp{CLOSED}, special property @cindex @samp{DEADLINE}, special property @cindex @samp{FILE}, special property @cindex @samp{ITEM}, special property @cindex @samp{PRIORITY}, special property @cindex @samp{SCHEDULED}, special property @cindex @samp{TAGS}, special property @cindex @samp{TIMESTAMP}, special property @cindex @samp{TIMESTAMP_IA}, special property @cindex @samp{TODO}, special property @multitable {aaaaaaaaaaaaaa} {aaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaa} @item @samp{ALLTAGS} @tab All tags, including inherited ones. @item @samp{BLOCKED} @tab @code{t} if task is currently blocked by children or siblings. @item @samp{CATEGORY} @tab The category of an entry. @item @samp{CLOCKSUM} @tab The sum of CLOCK intervals in the subtree. @code{org-clock-sum} @item @tab must be run first to compute the values in the current buffer. @item @samp{CLOCKSUM_T} @tab The sum of CLOCK intervals in the subtree for today. @item @tab @code{org-clock-sum-today} must be run first to compute the @item @tab values in the current buffer. @item @samp{CLOSED} @tab When was this entry closed? @item @samp{DEADLINE} @tab The deadline timestamp. @item @samp{FILE} @tab The filename the entry is located in. @item @samp{ITEM} @tab The headline of the entry. @item @samp{PRIORITY} @tab The priority of the entry, a string with a single letter. @item @samp{SCHEDULED} @tab The scheduling timestamp. @item @samp{TAGS} @tab The tags defined directly in the headline. @item @samp{TIMESTAMP} @tab The first keyword-less timestamp in the entry. @item @samp{TIMESTAMP_IA} @tab The first inactive timestamp in the entry. @item @samp{TODO} @tab The TODO keyword of the entry. @end multitable @node Property Searches @section Property Searches @cindex properties, searching @cindex searching, of properties To create sparse trees and special lists with selection based on properties, the same commands are used as for tag searches (see @ref{Tag Searches}). @table @asis @item @kbd{C-c / m} or @kbd{C-c \} (@code{org-match-sparse-tree}) @kindex C-c / m @kindex C-c \ @findex org-match-sparse-tree Create a sparse tree with all matching entries. With a @kbd{C-u} prefix argument, ignore headlines that are not a TODO line. @item @kbd{M-x org-agenda m} (@code{org-tags-view}) @kindex m @r{(Agenda dispatcher)} @findex org-tags-view Create a global list of tag/property matches from all agenda files. @item @kbd{M-x org-agenda M} (@code{org-tags-view}) @kindex M @r{(Agenda dispatcher)} @vindex org-tags-match-list-sublevels Create a global list of tag matches from all agenda files, but check only TODO items and force checking of subitems (see the option @code{org-tags-match-list-sublevels}). @end table The syntax for the search string is described in @ref{Matching tags and properties}. There is also a special command for creating sparse trees based on a single property: @table @asis @item @kbd{C-c / p} @kindex C-c / p Create a sparse tree based on the value of a property. This first prompts for the name of a property, and then for a value. A sparse tree is created with all entries that define this property with the given value. If you enclose the value in curly braces, it is interpreted as a regular expression and matched against the property values. @end table @node Property Inheritance @section Property Inheritance @cindex properties, inheritance @cindex inheritance, of properties @vindex org-use-property-inheritance The outline structure of Org documents lends itself to an inheritance model of properties: if the parent in a tree has a certain property, the children can inherit this property. Org mode does not turn this on by default, because it can slow down property searches significantly and is often not needed. However, if you find inheritance useful, you can turn it on by setting the variable @code{org-use-property-inheritance}. It may be set to @code{t} to make all properties inherited from the parent, to a list of properties that should be inherited, or to a regular expression that matches inherited properties. If a property has the value @code{nil}, this is interpreted as an explicit un-define of the property, so that inheritance search stops at this value and returns @code{nil}. Org mode has a few properties for which inheritance is hard-coded, at least for the special applications for which they are used: @table @asis @item @code{COLUMNS} @cindex @samp{COLUMNS}, property The @samp{COLUMNS} property defines the format of column view (see @ref{Column View}). It is inherited in the sense that the level where a @samp{COLUMNS} property is defined is used as the starting point for a column view table, independently of the location in the subtree from where columns view is turned on. @item @code{CATEGORY} @cindex @samp{CATEGORY}, property For agenda view, a category set through a @samp{CATEGORY} property applies to the entire subtree. @item @code{ARCHIVE} @cindex @samp{ARCHIVE}, property For archiving, the @samp{ARCHIVE} property may define the archive location for the entire subtree (see @ref{Moving subtrees}). @item @code{LOGGING} @cindex @samp{LOGGING}, property The @samp{LOGGING} property may define logging settings for an entry or a subtree (see @ref{Tracking TODO state changes}). @end table @node Column View @section Column View A great way to view and edit properties in an outline tree is @emph{column view}. In column view, each outline node is turned into a table row. Columns in this table provide access to properties of the entries. Org mode implements columns by overlaying a tabular structure over the headline of each item. While the headlines have been turned into a table row, you can still change the visibility of the outline tree. For example, you get a compact table by switching to ``contents'' view---@kbd{S-@key{TAB}} @kbd{S-@key{TAB}}, or simply @kbd{c} while column view is active---but you can still open, read, and edit the entry below each headline. Or, you can switch to column view after executing a sparse tree command and in this way get a table only for the selected items. Column view also works in agenda buffers (see @ref{Agenda Views}) where queries have collected selected items, possibly from a number of files. @menu * Defining columns:: The COLUMNS format property. * Using column view:: How to create and use column view. * Capturing column view:: A dynamic block for column view. @end menu @node Defining columns @subsection Defining columns @cindex column view, for properties @cindex properties, column view Setting up a column view first requires defining the columns. This is done by defining a column format line. @menu * Scope of column definitions:: Where defined, where valid? * Column attributes:: Appearance and content of a column. @end menu @node Scope of column definitions @subsubsection Scope of column definitions To specify a format that only applies to a specific tree, add a @samp{COLUMNS} property to the top node of that tree, for example: @example ** Top node for columns view :PROPERTIES: :COLUMNS: %25ITEM %TAGS %PRIORITY %TODO :END: @end example A @samp{COLUMNS} property within a property drawer before first headline will apply to the entire file. As an addition to property drawers, keywords can also be defined for an entire file using a line like: @cindex @samp{COLUMNS}, keyword @example #+COLUMNS: %25ITEM %TAGS %PRIORITY %TODO @end example If a @samp{COLUMNS} property is present in an entry, it defines columns for the entry itself, and for the entire subtree below it. Since the column definition is part of the hierarchical structure of the document, you can define columns on level 1 that are general enough for all sublevels, and more specific columns further down, when you edit a deeper part of the tree. @node Column attributes @subsubsection Column attributes A column definition sets the attributes of a column. The general definition looks like this: @example %[WIDTH]PROPERTY[(TITLE)][@{SUMMARY-TYPE@}] @end example @noindent Except for the percent sign and the property name, all items are optional. The individual parts have the following meaning: @table @asis @item @var{WIDTH} An integer specifying the width of the column in characters. If omitted, the width is determined automatically. @item @var{PROPERTY} The property that should be edited in this column. Special properties representing meta data are allowed here as well (see @ref{Special Properties}). @item @var{TITLE} The header text for the column. If omitted, the property name is used. @item @var{SUMMARY-TYPE} The summary type. If specified, the column values for parent nodes are computed from the children@footnote{If more than one summary type applies to the same property, the parent values are computed according to the first of them.}. Supported summary types are: @multitable {aaaaaaaa} {aaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaa} @item @samp{+} @tab Sum numbers in this column. @item @samp{+;%.1f} @tab Like @samp{+}, but format result with @samp{%.1f}. @item @samp{$} @tab Currency, short for @samp{+;%.2f}. @item @samp{min} @tab Smallest number in column. @item @samp{max} @tab Largest number. @item @samp{mean} @tab Arithmetic mean of numbers. @item @samp{X} @tab Checkbox status, @samp{[X]} if all children are @samp{[X]}. @item @samp{X/} @tab Checkbox status, @samp{[n/m]}. @item @samp{X%} @tab Checkbox status, @samp{[n%]}. @item @samp{:} @tab Sum times, HH:MM, plain numbers are minutes. @item @samp{:min} @tab Smallest time value in column. @item @samp{:max} @tab Largest time value. @item @samp{:mean} @tab Arithmetic mean of time values. @item @samp{@@min} @tab Minimum age@footnote{An age can be defined as a duration, using units defined in @code{org-duration-units}, e.g., @samp{3d 1h}. If any value in the column is as such, the summary is also expressed as a duration.} (in days/hours/mins/seconds). @item @samp{@@max} @tab Maximum age (in days/hours/mins/seconds). @item @samp{@@mean} @tab Arithmetic mean of ages (in days/hours/mins/seconds). @item @samp{est+} @tab Add low-high estimates. @end multitable @vindex org-columns-summary-types You can also define custom summary types by setting @code{org-columns-summary-types}. @end table The @samp{est+} summary type requires further explanation. It is used for combining estimates, expressed as low-high ranges. For example, instead of estimating a particular task will take 5 days, you might estimate it as 5--6 days if you're fairly confident you know how much work is required, or 1--10 days if you do not really know what needs to be done. Both ranges average at 5.5 days, but the first represents a more predictable delivery. When combining a set of such estimates, simply adding the lows and highs produces an unrealistically wide result. Instead, @samp{est+} adds the statistical mean and variance of the subtasks, generating a final estimate from the sum. For example, suppose you had ten tasks, each of which was estimated at 0.5 to 2 days of work. Straight addition produces an estimate of 5 to 20 days, representing what to expect if everything goes either extremely well or extremely poorly. In contrast, @samp{est+} estimates the full job more realistically, at 10--15 days. Here is an example for a complete columns definition, along with allowed values@footnote{Please note that the @samp{COLUMNS} definition must be on a single line; it is wrapped here only because of formatting constraints.}. @example :COLUMNS: %25ITEM %9Approved(Approved?)@{X@} %Owner %11Status \ %10Time_Estimate@{:@} %CLOCKSUM %CLOCKSUM_T :Owner_ALL: Tammy Mark Karl Lisa Don :Status_ALL: "In progress" "Not started yet" "Finished" "" :Approved_ALL: "[ ]" "[X]" @end example @noindent The first column, @samp{%25ITEM}, means the first 25 characters of the item itself, i.e., of the headline. You probably always should start the column definition with the @samp{ITEM} specifier. The other specifiers create columns @samp{Owner} with a list of names as allowed values, for @samp{Status} with four different possible values, and for a checkbox field @samp{Approved}. When no width is given after the @samp{%} character, the column is exactly as wide as it needs to be in order to fully display all values. The @samp{Approved} column does have a modified title (@samp{Approved?}, with a question mark). Summaries are created for the @samp{Time_Estimate} column by adding time duration expressions like HH:MM, and for the @samp{Approved} column, by providing an @samp{[X]} status if all children have been checked. The @samp{CLOCKSUM} and @samp{CLOCKSUM_T} columns are special, they lists the sums of CLOCK intervals in the subtree, either for all clocks or just for today. @node Using column view @subsection Using column view @anchor{Turning column view on or off} @subsubheading Turning column view on or off @table @asis @item @kbd{C-c C-x C-c} (@code{org-columns}) @kindex C-c C-x C-c @vindex org-columns @vindex org-columns-default-format Turn on column view. If point is before the first headline in the file, column view is turned on for the entire file, using the @samp{#+COLUMNS} definition. If point is somewhere inside the outline, this command searches the hierarchy, up from point, for a @samp{COLUMNS} property that defines a format. When one is found, the column view table is established for the tree starting at the entry that contains the @samp{COLUMNS} property. If no such property is found, the format is taken from the @samp{#+COLUMNS} line or from the variable @code{org-columns-default-format}, and column view is established for the current entry and its subtree. @item @kbd{r} or @kbd{g} on a columns view line (@code{org-columns-redo}) @kindex r @kindex g @findex org-columns-redo Recreate the column view, to include recent changes made in the buffer. @item @kbd{C-c C-c} or @kbd{q} on a columns view line (@code{org-columns-quit}) @kindex q @kindex C-c C-c @findex org-columns-quit Exit column view. @end table @anchor{Editing values} @subsubheading Editing values @table @asis @item @kbd{@key{LEFT}}, @kbd{@key{RIGHT}}, @kbd{@key{UP}}, @kbd{@key{DOWN}} Move through the column view from field to field. @item @kbd{1..9,0} @kindex 1..9,0 Directly select the Nth allowed value, @kbd{0} selects the 10th value. @item @kbd{n} or @kbd{S-@key{RIGHT}} (@code{org-columns-next-allowed-value}) @itemx @kbd{p} or @kbd{S-@key{LEFT}} (@code{org-columns-previous-allowed-value}) @kindex n @kindex S-RIGHT @kindex p @kindex S-LEFT @findex org-columns-next-allowed-value @findex org-columns-previous-allowed-value Switch to the next/previous allowed value of the field. For this, you have to have specified allowed values for a property. @item @kbd{e} (@code{org-columns-edit-value}) @kindex e @findex org-columns-edit-value Edit the property at point. For the special properties, this invokes the same interface that you normally use to change that property. For example, the tag completion or fast selection interface pops up when editing a @samp{TAGS} property. @item @kbd{C-c C-c} (@code{org-columns-toggle-or-columns-quit}) @kindex C-c C-c @findex org-columns-toggle-or-columns-quit When there is a checkbox at point, toggle it. Else exit column view. @item @kbd{v} (@code{org-columns-show-value}) @kindex v @findex org-columns-show-value View the full value of this property. This is useful if the width of the column is smaller than that of the value. @item @kbd{a} (@code{org-columns-edit-allowed}) @kindex a @findex org-columns-edit-allowed Edit the list of allowed values for this property. If the list is found in the hierarchy, the modified values is stored there. If no list is found, the new value is stored in the first entry that is part of the current column view. @end table @anchor{Modifying column view on-the-fly} @subsubheading Modifying column view on-the-fly @table @asis @item @kbd{<} (@code{org-columns-narrow}) @itemx @kbd{>} (@code{org-columns-widen}) @kindex < @kindex > @findex org-columns-narrow @findex org-columns-widen Make the column narrower/wider by one character. @item @kbd{S-M-@key{RIGHT}} (@code{org-columns-new}) @kindex S-M-RIGHT @findex org-columns-new Insert a new column, to the left of the current column. @item @kbd{S-M-@key{LEFT}} (@code{org-columns-delete}) @kindex S-M-LEFT @findex org-columns-delete Delete the current column. @end table @node Capturing column view @subsection Capturing column view Since column view is just an overlay over a buffer, it cannot be exported or printed directly. If you want to capture a column view, use a @samp{columnview} dynamic block (see @ref{Dynamic Blocks}). The frame of this block looks like this: @cindex @samp{BEGIN columnview} @example * The column view #+BEGIN: columnview :hlines 1 :id "label" #+END: @end example This dynamic block has the following parameters: @table @asis @item @samp{:id} This is the most important parameter. Column view is a feature that is often localized to a certain (sub)tree, and the capture block might be at a different location in the file. To identify the tree whose view to capture, you can use four values: @table @asis @item @samp{local} Use the tree in which the capture block is located. @item @samp{global} Make a global view, including all headings in the file. @item @samp{file:FILENAME} Run column view at the top of the @var{FILENAME} file. @item @samp{LABEL} @cindex @samp{ID}, property Call column view in the tree that has an @samp{ID} property with the value @var{LABEL}. You can use @kbd{M-x org-id-copy} to create a globally unique ID for the current entry and copy it to the kill-ring. @end table @item @samp{:match} When set to a string, use this as a tags/property match filter to select only a subset of the headlines in the scope set by the @code{:id} parameter. @end table @table @asis @item @samp{:hlines} When @code{t}, insert an hline after every line. When a number N, insert an hline before each headline with level @code{<= N}. @item @samp{:vlines} When non-@code{nil}, force column groups to get vertical lines. @item @samp{:maxlevel} When set to a number, do not capture entries below this level. @item @samp{:skip-empty-rows} When non-@code{nil}, skip rows where the only non-empty specifier of the column view is @samp{ITEM}. @item @samp{:exclude-tags} List of tags to exclude from column view table: entries with these tags will be excluded from the column view. @item @samp{:indent} When non-@code{nil}, indent each @samp{ITEM} field according to its level. @item @samp{:format} Specify a column attribute (see @ref{Column attributes}) for the dynamic block. @end table The following commands insert or update the dynamic block: @table @asis @item @code{org-columns-insert-dblock} @kindex C-c C-x x @findex org-columns-insert-dblock Insert a dynamic block capturing a column view. Prompt for the scope or ID of the view. This command can be invoked by calling @code{org-dynamic-block-insert-dblock} (@kbd{C-c C-x x}) and selecting ``columnview'' (see @ref{Dynamic Blocks}). @item @kbd{C-c C-c} @kbd{C-c C-x C-u} (@code{org-dblock-update}) @kindex C-c C-c @kindex C-c C-x C-u @findex org-dblock-update Update dynamic block at point. point needs to be in the @samp{#+BEGIN} line of the dynamic block. @item @kbd{C-u C-c C-x C-u} (@code{org-update-all-dblocks}) @kindex C-u C-c C-x C-u Update all dynamic blocks (see @ref{Dynamic Blocks}). This is useful if you have several clock table blocks, column-capturing blocks or other dynamic blocks in a buffer. @end table You can add formulas to the column view table and you may add plotting instructions in front of the table---these survive an update of the block. If there is a @samp{TBLFM} keyword after the table, the table is recalculated automatically after an update. An alternative way to capture and process property values into a table is provided by Eric Schulte's @samp{org-collector.el}, which is a contributed package@footnote{Contributed packages are not part of Emacs, but are distributed with the main distribution of Org---visit @uref{https://orgmode.org}.}. It provides a general API to collect properties from entries in a certain scope, and arbitrary Lisp expressions to process these values before inserting them into a table or a dynamic block. @node Dates and Times @chapter Dates and Times @cindex dates @cindex times @cindex timestamp @cindex date stamp To assist project planning, TODO items can be labeled with a date and/or a time. The specially formatted string carrying the date and time information is called a @emph{timestamp} in Org mode. This may be a little confusing because timestamp is often used as indicating when something was created or last changed. However, in Org mode this term is used in a much wider sense. @menu * Timestamps:: Assigning a time to a tree entry. * Creating Timestamps:: Commands to insert timestamps. * Deadlines and Scheduling:: Planning your work. * Clocking Work Time:: Tracking how long you spend on a task. * Effort Estimates:: Planning work effort in advance. * Timers:: Notes with a running timer. @end menu @node Timestamps @section Timestamps @cindex timestamps @cindex ranges, time @cindex date stamps @cindex deadlines @cindex scheduling A timestamp is a specification of a date (possibly with a time or a range of times) in a special format, either @samp{<2003-09-16 Tue>} or @samp{<2003-09-16 Tue 09:39>} or @samp{<2003-09-16 Tue 12:00-12:30>}@footnote{The Org date format is inspired by the standard ISO 8601 date/time format. To use an alternative format, see @ref{Custom time format}. The day name is optional when you type the date yourself. However, any date inserted or modified by Org adds that day name, for reading convenience.}. A timestamp can appear anywhere in the headline or body of an Org tree entry. Its presence causes entries to be shown on specific dates in the agenda (see @ref{Weekly/daily agenda}). We distinguish: @table @asis @item Plain timestamp; Event; Appointment @cindex timestamp @cindex appointment A simple timestamp just assigns a date/time to an item. This is just like writing down an appointment or event in a paper agenda. In the agenda display, the headline of an entry associated with a plain timestamp is shown exactly on that date. @example * Meet Peter at the movies <2006-11-01 Wed 19:15> * Discussion on climate change <2006-11-02 Thu 20:00-22:00> @end example @item Timestamp with repeater interval @cindex timestamp, with repeater interval A timestamp may contain a @emph{repeater interval}, indicating that it applies not only on the given date, but again and again after a certain interval of N days (d), weeks (w), months (m), or years (y). The following shows up in the agenda every Wednesday: @example * Pick up Sam at school <2007-05-16 Wed 12:30 +1w> @end example @item Diary-style expression entries @cindex diary style timestamps @cindex sexp timestamps For more complex date specifications, Org mode supports using the special expression diary entries implemented in the Emacs Calendar package@footnote{When working with the standard diary expression functions, you need to be very careful with the order of the arguments. That order depends evilly on the variable @code{calendar-date-style}. For example, to specify a date December 12, 2005, the call might look like @samp{(diary-date 12 1 2005)} or @samp{(diary-date 1 12 2005)} or @samp{(diary-date 2005 12 1)}, depending on the settings. This has been the source of much confusion. Org mode users can resort to special versions of these functions like @code{org-date} or @code{org-anniversary}. These work just like the corresponding @code{diary-} functions, but with stable ISO order of arguments (year, month, day) wherever applicable, independent of the value of @code{calendar-date-style}.}. For example, with optional time: @example * 22:00-23:00 The nerd meeting on every 2nd Thursday of the month <%%(diary-float t 4 2)> @end example @item Time/Date range @cindex timerange @cindex date range Two timestamps connected by @samp{--} denote a range. The headline is shown on the first and last day of the range, and on any dates that are displayed and fall in the range. Here is an example: @example ** Meeting in Amsterdam <2004-08-23 Mon>--<2004-08-26 Thu> @end example @item Inactive timestamp @cindex timestamp, inactive @cindex inactive timestamp Just like a plain timestamp, but with square brackets instead of angular ones. These timestamps are inactive in the sense that they do @emph{not} trigger an entry to show up in the agenda. @example * Gillian comes late for the fifth time [2006-11-01 Wed] @end example @end table @node Creating Timestamps @section Creating Timestamps For Org mode to recognize timestamps, they need to be in the specific format. All commands listed below produce timestamps in the correct format. @table @asis @item @kbd{C-c .} (@code{org-time-stamp}) @kindex C-c . @findex org-time-stamp Prompt for a date and insert a corresponding timestamp. When point is at an existing timestamp in the buffer, the command is used to modify this timestamp instead of inserting a new one. When this command is used twice in succession, a time range is inserted. @kindex C-u C-c . @vindex org-time-stamp-rounding-minutes When called with a prefix argument, use the alternative format which contains date and time. The default time can be rounded to multiples of 5 minutes. See the option @code{org-time-stamp-rounding-minutes}. @kindex C-u C-u C-c . With two prefix arguments, insert an active timestamp with the current time without prompting. @item @kbd{C-c !} (@code{org-time-stamp-inactive}) @kindex C-c ! @kindex C-u C-c ! @kindex C-u C-u C-c ! @findex org-time-stamp-inactive Like @kbd{C-c .}, but insert an inactive timestamp that does not cause an agenda entry. @item @kbd{C-c C-c} @kindex C-c C-c Normalize timestamp, insert or fix day name if missing or wrong. @item @kbd{C-c <} (@code{org-date-from-calendar}) @kindex C-c < @findex org-date-from-calendar Insert a timestamp corresponding to point date in the calendar. @item @kbd{C-c >} (@code{org-goto-calendar}) @kindex C-c > @findex org-goto-calendar Access the Emacs calendar for the current date. If there is a timestamp in the current line, go to the corresponding date instead. @item @kbd{C-c C-o} (@code{org-open-at-point}) @kindex C-c C-o @findex org-open-at-point Access the agenda for the date given by the timestamp or -range at point (see @ref{Weekly/daily agenda}). @item @kbd{S-@key{LEFT}} (@code{org-timestamp-down-day}) @itemx @kbd{S-@key{RIGHT}} (@code{org-timestamp-up-day}) @kindex S-LEFT @kindex S-RIGHT @findex org-timestamp-down-day @findex org-timestamp-up-day Change date at point by one day. These key bindings conflict with shift-selection and related modes (see @ref{Conflicts}). @item @kbd{S-@key{UP}} (@code{org-timestamp-up}) @itemx @kbd{S-@key{DOWN}} (@code{org-timestamp-down}) @kindex S-UP @kindex S-DOWN On the beginning or enclosing bracket of a timestamp, change its type. Within a timestamp, change the item under point. Point can be on a year, month, day, hour or minute. When the timestamp contains a time range like @samp{15:30-16:30}, modifying the first time also shifts the second, shifting the time block with constant length. To change the length, modify the second time. Note that if point is in a headline and not at a timestamp, these same keys modify the priority of an item (see @ref{Priorities}). The key bindings also conflict with shift-selection and related modes (see @ref{Conflicts}). @item @kbd{C-c C-y} (@code{org-evaluate-time-range}) @kindex C-c C-y @findex org-evaluate-time-range @cindex evaluate time range Evaluate a time range by computing the difference between start and end. With a prefix argument, insert result after the time range (in a table: into the following column). @end table @menu * The date/time prompt:: How Org mode helps you enter dates and times. * Custom time format:: Making dates look different. @end menu @node The date/time prompt @subsection The date/time prompt @cindex date, reading in minibuffer @cindex time, reading in minibuffer @vindex org-read-date-prefer-future When Org mode prompts for a date/time, the default is shown in default date/time format, and the prompt therefore seems to ask for a specific format. But it in fact accepts date/time information in a variety of formats. Generally, the information should start at the beginning of the string. Org mode finds whatever information is in there and derives anything you have not specified from the @emph{default date and time}. The default is usually the current date and time, but when modifying an existing timestamp, or when entering the second stamp of a range, it is taken from the stamp in the buffer. When filling in information, Org mode assumes that most of the time you want to enter a date in the future: if you omit the month/year and the given day/month is @emph{before} today, it assumes that you mean a future date@footnote{See the variable @code{org-read-date-prefer-future}. You may set that variable to the symbol @code{time} to even make a time before now shift the date to tomorrow.}. If the date has been automatically shifted into the future, the time prompt shows this with @samp{(=>F)}. For example, let's assume that today is @strong{June 13, 2006}. Here is how various inputs are interpreted, the items filled in by Org mode are in @strong{bold}. @multitable {aaaaaaaaaaaaaa} {aaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaa} @item @samp{3-2-5} @tab @result{} 2003-02-05 @item @samp{2/5/3} @tab @result{} 2003-02-05 @item @samp{14} @tab @result{} @strong{2006}-@strong{06}-14 @item @samp{12} @tab @result{} @strong{2006}-@strong{07}-12 @item @samp{2/5} @tab @result{} @strong{2007}-02-05 @item @samp{Fri} @tab @result{} nearest Friday (default date or later) @item @samp{sep 15} @tab @result{} @strong{2006}-09-15 @item @samp{feb 15} @tab @result{} @strong{2007}-02-15 @item @samp{sep 12 9} @tab @result{} 2009-09-12 @item @samp{12:45} @tab @result{} @strong{2006}-@strong{06}-@strong{13} 12:45 @item @samp{22 sept 0:34} @tab @result{} @strong{2006}-09-22 0:34 @item @samp{w4} @tab @result{} ISO week for of the current year @strong{2006} @item @samp{2012 w4 fri} @tab @result{} Friday of ISO week 4 in 2012 @item @samp{2012-w04-5} @tab @result{} Same as above @end multitable Furthermore you can specify a relative date by giving, as the @emph{first} thing in the input: a plus/minus sign, a number and a letter---@samp{d}, @samp{w}, @samp{m} or @samp{y}---to indicate change in days, weeks, months, or years. With a single plus or minus, the date is always relative to today. With a double plus or minus, it is relative to the default date. If instead of a single letter, you use the abbreviation of day name, the date is the Nth such day, e.g.: @multitable {aaaaaaa} {aaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaa} @item @samp{+0} @tab @result{} today @item @samp{.} @tab @result{} today @item @samp{+4d} @tab @result{} four days from today @item @samp{+4} @tab @result{} same as +4d @item @samp{+2w} @tab @result{} two weeks from today @item @samp{++5} @tab @result{} five days from default date @item @samp{+2tue} @tab @result{} second Tuesday from now @end multitable @vindex parse-time-months @vindex parse-time-weekdays The function understands English month and weekday abbreviations. If you want to use un-abbreviated names and/or other languages, configure the variables @code{parse-time-months} and @code{parse-time-weekdays}. @vindex org-read-date-force-compatible-dates Not all dates can be represented in a given Emacs implementation. By default Org mode forces dates into the compatibility range 1970--2037 which works on all Emacs implementations. If you want to use dates outside of this range, read the docstring of the variable @code{org-read-date-force-compatible-dates}. You can specify a time range by giving start and end times or by giving a start time and a duration (in HH:MM format). Use one or two dash(es) as the separator in the former case and use @samp{+} as the separator in the latter case, e.g.: @multitable {aaaaaaaaaaaaaa} {aaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaa} @item @samp{11am-1:15pm} @tab @result{} 11:00-13:15 @item @samp{11am--1:15pm} @tab @result{} same as above @item @samp{11am+2:15} @tab @result{} same as above @end multitable @cindex calendar, for selecting date @vindex org-popup-calendar-for-date-prompt Parallel to the minibuffer prompt, a calendar is popped up@footnote{If you do not need/want the calendar, configure the variable @code{org-popup-calendar-for-date-prompt}.}. When you exit the date prompt, either by clicking on a date in the calendar, or by pressing @kbd{@key{RET}}, the date selected in the calendar is combined with the information entered at the prompt. You can control the calendar fully from the minibuffer: @kindex < @kindex > @kindex M-v @kindex C-v @kindex mouse-1 @kindex S-RIGHT @kindex S-LEFT @kindex S-DOWN @kindex S-UP @kindex M-S-RIGHT @kindex M-S-LEFT @kindex RET @kindex . @kindex C-. @multitable @columnfractions 0.25 0.55 @item @kbd{@key{RET}} @tab Choose date at point in calendar. @item @kbd{mouse-1} @tab Select date by clicking on it. @item @kbd{S-@key{RIGHT}} @tab One day forward. @item @kbd{S-@key{LEFT}} @tab One day backward. @item @kbd{S-@key{DOWN}} @tab One week forward. @item @kbd{S-@key{UP}} @tab One week backward. @item @kbd{M-S-@key{RIGHT}} @tab One month forward. @item @kbd{M-S-@key{LEFT}} @tab One month backward. @item @kbd{>} @tab Scroll calendar forward by one month. @item @kbd{<} @tab Scroll calendar backward by one month. @item @kbd{M-v} @tab Scroll calendar forward by 3 months. @item @kbd{C-v} @tab Scroll calendar backward by 3 months. @item @kbd{C-.} @tab Select today's date@footnote{You can also use the calendar command @kbd{.} to jump to today's date, but if you are inserting an hour specification for your timestamp, @kbd{.} will then insert a dot after the hour. By contrast, @kbd{C-.} will always jump to today's date.} @end multitable @vindex org-read-date-display-live The actions of the date/time prompt may seem complex, but I assure you they will grow on you, and you will start getting annoyed by pretty much any other way of entering a date/time out there. To help you understand what is going on, the current interpretation of your input is displayed live in the minibuffer@footnote{If you find this distracting, turn off the display with @code{org-read-date-display-live}.}. @node Custom time format @subsection Custom time format @cindex custom date/time format @cindex time format, custom @cindex date format, custom @vindex org-display-custom-times @vindex org-time-stamp-custom-formats Org mode uses the standard ISO notation for dates and times as it is defined in ISO 8601. If you cannot get used to this and require another representation of date and time to keep you happy, you can get it by customizing the variables @code{org-display-custom-times} and @code{org-time-stamp-custom-formats}. @table @asis @item @kbd{C-c C-x C-t} (@code{org-toggle-time-stamp-overlays}) @kindex C-c C-x C-t @findex org-toggle-time-stamp-overlays Toggle the display of custom formats for dates and times. @end table Org mode needs the default format for scanning, so the custom date/time format does not @emph{replace} the default format. Instead, it is put @emph{over} the default format using text properties. This has the following consequences: @itemize @item You cannot place point onto a timestamp anymore, only before or after. @item The @kbd{S-@key{UP}} and @kbd{S-@key{DOWN}} keys can no longer be used to adjust each component of a timestamp. If point is at the beginning of the stamp, @kbd{S-@key{UP}} and @kbd{S-@key{DOWN}} change the stamp by one day, just like @kbd{S-@key{LEFT}} @kbd{S-@key{RIGHT}}. At the end of the stamp, change the time by one minute. @item If the timestamp contains a range of clock times or a repeater, these are not overlaid, but remain in the buffer as they were. @item When you delete a timestamp character-by-character, it only disappears from the buffer after @emph{all} (invisible) characters belonging to the ISO timestamp have been removed. @item If the custom timestamp format is longer than the default and you are using dates in tables, table alignment will be messed up. If the custom format is shorter, things do work as expected. @end itemize @node Deadlines and Scheduling @section Deadlines and Scheduling A timestamp may be preceded by special keywords to facilitate planning. Both the timestamp and the keyword have to be positioned immediately after the task they refer to. @table @asis @item @samp{DEADLINE} @cindex @samp{DEADLINE} marker Meaning: the task---most likely a TODO item, though not necessarily---is supposed to be finished on that date. @vindex org-deadline-warning-days On the deadline date, the task is listed in the agenda. In addition, the agenda for @emph{today} carries a warning about the approaching or missed deadline, starting @code{org-deadline-warning-days} before the due date, and continuing until the entry is marked as done. An example: @example *** TODO write article about the Earth for the Guide DEADLINE: <2004-02-29 Sun> The editor in charge is [[bbdb:Ford Prefect]] @end example @vindex org-agenda-skip-deadline-prewarning-if-scheduled You can specify a different lead time for warnings for a specific deadlines using the following syntax. Here is an example with a warning period of 5 days @samp{DEADLINE: <2004-02-29 Sun -5d>}. This warning is deactivated if the task gets scheduled and you set @code{org-agenda-skip-deadline-prewarning-if-scheduled} to @code{t}. @item @samp{SCHEDULED} @cindex @samp{SCHEDULED} marker Meaning: you are planning to start working on that task on the given date. @vindex org-agenda-skip-scheduled-if-done The headline is listed under the given date@footnote{It will still be listed on that date after it has been marked as done. If you do not like this, set the variable @code{org-agenda-skip-scheduled-if-done}.}. In addition, a reminder that the scheduled date has passed is present in the compilation for @emph{today}, until the entry is marked as done, i.e., the task is automatically forwarded until completed. @example *** TODO Call Trillian for a date on New Years Eve. SCHEDULED: <2004-12-25 Sat> @end example @vindex org-scheduled-delay-days @vindex org-agenda-skip-scheduled-delay-if-deadline If you want to @emph{delay} the display of this task in the agenda, use @samp{SCHEDULED: <2004-12-25 Sat -2d>}: the task is still scheduled on the 25th but will appear two days later. In case the task contains a repeater, the delay is considered to affect all occurrences; if you want the delay to only affect the first scheduled occurrence of the task, use @samp{--2d} instead. See @code{org-scheduled-delay-days} and @code{org-agenda-skip-scheduled-delay-if-deadline} for details on how to control this globally or per agenda. @quotation Important Scheduling an item in Org mode should @emph{not} be understood in the same way that we understand @emph{scheduling a meeting}. Setting a date for a meeting is just a simple appointment, you should mark this entry with a simple plain timestamp, to get this item shown on the date where it applies. This is a frequent misunderstanding by Org users. In Org mode, @emph{scheduling} means setting a date when you want to start working on an action item. @end quotation @end table You may use timestamps with repeaters in scheduling and deadline entries. Org mode issues early and late warnings based on the assumption that the timestamp represents the @emph{nearest instance} of the repeater. However, the use of diary expression entries like @example <%%(diary-float t 42)> @end example @noindent in scheduling and deadline timestamps is limited. Org mode does not know enough about the internals of each function to issue early and late warnings. However, it shows the item on each day where the expression entry matches. @menu * Inserting deadline/schedule:: Planning items. * Repeated tasks:: Items that show up again and again. @end menu @node Inserting deadline/schedule @subsection Inserting deadlines or schedules The following commands allow you to quickly insert a deadline or to schedule an item:@footnote{The @samp{SCHEDULED} and @samp{DEADLINE} dates are inserted on the line right below the headline. Do not put any text between this line and the headline.} @table @asis @item @kbd{C-c C-d} (@code{org-deadline}) @kindex C-c C-d @findex org-deadline @vindex org-log-redeadline Insert @samp{DEADLINE} keyword along with a stamp. The insertion happens in the line directly following the headline. Remove any @samp{CLOSED} timestamp . When called with a prefix argument, also remove any existing deadline from the entry. Depending on the variable @code{org-log-redeadline}, take a note when changing an existing deadline@footnote{Note the corresponding @samp{STARTUP} options @samp{logredeadline}, @samp{lognoteredeadline}, and @samp{nologredeadline}.}. @item @kbd{C-c C-s} (@code{org-schedule}) @kindex C-c C-s @findex org-schedule @vindex org-log-reschedule Insert @samp{SCHEDULED} keyword along with a stamp. The insertion happens in the line directly following the headline. Remove any @samp{CLOSED} timestamp. When called with a prefix argument, also remove the scheduling date from the entry. Depending on the variable @code{org-log-reschedule}, take a note when changing an existing scheduling time@footnote{Note the corresponding @samp{STARTUP} options @samp{logreschedule}, @samp{lognotereschedule}, and @samp{nologreschedule}.}. @item @kbd{C-c / d} (@code{org-check-deadlines}) @kindex C-c / d @findex org-check-deadlines @cindex sparse tree, for deadlines @vindex org-deadline-warning-days Create a sparse tree with all deadlines that are either past-due, or which will become due within @code{org-deadline-warning-days}. With @kbd{C-u} prefix, show all deadlines in the file. With a numeric prefix, check that many days. For example, @kbd{C-1 C-c / d} shows all deadlines due tomorrow. @item @kbd{C-c / b} (@code{org-check-before-date}) @kindex C-c / b @findex org-check-before-date Sparse tree for deadlines and scheduled items before a given date. @item @kbd{C-c / a} (@code{org-check-after-date}) @kindex C-c / a @findex org-check-after-date Sparse tree for deadlines and scheduled items after a given date. @end table Note that @code{org-schedule} and @code{org-deadline} supports setting the date by indicating a relative time e.g., @samp{+1d} sets the date to the next day after today, and @samp{--1w} sets the date to the previous week before any current timestamp. @node Repeated tasks @subsection Repeated tasks @cindex tasks, repeated @cindex repeated tasks Some tasks need to be repeated again and again. Org mode helps to organize such tasks using a so-called repeater in a @samp{DEADLINE}, @samp{SCHEDULED}, or plain timestamps@footnote{Org does not repeat inactive timestamps, however. See @ref{Timestamps}.}. In the following example: @example ** TODO Pay the rent DEADLINE: <2005-10-01 Sat +1m> @end example @noindent the @samp{+1m} is a repeater; the intended interpretation is that the task has a deadline on @samp{<2005-10-01>} and repeats itself every (one) month starting from that time. You can use yearly, monthly, weekly, daily and hourly repeat cookies by using the @samp{y}, @samp{m}, @samp{w}, @samp{d} and @samp{h} letters. If you need both a repeater and a special warning period in a deadline entry, the repeater should come first and the warning period last @example DEADLINE: <2005-10-01 Sat +1m -3d> @end example @vindex org-todo-repeat-to-state Deadlines and scheduled items produce entries in the agenda when they are over-due, so it is important to be able to mark such an entry as done once you have done so. When you mark a @samp{DEADLINE} or a @samp{SCHEDULED} with the TODO keyword @samp{DONE}, it no longer produces entries in the agenda. The problem with this is, however, is that then also the @emph{next} instance of the repeated entry will not be active. Org mode deals with this in the following way: when you try to mark such an entry as done, using @kbd{C-c C-t}, it shifts the base date of the repeating timestamp by the repeater interval, and immediately sets the entry state back to TODO@footnote{In fact, the target state is taken from, in this sequence, the @samp{REPEAT_TO_STATE} property, the variable @code{org-todo-repeat-to-state} if it is a string, the previous TODO state if @code{org-todo-repeat-to-state} is @code{t}, or the first state of the TODO state sequence.}. In the example above, setting the state to @samp{DONE} would actually switch the date like this: @example ** TODO Pay the rent DEADLINE: <2005-11-01 Tue +1m> @end example To mark a task with a repeater as DONE, use @kbd{C-- 1 C-c C-t}, i.e., @code{org-todo} with a numeric prefix argument of @samp{-1}. @vindex org-log-repeat A timestamp@footnote{You can change this using the option @code{org-log-repeat}, or the @samp{STARTUP} options @samp{logrepeat}, @samp{lognoterepeat}, and @samp{nologrepeat}. With @samp{lognoterepeat}, you will also be prompted for a note.} is added under the deadline, to keep a record that you actually acted on the previous instance of this deadline. As a consequence of shifting the base date, this entry is no longer visible in the agenda when checking past dates, but all future instances will be visible. With the @samp{+1m} cookie, the date shift is always exactly one month. So if you have not paid the rent for three months, marking this entry DONE still keeps it as an overdue deadline. Depending on the task, this may not be the best way to handle it. For example, if you forgot to call your father for 3 weeks, it does not make sense to call him 3 times in a single day to make up for it. Finally, there are tasks, like changing batteries, which should always repeat a certain time @emph{after} the last time you did it. For these tasks, Org mode has special repeaters @samp{++} and @samp{.+}. For example: @example ** TODO Call Father DEADLINE: <2008-02-10 Sun ++1w> Marking this DONE shifts the date by at least one week, but also by as many weeks as it takes to get this date into the future. However, it stays on a Sunday, even if you called and marked it done on Saturday. ** TODO Empty kitchen trash DEADLINE: <2008-02-08 Fri 20:00 ++1d> Marking this DONE shifts the date by at least one day, and also by as many days as it takes to get the timestamp into the future. Since there is a time in the timestamp, the next deadline in the future will be on today's date if you complete the task before 20:00. ** TODO Check the batteries in the smoke detectors DEADLINE: <2005-11-01 Tue .+1m> Marking this DONE shifts the date to one month after today. ** TODO Wash my hands DEADLINE: <2019-04-05 08:00 Sun .+1h> Marking this DONE shifts the date to exactly one hour from now. @end example @vindex org-agenda-skip-scheduled-if-deadline-is-shown You may have both scheduling and deadline information for a specific task. If the repeater is set for the scheduling information only, you probably want the repeater to be ignored after the deadline. If so, set the variable @code{org-agenda-skip-scheduled-if-deadline-is-shown} to @code{repeated-after-deadline}. However, any scheduling information without a repeater is no longer relevant once the task is done, and thus, removed upon repeating the task. If you want both scheduling and deadline information to repeat after the same interval, set the same repeater for both timestamps. An alternative to using a repeater is to create a number of copies of a task subtree, with dates shifted in each copy. The command @kbd{C-c C-x c} was created for this purpose; it is described in @ref{Structure Editing}. @node Clocking Work Time @section Clocking Work Time @cindex clocking time @cindex time clocking Org mode allows you to clock the time you spend on specific tasks in a project. When you start working on an item, you can start the clock. When you stop working on that task, or when you mark the task done, the clock is stopped and the corresponding time interval is recorded. It also computes the total time spent on each subtree@footnote{Clocking only works if all headings are indented with less than 30 stars. This is a hard-coded limitation of @code{lmax} in @code{org-clock-sum}.} of a project. And it remembers a history or tasks recently clocked, so that you can jump quickly between a number of tasks absorbing your time. To save the clock history across Emacs sessions, use: @lisp (setq org-clock-persist 'history) (org-clock-persistence-insinuate) @end lisp @vindex org-clock-persist When you clock into a new task after resuming Emacs, the incomplete clock@footnote{To resume the clock under the assumption that you have worked on this task while outside Emacs, use @samp{(setq org-clock-persist t)}.} is retrieved (see @ref{Resolving idle time (1)}) and you are prompted about what to do with it. @menu * Clocking commands:: Starting and stopping a clock. * The clock table:: Detailed reports. * Resolving idle time:: Resolving time when you've been idle. @end menu @node Clocking commands @subsection Clocking commands @table @asis @item @kbd{C-c C-x C-i} (@code{org-clock-in}) @kindex C-c C-x C-i @findex org-clock-in @vindex org-clock-into-drawer @vindex org-clock-continuously @cindex @samp{LOG_INTO_DRAWER}, property Start the clock on the current item (clock-in). This inserts the @samp{CLOCK} keyword together with a timestamp. If this is not the first clocking of this item, the multiple @samp{CLOCK} lines are wrapped into a @samp{LOGBOOK} drawer (see also the variable @code{org-clock-into-drawer}). You can also overrule the setting of this variable for a subtree by setting a @samp{CLOCK_INTO_DRAWER} or @samp{LOG_INTO_DRAWER} property. When called with a @kbd{C-u} prefix argument, select the task from a list of recently clocked tasks. With two @kbd{C-u C-u} prefixes, clock into the task at point and mark it as the default task; the default task is always be available with letter @kbd{d} when selecting a clocking task. With three @kbd{C-u C-u C-u} prefixes, force continuous clocking by starting the clock when the last clock stopped. @cindex @samp{CLOCK_MODELINE_TOTAL}, property @cindex @samp{LAST_REPEAT}, property @vindex org-clock-mode-line-total @vindex org-clock-in-prepare-hook While the clock is running, Org shows the current clocking time in the mode line, along with the title of the task. The clock time shown is all time ever clocked for this task and its children. If the task has an effort estimate (see @ref{Effort Estimates}), the mode line displays the current clocking time against it@footnote{To add an effort estimate ``on the fly'', hook a function doing this to @code{org-clock-in-prepare-hook}.}. If the task is a repeating one (see @ref{Repeated tasks}), show only the time since the last reset of the task@footnote{The last reset of the task is recorded by the @samp{LAST_REPEAT} property.}. You can exercise more control over show time with the @samp{CLOCK_MODELINE_TOTAL} property. It may have the values @samp{current} to show only the current clocking instance, @samp{today} to show all time clocked on this tasks today---see also the variable @code{org-extend-today-until}, @code{all} to include all time, or @code{auto} which is the default@footnote{See also the variable @code{org-clock-mode-line-total}.}. Clicking with @kbd{mouse-1} onto the mode line entry pops up a menu with clocking options. @item @kbd{C-c C-x C-o} (@code{org-clock-out}) @kindex C-c C-x C-o @findex org-clock-out @vindex org-log-note-clock-out Stop the clock (clock-out). This inserts another timestamp at the same location where the clock was last started. It also directly computes the resulting time in inserts it after the time range as @samp{=>HH:MM}. See the variable @code{org-log-note-clock-out} for the possibility to record an additional note together with the clock-out timestamp@footnote{The corresponding in-buffer setting is: @samp{#+STARTUP: lognoteclock-out}.}. @item @kbd{C-c C-x C-x} (@code{org-clock-in-last}) @kindex C-c C-x C-x @findex org-clock-in-last @vindex org-clock-continuously Re-clock the last clocked task. With one @kbd{C-u} prefix argument, select the task from the clock history. With two @kbd{C-u} prefixes, force continuous clocking by starting the clock when the last clock stopped. @item @kbd{C-c C-x C-e} (@code{org-clock-modify-effort-estimate}) @kindex C-c C-x C-e @findex org-clock-modify-effort-estimate Update the effort estimate for the current clock task. @item @kbd{C-c C-c} or @kbd{C-c C-y} (@code{org-evaluate-time-range}) @kindex C-c C-c @kindex C-c C-y @findex org-evaluate-time-range Recompute the time interval after changing one of the timestamps. This is only necessary if you edit the timestamps directly. If you change them with @kbd{S-} keys, the update is automatic. @item @kbd{C-S-@key{UP}} (@code{org-clock-timestamps-up}) @itemx @kbd{C-S-@key{DOWN}} (@code{org-clock-timestamps-down}) @kindex C-S-UP @findex org-clock-timestamps-up @kindex C-S-DOWN @findex org-clock-timestamps-down On CLOCK log lines, increase/decrease both timestamps so that the clock duration keeps the same value. @item @kbd{S-M-@key{UP}} (@code{org-timestamp-up}) @itemx @kbd{S-M-@key{DOWN}} (@code{org-timestamp-down}) @kindex S-M-UP @findex org-clock-timestamp-up @kindex S-M-DOWN @findex org-clock-timestamp-down On @samp{CLOCK} log lines, increase/decrease the timestamp at point and the one of the previous, or the next, clock timestamp by the same duration. For example, if you hit @kbd{S-M-@key{UP}} to increase a clocked-out timestamp by five minutes, then the clocked-in timestamp of the next clock is increased by five minutes. @item @kbd{C-c C-t} (@code{org-todo}) @kindex C-c C-t @findex org-todo Changing the TODO state of an item to DONE automatically stops the clock if it is running in this same item. @item @kbd{C-c C-x C-q} (@code{org-clock-cancel}) @kindex C-c C-x C-q @findex org-clock-cancel Cancel the current clock. This is useful if a clock was started by mistake, or if you ended up working on something else. @item @kbd{C-c C-x C-j} (@code{org-clock-goto}) @kindex C-c C-x C-j @findex or-clock-goto Jump to the headline of the currently clocked in task. With a @kbd{C-u} prefix argument, select the target task from a list of recently clocked tasks. @item @kbd{C-c C-x C-d} (@code{org-clock-display}) @kindex C-c C-x C-d @findex org-clock-display @vindex org-remove-highlights-with-change Display time summaries for each subtree in the current buffer. This puts overlays at the end of each headline, showing the total time recorded under that heading, including the time of any subheadings. You can use visibility cycling to study the tree, but the overlays disappear when you change the buffer (see variable @code{org-remove-highlights-with-change}) or press @kbd{C-c C-c}. @end table The @kbd{l} key may be used in the agenda (see @ref{Weekly/daily agenda}) to show which tasks have been worked on or closed during a day. @strong{Important:} note that both @code{org-clock-out} and @code{org-clock-in-last} can have a global keybinding and do not modify the window disposition. @node The clock table @subsection The clock table @cindex clocktable, dynamic block @cindex report, of clocked time Org mode can produce quite complex reports based on the time clocking information. Such a report is called a @emph{clock table}, because it is formatted as one or several Org tables. @table @asis @item @code{org-clock-report} @kindex C-c C-x x @findex org-clock-report Insert or update a clock table. When called with a prefix argument, jump to the first clock table in the current document and update it. The clock table includes archived trees. This command can be invoked by calling @code{org-dynamic-block-insert-dblock} (@kbd{C-c C-x x}) and selecting ``clocktable'' (see @ref{Dynamic Blocks}). @item @kbd{C-c C-c} or @kbd{C-c C-x C-u} (@code{org-dblock-update}) @kindex C-c C-c @kindex C-c C-x C-u @findex org-dblock-update Update dynamic block at point. Point needs to be in the @samp{BEGIN} line of the dynamic block. @item @kbd{C-u C-c C-x C-u} @kindex C-u C-c C-x C-u Update all dynamic blocks (see @ref{Dynamic Blocks}). This is useful if you have several clock table blocks in a buffer. @item @kbd{S-@key{LEFT}} @itemx @kbd{S-@key{RIGHT}} (@code{org-clocktable-try-shift}) @kindex S-LEFT @kindex S-RIGHT @findex org-clocktable-try-shift Shift the current @samp{:block} interval and update the table. Point needs to be in the @samp{#+BEGIN: clocktable} line for this command. If @samp{:block} is @samp{today}, it is shifted to @samp{today-1}, etc. @end table Here is an example of the frame for a clock table as it is inserted into the buffer by @code{org-clock-report}: @cindex @samp{BEGIN clocktable} @example #+BEGIN: clocktable :maxlevel 2 :emphasize nil :scope file #+END: clocktable @end example @vindex org-clocktable-defaults The @samp{#+BEGIN} line contains options to define the scope, structure, and formatting of the report. Defaults for all these options can be configured in the variable @code{org-clocktable-defaults}. First there are options that determine which clock entries are to be selected: @table @asis @item @samp{:maxlevel} Maximum level depth to which times are listed in the table. Clocks at deeper levels are summed into the upper level. @item @samp{:scope} The scope to consider. This can be any of the following: @multitable {aaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaa} {aaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaa} @item @samp{nil} @tab the current buffer or narrowed region @item @samp{file} @tab the full current buffer @item @samp{subtree} @tab the subtree where the clocktable is located @item @samp{treeN} @tab the surrounding level N tree, for example @samp{tree3} @item @samp{tree} @tab the surrounding level 1 tree @item @samp{agenda} @tab all agenda files @item @samp{("file" ...)} @tab scan these files @item @samp{FUNCTION} @tab scan files returned by calling @var{FUNCTION} with no argument @item @samp{file-with-archives} @tab current file and its archives @item @samp{agenda-with-archives} @tab all agenda files, including archives @end multitable @item @samp{:block} The time block to consider. This block is specified either absolutely, or relative to the current time and may be any of these formats: @multitable {aaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaa} {aaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaa} @item @samp{2007-12-31} @tab New year eve 2007 @item @samp{2007-12} @tab December 2007 @item @samp{2007-W50} @tab ISO-week 50 in 2007 @item @samp{2007-Q2} @tab 2nd quarter in 2007 @item @samp{2007} @tab the year 2007 @item @samp{today}, @samp{yesterday}, @samp{today-N} @tab a relative day @item @samp{thisweek}, @samp{lastweek}, @samp{thisweek-N} @tab a relative week @item @samp{thismonth}, @samp{lastmonth}, @samp{thismonth-N} @tab a relative month @item @samp{thisyear}, @samp{lastyear}, @samp{thisyear-N} @tab a relative year @item @samp{untilnow}@footnote{When using @code{:step}, @code{untilnow} starts from the beginning of 2003, not the beginning of time.} @tab all clocked time ever @end multitable @vindex org-clock-display-default-range When this option is not set, Org falls back to the value in @code{org-clock-display-default-range}, which defaults to the current year. Use @kbd{S-@key{LEFT}} or @kbd{S-@key{RIGHT}} to shift the time interval. @item @samp{:tstart} A time string specifying when to start considering times. Relative times like @samp{"<-2w>"} can also be used. See @ref{Matching tags and properties} for relative time syntax. @item @samp{:tend} A time string specifying when to stop considering times. Relative times like @samp{""} can also be used. See @ref{Matching tags and properties} for relative time syntax. @item @samp{:wstart} The starting day of the week. The default is 1 for Monday. @item @samp{:mstart} The starting day of the month. The default is 1 for the first. @item @samp{:step} Set to @samp{day}, @samp{week}, @samp{semimonth}, @samp{month}, or @samp{year} to split the table into chunks. To use this, either @samp{:block}, or @samp{:tstart} and @samp{:tend} are required. @item @samp{:stepskip0} When non-@code{nil}, do not show steps that have zero time. @item @samp{:fileskip0} When non-@code{nil}, do not show table sections from files which did not contribute. @item @samp{:match} A tags match to select entries that should contribute. See @ref{Matching tags and properties} for the match syntax. @end table @findex org-clocktable-write-default Then there are options that determine the formatting of the table. There options are interpreted by the function @code{org-clocktable-write-default}, but you can specify your own function using the @samp{:formatter} parameter. @table @asis @item @samp{:emphasize} When non-@code{nil}, emphasize level one and level two items. @item @samp{:lang} Language@footnote{Language terms can be set through the variable @code{org-clock-clocktable-language-setup}.} to use for descriptive cells like ``Task''. @item @samp{:link} Link the item headlines in the table to their origins. @item @samp{:narrow} An integer to limit the width of the headline column in the Org table. If you write it like @samp{50!}, then the headline is also shortened in export. @item @samp{:indent} Indent each headline field according to its level. @item @samp{:hidefiles} Hide the file column when multiple files are used to produce the table. @item @samp{:tcolumns} Number of columns to be used for times. If this is smaller than @samp{:maxlevel}, lower levels are lumped into one column. @item @samp{:level} Should a level number column be included? @item @samp{:sort} A cons cell containing the column to sort and a sorting type. E.g., @samp{:sort (1 . ?a)} sorts the first column alphabetically. @item @samp{:compact} Abbreviation for @samp{:level nil :indent t :narrow 40! :tcolumns 1}. All are overwritten except if there is an explicit @samp{:narrow}. @item @samp{:timestamp} A timestamp for the entry, when available. Look for @samp{SCHEDULED}, @samp{DEADLINE}, @samp{TIMESTAMP} and @samp{TIMESTAMP_IA} special properties (see @ref{Special Properties}), in this order. @item @samp{:tags} When this flag is non-@code{nil}, show the headline's tags. @item @samp{:properties} List of properties shown in the table. Each property gets its own column. @item @samp{:inherit-props} When this flag is non-@code{nil}, the values for @samp{:properties} are inherited. @item @samp{:formula} Content of a @samp{TBLFM} keyword to be added and evaluated. As a special case, @samp{:formula %} adds a column with % time. If you do not specify a formula here, any existing formula below the clock table survives updates and is evaluated. @item @samp{:formatter} A function to format clock data and insert it into the buffer. @end table To get a clock summary of the current level 1 tree, for the current day, you could write: @example #+BEGIN: clocktable :maxlevel 2 :block today :scope tree1 :link t #+END: clocktable @end example @noindent To use a specific time range you could write@footnote{Note that all parameters must be specified in a single line---the line is broken here only to fit it into the manual.} @example #+BEGIN: clocktable :tstart "<2006-08-10 Thu 10:00>" :tend "<2006-08-10 Thu 12:00>" #+END: clocktable @end example @noindent A range starting a week ago and ending right now could be written as @example #+BEGIN: clocktable :tstart "<-1w>" :tend "" #+END: clocktable @end example @noindent A summary of the current subtree with % times would be @example #+BEGIN: clocktable :scope subtree :link t :formula % #+END: clocktable @end example @noindent A horizontally compact representation of everything clocked during last week would be @example #+BEGIN: clocktable :scope agenda :block lastweek :compact t #+END: clocktable @end example @node Resolving idle time @subsection Resolving idle time and continuous clocking @anchor{Resolving idle time (1)} @subsubheading Resolving idle time @cindex resolve idle time @cindex idle, resolve, dangling If you clock in on a work item, and then walk away from your computer---perhaps to take a phone call---you often need to ``resolve'' the time you were away by either subtracting it from the current clock, or applying it to another one. @vindex org-clock-idle-time @vindex org-clock-x11idle-program-name By customizing the variable @code{org-clock-idle-time} to some integer, such as 10 or 15, Emacs can alert you when you get back to your computer after being idle for that many minutes@footnote{On computers using macOS, idleness is based on actual user idleness, not just Emacs' idle time. For X11, you can install a utility program @samp{x11idle.c}, available in the @samp{contrib/scripts/} directory of the Org Git distribution, or install the xprintidle package and set it to the variable @code{org-clock-x11idle-program-name} if you are running Debian, to get the same general treatment of idleness. On other systems, idle time refers to Emacs idle time only.}, and ask what you want to do with the idle time. There will be a question waiting for you when you get back, indicating how much idle time has passed constantly updated with the current amount, as well as a set of choices to correct the discrepancy: @table @asis @item @kbd{k} @kindex k To keep some or all of the minutes and stay clocked in, press @kbd{k}. Org asks how many of the minutes to keep. Press @kbd{@key{RET}} to keep them all, effectively changing nothing, or enter a number to keep that many minutes. @item @kbd{K} @kindex K If you use the shift key and press @kbd{K}, it keeps however many minutes you request and then immediately clock out of that task. If you keep all of the minutes, this is the same as just clocking out of the current task. @item @kbd{s} @kindex s To keep none of the minutes, use @kbd{s} to subtract all the away time from the clock, and then check back in from the moment you returned. @item @kbd{S} @kindex S To keep none of the minutes and just clock out at the start of the away time, use the shift key and press @kbd{S}. Remember that using shift always leave you clocked out, no matter which option you choose. @item @kbd{C} @kindex C To cancel the clock altogether, use @kbd{C}. Note that if instead of canceling you subtract the away time, and the resulting clock amount is less than a minute, the clock is still canceled rather than cluttering up the log with an empty entry. @end table What if you subtracted those away minutes from the current clock, and now want to apply them to a new clock? Simply clock in to any task immediately after the subtraction. Org will notice that you have subtracted time ``on the books'', so to speak, and will ask if you want to apply those minutes to the next task you clock in on. There is one other instance when this clock resolution magic occurs. Say you were clocked in and hacking away, and suddenly your cat chased a mouse who scared a hamster that crashed into your UPS's power button! You suddenly lose all your buffers, but thanks to auto-save you still have your recent Org mode changes, including your last clock in. If you restart Emacs and clock into any task, Org will notice that you have a dangling clock which was never clocked out from your last session. Using that clock's starting time as the beginning of the unaccounted-for period, Org will ask how you want to resolve that time. The logic and behavior is identical to dealing with away time due to idleness; it is just happening due to a recovery event rather than a set amount of idle time. You can also check all the files visited by your Org agenda for dangling clocks at any time using @kbd{M-x org-resolve-clocks @key{RET}} (or @kbd{C-c C-x C-z}). @anchor{Continuous clocking} @subsubheading Continuous clocking @cindex continuous clocking @vindex org-clock-continuously You may want to start clocking from the time when you clocked out the previous task. To enable this systematically, set @code{org-clock-continuously} to non-@code{nil}. Each time you clock in, Org retrieves the clock-out time of the last clocked entry for this session, and start the new clock from there. If you only want this from time to time, use three universal prefix arguments with @code{org-clock-in} and two @kbd{C-u C-u} with @code{org-clock-in-last}. @anchor{Clocking out automatically after some idle time} @subsubheading Clocking out automatically after some idle time @cindex auto clocking out after idle time @vindex org-clock-auto-clockout-timer When you often forget to clock out before being idle and you don't want to manually set the clocking time to take into account, you can set @code{org-clock-auto-clockout-timer} to a number of seconds and add @samp{(org-clock-auto-clockout-insinuate)} to your @samp{.emacs} file. When the clock is running and Emacs is idle for more than this number of seconds, the clock will be clocked out automatically. Use @samp{M-x org-clock-toggle-auto-clockout RET} to temporarily turn this on or off. @node Effort Estimates @section Effort Estimates @cindex effort estimates @cindex @samp{EFFORT}, property @vindex org-effort-property If you want to plan your work in a very detailed way, or if you need to produce offers with quotations of the estimated work effort, you may want to assign effort estimates to entries. If you are also clocking your work, you may later want to compare the planned effort with the actual working time, a great way to improve planning estimates. Effort estimates are stored in a special property @samp{EFFORT}. Multiple formats are supported, such as @samp{3:12}, @samp{1:23:45}, or @samp{1d3h5min}; see the file @samp{org-duration.el} for more detailed information about the format. You can set the effort for an entry with the following commands: @table @asis @item @kbd{C-c C-x e} (@code{org-set-effort}) @kindex C-c C-x e @findex org-set-effort Set the effort estimate for the current entry. With a prefix argument, set it to the next allowed value---see below. This command is also accessible from the agenda with the @kbd{e} key. @item @kbd{C-c C-x C-e} (@code{org-clock-modify-effort-estimate}) @kindex C-c C-x C-e @findex org-clock-modify-effort-estimate Modify the effort estimate of the item currently being clocked. @end table Clearly the best way to work with effort estimates is through column view (see @ref{Column View}). You should start by setting up discrete values for effort estimates, and a @samp{COLUMNS} format that displays these values together with clock sums---if you want to clock your time. For a specific buffer you can use: @example #+PROPERTY: Effort_ALL 0 0:10 0:30 1:00 2:00 3:00 4:00 5:00 6:00 7:00 #+COLUMNS: %40ITEM(Task) %17Effort(Estimated Effort)@{:@} %CLOCKSUM @end example @noindent @vindex org-global-properties @vindex org-columns-default-format or, even better, you can set up these values globally by customizing the variables @code{org-global-properties} and @code{org-columns-default-format}. In particular if you want to use this setup also in the agenda, a global setup may be advised. The way to assign estimates to individual items is then to switch to column mode, and to use @kbd{S-@key{RIGHT}} and @kbd{S-@key{LEFT}} to change the value. The values you enter are immediately summed up in the hierarchy. In the column next to it, any clocked time is displayed. @vindex org-agenda-columns-add-appointments-to-effort-sum If you switch to column view in the daily/weekly agenda, the effort column summarizes the estimated work effort for each day@footnote{Please note the pitfalls of summing hierarchical data in a flat list (see @ref{Agenda Column View}).}, and you can use this to find space in your schedule. To get an overview of the entire part of the day that is committed, you can set the option @code{org-agenda-columns-add-appointments-to-effort-sum}. The appointments on a day that take place over a specified time interval are then also added to the load estimate of the day. Effort estimates can be used in secondary agenda filtering that is triggered with the @kbd{/} key in the agenda (see @ref{Agenda Commands}). If you have these estimates defined consistently, two or three key presses narrow down the list to stuff that fits into an available time slot. @node Timers @section Taking Notes with a Relative Timer @cindex relative timer @cindex countdown timer Org provides two types of timers. There is a relative timer that counts up, which can be useful when taking notes during, for example, a meeting or a video viewing. There is also a countdown timer. The relative and countdown are started with separate commands. @table @asis @item @kbd{C-c C-x 0} (@code{org-timer-start}) @kindex C-c C-x 0 @findex org-timer-start Start or reset the relative timer. By default, the timer is set to 0. When called with a @kbd{C-u} prefix, prompt the user for a starting offset. If there is a timer string at point, this is taken as the default, providing a convenient way to restart taking notes after a break in the process. When called with a double prefix argument @kbd{C-u C-u}, change all timer strings in the active region by a certain amount. This can be used to fix timer strings if the timer was not started at exactly the right moment. @item @kbd{C-c C-x ;} (@code{org-timer-set-timer}) @kindex C-c C-x ; @findex org-timer-set-timer @vindex org-timer-default-timer Start a countdown timer. The user is prompted for a duration. @code{org-timer-default-timer} sets the default countdown value. Giving a numeric prefix argument overrides this default value. This command is available as @kbd{;} in agenda buffers. @end table Once started, relative and countdown timers are controlled with the same commands. @table @asis @item @kbd{C-c C-x .} (@code{org-timer}) @kindex C-c C-x . @findex org-timer Insert a relative time into the buffer. The first time you use this, the timer starts. Using a prefix argument restarts it. @item @kbd{C-c C-x -} (@code{org-timer-item}) @kindex C-c C-x - @findex org-timer-item Insert a description list item with the current relative time. With a prefix argument, first reset the timer to 0. @item @kbd{M-@key{RET}} (@code{org-insert-heading}) @kindex M-RET @findex org-insert-heading Once the timer list is started, you can also use @kbd{M-@key{RET}} to insert new timer items. @item @kbd{C-c C-x ,} (@code{org-timer-pause-or-continue}) @kindex C-c C-x , @findex org-timer-pause-or-continue Pause the timer, or continue it if it is already paused. @item @kbd{C-c C-x _} (@code{org-timer-stop}) @kindex C-c C-x _ @findex org-timer-stop Stop the timer. After this, you can only start a new timer, not continue the old one. This command also removes the timer from the mode line. @end table @node Refiling and Archiving @chapter Refiling and Archiving @cindex refiling notes @cindex copying notes @cindex archiving Once information is in the system, it may need to be moved around. Org provides Refile, Copy and Archive commands for this. Refile and Copy helps with moving and copying outlines. Archiving helps to keep the system compact and fast. @menu * Refile and Copy:: Moving/copying a tree from one place to another. * Archiving:: What to do with finished products. @end menu @node Refile and Copy @section Refile and Copy @cindex refiling notes @cindex copying notes When reviewing the captured data, you may want to refile or to copy some of the entries into a different list, for example into a project. Cutting, finding the right location, and then pasting the note is cumbersome. To simplify this process, you can use the following special command: @table @asis @item @kbd{C-c C-w} (@code{org-refile}) @kindex C-c C-w @findex org-refile @vindex org-reverse-note-order @vindex org-refile-targets @vindex org-refile-use-outline-path @vindex org-outline-path-complete-in-steps @vindex org-refile-allow-creating-parent-nodes @vindex org-log-refile Refile the entry or region at point. This command offers possible locations for refiling the entry and lets you select one with completion. The item (or all items in the region) is filed below the target heading as a subitem. Depending on @code{org-reverse-note-order}, it is either the first or last subitem. By default, all level 1 headlines in the current buffer are considered to be targets, but you can have more complex definitions across a number of files. See the variable @code{org-refile-targets} for details. If you would like to select a location via a file-path-like completion along the outline path, see the variables @code{org-refile-use-outline-path} and @code{org-outline-path-complete-in-steps}. If you would like to be able to create new nodes as new parents for refiling on the fly, check the variable @code{org-refile-allow-creating-parent-nodes}. When the variable @code{org-log-refile}@footnote{Note the corresponding @samp{STARTUP} options @samp{logrefile}, @samp{lognoterefile}, and @samp{nologrefile}.} is set, a timestamp or a note is recorded whenever an entry is refiled. @item @kbd{C-u C-c C-w} @kindex C-u C-c C-w Use the refile interface to jump to a heading. @item @kbd{C-u C-u C-c C-w} (@code{org-refile-goto-last-stored}) @kindex C-u C-u C-c C-w @findex org-refile-goto-last-stored Jump to the location where @code{org-refile} last moved a tree to. @item @kbd{C-2 C-c C-w} @kindex C-2 C-c C-w Refile as the child of the item currently being clocked. @item @kbd{C-3 C-c C-w} @kindex C-3 C-c C-w @vindex org-refile-keep Refile and keep the entry in place. Also see @code{org-refile-keep} to make this the default behavior, and beware that this may result in duplicated @samp{ID} properties. @item @kbd{C-0 C-c C-w} or @kbd{C-u C-u C-u C-c C-w} (@code{org-refile-cache-clear}) @kindex C-u C-u C-u C-c C-w @kindex C-0 C-c C-w @findex org-refile-cache-clear @vindex org-refile-use-cache Clear the target cache. Caching of refile targets can be turned on by setting @code{org-refile-use-cache}. To make the command see new possible targets, you have to clear the cache with this command. @item @kbd{C-c M-w} (@code{org-refile-copy}) @kindex C-c M-w @findex org-refile-copy Copying works like refiling, except that the original note is not deleted. @end table @node Archiving @section Archiving @cindex archiving When a project represented by a (sub)tree is finished, you may want to move the tree out of the way and to stop it from contributing to the agenda. Archiving is important to keep your working files compact and global searches like the construction of agenda views fast. @table @asis @item @kbd{C-c C-x C-a} (@code{org-archive-subtree-default}) @kindex C-c C-x C-a @findex org-archive-subtree-default @vindex org-archive-default-command Archive the current entry using the command specified in the variable @code{org-archive-default-command}. @end table @menu * Moving subtrees:: Moving a tree to an archive file. * Internal archiving:: Switch off a tree but keep it in the file. @end menu @node Moving subtrees @subsection Moving a tree to an archive file @cindex external archiving The most common archiving action is to move a project tree to another file, the archive file. @table @asis @item @kbd{C-c C-x C-s} or short @kbd{C-c $} (@code{org-archive-subtree}) @kindex C-c C-x C-s @kindex C-c $ @findex org-archive-subtree @vindex org-archive-location Archive the subtree starting at point position to the location given by @code{org-archive-location}. @item @kbd{C-u C-c C-x C-s} @kindex C-u C-c C-x C-s Check if any direct children of the current headline could be moved to the archive. To do this, check each subtree for open TODO entries. If none is found, the command offers to move it to the archive location. If point is @emph{not} on a headline when this command is invoked, check level 1 trees. @item @kbd{C-u C-u C-c C-x C-s} @kindex C-u C-u C-c C-x C-s As above, but check subtree for timestamps instead of TODO entries. The command offers to archive the subtree if it @emph{does} contain a timestamp, and that timestamp is in the past. @end table @cindex archive locations The default archive location is a file in the same directory as the current file, with the name derived by appending @samp{_archive} to the current file name. You can also choose what heading to file archived items under, with the possibility to add them to a datetree in a file. For information and examples on how to specify the file and the heading, see the documentation string of the variable @code{org-archive-location}. There is also an in-buffer option for setting this variable, for example: @cindex @samp{ARCHIVE}, keyword @example #+ARCHIVE: %s_done:: @end example @cindex ARCHIVE, property If you would like to have a special archive location for a single entry or a (sub)tree, give the entry an @samp{ARCHIVE} property with the location as the value (see @ref{Properties and Columns}). @vindex org-archive-save-context-info When a subtree is moved, it receives a number of special properties that record context information like the file from where the entry came, its outline path the archiving time etc. Configure the variable @code{org-archive-save-context-info} to adjust the amount of information added. @vindex org-archive-subtree-save-file-p When @code{org-archive-subtree-save-file-p} is non-@code{nil}, save the target archive buffer. @node Internal archiving @subsection Internal archiving @cindex @samp{ARCHIVE}, tag If you want to just switch off---for agenda views---certain subtrees without moving them to a different file, you can use the @samp{ARCHIVE} tag. A headline that is marked with the @samp{ARCHIVE} tag (see @ref{Tags}) stays at its location in the outline tree, but behaves in the following way: @itemize @item @vindex org-cycle-open-archived-trees It does not open when you attempt to do so with a visibility cycling command (see @ref{Visibility Cycling}). You can force cycling archived subtrees with @kbd{C-@key{TAB}}, or by setting the option @code{org-cycle-open-archived-trees}. Also normal outline commands, like @code{outline-show-all}, open archived subtrees. @item @vindex org-sparse-tree-open-archived-trees During sparse tree construction (see @ref{Sparse Trees}), matches in archived subtrees are not exposed, unless you configure the option @code{org-sparse-tree-open-archived-trees}. @item @vindex org-agenda-skip-archived-trees During agenda view construction (see @ref{Agenda Views}), the content of archived trees is ignored unless you configure the option @code{org-agenda-skip-archived-trees}, in which case these trees are always included. In the agenda you can press @kbd{v a} to get archives temporarily included. @item @vindex org-export-with-archived-trees Archived trees are not exported (see @ref{Exporting}), only the headline is. Configure the details using the variable @code{org-export-with-archived-trees}. @item @vindex org-columns-skip-archived-trees Archived trees are excluded from column view unless the variable @code{org-columns-skip-archived-trees} is configured to @code{nil}. @end itemize The following commands help manage the @samp{ARCHIVE} tag: @table @asis @item @kbd{C-c C-x a} (@code{org-toggle-archive-tag}) @kindex C-c C-x a @findex org-toggle-archive-tag Toggle the archive tag for the current headline. When the tag is set, the headline changes to a shadowed face, and the subtree below it is hidden. @item @kbd{C-u C-c C-x a} @kindex C-u C-c C-x a Check if any direct children of the current headline should be archived. To do this, check each subtree for open TODO entries. If none is found, the command offers to set the @samp{ARCHIVE} tag for the child. If point is @emph{not} on a headline when this command is invoked, check the level 1 trees. @item @kbd{C-c C-@key{TAB}} (@code{org-force-cycle-archived}) @kindex C-TAB Cycle a tree even if it is tagged with @samp{ARCHIVE}. @item @kbd{C-c C-x A} (@code{org-archive-to-archive-sibling}) @kindex C-c C-x A @findex org-archive-to-archive-sibling Move the current entry to the @emph{Archive Sibling}. This is a sibling of the entry with the heading @samp{Archive} and the archive tag. The entry becomes a child of that sibling and in this way retains a lot of its original context, including inherited tags and approximate position in the outline. @end table @node Capture and Attachments @chapter Capture and Attachments @cindex capture @cindex attachments @cindex RSS feeds @cindex Atom feeds @cindex protocols, for external access An important part of any organization system is the ability to quickly capture new ideas and tasks, and to associate reference material with them. Org does this using a process called @emph{capture}. It also can store files related to a task (@emph{attachments}) in a special directory. Finally, it can parse RSS feeds for information. To learn how to let external programs (for example a web browser) trigger Org to capture material, see @ref{Protocols}. @menu * Capture:: Capturing new stuff. * Attachments:: Attach files to outlines. * RSS Feeds:: Getting input from RSS feeds. @end menu @node Capture @section Capture @cindex capture Capture lets you quickly store notes with little interruption of your work flow. Org's method for capturing new items is heavily inspired by John Wiegley's excellent Remember package. @menu * Setting up capture:: Where notes will be stored. * Using capture:: Commands to invoke and terminate capture. * Capture templates:: Define the outline of different note types. @end menu @node Setting up capture @subsection Setting up capture The following customization sets a default target file for notes. @vindex org-default-notes-file @lisp (setq org-default-notes-file (concat org-directory "/notes.org")) @end lisp You may also define a global key for capturing new material (see @ref{Activation}). @node Using capture @subsection Using capture @table @asis @item @kbd{M-x org-capture} (@code{org-capture}) @findex org-capture @cindex date tree Display the capture templates menu. If you have templates defined (see @ref{Capture templates}), it offers these templates for selection or use a new Org outline node as the default template. It inserts the template into the target file and switch to an indirect buffer narrowed to this new node. You may then insert the information you want. @item @kbd{C-c C-c} (@code{org-capture-finalize}) @kindex C-c C-c @r{(Capture buffer)} @findex org-capture-finalize Once you have finished entering information into the capture buffer, @kbd{C-c C-c} returns you to the window configuration before the capture process, so that you can resume your work without further distraction. When called with a prefix argument, finalize and then jump to the captured item. @item @kbd{C-c C-w} (@code{org-capture-refile}) @kindex C-c C-w @r{(Capture buffer)} @findex org-capture-refile Finalize the capture process by refiling the note to a different place (see @ref{Refile and Copy}). Please realize that this is a normal refiling command that will be executed---so point position at the moment you run this command is important. If you have inserted a tree with a parent and children, first move point back to the parent. Any prefix argument given to this command is passed on to the @code{org-refile} command. @item @kbd{C-c C-k} (@code{org-capture-kill}) @kindex C-c C-k @r{(Capture buffer)} @findex org-capture-kill Abort the capture process and return to the previous state. @end table @kindex k c @r{(Agenda)} You can also call @code{org-capture} in a special way from the agenda, using the @kbd{k c} key combination. With this access, any timestamps inserted by the selected capture template defaults to the date at point in the agenda, rather than to the current date. To find the locations of the last stored capture, use @code{org-capture} with prefix commands: @table @asis @item @kbd{C-u M-x org-capture} Visit the target location of a capture template. You get to select the template in the usual way. @item @kbd{C-u C-u M-x org-capture} Visit the last stored capture item in its buffer. @end table @vindex org-capture-bookmark @vindex org-capture-last-stored You can also jump to the bookmark @code{org-capture-last-stored}, which is automatically created unless you set @code{org-capture-bookmark} to @code{nil}. To insert the capture at point in an Org buffer, call @code{org-capture} with a @kbd{C-0} prefix argument. @node Capture templates @subsection Capture templates @cindex templates, for Capture You can use templates for different types of capture items, and for different target locations. The easiest way to create such templates is through the customize interface. @table @asis @item @kbd{C} @kindex C @r{(Capture menu} @vindex org-capture-templates Customize the variable @code{org-capture-templates}. @end table Before we give the formal description of template definitions, let's look at an example. Say you would like to use one template to create general TODO entries, and you want to put these entries under the heading @samp{Tasks} in your file @samp{~/org/gtd.org}. Also, a date tree in the file @samp{journal.org} should capture journal entries. A possible configuration would look like: @lisp (setq org-capture-templates '(("t" "Todo" entry (file+headline "~/org/gtd.org" "Tasks") "* TODO %?\n %i\n %a") ("j" "Journal" entry (file+datetree "~/org/journal.org") "* %?\nEntered on %U\n %i\n %a"))) @end lisp If you then press @kbd{t} from the capture menu, Org will prepare the template for you like this: @example * TODO [[file:LINK TO WHERE YOU INITIATED CAPTURE]] @end example @noindent During expansion of the template, @samp{%a} has been replaced by a link to the location from where you called the capture command. This can be extremely useful for deriving tasks from emails, for example. You fill in the task definition, press @kbd{C-c C-c} and Org returns you to the same place where you started the capture process. To define special keys to capture to a particular template without going through the interactive template selection, you can create your key binding like this: @lisp (define-key global-map (kbd "C-c x") (lambda () (interactive) (org-capture nil "x"))) @end lisp @menu * Template elements:: What is needed for a complete template entry. * Template expansion:: Filling in information about time and context. * Templates in contexts:: Only show a template in a specific context. @end menu @node Template elements @subsubsection Template elements Now lets look at the elements of a template definition. Each entry in @code{org-capture-templates} is a list with the following items: @table @asis @item keys The keys that selects the template, as a string, characters only, for example @samp{"a"}, for a template to be selected with a single key, or @samp{"bt"} for selection with two keys. When using several keys, keys using the same prefix key must be sequential in the list and preceded by a 2-element entry explaining the prefix key, for example: @lisp ("b" "Templates for marking stuff to buy") @end lisp If you do not define a template for the @kbd{C} key, this key opens the Customize buffer for this complex variable. @item description A short string describing the template, shown during selection. @item type The type of entry, a symbol. Valid values are: @table @asis @item @code{entry} An Org mode node, with a headline. Will be filed as the child of the target entry or as a top-level entry. The target file should be an Org file. @item @code{item} A plain list item, placed in the first plain list at the target location. Again the target file should be an Org file. @item @code{checkitem} A checkbox item. This only differs from the plain list item by the default template. @item @code{table-line} A new line in the first table at the target location. Where exactly the line will be inserted depends on the properties @code{:prepend} and @code{:table-line-pos} (see below). @item @code{plain} Text to be inserted as it is. @end table @item target @vindex org-default-notes-file @vindex org-directory Specification of where the captured item should be placed. In Org files, targets usually define a node. Entries will become children of this node. Other types will be added to the table or list in the body of this node. Most target specifications contain a file name. If that file name is the empty string, it defaults to @code{org-default-notes-file}. A file can also be given as a variable or as a function called with no argument. When an absolute path is not specified for a target, it is taken as relative to @code{org-directory}. Valid values are: @table @asis @item @samp{(file "path/to/file")} Text will be placed at the beginning or end of that file. @item @samp{(id "id of existing org entry")} Filing as child of this entry, or in the body of the entry. @item @samp{(file+headline "filename" "node headline")} Fast configuration if the target heading is unique in the file. @item @samp{(file+olp "filename" "Level 1 heading" "Level 2" ...)} For non-unique headings, the full path is safer. @item @samp{(file+regexp "filename" "regexp to find location")} Use a regular expression to position point. @item @samp{(file+olp+datetree "filename" [ "Level 1 heading" ...])} This target@footnote{Org used to offer four different targets for date/week tree capture. Now, Org automatically translates these to use @code{file+olp+datetree}, applying the @code{:time-prompt} and @code{:tree-type} properties. Please rewrite your date/week-tree targets using @code{file+olp+datetree} since the older targets are now deprecated.} creates a heading in a date tree@footnote{A date tree is an outline structure with years on the highest level, months or ISO weeks as sublevels and then dates on the lowest level. Tags are allowed in the tree structure.} for today's date. If the optional outline path is given, the tree will be built under the node it is pointing to, instead of at top level. Check out the @code{:time-prompt} and @code{:tree-type} properties below for additional options. @item @samp{(file+function "filename" function-finding-location)} A function to find the right location in the file. @item @samp{(clock)} File to the entry that is currently being clocked. @item @samp{(function function-finding-location)} Most general way: write your own function which both visits the file and moves point to the right location. @end table @item template The template for creating the capture item. If you leave this empty, an appropriate default template will be used. Otherwise this is a string with escape codes, which will be replaced depending on time and context of the capture call. You may also get this template string from a file@footnote{When the file name is not absolute, Org assumes it is relative to @code{org-directory}.}, or dynamically, from a function using either syntax: @example (file "/path/to/template-file") (function FUNCTION-RETURNING-THE-TEMPLATE) @end example @item properties The rest of the entry is a property list of additional options. Recognized properties are: @table @asis @item @code{:prepend} Normally new captured information will be appended at the target location (last child, last table line, last list item, @dots{}). Setting this property changes that. @item @code{:immediate-finish} When set, do not offer to edit the information, just file it away immediately. This makes sense if the template only needs information that can be added automatically. @item @code{:jump-to-captured} When set, jump to the captured entry when finished. @item @code{:empty-lines} Set this to the number of lines to insert before and after the new item. Default 0, and the only other common value is 1. @item @code{:empty-lines-after} Set this to the number of lines that should be inserted after the new item. Overrides @code{:empty-lines} for the number of lines inserted after. @item @code{:empty-lines-before} Set this to the number of lines that should be inserted before the new item. Overrides @code{:empty-lines} for the number lines inserted before. @item @code{:clock-in} Start the clock in this item. @item @code{:clock-keep} Keep the clock running when filing the captured entry. @item @code{:clock-resume} If starting the capture interrupted a clock, restart that clock when finished with the capture. Note that @code{:clock-keep} has precedence over @code{:clock-resume}. When setting both to non-@code{nil}, the current clock will run and the previous one will not be resumed. @item @code{:time-prompt} Prompt for a date/time to be used for date/week trees and when filling the template. Without this property, capture uses the current date and time. Even if this property has not been set, you can force the same behavior by calling @code{org-capture} with a @kbd{C-1} prefix argument. @item @code{:tree-type} Use @code{week} to make a week tree instead of the month-day tree, i.e., place the headings for each day under a heading with the current ISO week. Use @code{month} to group entries by month only. Default is to group entries by day. @item @code{:unnarrowed} Do not narrow the target buffer, simply show the full buffer. Default is to narrow it so that you only see the new material. @item @code{:table-line-pos} Specification of the location in the table where the new line should be inserted. It should be a string like @samp{II-3} meaning that the new line should become the third line before the second horizontal separator line. @item @code{:kill-buffer} If the target file was not yet visited when capture was invoked, kill the buffer again after capture is completed. @item @code{:no-save} Do not save the target file after finishing the capture. @end table @end table @node Template expansion @subsubsection Template expansion In the template itself, special ``%-escapes''@footnote{If you need one of these sequences literally, escape the @samp{%} with a backslash.} allow dynamic insertion of content. The templates are expanded in the order given here: @table @asis @item @samp{%[FILE]} Insert the contents of the file given by @var{FILE}. @item @samp{%(EXP)} Evaluate Elisp expression @var{EXP} and replace it with the result. The @var{EXP} form must return a string. Only placeholders pre-existing within the template, or introduced with @samp{%[file]}, are expanded this way. Since this happens after expanding non-interactive ``%-escapes'', those can be used to fill the expression. @item @samp{%} The result of format-time-string on the @var{FORMAT} specification. @item @samp{%t} Timestamp, date only. @item @samp{%T} Timestamp, with date and time. @item @samp{%u}, @samp{%U} Like @samp{%t}, @samp{%T} above, but inactive timestamps. @item @samp{%i} Initial content, the region when capture is called while the region is active. If there is text before @samp{%i} on the same line, such as indentation, and @samp{%i} is not inside a @samp{%(exp)} form, that prefix is added before every line in the inserted text. @item @samp{%a} Annotation, normally the link created with @code{org-store-link}. @item @samp{%A} Like @samp{%a}, but prompt for the description part. @item @samp{%l} Like @samp{%a}, but only insert the literal link. @item @samp{%c} Current kill ring head. @item @samp{%x} Content of the X clipboard. @item @samp{%k} Title of the currently clocked task. @item @samp{%K} Link to the currently clocked task. @item @samp{%n} User name (taken from @code{user-full-name}). @item @samp{%f} File visited by current buffer when org-capture was called. @item @samp{%F} Full path of the file or directory visited by current buffer. @item @samp{%:keyword} Specific information for certain link types, see below. @item @samp{%^g} Prompt for tags, with completion on tags in target file. @item @samp{%^G} Prompt for tags, with completion all tags in all agenda files. @item @samp{%^t} Like @samp{%t}, but prompt for date. Similarly @samp{%^T}, @samp{%^u}, @samp{%^U}. You may define a prompt like @samp{%^@{Birthday@}t}. @item @samp{%^C} Interactive selection of which kill or clip to use. @item @samp{%^L} Like @samp{%^C}, but insert as link. @item @samp{%^@{PROP@}p} Prompt the user for a value for property @var{PROP}. @item @samp{%^@{PROMPT@}} Prompt the user for a string and replace this sequence with it. You may specify a default value and a completion table with @samp{%^@{prompt|default|completion2|completion3...@}}. The arrow keys access a prompt-specific history. @item @samp{%\N} Insert the text entered at the @var{N}th @samp{%^@{PROMPT@}}, where @var{N} is a number, starting from 1. @item @samp{%?} After completing the template, position point here. @end table @vindex org-store-link-props For specific link types, the following keywords are defined@footnote{If you define your own link types (see @ref{Adding Hyperlink Types}), any property you store with @code{org-store-link-props} can be accessed in capture templates in a similar way.}: @vindex org-link-from-user-regexp @multitable {aaaaaaaaaaaa} {aaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaa} @headitem Link type @tab Available keywords @item bbdb @tab @samp{%:name}, @samp{%:company} @item irc @tab @samp{%:server}, @samp{%:port}, @samp{%:nick} @item mh, rmail @tab @samp{%:type}, @samp{%:subject}, @samp{%:message-id} @item @tab @samp{%:from}, @samp{%:fromname}, @samp{%:fromaddress} @item @tab @samp{%:to}, @samp{%:toname}, @samp{%:toaddress} @item @tab @samp{%:date} (message date header field) @item @tab @samp{%:date-timestamp} (date as active timestamp) @item @tab @samp{%:date-timestamp-inactive} (date as inactive timestamp) @item @tab @samp{%:fromto} (either ``to NAME'' or ``from NAME'')@footnote{This is always the other, not the user. See the variable @code{org-link-from-user-regexp}.} @item gnus @tab @samp{%:group}, for messages also all email fields @item w3, w3m @tab @samp{%:url} @item info @tab @samp{%:file}, @samp{%:node} @item calendar @tab @samp{%:date} @item org-protocol @tab @samp{%:link}, @samp{%:description}, @samp{%:annotation} @end multitable @node Templates in contexts @subsubsection Templates in contexts @vindex org-capture-templates-contexts To control whether a capture template should be accessible from a specific context, you can customize @code{org-capture-templates-contexts}. Let's say, for example, that you have a capture template ``p'' for storing Gnus emails containing patches. Then you would configure this option like this: @lisp (setq org-capture-templates-contexts '(("p" (in-mode . "message-mode")))) @end lisp You can also tell that the command key @kbd{p} should refer to another template. In that case, add this command key like this: @lisp (setq org-capture-templates-contexts '(("p" "q" (in-mode . "message-mode")))) @end lisp See the docstring of the variable for more information. @node Attachments @section Attachments @cindex attachments It is often useful to associate reference material with an outline node. Small chunks of plain text can simply be stored in the subtree of a project. Hyperlinks (see @ref{Hyperlinks}) can establish associations with files that live elsewhere on a local, or even remote, computer, like emails or source code files belonging to a project. Another method is @emph{attachments}, which are files located in a directory belonging to an outline node. Org uses directories either named by a unique ID of each entry, or by a @samp{DIR} property. @menu * Attachment defaults and dispatcher:: How to access attachment commands * Attachment options:: Configuring the attachment system * Attachment links:: Hyperlink access to attachments * Automatic version-control with Git:: Everything safely stored away * Attach from Dired:: Using dired to select an attachment @end menu @node Attachment defaults and dispatcher @subsection Attachment defaults and dispatcher By default, Org attach uses ID properties when adding attachments to outline nodes. This makes working with attachments fully automated. There is no decision needed for folder-name or location. ID-based directories are by default located in the @samp{data/} directory, which lives in the same directory where your Org file lives@footnote{If you move entries or Org files from one directory to another, you may want to configure @code{org-attach-id-dir} to contain an absolute path.}. When attachments are made using @code{org-attach} a default tag @samp{ATTACH} is added to the node that gets the attachments. For more control over the setup, see @ref{Attachment options}. The following commands deal with attachments: @table @asis @item @kbd{C-c C-a} (@code{org-attach}) @kindex C-c C-a @findex org-attach The dispatcher for commands related to the attachment system. After these keys, a list of commands is displayed and you must press an additional key to select a command: @table @asis @item @kbd{a} (@code{org-attach-attach}) @kindex C-c C-a a @findex org-attach-attach @vindex org-attach-method Select a file and move it into the task's attachment directory. The file is copied, moved, or linked, depending on @code{org-attach-method}. Note that hard links are not supported on all systems. @item @kbd{c}/@kbd{m}/@kbd{l} @kindex C-c C-a c @kindex C-c C-a m @kindex C-c C-a l Attach a file using the copy/move/link method. Note that hard links are not supported on all systems. @item @kbd{b} (@code{org-attach-buffer}) @kindex C-c C-a b @findex org-attach-buffer Select a buffer and save it as a file in the task's attachment directory. @item @kbd{n} (@code{org-attach-new}) @kindex C-c C-a n @findex org-attach-new Create a new attachment as an Emacs buffer. @item @kbd{z} (@code{org-attach-sync}) @kindex C-c C-a z @findex org-attach-sync Synchronize the current task with its attachment directory, in case you added attachments yourself. @item @kbd{o} (@code{org-attach-open}) @kindex C-c C-a o @findex org-attach-open @vindex org-file-apps Open current task's attachment. If there is more than one, prompt for a file name first. Opening follows the rules set by @code{org-file-apps}. For more details, see the information on following hyperlinks (see @ref{Handling Links}). @item @kbd{O} (@code{org-attach-open-in-emacs}) @kindex C-c C-a O @findex org-attach-open-in-emacs Also open the attachment, but force opening the file in Emacs. @item @kbd{f} (@code{org-attach-reveal}) @kindex C-c C-a f @findex org-attach-reveal Open the current task's attachment directory. @item @kbd{F} (@code{org-attach-reveal-in-emacs}) @kindex C-c C-a F @findex org-attach-reveal-in-emacs Also open the directory, but force using Dired in Emacs. @item @kbd{d} (@code{org-attach-delete-one}) @kindex C-c C-a d Select and delete a single attachment. @item @kbd{D} (@code{org-attach-delete-all}) @kindex C-c C-a D Delete all of a task's attachments. A safer way is to open the directory in Dired and delete from there. @item @kbd{s} (@code{org-attach-set-directory}) @kindex C-c C-a s @cindex @samp{DIR}, property Set a specific directory as the entry's attachment directory. This works by putting the directory path into the @samp{DIR} property. @item @kbd{S} (@code{org-attach-unset-directory}) @kindex C-c C-a S @cindex @samp{DIR}, property Remove the attachment directory. This command removes the @samp{DIR} property and asks the user to either move content inside that folder, if an @samp{ID} property is set, delete the content, or to leave the attachment directory as is but no longer attached to the outline node. @end table @end table @node Attachment options @subsection Attachment options There are a couple of options for attachments that are worth mentioning. @table @asis @item @code{org-attach-id-dir} @vindex org-attach-id-dir The directory where attachments are stored when @samp{ID} is used as method. @item @code{org-attach-dir-relative} @vindex org-attach-dir-relative When setting the @samp{DIR} property on a node using @kbd{C-c C-a s} (@code{org-attach-set-directory}), absolute links are entered by default. This option changes that to relative links. @item @code{org-attach-use-inheritance} @vindex org-attach-use-inheritance By default folders attached to an outline node are inherited from parents according to @code{org-use-property-inheritance}. If one instead want to set inheritance specifically for Org attach that can be done using @code{org-attach-use-inheritance}. Inheriting documents through the node hierarchy makes a lot of sense in most cases. Especially when using attachment links (see @ref{Attachment links}). The following example shows one use case for attachment inheritance: @example * Chapter A ... :PROPERTIES: :DIR: Chapter A/ :END: ** Introduction Some text #+NAME: Image 1 [[attachment:image 1.jpg]] @end example Without inheritance one would not be able to resolve the link to @samp{image 1.jpg}, since the link is inside a sub-heading to @samp{Chapter A}. Inheritance works the same way for both @samp{ID} and @samp{DIR} property. If both properties are defined on the same headline then @samp{DIR} takes precedence. This is also true if inheritance is enabled. If @samp{DIR} is inherited from a parent node in the outline, that property still takes precedence over an @samp{ID} property defined on the node itself. @item @code{org-attach-method} @vindex org-attach-method When attaching files using the dispatcher @kbd{C-c C-a} it defaults to copying files. The behavior can be changed by customizing @code{org-attach-method}. Options are Copy, Move/Rename, Hard link or Symbolic link. @item @code{org-attach-preferred-new-method} @vindex org-attach-preferred-new-method This customization lets you choose the default way to attach to nodes without existing @samp{ID} and @samp{DIR} property. It defaults to @code{id} but can also be set to @code{dir}, @code{ask} or @code{nil}. @item @code{org-attach-archive-delete} @vindex org-attach-archive-delete Configure this to determine if attachments should be deleted or not when a subtree that has attachments is archived. @item @code{org-attach-auto-tag} @vindex org-attach-auto-tag When attaching files to a heading it will be assigned a tag according to what is set here. @item @code{org-attach-id-to-path-function-list} @vindex org-attach-id-to-path-function-list When @samp{ID} is used for attachments, the ID is parsed into a part of a directory-path. See @code{org-attach-id-uuid-folder-format} for the default function. Define a new one and add it as first element in @code{org-attach-id-to-path-function-list} if you want the folder structure in any other way. All functions in this list will be tried when resolving existing ID's into paths, to maintain backward compatibility with existing folders in your system. @item @code{org-attach-store-link-p} @vindex org-attach-store-link-p Stores a link to the file that is being attached. The link is stored in @code{org-stored-links} for later insertion with @kbd{C-c C-l} (see @ref{Handling Links}). Depending on what option is set in @code{org-attach-store-link-p}, the link is stored to either the original location as a file link, the attachment location as an attachment link or to the attachment location as a file link. @item @code{org-attach-commands} @vindex org-attach-commands List of all commands used in the attach dispatcher. @item @code{org-attach-expert} @vindex org-attach-expert Do not show the splash buffer with the attach dispatcher when @code{org-attach-expert} is set to non-@code{nil}. @end table See customization group @samp{Org Attach} if you want to change the default settings. @node Attachment links @subsection Attachment links Attached files and folders can be referenced using attachment links. This makes it easy to refer to the material added to an outline node. Especially if it was attached using the unique ID of the entry! @example * TODO Some task :PROPERTIES: :ID: 95d50008-c12e-479f-a4f2-cc0238205319 :END: See attached document for more information: [[attachment:info.org]] @end example See @ref{External Links} for more information about these links. @node Automatic version-control with Git @subsection Automatic version-control with Git If the directory attached to an outline node is a Git repository, Org can be configured to automatically commit changes to that repository when it sees them. To make Org mode take care of versioning of attachments for you, add the following to your Emacs config: @lisp (require 'org-attach-git) @end lisp @node Attach from Dired @subsection Attach from Dired @cindex attach from Dired @findex org-attach-dired-to-subtree It is possible to attach files to a subtree from a Dired buffer. To use this feature, have one window in Dired mode containing the file(s) to be attached and another window with point in the subtree that shall get the attachments. In the Dired window, with point on a file, @kbd{M-x org-attach-dired-to-subtree} attaches the file to the subtree using the attachment method set by variable @code{org-attach-method}. When files are marked in the Dired window then all marked files get attached. Add the following lines to the Emacs init file to have @kbd{C-c C-x a} attach files in Dired buffers. @lisp (add-hook 'dired-mode-hook (lambda () (define-key dired-mode-map (kbd "C-c C-x a") #'org-attach-dired-to-subtree))) @end lisp The following code shows how to bind the previous command with a specific attachment method. @lisp (add-hook 'dired-mode-hook (lambda () (define-key dired-mode-map (kbd "C-c C-x c") (lambda () (interactive) (let ((org-attach-method 'cp)) (call-interactively #'org-attach-dired-to-subtree)))))) @end lisp @node RSS Feeds @section RSS Feeds @cindex RSS feeds @cindex Atom feeds Org can add and change entries based on information found in RSS feeds and Atom feeds. You could use this to make a task out of each new podcast in a podcast feed. Or you could use a phone-based note-creating service on the web to import tasks into Org. To access feeds, configure the variable @code{org-feed-alist}. The docstring of this variable has detailed information. With the following @lisp (setq org-feed-alist '(("Slashdot" "http://rss.slashdot.org/Slashdot/slashdot" "~/txt/org/feeds.org" "Slashdot Entries"))) @end lisp @noindent new items from the feed provided by @samp{rss.slashdot.org} result in new entries in the file @samp{~/org/feeds.org} under the heading @samp{Slashdot Entries}, whenever the following command is used: @table @asis @item @kbd{C-c C-x g} (@code{org-feed-update-all}) @kindex C-c C-x g Collect items from the feeds configured in @code{org-feed-alist} and act upon them. @item @kbd{C-c C-x G} (@code{org-feed-goto-inbox}) @kindex C-c C-x G Prompt for a feed name and go to the inbox configured for this feed. @end table Under the same headline, Org creates a drawer @samp{FEEDSTATUS} in which it stores information about the status of items in the feed, to avoid adding the same item several times. For more information, including how to read atom feeds, see @samp{org-feed.el} and the docstring of @code{org-feed-alist}. @node Agenda Views @chapter Agenda Views @cindex agenda views Due to the way Org works, TODO items, time-stamped items, and tagged headlines can be scattered throughout a file or even a number of files. To get an overview of open action items, or of events that are important for a particular date, this information must be collected, sorted and displayed in an organized way. Org can select items based on various criteria and display them in a separate buffer. Six different view types are provided: @itemize @item an @emph{agenda} that is like a calendar and shows information for specific dates, @item a @emph{TODO list} that covers all unfinished action items, @item a @emph{match view}, showings headlines based on the tags, properties, and TODO state associated with them, @item a @emph{text search view} that shows all entries from multiple files that contain specified keywords, @item a @emph{stuck projects view} showing projects that currently do not move along, and @item @emph{custom views} that are special searches and combinations of different views. @end itemize The extracted information is displayed in a special @emph{agenda buffer}. This buffer is read-only, but provides commands to visit the corresponding locations in the original Org files, and even to edit these files remotely. @vindex org-agenda-skip-comment-trees @vindex org-agenda-skip-archived-trees @cindex commented entries, in agenda views @cindex archived entries, in agenda views By default, the report ignores commented (see @ref{Comment Lines}) and archived (see @ref{Internal archiving}) entries. You can override this by setting @code{org-agenda-skip-comment-trees} and @code{org-agenda-skip-archived-trees} to @code{nil}. @vindex org-agenda-window-setup @vindex org-agenda-restore-windows-after-quit Two variables control how the agenda buffer is displayed and whether the window configuration is restored when the agenda exits: @code{org-agenda-window-setup} and @code{org-agenda-restore-windows-after-quit}. @menu * Agenda Files:: Files being searched for agenda information. * Agenda Dispatcher:: Keyboard access to agenda views. * Built-in Agenda Views:: What is available out of the box? * Presentation and Sorting:: How agenda items are prepared for display. * Agenda Commands:: Remote editing of Org trees. * Custom Agenda Views:: Defining special searches and views. * Exporting Agenda Views:: Writing a view to a file. * Agenda Column View:: Using column view for collected entries. @end menu @node Agenda Files @section Agenda Files @cindex agenda files @cindex files for agenda @vindex org-agenda-files The information to be shown is normally collected from all @emph{agenda files}, the files listed in the variable @code{org-agenda-files}@footnote{If the value of that variable is not a list, but a single file name, then the list of agenda files in maintained in that external file.}. If a directory is part of this list, all files with the extension @samp{.org} in this directory are part of the list. Thus, even if you only work with a single Org file, that file should be put into the list@footnote{When using the dispatcher, pressing @kbd{<} before selecting a command actually limits the command to the current file, and ignores @code{org-agenda-files} until the next dispatcher command.}. You can customize @code{org-agenda-files}, but the easiest way to maintain it is through the following commands @table @asis @item @kbd{C-c [} (@code{org-agenda-file-to-front}) @kindex C-c [ @findex org-agenda-file-to-front @cindex files, adding to agenda list Add current file to the list of agenda files. The file is added to the front of the list. If it was already in the list, it is moved to the front. With a prefix argument, file is added/moved to the end. @item @kbd{C-c ]} (@code{org-remove-file}) @kindex C-c ] @findex org-remove-file Remove current file from the list of agenda files. @item @kbd{C-'} @itemx @kbd{C-,} (@code{org-cycle-agenda-files}) @kindex C-' @kindex C-, @findex org-cycle-agenda-files @cindex cycling, of agenda files Cycle through agenda file list, visiting one file after the other. @item @kbd{M-x org-switchb} @findex org-switchb Command to use an Iswitchb-like interface to switch to and between Org buffers. @end table @noindent The Org menu contains the current list of files and can be used to visit any of them. If you would like to focus the agenda temporarily on a file not in this list, or on just one file in the list, or even on only a subtree in a file, then this can be done in different ways. For a single agenda command, you may press @kbd{<} once or several times in the dispatcher (see @ref{Agenda Dispatcher}). To restrict the agenda scope for an extended period, use the following commands: @table @asis @item @kbd{C-c C-x <} (@code{org-agenda-set-restriction-lock}) @kindex C-c C-x < @findex org-agenda-set-restriction-lock Restrict the agenda to the current subtree. If there already is a restriction at point, remove it. When called with a universal prefix argument or with point before the first headline in a file, set the agenda scope to the entire file. This restriction remains in effect until removed with @kbd{C-c C-x >}, or by typing either @kbd{<} or @kbd{>} in the agenda dispatcher. If there is a window displaying an agenda view, the new restriction takes effect immediately. @item @kbd{C-c C-x >} (@code{org-agenda-remove-restriction-lock}) @kindex C-c C-x > @findex org-agenda-remove-restriction-lock Remove the restriction created by @kbd{C-c C-x <}. @end table When working with Speedbar, you can use the following commands in the Speedbar frame: @table @asis @item @kbd{<} (@code{org-speedbar-set-agenda-restriction}) @findex org-speedbar-set-agenda-restriction Restrict the agenda to the item---either an Org file or a subtree in such a file---at point in the Speedbar frame. If agenda is already restricted there, remove the restriction. If there is a window displaying an agenda view, the new restriction takes effect immediately. @item @kbd{>} (@code{org-agenda-remove-restriction-lock}) @findex org-agenda-remove-restriction-lock Remove the restriction. @end table @node Agenda Dispatcher @section The Agenda Dispatcher @cindex agenda dispatcher @cindex dispatching agenda commands The views are created through a dispatcher, accessible with @kbd{M-x org-agenda}, or, better, bound to a global key (see @ref{Activation}). It displays a menu from which an additional letter is required to execute a command. The dispatcher offers the following default commands: @table @asis @item @kbd{a} Create the calendar-like agenda (see @ref{Weekly/daily agenda}). @item @kbd{t} @itemx @kbd{T} Create a list of all TODO items (see @ref{Global TODO list}). @item @kbd{m} @itemx @kbd{M} Create a list of headlines matching a given expression (see @ref{Matching tags and properties}). @item @kbd{s} @kindex s @r{(Agenda dispatcher)} Create a list of entries selected by a boolean expression of keywords and/or regular expressions that must or must not occur in the entry. @item @kbd{/} @kindex / @r{(Agenda dispatcher)} @vindex org-agenda-text-search-extra-files Search for a regular expression in all agenda files and additionally in the files listed in @code{org-agenda-text-search-extra-files}. This uses the Emacs command @code{multi-occur}. A prefix argument can be used to specify the number of context lines for each match, default is @enumerate @item @end enumerate @item @kbd{#} Create a list of stuck projects (see @ref{Stuck projects}). @item @kbd{!} Configure the list of stuck projects (see @ref{Stuck projects}). @item @kbd{<} @kindex < @r{(Agenda dispatcher)} Restrict an agenda command to the current buffer@footnote{For backward compatibility, you can also press @kbd{1} to restrict to the current buffer.}. If narrowing is in effect restrict to the narrowed part of the buffer. After pressing @kbd{<}, you still need to press the character selecting the command. @item @kbd{< <} @kindex < < @r{(Agenda dispatcher)} If there is an active region, restrict the following agenda command to the region. Otherwise, restrict it to the current subtree@footnote{For backward compatibility, you can also press @kbd{0} to restrict to the current region/subtree.}. After pressing @kbd{< <}, you still need to press the character selecting the command. @item @kbd{*} @kindex * @r{(Agenda dispatcher)} @vindex org-agenda-sticky @findex org-toggle-sticky-agenda Toggle sticky agenda views. By default, Org maintains only a single agenda buffer and rebuilds it each time you change the view, to make sure everything is always up to date. If you switch between views often and the build time bothers you, you can turn on sticky agenda buffers (make this the default by customizing the variable @code{org-agenda-sticky}). With sticky agendas, the dispatcher only switches to the selected view, you need to update it by hand with @kbd{r} or @kbd{g}. You can toggle sticky agenda view any time with @code{org-toggle-sticky-agenda}. @end table You can also define custom commands that are accessible through the dispatcher, just like the default commands. This includes the possibility to create extended agenda buffers that contain several blocks together, for example the weekly agenda, the global TODO list and a number of special tags matches. See @ref{Custom Agenda Views}. @node Built-in Agenda Views @section The Built-in Agenda Views In this section we describe the built-in views. @menu * Weekly/daily agenda:: The calendar page with current tasks. * Global TODO list:: All unfinished action items. * Matching tags and properties:: Structured information with fine-tuned search. * Search view:: Find entries by searching for text. * Stuck projects:: Find projects you need to review. @end menu @node Weekly/daily agenda @subsection Weekly/daily agenda @cindex agenda @cindex weekly agenda @cindex daily agenda The purpose of the weekly/daily @emph{agenda} is to act like a page of a paper agenda, showing all the tasks for the current week or day. @table @asis @item @kbd{M-x org-agenda a} (@code{org-agenda-list}) @kindex a @r{(Agenda dispatcher)} @findex org-agenda-list @cindex org-agenda, command Compile an agenda for the current week from a list of Org files. The agenda shows the entries for each day. With a numeric prefix argument@footnote{For backward compatibility, the universal prefix argument @kbd{C-u} causes all TODO entries to be listed before the agenda. This feature is deprecated, use the dedicated TODO list, or a block agenda instead (see @ref{Block agenda}).}---like @kbd{C-u 2 1 M-x org-agenda a}---you may set the number of days to be displayed. @end table @vindex org-agenda-span @vindex org-agenda-start-day @vindex org-agenda-start-on-weekday The default number of days displayed in the agenda is set by the variable @code{org-agenda-span}. This variable can be set to any number of days you want to see by default in the agenda, or to a span name, such a @code{day}, @code{week}, @code{month} or @code{year}. For weekly agendas, the default is to start on the previous Monday (see @code{org-agenda-start-on-weekday}). You can also set the start date using a date shift: @samp{(setq org-agenda-start-day "+10d")} starts the agenda ten days from today in the future. Remote editing from the agenda buffer means, for example, that you can change the dates of deadlines and appointments from the agenda buffer. The commands available in the Agenda buffer are listed in @ref{Agenda Commands}. @anchor{Calendar/Diary integration} @subsubheading Calendar/Diary integration @cindex calendar integration @cindex diary integration Emacs contains the calendar and diary by Edward@tie{}M@.@tie{}Reingold. The calendar displays a three-month calendar with holidays from different countries and cultures. The diary allows you to keep track of anniversaries, lunar phases, sunrise/set, recurrent appointments (weekly, monthly) and more. In this way, it is quite complementary to Org. It can be very useful to combine output from Org with the diary. In order to include entries from the Emacs diary into Org mode's agenda, you only need to customize the variable @lisp (setq org-agenda-include-diary t) @end lisp @noindent After that, everything happens automatically. All diary entries including holidays, anniversaries, etc., are included in the agenda buffer created by Org mode. @kbd{@key{SPC}}, @kbd{@key{TAB}}, and @kbd{@key{RET}} can be used from the agenda buffer to jump to the diary file in order to edit existing diary entries. The @kbd{i} command to insert new entries for the current date works in the agenda buffer, as well as the commands @kbd{S}, @kbd{M}, and @kbd{C} to display Sunrise/Sunset times, show lunar phases and to convert to other calendars, respectively. @kbd{c} can be used to switch back and forth between calendar and agenda. If you are using the diary only for expression entries and holidays, it is faster to not use the above setting, but instead to copy or even move the entries into an Org file. Org mode evaluates diary-style expression entries, and does it faster because there is no overhead for first creating the diary display. Note that the expression entries must start at the left margin, no whitespace is allowed before them, as seen in the following segment of an Org file:@footnote{The variable @code{org-anniversary} used in the example is just like @code{diary-anniversary}, but the argument order is always according to ISO and therefore independent of the value of @code{calendar-date-style}.} @example * Holidays :PROPERTIES: :CATEGORY: Holiday :END: %%(org-calendar-holiday) ; special function for holiday names * Birthdays :PROPERTIES: :CATEGORY: Ann :END: %%(org-anniversary 1956 5 14) Arthur Dent is %d years old %%(org-anniversary 1869 10 2) Mahatma Gandhi would be %d years old @end example @anchor{Anniversaries from BBDB} @subsubheading Anniversaries from BBDB @cindex BBDB, anniversaries @cindex anniversaries, from BBDB @findex org-bbdb-anniversaries If you are using the Insidious Big Brother Database to store your contacts, you very likely prefer to store anniversaries in BBDB rather than in a separate Org or diary file. Org supports this and can show BBDB anniversaries as part of the agenda. All you need to do is to add the following to one of your agenda files: @example * Anniversaries :PROPERTIES: :CATEGORY: Anniv :END: %%(org-bbdb-anniversaries) @end example You can then go ahead and define anniversaries for a BBDB record. Basically, you need a field named @samp{anniversary} for the BBDB record which contains the date in the format @samp{YYYY-MM-DD} or @samp{MM-DD}, followed by a space and the class of the anniversary (@samp{birthday}, @samp{wedding}, or a format string). If you omit the class, it defaults to @samp{birthday}. Here are a few examples, the header for the file @samp{ol-bbdb.el} contains more detailed information. @example 1973-06-22 06-22 1955-08-02 wedding 2008-04-14 %s released version 6.01 of Org mode, %d years ago @end example After a change to BBDB, or for the first agenda display during an Emacs session, the agenda display suffers a short delay as Org updates its hash with anniversaries. However, from then on things will be very fast, much faster in fact than a long list of @samp{%%(diary-anniversary)} entries in an Org or Diary file. @findex org-bbdb-anniversaries-future If you would like to see upcoming anniversaries with a bit of forewarning, you can use the following instead: @example * Anniversaries :PROPERTIES: :CATEGORY: Anniv :END: %%(org-bbdb-anniversaries-future 3) @end example That will give you three days' warning: on the anniversary date itself and the two days prior. The argument is optional: if omitted, it defaults to 7. @anchor{Appointment reminders} @subsubheading Appointment reminders @cindex @file{appt.el} @cindex appointment reminders @cindex appointment @cindex reminders @cindex APPT_WARNTIME, keyword Org can interact with Emacs appointments notification facility. To add the appointments of your agenda files, use the command @code{org-agenda-to-appt}. This command lets you filter through the list of your appointments and add only those belonging to a specific category or matching a regular expression. It also reads a @samp{APPT_WARNTIME} property which overrides the value of @code{appt-message-warning-time} for this appointment. See the docstring for details. @node Global TODO list @subsection The global TODO list @cindex global TODO list @cindex TODO list, global The global TODO list contains all unfinished TODO items formatted and collected into a single place. @table @asis @item @kbd{M-x org-agenda t} (@code{org-todo-list}) @kindex t @r{(Agenda dispatcher)} @findex org-todo-list Show the global TODO list. This collects the TODO items from all agenda files (see @ref{Agenda Views}) into a single buffer. By default, this lists items with a state the is not a DONE state. The buffer is in Agenda mode, so there are commands to examine and manipulate the TODO entries directly from that buffer (see @ref{Agenda Commands}). @item @kbd{M-x org-agenda T} (@code{org-todo-list}) @kindex T @r{(Agenda dispatcher)} @findex org-todo-list @cindex TODO keyword matching @vindex org-todo-keywords Like the above, but allows selection of a specific TODO keyword. You can also do this by specifying a prefix argument to @kbd{t}. You are prompted for a keyword, and you may also specify several keywords by separating them with @samp{|} as the boolean OR operator. With a numeric prefix, the Nth keyword in @code{org-todo-keywords} is selected. @kindex r The @kbd{r} key in the agenda buffer regenerates it, and you can give a prefix argument to this command to change the selected TODO keyword, for example @kbd{3 r}. If you often need a search for a specific keyword, define a custom command for it (see @ref{Agenda Dispatcher}). Matching specific TODO keywords can also be done as part of a tags search (see @ref{Tag Searches}). @end table Remote editing of TODO items means that you can change the state of a TODO entry with a single key press. The commands available in the TODO list are described in @ref{Agenda Commands}. @cindex sublevels, inclusion into TODO list Normally the global TODO list simply shows all headlines with TODO keywords. This list can become very long. There are two ways to keep it more compact: @itemize @item @vindex org-agenda-todo-ignore-scheduled @vindex org-agenda-todo-ignore-deadlines @vindex org-agenda-todo-ignore-timestamp @vindex org-agenda-todo-ignore-with-date Some people view a TODO item that has been @emph{scheduled} for execution or have a @emph{deadline} (see @ref{Timestamps}) as no longer @emph{open}. Configure the variables @code{org-agenda-todo-ignore-scheduled} to exclude some or all scheduled items from the global TODO list, @code{org-agenda-todo-ignore-deadlines} to exclude some or all items with a deadline set, @code{org-agenda-todo-ignore-timestamp} to exclude some or all items with an active timestamp other than a DEADLINE or a SCHEDULED timestamp and/or @code{org-agenda-todo-ignore-with-date} to exclude items with at least one active timestamp. @item @vindex org-agenda-todo-list-sublevels TODO items may have sublevels to break up the task into subtasks. In such cases it may be enough to list only the highest level TODO headline and omit the sublevels from the global list. Configure the variable @code{org-agenda-todo-list-sublevels} to get this behavior. @end itemize @node Matching tags and properties @subsection Matching tags and properties @cindex matching, of tags @cindex matching, of properties @cindex tags view @cindex match view If headlines in the agenda files are marked with @emph{tags} (see @ref{Tags}), or have properties (see @ref{Properties and Columns}), you can select headlines based on this metadata and collect them into an agenda buffer. The match syntax described here also applies when creating sparse trees with @kbd{C-c / m}. @table @asis @item @kbd{M-x org-agenda m} (@code{org-tags-view}) @kindex m @r{(Agenda dispatcher)} @findex org-tags-view Produce a list of all headlines that match a given set of tags. The command prompts for a selection criterion, which is a boolean logic expression with tags, like @samp{+work+urgent-withboss} or @samp{work|home} (see @ref{Tags}). If you often need a specific search, define a custom command for it (see @ref{Agenda Dispatcher}). @item @kbd{M-x org-agenda M} (@code{org-tags-view}) @kindex M @r{(Agenda dispatcher)} @findex org-tags-view @vindex org-tags-match-list-sublevels @vindex org-agenda-tags-todo-honor-ignore-options Like @kbd{m}, but only select headlines that are also TODO items and force checking subitems (see the variable @code{org-tags-match-list-sublevels}). To exclude scheduled/deadline items, see the variable @code{org-agenda-tags-todo-honor-ignore-options}. Matching specific TODO keywords together with a tags match is also possible, see @ref{Tag Searches}. @end table The commands available in the tags list are described in @ref{Agenda Commands}. @cindex boolean logic, for agenda searches A search string can use Boolean operators @samp{&} for AND and @samp{|} for OR@. @samp{&} binds more strongly than @samp{|}. Parentheses are currently not implemented. Each element in the search is either a tag, a regular expression matching tags, or an expression like @samp{PROPERTY OPERATOR VALUE} with a comparison operator, accessing a property value. Each element may be preceded by @samp{-} to select against it, and @samp{+} is syntactic sugar for positive selection. The AND operator @samp{&} is optional when @samp{+} or @samp{-} is present. Here are some examples, using only tags. @table @asis @item @samp{+work-boss} Select headlines tagged @samp{work}, but discard those also tagged @samp{boss}. @item @samp{work|laptop} Selects lines tagged @samp{work} or @samp{laptop}. @item @samp{work|laptop+night} Like before, but require the @samp{laptop} lines to be tagged also @samp{night}. @end table @cindex regular expressions, with tags search Instead of a tag, you may also specify a regular expression enclosed in curly braces. For example, @samp{work+@{^boss.*@}} matches headlines that contain the tag @samp{:work:} and any tag @emph{starting} with @samp{boss}. @cindex group tags, as regular expressions Group tags (see @ref{Tag Hierarchy}) are expanded as regular expressions. E.g., if @samp{work} is a group tag for the group @samp{:work:lab:conf:}, then searching for @samp{work} also searches for @samp{@{\(?:work\|lab\|conf\)@}} and searching for @samp{-work} searches for all headlines but those with one of the tags in the group (i.e., @samp{-@{\(?:work\|lab\|conf\)@}}). @cindex TODO keyword matching, with tags search @cindex level, for tags/property match @cindex category, for tags/property match @vindex org-odd-levels-only You may also test for properties (see @ref{Properties and Columns}) at the same time as matching tags. The properties may be real properties, or special properties that represent other metadata (see @ref{Special Properties}). For example, the property @samp{TODO} represents the TODO keyword of the entry. Or, the property @samp{LEVEL} represents the level of an entry. So searching @samp{+LEVEL=3+boss-TODO​="DONE"} lists all level three headlines that have the tag @samp{boss} and are @emph{not} marked with the TODO keyword @samp{DONE}. In buffers with @code{org-odd-levels-only} set, @samp{LEVEL} does not count the number of stars, but @samp{LEVEL=2} corresponds to 3 stars etc. Here are more examples: @table @asis @item @samp{work+TODO​="WAITING"} Select @samp{work}-tagged TODO lines with the specific TODO keyword @samp{WAITING}. @item @samp{work+TODO​="WAITING"|home+TODO​="WAITING"} Waiting tasks both at work and at home. @end table When matching properties, a number of different operators can be used to test the value of a property. Here is a complex example: @example +work-boss+PRIORITY="A"+Coffee="unlimited"+Effort<2 +With=@{Sarah|Denny@}+SCHEDULED>="<2008-10-11>" @end example @noindent The type of comparison depends on how the comparison value is written: @itemize @item If the comparison value is a plain number, a numerical comparison is done, and the allowed operators are @samp{<}, @samp{=}, @samp{>}, @samp{<=}, @samp{>=}, and @samp{<>}. @item If the comparison value is enclosed in double-quotes, a string comparison is done, and the same operators are allowed. @item If the comparison value is enclosed in double-quotes @emph{and} angular brackets (like @samp{DEADLINE<​="<2008-12-24 18:30>"}), both values are assumed to be date/time specifications in the standard Org way, and the comparison is done accordingly. Valid values also include @samp{""} for now (including time), @samp{""}, and @samp{""} for these days at 0:00 hours, i.e., without a time specification. You can also use strings like @samp{"<+5d>"} or @samp{"<-2m>"} with units @samp{d}, @samp{w}, @samp{m}, and @samp{y} for day, week, month, and year, respectively. @item If the comparison value is enclosed in curly braces, a regexp match is performed, with @samp{=} meaning that the regexp matches the property value, and @samp{<>} meaning that it does not match. @end itemize So the search string in the example finds entries tagged @samp{work} but not @samp{boss}, which also have a priority value @samp{A}, a @samp{Coffee} property with the value @samp{unlimited}, an @samp{EFFORT} property that is numerically smaller than 2, a @samp{With} property that is matched by the regular expression @samp{Sarah|Denny}, and that are scheduled on or after October 11, 2008. You can configure Org mode to use property inheritance during a search, but beware that this can slow down searches considerably. See @ref{Property Inheritance}, for details. For backward compatibility, and also for typing speed, there is also a different way to test TODO states in a search. For this, terminate the tags/property part of the search string (which may include several terms connected with @samp{|}) with a @samp{/} and then specify a Boolean expression just for TODO keywords. The syntax is then similar to that for tags, but should be applied with care: for example, a positive selection on several TODO keywords cannot meaningfully be combined with boolean AND@. However, @emph{negative selection} combined with AND can be meaningful. To make sure that only lines are checked that actually have any TODO keyword (resulting in a speed-up), use @kbd{M-x org-agenda M}, or equivalently start the TODO part after the slash with @samp{!}. Using @kbd{M-x org-agenda M} or @samp{/!} does not match TODO keywords in a DONE state. Examples: @table @asis @item @samp{work/WAITING} Same as @samp{work+TODO​="WAITING"}. @item @samp{work/!-WAITING-NEXT} Select @samp{work}-tagged TODO lines that are neither @samp{WAITING} nor @samp{NEXT}. @item @samp{work/!+WAITING|+NEXT} Select @samp{work}-tagged TODO lines that are either @samp{WAITING} or @samp{NEXT}. @end table @node Search view @subsection Search view @cindex search view @cindex text search @cindex searching, for text This agenda view is a general text search facility for Org mode entries. It is particularly useful to find notes. @table @asis @item @kbd{M-x org-agenda s} (@code{org-search-view}) @kindex s @r{(Agenda dispatcher)} @findex org-search-view This is a special search that lets you select entries by matching a substring or specific words using a boolean logic. @end table For example, the search string @samp{computer equipment} matches entries that contain @samp{computer equipment} as a substring, even if the two words are separated by more space or a line break. Search view can also search for specific keywords in the entry, using Boolean logic. The search string @samp{+computer +wifi -ethernet -@{8\.11[bg]@}} matches note entries that contain the keywords @samp{computer} and @samp{wifi}, but not the keyword @samp{ethernet}, and which are also not matched by the regular expression @samp{8\.11[bg]}, meaning to exclude both @samp{8.11b} and @samp{8.11g}. The first @samp{+} is necessary to turn on boolean search, other @samp{+} characters are optional. For more details, see the docstring of the command @code{org-search-view}. You can incrementally and conveniently adjust a boolean search from the agenda search view with the following keys @multitable @columnfractions 0.1 0.6 @item @kbd{[} @tab Add a positive search word @item @kbd{]} @tab Add a negative search word @item @kbd{@{} @tab Add a positive regular expression @item @kbd{@}} @tab Add a negative regular expression @end multitable @vindex org-agenda-text-search-extra-files Note that in addition to the agenda files, this command also searches the files listed in @code{org-agenda-text-search-extra-files}. @node Stuck projects @subsection Stuck projects @pindex GTD, Getting Things Done If you are following a system like David Allen's GTD to organize your work, one of the ``duties'' you have is a regular review to make sure that all projects move along. A @emph{stuck} project is a project that has no defined next actions, so it never shows up in the TODO lists Org mode produces. During the review, you need to identify such projects and define next actions for them. @table @asis @item @kbd{M-x org-agenda #} (@code{org-agenda-list-stuck-projects}) @kindex # @r{(Agenda dispatcher)} @findex org-agenda-list-stuck-projects List projects that are stuck. @item @kbd{M-x org-agenda !} @kindex ! @r{(Agenda dispatcher)} @vindex org-stuck-projects Customize the variable @code{org-stuck-projects} to define what a stuck project is and how to find it. @end table You almost certainly need to configure this view before it works for you. The built-in default assumes that all your projects are level-2 headlines, and that a project is not stuck if it has at least one entry marked with a TODO keyword @samp{TODO} or @samp{NEXT} or @samp{NEXTACTION}. Let's assume that you, in your own way of using Org mode, identify projects with a tag @samp{:PROJECT:}, and that you use a TODO keyword @samp{MAYBE} to indicate a project that should not be considered yet. Let's further assume that the TODO keyword @samp{DONE} marks finished projects, and that @samp{NEXT} and @samp{TODO} indicate next actions. The tag @samp{:@@shop:} indicates shopping and is a next action even without the NEXT tag. Finally, if the project contains the special word @samp{IGNORE} anywhere, it should not be listed either. In this case you would start by identifying eligible projects with a tags/TODO match (see @ref{Tag Searches}) @samp{+PROJECT/-MAYBE-DONE}, and then check for @samp{TODO}, @samp{NEXT}, @samp{@@shop}, and @samp{IGNORE} in the subtree to identify projects that are not stuck. The correct customization for this is: @lisp (setq org-stuck-projects '("+PROJECT/-MAYBE-DONE" ("NEXT" "TODO") ("@@shop") "\\")) @end lisp Note that if a project is identified as non-stuck, the subtree of this entry is searched for stuck projects. @node Presentation and Sorting @section Presentation and Sorting @cindex presentation, of agenda items @vindex org-agenda-prefix-format @vindex org-agenda-tags-column Before displaying items in an agenda view, Org mode visually prepares the items and sorts them. Each item occupies a single line. The line starts with a @emph{prefix} that contains the @emph{category} (see @ref{Categories}) of the item and other important information. You can customize in which column tags are displayed through @code{org-agenda-tags-column}. You can also customize the prefix using the option @code{org-agenda-prefix-format}. This prefix is followed by a cleaned-up version of the outline headline associated with the item. @menu * Categories:: Not all tasks are equal. * Time-of-day specifications:: How the agenda knows the time. * Sorting of agenda items:: The order of things. * Filtering/limiting agenda items:: Dynamically narrow the agenda. @end menu @node Categories @subsection Categories @cindex category @cindex @samp{CATEGORY}, keyword The category is a broad label assigned to each agenda item. By default, the category is simply derived from the file name, but you can also specify it with a special line in the buffer, like this: @example #+CATEGORY: Thesis @end example @cindex @samp{CATEGORY}, property If you would like to have a special category for a single entry or a (sub)tree, give the entry a @samp{CATEGORY} property with the special category you want to apply as the value. @vindex org-agenda-category-icon-alist The display in the agenda buffer looks best if the category is not longer than 10 characters. You can set up icons for category by customizing the @code{org-agenda-category-icon-alist} variable. @node Time-of-day specifications @subsection Time-of-day specifications @cindex time-of-day specification Org mode checks each agenda item for a time-of-day specification. The time can be part of the timestamp that triggered inclusion into the agenda, for example @example <2005-05-10 Tue 19:00> @end example @noindent Time ranges can be specified with two timestamps: @example <2005-05-10 Tue 20:30>--<2005-05-10 Tue 22:15> @end example @vindex org-agenda-search-headline-for-time In the headline of the entry itself, a time(range)---like @samp{12:45} or a @samp{8:30-1pm}---may also appear as plain text@footnote{You can, however, disable this by setting @code{org-agenda-search-headline-for-time} variable to a @code{nil} value.}. If the agenda integrates the Emacs diary (see @ref{Weekly/daily agenda}), time specifications in diary entries are recognized as well. For agenda display, Org mode extracts the time and displays it in a standard 24 hour format as part of the prefix. The example times in the previous paragraphs would end up in the agenda like this: @example 8:30-13:00 Arthur Dent lies in front of the bulldozer 12:45...... Ford Prefect arrives and takes Arthur to the pub 19:00...... The Vogon reads his poem 20:30-22:15 Marvin escorts the Hitchhikers to the bridge @end example @cindex time grid If the agenda is in single-day mode, or for the display of today, the timed entries are embedded in a time grid, like @example 8:00...... ------------------ 8:30-13:00 Arthur Dent lies in front of the bulldozer 10:00...... ------------------ 12:00...... ------------------ 12:45...... Ford Prefect arrives and takes Arthur to the pub 14:00...... ------------------ 16:00...... ------------------ 18:00...... ------------------ 19:00...... The Vogon reads his poem 20:00...... ------------------ 20:30-22:15 Marvin escorts the Hitchhikers to the bridge @end example @vindex org-agenda-use-time-grid @vindex org-agenda-time-grid The time grid can be turned on and off with the variable @code{org-agenda-use-time-grid}, and can be configured with @code{org-agenda-time-grid}. @node Sorting of agenda items @subsection Sorting of agenda items @cindex sorting, of agenda items @cindex priorities, of agenda items Before being inserted into a view, the items are sorted. How this is done depends on the type of view. @itemize @item @vindex org-agenda-files For the daily/weekly agenda, the items for each day are sorted. The default order is to first collect all items containing an explicit time-of-day specification. These entries are shown at the beginning of the list, as a @emph{schedule} for the day. After that, items remain grouped in categories, in the sequence given by @code{org-agenda-files}. Within each category, items are sorted by priority (see @ref{Priorities}), which is composed of the base priority (2000 for priority @samp{A}, 1000 for @samp{B}, and 0 for @samp{C}), plus additional increments for overdue scheduled or deadline items. @item For the TODO list, items remain in the order of categories, but within each category, sorting takes place according to priority (see @ref{Priorities}). The priority used for sorting derives from the priority cookie, with additions depending on how close an item is to its due or scheduled date. @item For tags matches, items are not sorted at all, but just appear in the sequence in which they are found in the agenda files. @end itemize @vindex org-agenda-sorting-strategy Sorting can be customized using the variable @code{org-agenda-sorting-strategy}, and may also include criteria based on the estimated effort of an entry (see @ref{Effort Estimates}). @node Filtering/limiting agenda items @subsection Filtering/limiting agenda items @vindex org-agenda-category-filter-preset @vindex org-agenda-tag-filter-preset @vindex org-agenda-effort-filter-preset @vindex org-agenda-regexp-filter-preset Agenda built-in or custom commands are statically defined. Agenda filters and limits allow to flexibly narrow down the list of agenda entries. @emph{Filters} only change the visibility of items, are very fast and are mostly used interactively@footnote{Custom agenda commands can preset a filter by binding one of the variables @code{org-agenda-tag-filter-preset}, @code{org-agenda-category-filter-preset}, @code{org-agenda-effort-filter-preset} or @code{org-agenda-regexp-filter-preset} as an option. This filter is then applied to the view and persists as a basic filter through refreshes and more secondary filtering. The filter is a global property of the entire agenda view---in a block agenda, you should only set this in the global options section, not in the section of an individual block.}. You can switch quickly between different filters without having to recreate the agenda. @emph{Limits} on the other hand take effect before the agenda buffer is populated, so they are mostly useful when defined as local variables within custom agenda commands. @anchor{Filtering in the agenda} @subsubheading Filtering in the agenda @cindex agenda filtering @cindex filtering entries, in agenda @cindex tag filtering, in agenda @cindex category filtering, in agenda @cindex top headline filtering, in agenda @cindex effort filtering, in agenda @cindex query editing, in agenda The general filtering command is @code{org-agenda-filter}, bound to @kbd{/}. Before we introduce it, we describe commands for individual filter types. All filtering commands handle prefix arguments in the same way: A single @kbd{C-u} prefix negates the filter, so it removes lines selected by the filter. A double prefix adds the new filter condition to the one(s) already in place, so filter elements are accumulated. @table @asis @item @kbd{\} (@code{org-agenda-filter-by-tag}) @findex org-agenda-filter-by-tag Filter the agenda view with respect to a tag. You are prompted for a tag selection letter; @kbd{@key{SPC}} means any tag at all. Pressing @kbd{@key{TAB}} at that prompt offers completion to select a tag, including any tags that do not have a selection character. The command then hides all entries that do not contain or inherit this tag. Pressing @kbd{+} or @kbd{-} at the prompt switches between filtering for and against the next tag. To clear the filter, press @kbd{\} twice (once to call the command again, and once at the prompt). @item @kbd{<} (@code{org-agenda-filter-by-category}) @findex org-agenda-filter-by-category Filter by category of the line at point, and show only entries with this category. When called with a prefix argument, hide all entries with the category at point. To clear the filter, call this command again by pressing @kbd{<}. @item @kbd{=} (@code{org-agenda-filter-by-regexp}) @findex org-agenda-filter-by-regexp Filter the agenda view by a regular expression: only show agenda entries matching the regular expression the user entered. To clear the filter, call the command again by pressing @kbd{=}. @item @kbd{_} (@code{org-agenda-filter-by-effort}) @findex org-agenda-filter-by-effort Filter the agenda view with respect to effort estimates, so select tasks that take the right amount of time. You first need to set up a list of efforts globally, for example @lisp (setq org-global-properties '(("Effort_ALL". "0 0:10 0:30 1:00 2:00 3:00 4:00"))) @end lisp @vindex org-sort-agenda-noeffort-is-high You can then filter for an effort by first typing an operator, one of @kbd{<}, @kbd{>} and @kbd{=}, and then the one-digit index of an effort estimate in your array of allowed values, where @kbd{0} means the 10th value. The filter then restricts to entries with effort smaller-or-equal, equal, or larger-or-equal than the selected value. For application of the operator, entries without a defined effort are treated according to the value of @code{org-sort-agenda-noeffort-is-high}. To clear the filter, press @kbd{_} twice (once to call the command again, and once at the first prompt). @item @kbd{^} (@code{org-agenda-filter-by-top-headline}) @findex org-agenda-filter-by-top-headline Filter the current agenda view and only display items that fall under the same top-level headline as the current entry. To clear the filter, call this command again by pressing @kbd{^}. @item @kbd{/} (@code{org-agenda-filter}) @findex org-agenda-filter This is the unified interface to four of the five filter methods described above. At the prompt, specify different filter elements in a single string, with full completion support. For example, @example +work-John+<0:10-/plot/ @end example selects entries with category @samp{work} and effort estimates below 10 minutes, and deselects entries with tag @samp{John} or matching the regexp @samp{plot}. You can leave @samp{+} out if that does not lead to ambiguities. The sequence of elements is arbitrary. The filter syntax assumes that there is no overlap between categories and tags. Otherwise, tags take priority. If you reply to the prompt with the empty string, all filtering is removed. If a filter is specified, it replaces all current filters. But if you call the command with a double prefix argument, or if you add an additional @samp{+} (e.g., @samp{++work}) to the front of the string, the new filter elements are added to the active ones. A single prefix argument applies the entire filter in a negative sense. @item @kbd{|} (@code{org-agenda-filter-remove-all}) Remove all filters in the current agenda view. @end table @anchor{Computed tag filtering} @subsubheading Computed tag filtering @vindex org-agenda-auto-exclude-function If the variable @code{org-agenda-auto-exclude-function} is set to a user-defined function, that function can select tags that should be used as a tag filter when requested. The function will be called with lower-case versions of all tags represented in the current view. The function should return @samp{"-tag"} if the filter should remove entries with that tag, @samp{"+tag"} if only entries with this tag should be kept, or @samp{nil} if that tag is irrelevant. For example, let's say you use a @samp{Net} tag to identify tasks which need network access, an @samp{Errand} tag for errands in town, and a @samp{Call} tag for making phone calls. You could auto-exclude these tags based on the availability of the Internet, and outside of business hours, with something like this: @lisp (defun my-auto-exclude-fn (tag) (when (cond ((string= tag "net") (/= 0 (call-process "/sbin/ping" nil nil nil "-c1" "-q" "-t1" "mail.gnu.org"))) ((member tag '("errand" "call")) (let ((hr (nth 2 (decode-time)))) (or (< hr 8) (> hr 21))))) (concat "-" tag))) (setq org-agenda-auto-exclude-function #'my-auto-exclude-fn) @end lisp You can apply this self-adapting filter by using a triple prefix argument to @code{org-agenda-filter}, i.e.@tie{}press @kbd{C-u C-u C-u /}, or by pressing @kbd{@key{RET}} in @code{org-agenda-filter-by-tag}. @anchor{Setting limits for the agenda} @subsubheading Setting limits for the agenda @cindex limits, in agenda Here is a list of options that you can set, either globally, or locally in your custom agenda views (see @ref{Custom Agenda Views}). @table @asis @item @code{org-agenda-max-entries} @vindex org-agenda-max-entries Limit the number of entries. @item @code{org-agenda-max-effort} @vindex org-agenda-max-effort Limit the duration of accumulated efforts (as minutes). @item @code{org-agenda-max-todos} @vindex org-agenda-max-todos Limit the number of entries with TODO keywords. @item @code{org-agenda-max-tags} @vindex org-agenda-max-tags Limit the number of tagged entries. @end table When set to a positive integer, each option excludes entries from other categories: for example, @samp{(setq org-agenda-max-effort 100)} limits the agenda to 100 minutes of effort and exclude any entry that has no effort property. If you want to include entries with no effort property, use a negative value for @code{org-agenda-max-effort}. One useful setup is to use @code{org-agenda-max-entries} locally in a custom command. For example, this custom command displays the next five entries with a @samp{NEXT} TODO keyword. @lisp (setq org-agenda-custom-commands '(("n" todo "NEXT" ((org-agenda-max-entries 5))))) @end lisp Once you mark one of these five entry as DONE, rebuilding the agenda will again the next five entries again, including the first entry that was excluded so far. You can also dynamically set temporary limits, which are lost when rebuilding the agenda: @table @asis @item @kbd{~} (@code{org-agenda-limit-interactively}) @findex org-agenda-limit-interactively This prompts for the type of limit to apply and its value. @end table @node Agenda Commands @section Commands in the Agenda Buffer @cindex commands, in agenda buffer Entries in the agenda buffer are linked back to the Org file or diary file where they originate. You are not allowed to edit the agenda buffer itself, but commands are provided to show and jump to the original entry location, and to edit the Org files ``remotely'' from the agenda buffer. In this way, all information is stored only once, removing the risk that your agenda and note files may diverge. Some commands can be executed with mouse clicks on agenda lines. For the other commands, point needs to be in the desired line. @anchor{Motion (1)} @subheading Motion @cindex motion commands in agenda @table @asis @item @kbd{n} (@code{org-agenda-next-line}) @kindex n @findex org-agenda-next-line Next line (same as @kbd{@key{DOWN}} and @kbd{C-n}). @item @kbd{p} (@code{org-agenda-previous-line}) @kindex p @findex org-agenda-previous-line Previous line (same as @kbd{@key{UP}} and @kbd{C-p}). @end table @anchor{View/Go to Org file} @subheading View/Go to Org file @cindex view file commands in agenda @table @asis @item @kbd{@key{SPC}} or @kbd{mouse-3} (@code{org-agenda-show-and-scroll-up}) @kindex SPC @kindex mouse-3 @findex org-agenda-show-and-scroll-up Display the original location of the item in another window. With a prefix argument, make sure that drawers stay folded. @item @kbd{L} (@code{org-agenda-recenter}) @findex org-agenda-recenter Display original location and recenter that window. @item @kbd{@key{TAB}} or @kbd{mouse-2} (@code{org-agenda-goto}) @kindex TAB @kindex mouse-2 @findex org-agenda-goto Go to the original location of the item in another window. @item @kbd{@key{RET}} (@code{org-agenda-switch-to}) @kindex RET @findex org-agenda-switch-to Go to the original location of the item and delete other windows. @item @kbd{F} (@code{org-agenda-follow-mode}) @kindex F @findex org-agenda-follow-mode @vindex org-agenda-start-with-follow-mode Toggle Follow mode. In Follow mode, as you move point through the agenda buffer, the other window always shows the corresponding location in the Org file. The initial setting for this mode in new agenda buffers can be set with the variable @code{org-agenda-start-with-follow-mode}. @item @kbd{C-c C-x b} (@code{org-agenda-tree-to-indirect-buffer}) @kindex C-c C-x b @findex org-agenda-tree-to-indirect-buffer Display the entire subtree of the current item in an indirect buffer. With a numeric prefix argument N, go up to level N and then take that tree. If N is negative, go up that many levels. With a @kbd{C-u} prefix, do not remove the previously used indirect buffer. @item @kbd{C-c C-o} (@code{org-agenda-open-link}) @kindex C-c C-o @findex org-agenda-open-link Follow a link in the entry. This offers a selection of any links in the text belonging to the referenced Org node. If there is only one link, follow it without a selection prompt. @end table @anchor{Change display} @subheading Change display @cindex change agenda display @cindex display changing, in agenda @table @asis @item @kbd{A} @kindex A Interactively select another agenda view and append it to the current view. @item @kbd{o} @kindex o Delete other windows. @item @kbd{v d} or short @kbd{d} (@code{org-agenda-day-view}) @kindex v d @kindex d @findex org-agenda-day-view Switch to day view. When switching to day view, this setting becomes the default for subsequent agenda refreshes. A numeric prefix argument may be used to jump directly to a specific day of the year. For example, @kbd{32 d} jumps to February 1st. When setting day view, a year may be encoded in the prefix argument as well. For example, @kbd{200712 d} jumps to January 12, 2007. If such a year specification has only one or two digits, it is expanded into one of the 30 next years or the last 69 years. @item @kbd{v w} or short @kbd{w} (@code{org-agenda-week-view}) @kindex v w @kindex w @findex org-agenda-week-view Switch to week view. When switching week view, this setting becomes the default for subsequent agenda refreshes. A numeric prefix argument may be used to jump directly to a specific day of the ISO week. For example @kbd{9 w} to ISO week number 9. When setting week view, a year may be encoded in the prefix argument as well. For example, @kbd{200712 w} jumps to week 12 in 2007. If such a year specification has only one or two digits, it is expanded into one of the 30 next years or the last 69 years. @item @kbd{v m} (@code{org-agenda-month-view}) @kindex v m @findex org-agenda-month-view Switch to month view. Because month views are slow to create, they do not become the default for subsequent agenda refreshes. A numeric prefix argument may be used to jump directly to a specific day of the month. When setting month view, a year may be encoded in the prefix argument as well. For example, @kbd{200712 m} jumps to December, 2007. If such a year specification has only one or two digits, it is expanded into one of the 30 next years or the last 69 years. @item @kbd{v y} (@code{org-agenda-year-view}) @kindex v y @findex org-agenda-year-view Switch to year view. Because year views are slow to create, they do not become the default for subsequent agenda refreshes. A numeric prefix argument may be used to jump directly to a specific day of the year. @item @kbd{v @key{SPC}} (@code{org-agenda-reset-view}) @kindex v SPC @findex org-agenda-reset-view @vindex org-agenda-span Reset the current view to @code{org-agenda-span}. @item @kbd{f} (@code{org-agenda-later}) @kindex f @findex org-agenda-later Go forward in time to display the span following the current one. For example, if the display covers a week, switch to the following week. With a prefix argument, repeat that many times. @item @kbd{b} (@code{org-agenda-earlier}) @kindex b @findex org-agenda-earlier Go backward in time to display earlier dates. @item @kbd{.} (@code{org-agenda-goto-today}) @kindex . @findex org-agenda-goto-today Go to today. @item @kbd{j} (@code{org-agenda-goto-date}) @kindex j @findex org-agenda-goto-date Prompt for a date and go there. @item @kbd{J} (@code{org-agenda-clock-goto}) @kindex J @findex org-agenda-clock-goto Go to the currently clocked-in task @emph{in the agenda buffer}. @item @kbd{D} (@code{org-agenda-toggle-diary}) @kindex D @findex org-agenda-toggle-diary Toggle the inclusion of diary entries. See @ref{Weekly/daily agenda}. @item @kbd{v l} or @kbd{v L} or short @kbd{l} (@code{org-agenda-log-mode}) @kindex v l @kindex l @kindex v L @findex org-agenda-log-mode @vindex org-log-done @vindex org-agenda-log-mode-items Toggle Logbook mode. In Logbook mode, entries that were marked as done while logging was on (see the variable @code{org-log-done}) are shown in the agenda, as are entries that have been clocked on that day. You can configure the entry types that should be included in log mode using the variable @code{org-agenda-log-mode-items}. When called with a @kbd{C-u} prefix argument, show all possible logbook entries, including state changes. When called with two prefix arguments @kbd{C-u C-u}, show only logging information, nothing else. @kbd{v L} is equivalent to @kbd{C-u v l}. @item @kbd{v [} or short @kbd{[} (@code{org-agenda-manipulate-query-add}) @kindex v [ @kindex [ @findex org-agenda-manipulate-query-add Include inactive timestamps into the current view. Only for weekly/daily agenda. @item @kbd{v a} (@code{org-agenda-archives-mode}) @kindex v a @findex org-agenda-archives-mode Toggle Archives mode. In Archives mode, trees that are archived (see @ref{Internal archiving}) are also scanned when producing the agenda. To exit archives mode, press @kbd{v a} again. @item @kbd{v A} @kindex v A Toggle Archives mode. Include all archive files as well. @item @kbd{v R} or short @kbd{R} (@code{org-agenda-clockreport-mode}) @kindex v R @kindex R @findex org-agenda-clockreport-mode @vindex org-agenda-start-with-clockreport-mode @vindex org-clock-report-include-clocking-task Toggle Clockreport mode. In Clockreport mode, the daily/weekly agenda always shows a table with the clocked times for the time span and file scope covered by the current agenda view. The initial setting for this mode in new agenda buffers can be set with the variable @code{org-agenda-start-with-clockreport-mode}. By using a prefix argument when toggling this mode (i.e., @kbd{C-u R}), the clock table does not show contributions from entries that are hidden by agenda filtering@footnote{Only tags filtering is respected here, effort filtering is ignored.}. See also the variable @code{org-clock-report-include-clocking-task}. @item @kbd{v c} @kindex v c @vindex org-agenda-clock-consistency-checks Show overlapping clock entries, clocking gaps, and other clocking problems in the current agenda range. You can then visit clocking lines and fix them manually. See the variable @code{org-agenda-clock-consistency-checks} for information on how to customize the definition of what constituted a clocking problem. To return to normal agenda display, press @kbd{l} to exit Logbook mode. @item @kbd{v E} or short @kbd{E} (@code{org-agenda-entry-text-mode}) @kindex v E @kindex E @findex org-agenda-entry-text-mode @vindex org-agenda-start-with-entry-text-mode @vindex org-agenda-entry-text-maxlines Toggle entry text mode. In entry text mode, a number of lines from the Org outline node referenced by an agenda line are displayed below the line. The maximum number of lines is given by the variable @code{org-agenda-entry-text-maxlines}. Calling this command with a numeric prefix argument temporarily modifies that number to the prefix value. @item @kbd{G} (@code{org-agenda-toggle-time-grid}) @kindex G @vindex org-agenda-use-time-grid @vindex org-agenda-time-grid Toggle the time grid on and off. See also the variables @code{org-agenda-use-time-grid} and @code{org-agenda-time-grid}. @item @kbd{r} (@code{org-agenda-redo}) @itemx @kbd{g} @kindex r @kindex g @findex org-agenda-redo Recreate the agenda buffer, for example to reflect the changes after modification of the timestamps of items with @kbd{S-@key{LEFT}} and @kbd{S-@key{RIGHT}}. When the buffer is the global TODO list, a prefix argument is interpreted to create a selective list for a specific TODO keyword. @item @kbd{C-x C-s} or short @kbd{s} (@code{org-save-all-org-buffers}) @kindex C-x C-s @findex org-save-all-org-buffers @kindex s Save all Org buffers in the current Emacs session, and also the locations of IDs. @item @kbd{C-c C-x C-c} (@code{org-agenda-columns}) @kindex C-c C-x C-c @findex org-agenda-columns @vindex org-columns-default-format Invoke column view (see @ref{Column View}) in the agenda buffer. The column view format is taken from the entry at point, or, if there is no entry at point, from the first entry in the agenda view. So whatever the format for that entry would be in the original buffer (taken from a property, from a @samp{COLUMNS} keyword, or from the default variable @code{org-columns-default-format}) is used in the agenda. @item @kbd{C-c C-x >} (@code{org-agenda-remove-restriction-lock}) @kindex C-c C-x > @findex org-agenda-remove-restriction-lock Remove the restriction lock on the agenda, if it is currently restricted to a file or subtree (see @ref{Agenda Files}). @item @kbd{M-@key{UP}} (@code{org-agenda-drag-line-backward}) @kindex M-UP @findex org-agenda-drag-line-backward Drag the line at point backward one line. With a numeric prefix argument, drag backward by that many lines. Moving agenda lines does not persist after an agenda refresh and does not modify the contributing Org files. @item @kbd{M-@key{DOWN}} (@code{org-agenda-drag-line-forward}) @kindex M-DOWN @findex org-agenda-drag-line-forward Drag the line at point forward one line. With a numeric prefix argument, drag forward by that many lines. @end table @anchor{Remote editing} @subheading Remote editing @cindex remote editing, from agenda @table @asis @item @kbd{0--9} Digit argument. @item @kbd{C-_} (@code{org-agenda-undo}) @kindex C-_ @findex org-agenda-undo @cindex undoing remote-editing events @cindex remote editing, undo Undo a change due to a remote editing command. The change is undone both in the agenda buffer and in the remote buffer. @item @kbd{t} (@code{org-agenda-todo}) @kindex t @findex org-agenda-todo Change the TODO state of the item, both in the agenda and in the original Org file. A prefix arg is passed through to the @code{org-todo} command, so for example a @kbd{C-u} prefix are will trigger taking a note to document the state change. @item @kbd{C-S-@key{RIGHT}} (@code{org-agenda-todo-nextset}) @kindex C-S-RIGHT @findex org-agenda-todo-nextset Switch to the next set of TODO keywords. @item @kbd{C-S-@key{LEFT}}, @code{org-agenda-todo-previousset} @kindex C-S-LEFT Switch to the previous set of TODO keywords. @item @kbd{C-k} (@code{org-agenda-kill}) @kindex C-k @findex org-agenda-kill @vindex org-agenda-confirm-kill Delete the current agenda item along with the entire subtree belonging to it in the original Org file. If the text to be deleted remotely is longer than one line, the kill needs to be confirmed by the user. See variable @code{org-agenda-confirm-kill}. @item @kbd{C-c C-w} (@code{org-agenda-refile}) @kindex C-c C-w @findex org-agenda-refile Refile the entry at point. @item @kbd{C-c C-x C-a} or short @kbd{a} (@code{org-agenda-archive-default-with-confirmation}) @kindex C-c C-x C-a @kindex a @findex org-agenda-archive-default-with-confirmation @vindex org-archive-default-command Archive the subtree corresponding to the entry at point using the default archiving command set in @code{org-archive-default-command}. When using the @kbd{a} key, confirmation is required. @item @kbd{C-c C-x a} (@code{org-agenda-toggle-archive-tag}) @kindex C-c C-x a @findex org-agenda-toggle-archive-tag Toggle the archive tag (see @ref{Internal archiving}) for the current headline. @item @kbd{C-c C-x A} (@code{org-agenda-archive-to-archive-sibling}) @kindex C-c C-x A @findex org-agenda-archive-to-archive-sibling Move the subtree corresponding to the current entry to its @emph{archive sibling}. @item @kbd{C-c C-x C-s} or short @kbd{$} (@code{org-agenda-archive}) @kindex C-c C-x C-s @kindex $ @findex org-agenda-archive Archive the subtree corresponding to the current headline. This means the entry is moved to the configured archive location, most likely a different file. @item @kbd{T} (@code{org-agenda-show-tags}) @kindex T @findex org-agenda-show-tags @vindex org-agenda-show-inherited-tags Show all tags associated with the current item. This is useful if you have turned off @code{org-agenda-show-inherited-tags}, but still want to see all tags of a headline occasionally. @item @kbd{:} (@code{org-agenda-set-tags}) @kindex : @findex org-agenda-set-tags Set tags for the current headline. If there is an active region in the agenda, change a tag for all headings in the region. @item @kbd{,} (@code{org-agenda-priority}) @kindex , @findex org-agenda-priority Set the priority for the current item. Org mode prompts for the priority character. If you reply with @kbd{@key{SPC}}, the priority cookie is removed from the entry. @item @kbd{+} or @kbd{S-@key{UP}} (@code{org-agenda-priority-up}) @kindex + @kindex S-UP @findex org-agenda-priority-up Increase the priority of the current item. The priority is changed in the original buffer, but the agenda is not resorted. Use the @kbd{r} key for this. @item @kbd{-} or @kbd{S-@key{DOWN}} (@code{org-agenda-priority-down}) @kindex - @kindex S-DOWN @findex org-agenda-priority-down Decrease the priority of the current item. @item @kbd{C-c C-x e} or short @kbd{e} (@code{org-agenda-set-effort}) @kindex e @kindex C-c C-x e @findex org-agenda-set-effort Set the effort property for the current item. @item @kbd{C-c C-z} or short @kbd{z} (@code{org-agenda-add-note}) @kindex z @kindex C-c C-z @findex org-agenda-add-note @vindex org-log-into-drawer Add a note to the entry. This note is recorded, and then filed to the same location where state change notes are put. Depending on @code{org-log-into-drawer}, this may be inside a drawer. @item @kbd{C-c C-a} (@code{org-attach}) @kindex C-c C-a @findex org-attach Dispatcher for all command related to attachments. @item @kbd{C-c C-s} (@code{org-agenda-schedule}) @kindex C-c C-s @findex org-agenda-schedule Schedule this item. With a prefix argument, remove the scheduling timestamp @item @kbd{C-c C-d} (@code{org-agenda-deadline}) @kindex C-c C-d @findex org-agenda-deadline Set a deadline for this item. With a prefix argument, remove the deadline. @item @kbd{S-@key{RIGHT}} (@code{org-agenda-do-date-later}) @kindex S-RIGHT @findex org-agenda-do-date-later Change the timestamp associated with the current line by one day into the future. If the date is in the past, the first call to this command moves it to today. With a numeric prefix argument, change it by that many days. For example, @kbd{3 6 5 S-@key{RIGHT}} changes it by a year. With a @kbd{C-u} prefix, change the time by one hour. If you immediately repeat the command, it will continue to change hours even without the prefix argument. With a double @kbd{C-u C-u} prefix, do the same for changing minutes. The stamp is changed in the original Org file, but the change is not directly reflected in the agenda buffer. Use @kbd{r} or @kbd{g} to update the buffer. @item @kbd{S-@key{LEFT}} (@code{org-agenda-do-date-earlier}) @kindex S-LEFT @findex org-agenda-do-date-earlier Change the timestamp associated with the current line by one day into the past. @item @kbd{>} (@code{org-agenda-date-prompt}) @kindex > @findex org-agenda-date-prompt Change the timestamp associated with the current line. The key @kbd{>} has been chosen, because it is the same as @kbd{S-.} on my keyboard. @item @kbd{I} (@code{org-agenda-clock-in}) @kindex I @findex org-agenda-clock-in Start the clock on the current item. If a clock is running already, it is stopped first. @item @kbd{O} (@code{org-agenda-clock-out}) @kindex O @findex org-agenda-clock-out Stop the previously started clock. @item @kbd{X} (@code{org-agenda-clock-cancel}) @kindex X @findex org-agenda-clock-cancel Cancel the currently running clock. @item @kbd{J} (@code{org-agenda-clock-goto}) @kindex J @findex org-agenda-clock-goto Jump to the running clock in another window. @item @kbd{k} (@code{org-agenda-capture}) @kindex k @findex org-agenda-capture @cindex capturing, from agenda @vindex org-capture-use-agenda-date Like @code{org-capture}, but use the date at point as the default date for the capture template. See @code{org-capture-use-agenda-date} to make this the default behavior of @code{org-capture}. @end table @anchor{Bulk remote editing selected entries} @subheading Bulk remote editing selected entries @cindex remote editing, bulk, from agenda @vindex org-agenda-bulk-custom-functions @table @asis @item @kbd{m} (@code{org-agenda-bulk-mark}) @kindex m @findex org-agenda-bulk-mark Mark the entry at point for bulk action. If there is an active region in the agenda, mark the entries in the region. With numeric prefix argument, mark that many successive entries. @item @kbd{*} (@code{org-agenda-bulk-mark-all}) @kindex * @findex org-agenda-bulk-mark-all Mark all visible agenda entries for bulk action. @item @kbd{u} (@code{org-agenda-bulk-unmark}) @kindex u @findex org-agenda-bulk-unmark Unmark entry for bulk action. @item @kbd{U} (@code{org-agenda-bulk-remove-all-marks}) @kindex U @findex org-agenda-bulk-remove-all-marks Unmark all marked entries for bulk action. @item @kbd{M-m} (@code{org-agenda-bulk-toggle}) @kindex M-m @findex org-agenda-bulk-toggle Toggle mark of the entry at point for bulk action. @item @kbd{M-*} (@code{org-agenda-bulk-toggle-all}) @kindex M-* @findex org-agenda-bulk-toggle-all Toggle mark of every entry for bulk action. @item @kbd{%} (@code{org-agenda-bulk-mark-regexp}) @kindex % @findex org-agenda-bulk-mark-regexp Mark entries matching a regular expression for bulk action. @item @kbd{B} (@code{org-agenda-bulk-action}) @kindex B @findex org-agenda-bulk-action @vindex org-agenda-bulk-persistent-marks Bulk action: act on all marked entries in the agenda. This prompts for another key to select the action to be applied. The prefix argument to @kbd{B} is passed through to the @kbd{s} and @kbd{d} commands, to bulk-remove these special timestamps. By default, marks are removed after the bulk. If you want them to persist, set @code{org-agenda-bulk-persistent-marks} to @code{t} or hit @kbd{p} at the prompt. @table @asis @item @kbd{p} Toggle persistent marks. @item @kbd{$} Archive all selected entries. @item @kbd{A} Archive entries by moving them to their respective archive siblings. @item @kbd{t} Change TODO state. This prompts for a single TODO keyword and changes the state of all selected entries, bypassing blocking and suppressing logging notes---but not timestamps. @item @kbd{+} Add a tag to all selected entries. @item @kbd{-} Remove a tag from all selected entries. @item @kbd{s} Schedule all items to a new date. To shift existing schedule dates by a fixed number of days, use something starting with double plus at the prompt, for example @samp{++8d} or @samp{++2w}. @item @kbd{d} Set deadline to a specific date. @item @kbd{r} Prompt for a single refile target and move all entries. The entries are no longer in the agenda; refresh (@kbd{g}) to bring them back. @item @kbd{S} Reschedule randomly into the coming N days. N is prompted for. With a prefix argument (@kbd{C-u B S}), scatter only across weekdays. @item @kbd{f} @vindex org-agenda-bulk-custom-functions Apply a function@footnote{You can also create persistent custom functions through @code{org-agenda-bulk-custom-functions}.} to marked entries. For example, the function below sets the @samp{CATEGORY} property of the entries to @samp{web}. @lisp (defun set-category () (interactive "P") (let ((marker (or (org-get-at-bol 'org-hd-marker) (org-agenda-error)))) (org-with-point-at marker (org-back-to-heading t) (org-set-property "CATEGORY" "web")))) @end lisp @end table @end table @anchor{Calendar commands} @subheading Calendar commands @cindex calendar commands, from agenda @table @asis @item @kbd{c} (@code{org-agenda-goto-calendar}) @kindex c @findex org-agenda-goto-calendar Open the Emacs calendar and go to the date at point in the agenda. @item @kbd{c} (@code{org-calendar-goto-agenda}) @kindex c @findex org-calendar-goto-agenda When in the calendar, compute and show the Org agenda for the date at point. @item @kbd{i} (@code{org-agenda-diary-entry}) @kindex i @findex org-agenda-diary-entry @cindex diary entries, creating from agenda Insert a new entry into the diary, using the date at point and (for block entries) the date at the mark. This adds to the Emacs diary file@footnote{This file is parsed for the agenda when @code{org-agenda-include-diary} is set.}, in a way similar to the @kbd{i} command in the calendar. The diary file pops up in another window, where you can add the entry. @vindex org-agenda-diary-file If you configure @code{org-agenda-diary-file} to point to an Org file, Org creates entries in that file instead. Most entries are stored in a date-based outline tree that will later make it easy to archive appointments from previous months/years. The tree is built under an entry with a @samp{DATE_TREE} property, or else with years as top-level entries. Emacs prompts you for the entry text---if you specify it, the entry is created in @code{org-agenda-diary-file} without further interaction. If you directly press @kbd{@key{RET}} at the prompt without typing text, the target file is shown in another window for you to finish the entry there. See also the @kbd{k r} command. @item @kbd{M} (@code{org-agenda-phases-of-moon}) @kindex M @findex org-agenda-phases-of-moon Show the phases of the moon for the three months around current date. @item @kbd{S} (@code{org-agenda-sunrise-sunset}) @kindex S @findex org-agenda-sunrise-sunset Show sunrise and sunset times. The geographical location must be set with calendar variables, see the documentation for the Emacs calendar. @item @kbd{C} (@code{org-agenda-convert-date}) @kindex C @findex org-agenda-convert-date Convert the date at point into many other cultural and historic calendars. @item @kbd{H} (@code{org-agenda-holidays}) @kindex H @findex org-agenda-holidays Show holidays for three months around point date. @end table @anchor{Quit and exit} @subheading Quit and exit @table @asis @item @kbd{q} (@code{org-agenda-quit}) @kindex q @findex org-agenda-quit Quit agenda, remove the agenda buffer. @item @kbd{x} (@code{org-agenda-exit}) @kindex x @findex org-agenda-exit @cindex agenda files, removing buffers Exit agenda, remove the agenda buffer and all buffers loaded by Emacs for the compilation of the agenda. Buffers created by the user to visit Org files are not removed. @end table @node Custom Agenda Views @section Custom Agenda Views @cindex custom agenda views @cindex agenda views, custom Custom agenda commands serve two purposes: to store and quickly access frequently used TODO and tags searches, and to create special composite agenda buffers. Custom agenda commands are accessible through the dispatcher (see @ref{Agenda Dispatcher}), just like the default commands. @menu * Storing searches:: Type once, use often. * Block agenda:: All the stuff you need in a single buffer. * Setting options:: Changing the rules. @end menu @node Storing searches @subsection Storing searches The first application of custom searches is the definition of keyboard shortcuts for frequently used searches, either creating an agenda buffer, or a sparse tree (the latter covering of course only the current buffer). @kindex C @r{(Agenda dispatcher)} @vindex org-agenda-custom-commands @cindex agenda views, main example @cindex agenda, as an agenda views @cindex agenda*, as an agenda views @cindex tags, as an agenda view @cindex todo, as an agenda view @cindex tags-todo @cindex todo-tree @cindex occur-tree @cindex tags-tree Custom commands are configured in the variable @code{org-agenda-custom-commands}. You can customize this variable, for example by pressing @kbd{C} from the agenda dispatcher (see @ref{Agenda Dispatcher}). You can also directly set it with Emacs Lisp in the Emacs init file. The following example contains all valid agenda views: @lisp (setq org-agenda-custom-commands '(("x" agenda) ("y" agenda*) ("w" todo "WAITING") ("W" todo-tree "WAITING") ("u" tags "+boss-urgent") ("v" tags-todo "+boss-urgent") ("U" tags-tree "+boss-urgent") ("f" occur-tree "\\") ("h" . "HOME+Name tags searches") ;description for "h" prefix ("hl" tags "+home+Lisa") ("hp" tags "+home+Peter") ("hk" tags "+home+Kim"))) @end lisp The initial string in each entry defines the keys you have to press after the dispatcher command in order to access the command. Usually this is just a single character, but if you have many similar commands, you can also define two-letter combinations where the first character is the same in several combinations and serves as a prefix key@footnote{You can provide a description for a prefix key by inserting a cons cell with the prefix and the description.}. The second parameter is the search type, followed by the string or regular expression to be used for the matching. The example above will therefore define: @table @asis @item @kbd{x} as a global search for agenda entries planned@footnote{@emph{Planned} means here that these entries have some planning information attached to them, like a time-stamp, a scheduled or a deadline string. See @code{org-agenda-entry-types} on how to set what planning information is taken into account.} this week/day. @item @kbd{y} as the same search, but only for entries with an hour specification like @samp{[h]h:mm}---think of them as appointments. @item @kbd{w} as a global search for TODO entries with @samp{WAITING} as the TODO keyword. @item @kbd{W} as the same search, but only in the current buffer and displaying the results as a sparse tree. @item @kbd{u} as a global tags search for headlines tagged @samp{boss} but not @samp{urgent}. @item @kbd{v} The same search, but limiting it to headlines that are also TODO items. @item @kbd{U} as the same search, but only in the current buffer and displaying the result as a sparse tree. @item @kbd{f} to create a sparse tree (again, current buffer only) with all entries containing the word @samp{FIXME}. @item @kbd{h} as a prefix command for a @samp{HOME} tags search where you have to press an additional key (@kbd{l}, @kbd{p} or @kbd{k}) to select a name (Lisa, Peter, or Kim) as additional tag to match. @end table Note that @code{*-tree} agenda views need to be called from an Org buffer as they operate on the current buffer only. @node Block agenda @subsection Block agenda @cindex block agenda @cindex agenda, with block views Another possibility is the construction of agenda views that comprise the results of @emph{several} commands, each of which creates a block in the agenda buffer. The available commands include @code{agenda} for the daily or weekly agenda (as created with @kbd{a}) , @code{alltodo} for the global TODO list (as constructed with @kbd{t}), @code{stuck} for the list of stuck projects (as obtained with @kbd{#}) and the matching commands discussed above: @code{todo}, @code{tags}, and @code{tags-todo}. Here are two examples: @lisp (setq org-agenda-custom-commands '(("h" "Agenda and Home-related tasks" ((agenda "") (tags-todo "home") (tags "garden"))) ("o" "Agenda and Office-related tasks" ((agenda "") (tags-todo "work") (tags "office"))))) @end lisp @noindent This defines @kbd{h} to create a multi-block view for stuff you need to attend to at home. The resulting agenda buffer contains your agenda for the current week, all TODO items that carry the tag @samp{home}, and also all lines tagged with @samp{garden}. Finally the command @kbd{o} provides a similar view for office tasks. @node Setting options @subsection Setting options for custom commands @cindex options, for custom agenda views @vindex org-agenda-custom-commands Org mode contains a number of variables regulating agenda construction and display. The global variables define the behavior for all agenda commands, including the custom commands. However, if you want to change some settings just for a single custom view, you can do so. Setting options requires inserting a list of variable names and values at the right spot in @code{org-agenda-custom-commands}. For example: @lisp (setq org-agenda-custom-commands '(("w" todo "WAITING" ((org-agenda-sorting-strategy '(priority-down)) (org-agenda-prefix-format " Mixed: "))) ("U" tags-tree "+boss-urgent" ((org-show-context-detail 'minimal))) ("N" search "" ((org-agenda-files '("~org/notes.org")) (org-agenda-text-search-extra-files nil))))) @end lisp @noindent Now the @kbd{w} command sorts the collected entries only by priority, and the prefix format is modified to just say @samp{Mixed:} instead of giving the category of the entry. The sparse tags tree of @kbd{U} now turns out ultra-compact, because neither the headline hierarchy above the match, nor the headline following the match are shown. The command @kbd{N} does a text search limited to only a single file. For command sets creating a block agenda, @code{org-agenda-custom-commands} has two separate spots for setting options. You can add options that should be valid for just a single command in the set, and options that should be valid for all commands in the set. The former are just added to the command entry; the latter must come after the list of command entries. Going back to the block agenda example (see @ref{Block agenda}), let's change the sorting strategy for the @kbd{h} commands to @code{priority-down}, but let's sort the results for @samp{garden} tags query in the opposite order, @code{priority-up}. This would look like this: @lisp (setq org-agenda-custom-commands '(("h" "Agenda and Home-related tasks" ((agenda) (tags-todo "home") (tags "garden" ((org-agenda-sorting-strategy '(priority-up))))) ((org-agenda-sorting-strategy '(priority-down)))) ("o" "Agenda and Office-related tasks" ((agenda) (tags-todo "work") (tags "office"))))) @end lisp As you see, the values and parentheses setting is a little complex. When in doubt, use the customize interface to set this variable---it fully supports its structure. Just one caveat: when setting options in this interface, the @emph{values} are just Lisp expressions. So if the value is a string, you need to add the double-quotes around the value yourself. @vindex org-agenda-custom-commands-contexts To control whether an agenda command should be accessible from a specific context, you can customize @code{org-agenda-custom-commands-contexts}. Let's say for example that you have an agenda command @kbd{o} displaying a view that you only need when reading emails. Then you would configure this option like this: @lisp (setq org-agenda-custom-commands-contexts '(("o" (in-mode . "message-mode")))) @end lisp You can also tell that the command key @kbd{o} should refer to another command key @kbd{r}. In that case, add this command key like this: @lisp (setq org-agenda-custom-commands-contexts '(("o" "r" (in-mode . "message-mode")))) @end lisp See the docstring of the variable for more information. @node Exporting Agenda Views @section Exporting Agenda Views @cindex agenda views, exporting If you are away from your computer, it can be very useful to have a printed version of some agenda views to carry around. Org mode can export custom agenda views as plain text, HTML@footnote{For HTML you need to install Hrvoje Nikšić's @samp{htmlize.el} as an Emacs package from MELPA or from @uref{https://github.com/hniksic/emacs-htmlize, Hrvoje Nikšić's repository}.}, Postscript, PDF@footnote{To create PDF output, the Ghostscript ps2pdf utility must be installed on the system. Selecting a PDF file also creates the postscript file.}, and iCalendar files. If you want to do this only occasionally, use the following command: @table @asis @item @kbd{C-x C-w} (@code{org-agenda-write}) @kindex C-x C-w @findex org-agenda-write @cindex exporting agenda views @cindex agenda views, exporting @vindex org-agenda-exporter-settings Write the agenda view to a file. @end table If you need to export certain agenda views frequently, you can associate any custom agenda command with a list of output file names@footnote{If you want to store standard views like the weekly agenda or the global TODO list as well, you need to define custom commands for them in order to be able to specify file names.}. Here is an example that first defines custom commands for the agenda and the global TODO list, together with a number of files to which to export them. Then we define two block agenda commands and specify file names for them as well. File names can be relative to the current working directory, or absolute. @lisp (setq org-agenda-custom-commands '(("X" agenda "" nil ("agenda.html" "agenda.ps")) ("Y" alltodo "" nil ("todo.html" "todo.txt" "todo.ps")) ("h" "Agenda and Home-related tasks" ((agenda "") (tags-todo "home") (tags "garden")) nil ("~/views/home.html")) ("o" "Agenda and Office-related tasks" ((agenda) (tags-todo "work") (tags "office")) nil ("~/views/office.ps" "~/calendars/office.ics")))) @end lisp The extension of the file name determines the type of export. If it is @samp{.html}, Org mode uses the htmlize package to convert the buffer to HTML and save it to this file name. If the extension is @samp{.ps}, @code{ps-print-buffer-with-faces} is used to produce Postscript output. If the extension is @samp{.ics}, iCalendar export is run export over all files that were used to construct the agenda, and limit the export to entries listed in the agenda. Any other extension produces a plain ASCII file. The export files are @emph{not} created when you use one of those commands interactively because this might use too much overhead. Instead, there is a special command to produce @emph{all} specified files in one step: @table @asis @item @kbd{e} (@code{org-store-agenda-views}) @kindex e @r{(Agenda dispatcher)} @findex org-store-agenda-views Export all agenda views that have export file names associated with them. @end table You can use the options section of the custom agenda commands to also set options for the export commands. For example: @lisp (setq org-agenda-custom-commands '(("X" agenda "" ((ps-number-of-columns 2) (ps-landscape-mode t) (org-agenda-prefix-format " [ ] ") (org-agenda-with-colors nil) (org-agenda-remove-tags t)) ("theagenda.ps")))) @end lisp @noindent @vindex org-agenda-exporter-settings This command sets two options for the Postscript exporter, to make it print in two columns in landscape format---the resulting page can be cut in two and then used in a paper agenda. The remaining settings modify the agenda prefix to omit category and scheduling information, and instead include a checkbox to check off items. We also remove the tags to make the lines compact, and we do not want to use colors for the black-and-white printer. Settings specified in @code{org-agenda-exporter-settings} also apply, e.g., @lisp (setq org-agenda-exporter-settings '((ps-number-of-columns 2) (ps-landscape-mode t) (org-agenda-add-entry-text-maxlines 5) (htmlize-output-type 'css))) @end lisp @noindent but the settings in @code{org-agenda-custom-commands} take precedence. From the command line you may also use: @example emacs -eval (org-batch-store-agenda-views) -kill @end example @noindent or, if you need to modify some parameters@footnote{Quoting depends on the system you use, please check the FAQ for examples.} @example emacs -eval '(org-batch-store-agenda-views \ org-agenda-span (quote month) \ org-agenda-start-day "2007-11-01" \ org-agenda-include-diary nil \ org-agenda-files (quote ("~/org/project.org")))' \ -kill @end example @noindent which creates the agenda views restricted to the file @samp{~/org/project.org}, without diary entries and with a 30-day extent. You can also extract agenda information in a way that allows further processing by other programs. See @ref{Extracting Agenda Information}, for more information. @node Agenda Column View @section Using Column View in the Agenda @cindex column view, in agenda @cindex agenda, column view Column view (see @ref{Column View}) is normally used to view and edit properties embedded in the hierarchical structure of an Org file. It can be quite useful to use column view also from the agenda, where entries are collected by certain criteria. @table @asis @item @kbd{C-c C-x C-c} (@code{org-agenda-columns}) @kindex C-c C-x C-c @findex org-agenda-columns Turn on column view in the agenda. @end table To understand how to use this properly, it is important to realize that the entries in the agenda are no longer in their proper outline environment. This causes the following issues: @enumerate @item @vindex org-columns-default-format-for-agenda @vindex org-columns-default-format Org needs to make a decision which columns format to use. Since the entries in the agenda are collected from different files, and different files may have different columns formats, this is a non-trivial problem. Org first checks if @code{org-overriding-columns-format} is currently set, and if so, takes the format from there. You should set this variable only in the @emph{local settings section} of a custom agenda command (see @ref{Custom Agenda Views}) to make it valid for that specific agenda view. If no such binding exists, it checks, in sequence, @code{org-columns-default-format-for-agenda}, the format associated with the first item in the agenda (through a property or a @samp{#+COLUMNS} setting in that buffer) and finally @code{org-columns-default-format}. @item @cindex @samp{CLOCKSUM}, special property If any of the columns has a summary type defined (see @ref{Column attributes}), turning on column view in the agenda visits all relevant agenda files and make sure that the computations of this property are up to date. This is also true for the special @samp{CLOCKSUM} property. Org then sums the values displayed in the agenda. In the daily/weekly agenda, the sums cover a single day; in all other views they cover the entire block. It is important to realize that the agenda may show the same entry @emph{twice}---for example as scheduled and as a deadline---and it may show two entries from the same hierarchy (for example a @emph{parent} and its @emph{child}). In these cases, the summation in the agenda leads to incorrect results because some values count double. @item When the column view in the agenda shows the @samp{CLOCKSUM} property, that is always the entire clocked time for this item. So even in the daily/weekly agenda, the clocksum listed in column view may originate from times outside the current view. This has the advantage that you can compare these values with a column listing the planned total effort for a task---one of the major applications for column view in the agenda. If you want information about clocked time in the displayed period use clock table mode (press @kbd{R} in the agenda). @item @cindex @samp{CLOCKSUM_T}, special property When the column view in the agenda shows the @samp{CLOCKSUM_T} property, that is always today's clocked time for this item. So even in the weekly agenda, the clocksum listed in column view only originates from today. This lets you compare the time you spent on a task for today, with the time already spent---via @samp{CLOCKSUM}---and with the planned total effort for it. @end enumerate @node Markup for Rich Contents @chapter Markup for Rich Contents Org is primarily about organizing and searching through your plain-text notes. However, it also provides a lightweight yet robust markup language for rich text formatting and more. For instance, you may want to center or emphasize text. Or you may need to insert a formula or image in your writing. Org offers syntax for all of this and more. Used in conjunction with the export framework (see @ref{Exporting}), you can author beautiful documents in Org---like the fine manual you are currently reading. @menu * Paragraphs:: The basic unit of text. * Emphasis and Monospace:: Bold, italic, etc. * Subscripts and Superscripts:: Simple syntax for raising/lowering text. * Special Symbols:: Greek letters and other symbols. * Embedded @LaTeX{}:: LaTeX can be freely used inside Org documents. * Literal Examples:: Source code examples with special formatting. * Images:: Display an image. * Captions:: Describe tables, images... * Horizontal Rules:: Make a line. * Creating Footnotes:: Edit and read footnotes. @end menu @node Paragraphs @section Paragraphs @cindex paragraphs, markup rules Paragraphs are separated by at least one empty line. If you need to enforce a line break within a paragraph, use @samp{\\} at the end of a line. @cindex line breaks, markup rules To preserve the line breaks, indentation and blank lines in a region, but otherwise use normal formatting, you can use this construct, which can also be used to format poetry. @cindex @samp{BEGIN_VERSE} @cindex verse blocks @example #+BEGIN_VERSE Great clouds overhead Tiny black birds rise and fall Snow covers Emacs ---AlexSchroeder #+END_VERSE @end example When quoting a passage from another document, it is customary to format this as a paragraph that is indented on both the left and the right margin. You can include quotations in Org documents like this: @cindex @samp{BEGIN_QUOTE} @cindex quote blocks @example #+BEGIN_QUOTE Everything should be made as simple as possible, but not any simpler ---Albert Einstein #+END_QUOTE @end example If you would like to center some text, do it like this: @cindex @samp{BEGIN_CENTER} @cindex center blocks @example #+BEGIN_CENTER Everything should be made as simple as possible, \\ but not any simpler #+END_CENTER @end example @node Emphasis and Monospace @section Emphasis and Monospace @cindex underlined text, markup rules @cindex bold text, markup rules @cindex italic text, markup rules @cindex verbatim text, markup rules @cindex code text, markup rules @cindex strike-through text, markup rules You can make words @samp{*bold*}, @samp{/italic/}, @samp{_underlined_}, @samp{=verbatim=} and @samp{~code~}, and, if you must, @samp{+strike-through+}. Text in the code and verbatim string is not processed for Org specific syntax; it is exported verbatim. @vindex org-fontify-emphasized-text To turn off fontification for marked up text, you can set @code{org-fontify-emphasized-text} to @code{nil}. To narrow down the list of available markup syntax, you can customize @code{org-emphasis-alist}. @node Subscripts and Superscripts @section Subscripts and Superscripts @cindex subscript @cindex superscript @samp{^} and @samp{_} are used to indicate super- and subscripts. To increase the readability of ASCII text, it is not necessary, but OK, to surround multi-character sub- and superscripts with curly braces. For example @example The radius of the sun is R_sun = 6.96 x 10^8 m. On the other hand, the radius of Alpha Centauri is R_@{Alpha Centauri@} = 1.28 x R_@{sun@}. @end example @vindex org-use-sub-superscripts If you write a text where the underscore is often used in a different context, Org's convention to always interpret these as subscripts can get in your way. Configure the variable @code{org-use-sub-superscripts} to change this convention. For example, when setting this variable to @code{@{@}}, @samp{a_b} is not interpreted as a subscript, but @samp{a_@{b@}} is. You can set @code{org-use-sub-superscripts} in a file using the export option @samp{^:} (see @ref{Export Settings}). For example, @samp{#+OPTIONS: ^:@{@}} sets @code{org-use-sub-superscripts} to @code{@{@}} and limits super- and subscripts to the curly bracket notation. You can also toggle the visual display of super- and subscripts: @table @asis @item @kbd{C-c C-x \} (@code{org-toggle-pretty-entities}) @kindex C-c C-x \ @findex org-toggle-pretty-entities This command formats sub- and superscripts in a WYSIWYM way. @end table @vindex org-pretty-entities @vindex org-pretty-entities-include-sub-superscripts Set both @code{org-pretty-entities} and @code{org-pretty-entities-include-sub-superscripts} to @code{t} to start with super- and subscripts @emph{visually} interpreted as specified by the option @code{org-use-sub-superscripts}. @node Special Symbols @section Special Symbols @cindex math symbols @cindex special symbols @cindex entities You can use @LaTeX{}-like syntax to insert special symbols---named entities---like @samp{\alpha} to indicate the Greek letter, or @samp{\to} to indicate an arrow. Completion for these symbols is available, just type @samp{\} and maybe a few letters, and press @kbd{M-@key{TAB}} to see possible completions. If you need such a symbol inside a word, terminate it with a pair of curly brackets. For example @example Pro tip: Given a circle \Gamma of diameter d, the length of its circumference is \pi@{@}d. @end example @findex org-entities-help @vindex org-entities-user A large number of entities is provided, with names taken from both HTML and @LaTeX{}; you can comfortably browse the complete list from a dedicated buffer using the command @code{org-entities-help}. It is also possible to provide your own special symbols in the variable @code{org-entities-user}. During export, these symbols are transformed into the native format of the exporter back-end. Strings like @samp{\alpha} are exported as @samp{α} in the HTML output, and as @samp{\(\alpha\)} in the @LaTeX{} output. Similarly, @samp{\nbsp} becomes @samp{ } in HTML and @samp{~} in @LaTeX{}. @cindex special symbols, in-buffer display If you would like to see entities displayed as UTF-8 characters, use the following command@footnote{You can turn this on by default by setting the variable @code{org-pretty-entities}, or on a per-file base with the @samp{STARTUP} option @samp{entitiespretty}.}: @table @asis @item @kbd{C-c C-x \} (@code{org-toggle-pretty-entities}) @kindex C-c C-x \ @findex org-toggle-pretty-entities Toggle display of entities as UTF-8 characters. This does not change the buffer content which remains plain ASCII, but it overlays the UTF-8 character for display purposes only. @end table @cindex shy hyphen, special symbol @cindex dash, special symbol @cindex ellipsis, special symbol In addition to regular entities defined above, Org exports in a special way@footnote{This behavior can be disabled with @samp{-} export setting (see @ref{Export Settings}).} the following commonly used character combinations: @samp{\-} is treated as a shy hyphen, @samp{--} and @samp{---} are converted into dashes, and @samp{...} becomes a compact set of dots. @node Embedded @LaTeX{} @section Embedded @LaTeX{} @cindex @TeX{} interpretation @cindex @LaTeX{} interpretation Plain ASCII is normally sufficient for almost all note taking. Exceptions include scientific notes, which often require mathematical symbols and the occasional formula. @LaTeX{}@footnote{@LaTeX{} is a macro system based on Donald@tie{}E@.@tie{}Knuth's @TeX{} system. Many of the features described here as ``@LaTeX{}'' are really from @TeX{}, but for simplicity I am blurring this distinction.} is widely used to typeset scientific documents. Org mode supports embedding @LaTeX{} code into its files, because many academics are used to writing and reading @LaTeX{} source code, and because it can be readily processed to produce pretty output for a number of export back-ends. @menu * @LaTeX{} fragments:: Complex formulas made easy. * Previewing @LaTeX{} fragments:: What will this snippet look like? * CD@LaTeX{} mode:: Speed up entering of formulas. @end menu @node @LaTeX{} fragments @subsection @LaTeX{} fragments @cindex @LaTeX{} fragments @vindex org-format-latex-header Org mode can contain @LaTeX{} math fragments, and it supports ways to process these for several export back-ends. When exporting to @LaTeX{}, the code is left as it is. When exporting to HTML, Org can use either @uref{http://www.mathjax.org, MathJax} (see @ref{Math formatting in HTML export}) or transcode the math into images (see @ref{Previewing @LaTeX{} fragments}). @LaTeX{} fragments do not need any special marking at all. The following snippets are identified as @LaTeX{} source code: @itemize @item Environments of any kind@footnote{When MathJax is used, only the environments recognized by MathJax are processed. When dvipng, dvisvgm, or ImageMagick suite is used to create images, any @LaTeX{} environment is handled.}. The only requirement is that the @samp{\begin} statement appears on a new line, preceded by only whitespace. @item Text within the usual @LaTeX{} math delimiters. To avoid conflicts with currency specifications, single @samp{$} characters are only recognized as math delimiters if the enclosed text contains at most two line breaks, is directly attached to the @samp{$} characters with no whitespace in between, and if the closing @samp{$} is followed by whitespace, punctuation or a dash. For the other delimiters, there is no such restriction, so when in doubt, use @samp{\(...\)} as inline math delimiters. @end itemize @noindent For example: @example \begin@{equation@} % arbitrary environments, x=\sqrt@{b@} % even tables, figures \end@{equation@} % etc If $a^2=b$ and \( b=2 \), then the solution must be either $$ a=+\sqrt@{2@} $$ or \[ a=-\sqrt@{2@} \]. @end example @vindex org-export-with-latex @LaTeX{} processing can be configured with the variable @code{org-export-with-latex}. The default setting is @code{t} which means MathJax for HTML, and no processing for ASCII and @LaTeX{} back-ends. You can also set this variable on a per-file basis using one of these lines: @multitable {aaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaa} {aaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaa} @item @samp{#+OPTIONS: tex:t} @tab Do the right thing automatically (MathJax) @item @samp{#+OPTIONS: tex:nil} @tab Do not process @LaTeX{} fragments at all @item @samp{#+OPTIONS: tex:verbatim} @tab Verbatim export, for jsMath or so @end multitable @node Previewing @LaTeX{} fragments @subsection Previewing @LaTeX{} fragments @cindex @LaTeX{} fragments, preview @vindex org-preview-latex-default-process If you have a working @LaTeX{} installation and @samp{dvipng}, @samp{dvisvgm} or @samp{convert} installed@footnote{These are respectively available at @uref{http://sourceforge.net/projects/dvipng/}, @uref{http://dvisvgm.bplaced.net/} and from the ImageMagick suite. Choose the converter by setting the variable @code{org-preview-latex-default-process} accordingly.}, @LaTeX{} fragments can be processed to produce images of the typeset expressions to be used for inclusion while exporting to HTML (see @ref{@LaTeX{} fragments}), or for inline previewing within Org mode. @vindex org-format-latex-options @vindex org-format-latex-header You can customize the variables @code{org-format-latex-options} and @code{org-format-latex-header} to influence some aspects of the preview. In particular, the @code{:scale} (and for HTML export, @code{:html-scale}) property of the former can be used to adjust the size of the preview images. @table @asis @item @kbd{C-c C-x C-l} (@code{org-latex-preview}) @kindex C-c C-x C-l @findex org-latex-preview Produce a preview image of the @LaTeX{} fragment at point and overlay it over the source code. If there is no fragment at point, process all fragments in the current entry---between two headlines. When called with a single prefix argument, clear all images in the current entry. Two prefix arguments produce a preview image for all fragments in the buffer, while three of them clear all the images in that buffer. @end table @vindex org-startup-with-latex-preview You can turn on the previewing of all @LaTeX{} fragments in a file with @example #+STARTUP: latexpreview @end example To disable it, simply use @example #+STARTUP: nolatexpreview @end example @node CD@LaTeX{} mode @subsection Using CD@LaTeX{} to enter math @cindex CD@LaTeX{} CD@LaTeX{} mode is a minor mode that is normally used in combination with a major @LaTeX{} mode like AUC@TeX{} in order to speed-up insertion of environments and math templates. Inside Org mode, you can make use of some of the features of CD@LaTeX{} mode. You need to install @samp{cdlatex.el} and @samp{texmathp.el} (the latter comes also with AUC@TeX{}) using @uref{https://melpa.org/, MELPA} with the @uref{https://www.gnu.org/software/emacs/manual/html_node/emacs/Package-Installation.html, Emacs packaging system} or alternatively from @uref{https://staff.fnwi.uva.nl/c.dominik/Tools/cdlatex/}. Do not use CD@LaTeX{} mode itself under Org mode, but use the special version Org CD@LaTeX{} minor mode that comes as part of Org. Turn it on for the current buffer with @kbd{M-x org-cdlatex-mode}, or for all Org files with @lisp (add-hook 'org-mode-hook 'turn-on-org-cdlatex) @end lisp When this mode is enabled, the following features are present (for more details see the documentation of CD@LaTeX{} mode): @table @asis @item @kbd{C-c @{} @kindex C-c @{ Insert an environment template. @item @kbd{@key{TAB}} @kindex TAB The @kbd{@key{TAB}} key expands the template if point is inside a @LaTeX{} fragment@footnote{Org mode has a method to test if point is inside such a fragment, see the documentation of the function @code{org-inside-LaTeX-fragment-p}.}. For example, @kbd{@key{TAB}} expands @samp{fr} to @samp{\frac@{@}@{@}} and position point correctly inside the first brace. Another @kbd{@key{TAB}} gets you into the second brace. Even outside fragments, @kbd{@key{TAB}} expands environment abbreviations at the beginning of a line. For example, if you write @samp{equ} at the beginning of a line and press @kbd{@key{TAB}}, this abbreviation is expanded to an @samp{equation} environment. To get a list of all abbreviations, type @kbd{M-x cdlatex-command-help}. @item @kbd{^} @itemx @kbd{_} @kindex _ @kindex ^ @vindex cdlatex-simplify-sub-super-scripts Pressing @kbd{_} and @kbd{^} inside a @LaTeX{} fragment inserts these characters together with a pair of braces. If you use @kbd{@key{TAB}} to move out of the braces, and if the braces surround only a single character or macro, they are removed again (depending on the variable @code{cdlatex-simplify-sub-super-scripts}). @item @kbd{`} @kindex ` Pressing the backquote followed by a character inserts math macros, also outside @LaTeX{} fragments. If you wait more than 1.5 seconds after the backquote, a help window pops up. @item @kbd{'} @kindex ' Pressing the single-quote followed by another character modifies the symbol before point with an accent or a font. If you wait more than 1.5 seconds after the single-quote, a help window pops up. Character modification works only inside @LaTeX{} fragments; outside the quote is normal. @end table @node Literal Examples @section Literal Examples @cindex literal examples, markup rules @cindex code line references, markup rules You can include literal examples that should not be subjected to markup. Such examples are typeset in monospace, so this is well suited for source code and similar examples. @cindex @samp{BEGIN_EXAMPLE} @cindex example block @example #+BEGIN_EXAMPLE Some example from a text file. #+END_EXAMPLE @end example @cindex comma escape, in literal examples There is one limitation, however. You must insert a comma right before lines starting with either @samp{*}, @samp{,*}, @samp{#+} or @samp{,#+}, as those may be interpreted as outlines nodes or some other special syntax. Org transparently strips these additional commas whenever it accesses the contents of the block. @example #+BEGIN_EXAMPLE ,* I am no real headline #+END_EXAMPLE @end example For simplicity when using small examples, you can also start the example lines with a colon followed by a space. There may also be additional whitespace before the colon: @example Here is an example : Some example from a text file. @end example @cindex formatting source code, markup rules @vindex org-latex-listings If the example is source code from a programming language, or any other text that can be marked up by Font Lock in Emacs, you can ask for the example to look like the fontified Emacs buffer@footnote{This works automatically for the HTML backend (it requires version 1.34 of the @samp{htmlize.el} package, which you need to install). Fontified code chunks in @LaTeX{} can be achieved using either the @uref{https://www.ctan.org/pkg/listings, listings} package or the @uref{https://www.ctan.org/pkg/minted, minted} package. Refer to @code{org-export-latex-listings} for details.}. This is done with the code block, where you also need to specify the name of the major mode that should be used to fontify the example@footnote{Source code in code blocks may also be evaluated either interactively or on export. See @ref{Working with Source Code} for more information on evaluating code blocks.}, see @ref{Structure Templates} for shortcuts to easily insert code blocks. @cindex @samp{BEGIN_SRC} @cindex source block @example #+BEGIN_SRC emacs-lisp (defun org-xor (a b) "Exclusive or." (if a (not b) b)) #+END_SRC @end example Both in @samp{example} and in @samp{src} snippets, you can add a @samp{-n} switch to the end of the @samp{#+BEGIN} line, to get the lines of the example numbered. The @samp{-n} takes an optional numeric argument specifying the starting line number of the block. If you use a @samp{+n} switch, the numbering from the previous numbered snippet is continued in the current one. The @samp{+n} switch can also take a numeric argument. This adds the value of the argument to the last line of the previous block to determine the starting line number. @example #+BEGIN_SRC emacs-lisp -n 20 ;; This exports with line number 20. (message "This is line 21") #+END_SRC #+BEGIN_SRC emacs-lisp +n 10 ;; This is listed as line 31. (message "This is line 32") #+END_SRC @end example In literal examples, Org interprets strings like @samp{(ref:name)} as labels, and use them as targets for special hyperlinks like @samp{[[(name)]]}---i.e., the reference name enclosed in single parenthesis. In HTML, hovering the mouse over such a link remote-highlights the corresponding code line, which is kind of cool. You can also add a @samp{-r} switch which @emph{removes} the labels from the source code@footnote{Adding @samp{-k} to @samp{-n -r} @emph{keeps} the labels in the source code while using line numbers for the links, which might be useful to explain those in an Org mode example code.}. With the @samp{-n} switch, links to these references are labeled by the line numbers from the code listing. Otherwise links use the labels with no parentheses. Here is an example: @example #+BEGIN_SRC emacs-lisp -n -r (save-excursion (ref:sc) (goto-char (point-min)) (ref:jump) #+END_SRC In line [[(sc)]] we remember the current position. [[(jump)][Line (jump)]] jumps to point-min. @end example @cindex indentation, in source blocks Source code and examples may be @emph{indented} in order to align nicely with the surrounding text, and in particular with plain list structure (see @ref{Plain Lists}). By default, Org only retains the relative indentation between lines, e.g., when exporting the contents of the block. However, you can use the @samp{-i} switch to also preserve the global indentation, if it does matter. See @ref{Editing Source Code}. @vindex org-coderef-label-format If the syntax for the label format conflicts with the language syntax, use a @samp{-l} switch to change the format, for example @example #+BEGIN_SRC pascal -n -r -l "((%s))" @end example @noindent See also the variable @code{org-coderef-label-format}. HTML export also allows examples to be published as text areas (see @ref{Text areas in HTML export}). Because the @samp{#+BEGIN} @dots{} @samp{#+END} patterns need to be added so often, a shortcut is provided (see @ref{Structure Templates}). @table @asis @item @kbd{C-c '} (@code{org-edit-special}) @kindex C-c ' @findex org-edit-special Edit the source code example at point in its native mode. This works by switching to a temporary buffer with the source code. You need to exit by pressing @kbd{C-c '} again. The edited version then replaces the old version in the Org buffer. Fixed-width regions---where each line starts with a colon followed by a space---are edited using Artist mode@footnote{You may select a different mode with the variable @code{org-edit-fixed-width-region-mode}.} to allow creating ASCII drawings easily. Using this command in an empty line creates a new fixed-width region. @end table @cindex storing link, in a source code buffer Calling @code{org-store-link} (see @ref{Handling Links}) while editing a source code example in a temporary buffer created with @kbd{C-c '} prompts for a label. Make sure that it is unique in the current buffer, and insert it with the proper formatting like @samp{(ref:label)} at the end of the current line. Then the label is stored as a link @samp{(label)}, for retrieval with @kbd{C-c C-l}. @node Images @section Images @cindex inlining images @cindex images, markup rules An image is a link to an image file@footnote{What Emacs considers to be an image depends on @code{image-file-name-extensions} and @code{image-file-name-regexps}.} that does not have a description part, for example @example ./img/cat.jpg @end example If you wish to define a caption for the image (see @ref{Captions}) and maybe a label for internal cross references (see @ref{Internal Links}), make sure that the link is on a line by itself and precede it with @samp{CAPTION} and @samp{NAME} keywords as follows: @example #+CAPTION: This is the caption for the next figure link (or table) #+NAME: fig:SED-HR4049 [[./img/a.jpg]] @end example Such images can be displayed within the buffer with the following command: @table @asis @item @kbd{C-c C-x C-v} (@code{org-toggle-inline-images}) @kindex C-c C-x C-v @findex org-toggle-inline-images @vindex org-startup-with-inline-images Toggle the inline display of linked images. When called with a prefix argument, also display images that do have a link description. You can ask for inline images to be displayed at startup by configuring the variable @code{org-startup-with-inline-images}@footnote{The variable @code{org-startup-with-inline-images} can be set within a buffer with the @samp{STARTUP} options @samp{inlineimages} and @samp{noinlineimages}.}. @end table @node Captions @section Captions @cindex captions, markup rules @cindex @samp{CAPTION}, keyword You can assign a caption to a specific part of a document by inserting a @samp{CAPTION} keyword immediately before it: @example #+CAPTION: This is the caption for the next table (or link) | ... | ... | |-----+-----| @end example Optionally, the caption can take the form: @example #+CAPTION[Short caption]: Longer caption. @end example Even though images and tables are prominent examples of captioned structures, the same caption mechanism can apply to many others---e.g., @LaTeX{} equations, source code blocks. Depending on the export back-end, those may or may not be handled. @node Horizontal Rules @section Horizontal Rules @cindex horizontal rules, markup rules A line consisting of only dashes, and at least 5 of them, is exported as a horizontal line. @node Creating Footnotes @section Creating Footnotes @cindex footnotes A footnote is started by a footnote marker in square brackets in column 0, no indentation allowed. It ends at the next footnote definition, headline, or after two consecutive empty lines. The footnote reference is simply the marker in square brackets, inside text. Markers always start with @samp{fn:}. For example: @example The Org homepage[fn:1] now looks a lot better than it used to. ... [fn:1] The link is: https://orgmode.org @end example Org mode extends the number-based syntax to @emph{named} footnotes and optional inline definition. Here are the valid references: @table @asis @item @samp{[fn:NAME]} A named footnote reference, where @var{NAME} is a unique label word, or, for simplicity of automatic creation, a number. @item @samp{[fn:: This is the inline definition of this footnote]} An anonymous footnote where the definition is given directly at the reference point. @item @samp{[fn:NAME: a definition]} An inline definition of a footnote, which also specifies a name for the note. Since Org allows multiple references to the same note, you can then use @samp{[fn:NAME]} to create additional references. @end table @vindex org-footnote-auto-label Footnote labels can be created automatically, or you can create names yourself. This is handled by the variable @code{org-footnote-auto-label} and its corresponding @samp{STARTUP} keywords. See the docstring of that variable for details. The following command handles footnotes: @table @asis @item @kbd{C-c C-x f} The footnote action command. @kindex C-c C-x f When point is on a footnote reference, jump to the definition. When it is at a definition, jump to the---first---reference. @vindex org-footnote-define-inline @vindex org-footnote-section Otherwise, create a new footnote. Depending on the variable @code{org-footnote-define-inline}@footnote{The corresponding in-buffer setting is: @samp{#+STARTUP: fninline} or @samp{#+STARTUP: nofninline}.}, the definition is placed right into the text as part of the reference, or separately into the location determined by the variable @code{org-footnote-section}. When this command is called with a prefix argument, a menu of additional options is offered: @multitable @columnfractions 0.1 0.9 @item @kbd{s} @tab Sort the footnote definitions by reference sequence. @item @kbd{r} @tab Renumber the simple @samp{fn:N} footnotes. @item @kbd{S} @tab Short for first @kbd{r}, then @kbd{s} action. @item @kbd{n} @tab Rename all footnotes into a @samp{fn:1} @dots{} @samp{fn:n} sequence. @item @kbd{d} @tab Delete the footnote at point, including definition and references. @end multitable @vindex org-footnote-auto-adjust Depending on the variable @code{org-footnote-auto-adjust}@footnote{The corresponding in-buffer options are @samp{#+STARTUP: fnadjust} and @samp{#+STARTUP: nofnadjust}.}, renumbering and sorting footnotes can be automatic after each insertion or deletion. @item @kbd{C-c C-c} @kindex C-c C-c If point is on a footnote reference, jump to the definition. If it is at the definition, jump back to the reference. When called at a footnote location with a prefix argument, offer the same menu as @kbd{C-c C-x f}. @item @kbd{C-c C-o} or @kbd{mouse-1/2} @kindex C-c C-o @kindex mouse-1 @kindex mouse-2 Footnote labels are also links to the corresponding definition or reference, and you can use the usual commands to follow these links. @end table @node Exporting @chapter Exporting @cindex exporting At some point you might want to print your notes, publish them on the web, or share them with people not using Org. Org can convert and export documents to a variety of other formats while retaining as much structure (see @ref{Document Structure}) and markup (see @ref{Markup for Rich Contents}) as possible. @cindex export back-end The libraries responsible for translating Org files to other formats are called @emph{back-ends}. Org ships with support for the following back-ends: @itemize @item @emph{ascii} (ASCII format) @item @emph{beamer} (@LaTeX{} Beamer format) @item @emph{html} (HTML format) @item @emph{icalendar} (iCalendar format) @item @emph{latex} (@LaTeX{} format) @item @emph{md} (Markdown format) @item @emph{odt} (OpenDocument Text format) @item @emph{org} (Org format) @item @emph{texinfo} (Texinfo format) @item @emph{man} (Man page format) @end itemize Users can install libraries for additional formats from the Emacs packaging system. For easy discovery, these packages have a common naming scheme: @code{ox-NAME}, where @var{NAME} is a format. For example, @code{ox-koma-letter} for @emph{koma-letter} back-end. More libraries can be found in the @samp{contrib/} directory (see @ref{Installation}). @vindex org-export-backends Org only loads back-ends for the following formats by default: ASCII, HTML, iCalendar, @LaTeX{}, and ODT@. Additional back-ends can be loaded in either of two ways: by configuring the @code{org-export-backends} variable, or by requiring libraries in the Emacs init file. For example, to load the Markdown back-end, add this to your Emacs config: @lisp (require 'ox-md) @end lisp @menu * The Export Dispatcher:: The main interface. * Export Settings:: Common export settings. * Table of Contents:: The if and where of the table of contents. * Include Files:: Include additional files into a document. * Macro Replacement:: Use macros to create templates. * Comment Lines:: What will not be exported. * ASCII/Latin-1/UTF-8 export:: Exporting to flat files with encoding. * Beamer Export:: Producing presentations and slides. * HTML Export:: Exporting to HTML. * @LaTeX{} Export:: Exporting to @LaTeX{} and processing to PDF. * Markdown Export:: Exporting to Markdown. * OpenDocument Text Export:: Exporting to OpenDocument Text. * Org Export:: Exporting to Org. * Texinfo Export:: Exporting to Texinfo. * iCalendar Export:: Exporting to iCalendar. * Other Built-in Back-ends:: Exporting to a man page. * Advanced Export Configuration:: Fine-tuning the export output. * Export in Foreign Buffers:: Author tables and lists in Org syntax. @end menu @node The Export Dispatcher @section The Export Dispatcher @cindex dispatcher, for export commands @cindex export, dispatcher The export dispatcher is the main interface for Org's exports. A hierarchical menu presents the currently configured export formats. Options are shown as easy toggle switches on the same screen. @vindex org-export-dispatch-use-expert-ui Org also has a minimal prompt interface for the export dispatcher. When the variable @code{org-export-dispatch-use-expert-ui} is set to a non-@code{nil} value, Org prompts in the minibuffer. To switch back to the hierarchical menu, press @kbd{?}. @table @asis @item @kbd{C-c C-e} (@code{org-export}) @kindex C-c C-e @findex org-export Invokes the export dispatcher interface. The options show default settings. The @kbd{C-u} prefix argument preserves options from the previous export, including any sub-tree selections. @end table Org exports the entire buffer by default. If the Org buffer has an active region, then Org exports just that region. Within the dispatcher interface, the following key combinations can further alter what is exported, and how. @table @asis @item @kbd{C-a} @kindex C-c C-e C-a Toggle asynchronous export. Asynchronous export uses an external Emacs process with a specially configured initialization file to complete the exporting process in the background, without tying-up Emacs. This is particularly useful when exporting long documents. Output from an asynchronous export is saved on the @emph{export stack}. To view this stack, call the export dispatcher with a double @kbd{C-u} prefix argument. If already in the export dispatcher menu, @kbd{&} displays the stack. @vindex org-export-in-background You can make asynchronous export the default by setting @code{org-export-in-background}. @vindex org-export-async-init-file You can set the initialization file used by the background process by setting @code{org-export-async-init-file}. @item @kbd{C-b} @kindex C-c C-e C-b Toggle body-only export. Useful for excluding headers and footers in the export. Affects only those back-end formats that have sections like @samp{...} in HTML@. @item @kbd{C-s} @kindex C-c C-e C-s Toggle sub-tree export. When turned on, Org exports only the sub-tree starting from point position at the time the export dispatcher was invoked. Org uses the top heading of this sub-tree as the document's title. If point is not on a heading, Org uses the nearest enclosing header. If point is in the document preamble, Org signals an error and aborts export. @vindex org-export-initial-scope To make sub-tree export the default, customize the variable @code{org-export-initial-scope}. @item @kbd{C-v} @kindex C-c C-e C-v Toggle visible-only export. This is useful for exporting only certain parts of an Org document by adjusting the visibility of particular headings. @end table @node Export Settings @section Export Settings @cindex options, for export @cindex Export, settings @cindex @samp{OPTIONS}, keyword Export options can be set: globally with variables; for an individual file by making variables buffer-local with in-buffer settings (see @ref{In-buffer Settings}); by setting individual keywords or specifying them in compact form with the @samp{OPTIONS} keyword; or for a tree by setting properties (see @ref{Properties and Columns}). Options set at a specific level override options set at a more general level. @cindex @samp{SETUPFILE}, keyword In-buffer settings may appear anywhere in the file, either directly or indirectly through a file included using @samp{#+SETUPFILE: filename or URL} syntax. Option keyword sets tailored to a particular back-end can be inserted from the export dispatcher (see @ref{The Export Dispatcher}) using the @samp{Insert template} command by pressing @kbd{#}. To insert keywords individually, a good way to make sure the keyword is correct is to type @samp{#+} and then to use @kbd{M-@key{TAB}}@footnote{Many desktops intercept @kbd{M-@key{TAB}} to switch windows. Use @kbd{C-M-i} or @kbd{@key{ESC} @key{TAB}} instead.} for completion. The export keywords available for every back-end, and their equivalent global variables, include: @table @asis @item @samp{AUTHOR} @cindex @samp{AUTHOR}, keyword @vindex user-full-name The document author (@code{user-full-name}). @item @samp{CREATOR} @cindex @samp{CREATOR}, keyword @vindex org-expot-creator-string Entity responsible for output generation (@code{org-export-creator-string}). @item @samp{DATE} @cindex @samp{DATE}, keyword @vindex org-export-date-timestamp-format A date or a time-stamp@footnote{The variable @code{org-export-date-timestamp-format} defines how this timestamp are exported.}. @item @samp{EMAIL} @cindex @samp{EMAIL}, keyword @vindex user-mail-address The email address (@code{user-mail-address}). @item @samp{LANGUAGE} @cindex @samp{LANGUAGE}, keyword @vindex org-export-default-language Language to use for translating certain strings (@code{org-export-default-language}). With @samp{#+LANGUAGE: fr}, for example, Org translates @samp{Table of contents} to the French @samp{Table des matières}@footnote{DEFINITION NOT FOUND@.}. @item @samp{SELECT_TAGS} @cindex @samp{SELECT_TAGS}, keyword @vindex org-export-select-tags The default value is @samp{("export")}. When a tree is tagged with @samp{export} (@code{org-export-select-tags}), Org selects that tree and its sub-trees for export. Org excludes trees with @samp{noexport} tags, see below. When selectively exporting files with @samp{export} tags set, Org does not export any text that appears before the first headline. @item @samp{EXCLUDE_TAGS} @cindex @samp{EXCLUDE_TAGS}, keyword @vindex org-export-exclude-tags The default value is @samp{("noexport")}. When a tree is tagged with @samp{noexport} (@code{org-export-exclude-tags}), Org excludes that tree and its sub-trees from export. Entries tagged with @samp{noexport} are unconditionally excluded from the export, even if they have an @samp{export} tag. Even if a sub-tree is not exported, Org executes any code blocks contained there. @item @samp{TITLE} @cindex @samp{TITLE}, keyword @cindex document title Org displays this title. For long titles, use multiple @samp{#+TITLE} lines. @item @samp{EXPORT_FILE_NAME} @cindex @samp{EXPORT_FILE_NAME}, keyword The name of the output file to be generated. Otherwise, Org generates the file name based on the buffer name and the extension based on the back-end format. @end table The @samp{OPTIONS} keyword is a compact form. To configure multiple options, use several @samp{OPTIONS} lines. @samp{OPTIONS} recognizes the following arguments. @table @asis @item @code{'} @vindex org-export-with-smart-quotes Toggle smart quotes (@code{org-export-with-smart-quotes}). Depending on the language used, when activated, Org treats pairs of double quotes as primary quotes, pairs of single quotes as secondary quotes, and single quote marks as apostrophes. @item @code{*} @vindex org-export-with-emphasize Toggle emphasized text (@code{org-export-with-emphasize}). @item @code{-} @vindex org-export-with-special-strings Toggle conversion of special strings (@code{org-export-with-special-strings}). @item @code{:} @vindex org-export-with-fixed-width Toggle fixed-width sections (@code{org-export-with-fixed-width}). @item @code{<} @vindex org-export-with-timestamps Toggle inclusion of time/date active/inactive stamps (@code{org-export-with-timestamps}). @item @code{\n} @vindex org-export-preserve-breaks Toggles whether to preserve line breaks (@code{org-export-preserve-breaks}). @item @code{^} @vindex org-export-with-sub-superscripts Toggle @TeX{}-like syntax for sub- and superscripts. If you write @samp{^:@{@}}, @samp{a_@{b@}} is interpreted, but the simple @samp{a_b} is left as it is (@code{org-export-with-sub-superscripts}). @item @code{arch} @vindex org-export-with-archived-trees Configure how archived trees are exported. When set to @code{headline}, the export process skips the contents and processes only the headlines (@code{org-export-with-archived-trees}). @item @code{author} @vindex org-export-with-author Toggle inclusion of author name into exported file (@code{org-export-with-author}). @item @code{broken-links} @vindex org-export-with-broken-links Toggles if Org should continue exporting upon finding a broken internal link. When set to @code{mark}, Org clearly marks the problem link in the output (@code{org-export-with-broken-links}). @item @code{c} @vindex org-export-with-clocks Toggle inclusion of @samp{CLOCK} keywords (@code{org-export-with-clocks}). @item @code{creator} @vindex org-export-with-creator Toggle inclusion of creator information in the exported file (@code{org-export-with-creator}). @item @code{d} @vindex org-export-with-drawers Toggles inclusion of drawers, or list of drawers to include, or list of drawers to exclude (@code{org-export-with-drawers}). @item @code{date} @vindex org-export-with-date Toggle inclusion of a date into exported file (@code{org-export-with-date}). @item @code{e} @vindex org-export-with-entities Toggle inclusion of entities (@code{org-export-with-entities}). @item @code{email} @vindex org-export-with-email Toggle inclusion of the author's e-mail into exported file (@code{org-export-with-email}). @item @code{f} @vindex org-export-with-footnotes Toggle the inclusion of footnotes (@code{org-export-with-footnotes}). @item @code{H} @vindex org-export-headline-levels Set the number of headline levels for export (@code{org-export-headline-levels}). Below that level, headlines are treated differently. In most back-ends, they become list items. @item @code{inline} @vindex org-export-with-inlinetasks Toggle inclusion of inlinetasks (@code{org-export-with-inlinetasks}). @item @code{num} @vindex org-export-with-section-numbers @cindex @samp{UNNUMBERED}, property Toggle section-numbers (@code{org-export-with-section-numbers}). When set to number N, Org numbers only those headlines at level N or above. Set @samp{UNNUMBERED} property to non-@code{nil} to disable numbering of heading and subheadings entirely. Moreover, when the value is @samp{notoc} the headline, and all its children, do not appear in the table of contents either (see @ref{Table of Contents}). @item @code{p} @vindex org-export-with-planning Toggle export of planning information (@code{org-export-with-planning}). ``Planning information'' comes from lines located right after the headline and contain any combination of these cookies: @samp{SCHEDULED}, @samp{DEADLINE}, or @samp{CLOSED}. @item @code{pri} @vindex org-export-with-priority Toggle inclusion of priority cookies (@code{org-export-with-priority}). @item @code{prop} @vindex org-export-with-properties Toggle inclusion of property drawers, or list the properties to include (@code{org-export-with-properties}). @item @code{stat} @vindex org-export-with-statistics-cookies Toggle inclusion of statistics cookies (@code{org-export-with-statistics-cookies}). @item @code{tags} @vindex org-export-with-tags Toggle inclusion of tags, may also be @code{not-in-toc} (@code{org-export-with-tags}). @item @code{tasks} @vindex org-export-with-tasks Toggle inclusion of tasks (TODO items); or @code{nil} to remove all tasks; or @code{todo} to remove done tasks; or list the keywords to keep (@code{org-export-with-tasks}). @item @code{tex} @vindex org-export-with-latex @code{nil} does not export; @code{t} exports; @code{verbatim} keeps everything in verbatim (@code{org-export-with-latex}). @item @code{timestamp} @vindex org-export-time-stamp-file Toggle inclusion of the creation time in the exported file (@code{org-export-time-stamp-file}). @item @code{title} @vindex org-export-with-title Toggle inclusion of title (@code{org-export-with-title}). @item @code{toc} @vindex org-export-with-toc Toggle inclusion of the table of contents, or set the level limit (@code{org-export-with-toc}). @item @code{todo} @vindex org-export-with-todo-keywords Toggle inclusion of TODO keywords into exported text (@code{org-export-with-todo-keywords}). @item @code{|} @vindex org-export-with-tables Toggle inclusion of tables (@code{org-export-with-tables}). @end table When exporting sub-trees, special node properties can override the above keywords. These properties have an @samp{EXPORT_} prefix. For example, @samp{DATE} becomes, @samp{EXPORT_DATE} when used for a specific sub-tree. Except for @samp{SETUPFILE}, all other keywords listed above have an @samp{EXPORT_} equivalent. @cindex @samp{BIND}, keyword @vindex org-export-allow-bind-keywords If @code{org-export-allow-bind-keywords} is non-@code{nil}, Emacs variables can become buffer-local during export by using the @samp{BIND} keyword. Its syntax is @samp{#+BIND: variable value}. This is particularly useful for in-buffer settings that cannot be changed using keywords. @node Table of Contents @section Table of Contents @cindex table of contents @cindex list of tables @cindex list of listings @cindex @samp{toc}, in @samp{OPTIONS} keyword @vindex org-export-with-toc The table of contents includes all headlines in the document. Its depth is therefore the same as the headline levels in the file. If you need to use a different depth, or turn it off entirely, set the @code{org-export-with-toc} variable accordingly. You can achieve the same on a per file basis, using the following @samp{toc} item in @samp{OPTIONS} keyword: @example #+OPTIONS: toc:2 (only include two levels in TOC) #+OPTIONS: toc:nil (no default TOC at all) @end example @cindex excluding entries from table of contents @cindex table of contents, exclude entries Org includes both numbered and unnumbered headlines in the table of contents@footnote{At the moment, some export back-ends do not obey this specification. For example, @LaTeX{} export excludes every unnumbered headline from the table of contents.}. If you need to exclude an unnumbered headline, along with all its children, set the @samp{UNNUMBERED} property to @samp{notoc} value. @example * Subtree not numbered, not in table of contents either :PROPERTIES: :UNNUMBERED: notoc :END: @end example @cindex @samp{TOC}, keyword Org normally inserts the table of contents directly before the first headline of the file. To move the table of contents to a different location, first turn off the default with @code{org-export-with-toc} variable or with @samp{#+OPTIONS: toc:nil}. Then insert @samp{#+TOC: headlines N} at the desired location(s). @example #+OPTIONS: toc:nil ... #+TOC: headlines 2 @end example To adjust the table of contents depth for a specific section of the Org document, append an additional @samp{local} parameter. This parameter becomes a relative depth for the current level. The following example inserts a local table of contents, with direct children only. @example * Section #+TOC: headlines 1 local @end example Note that for this feature to work properly in @LaTeX{} export, the Org file requires the inclusion of the titletoc package. Because of compatibility issues, titletoc has to be loaded @emph{before} hyperref. Customize the @code{org-latex-default-packages-alist} variable. The following example inserts a table of contents that links to the children of the specified target. @example * Target :PROPERTIES: :CUSTOM_ID: TargetSection :END: ** Heading A ** Heading B * Another section #+TOC: headlines 1 :target #TargetSection @end example The @samp{:target} attribute is supported in HTML, Markdown, ODT, and ASCII export. Use the @samp{TOC} keyword to generate list of tables---respectively, all listings---with captions. @example #+TOC: listings #+TOC: tables @end example @cindex @samp{ALT_TITLE}, property Normally Org uses the headline for its entry in the table of contents. But with @samp{ALT_TITLE} property, a different entry can be specified for the table of contents. @node Include Files @section Include Files @cindex include files, during export @cindex export, include files @cindex @samp{INCLUDE}, keyword During export, you can include the content of another file. For example, to include your @samp{.emacs} file, you could use: @example #+INCLUDE: "~/.emacs" src emacs-lisp @end example @noindent The first parameter is the file name to include. The optional second parameter specifies the block type: @samp{example}, @samp{export} or @samp{src}. The optional third parameter specifies the source code language to use for formatting the contents. This is relevant to both @samp{export} and @samp{src} block types. If an included file is specified as having a markup language, Org neither checks for valid syntax nor changes the contents in any way. For example and source blocks, Org code-escapes the contents before inclusion. @cindex @samp{minlevel}, include If an included file is not specified as having any markup language, Org assumes it be in Org format and proceeds as usual with a few exceptions. Org makes the footnote labels (see @ref{Creating Footnotes}) in the included file local to that file. The contents of the included file belong to the same structure---headline, item---containing the @samp{INCLUDE} keyword. In particular, headlines within the file become children of the current section. That behavior can be changed by providing an additional keyword parameter, @samp{:minlevel}. It shifts the headlines in the included file to become the lowest level. For example, this syntax makes the included file a sibling of the current top-level headline: @example #+INCLUDE: "~/my-book/chapter2.org" :minlevel 1 @end example @cindex @samp{lines}, include Inclusion of only portions of files are specified using ranges parameter with @samp{:lines} keyword. The line at the upper end of the range will not be included. The start and/or the end of the range may be omitted to use the obvious defaults. @multitable {aaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaa} {aaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaa} @item @samp{#+INCLUDE: "~/.emacs" :lines "5-10"} @tab Include lines 5 to 10, 10 excluded @item @samp{#+INCLUDE: "~/.emacs" :lines "-10"} @tab Include lines 1 to 10, 10 excluded @item @samp{#+INCLUDE: "~/.emacs" :lines "10-"} @tab Include lines from 10 to EOF @end multitable Inclusions may specify a file-link to extract an object matched by @code{org-link-search}@footnote{Note that @code{org-link-search-must-match-exact-headline} is locally bound to non-@code{nil}. Therefore, @code{org-link-search} only matches headlines and named elements.} (see @ref{Search Options}). The ranges for @samp{:lines} keyword are relative to the requested element. Therefore, @example #+INCLUDE: "./paper.org::*conclusion" :lines 1-20 @end example @noindent includes the first 20 lines of the headline named @samp{conclusion}. @cindex @samp{only-contents}, include To extract only the contents of the matched object, set @samp{:only-contents} property to non-@code{nil}. This omits any planning lines or property drawers. For example, to include the body of the heading with the custom ID @samp{theory}, you can use @example #+INCLUDE: "./paper.org::#theory" :only-contents t @end example The following command allows navigating to the included document: @table @asis @item @kbd{C-c '} (@code{org-edit~special}) @kindex C-c ' @findex org-edit-special Visit the included file at point. @end table @node Macro Replacement @section Macro Replacement @cindex macro replacement, during export @cindex @samp{MACRO}, keyword @vindex org-export-global-macros Macros replace text snippets during export. Macros are defined globally in @code{org-export-global-macros}, or document-wise with the following syntax: @example #+MACRO: name replacement text; $1, $2 are arguments @end example @noindent which can be referenced using @samp{@{@{@{name(arg1, arg2)@}@}@}}@footnote{Since commas separate the arguments, commas within arguments have to be escaped with the backslash character. So only those backslash characters before a comma need escaping with another backslash character.}. For example @example #+MACRO: poem Rose is $1, violet's $2. Life's ordered: Org assists you. @{@{@{poem(red,blue)@}@}@} @end example @noindent becomes @example Rose is red, violet's blue. Life's ordered: Org assists you. @end example As a special case, Org parses any replacement text starting with @samp{(eval} as an Emacs Lisp expression and evaluates it accordingly. Within such templates, arguments become strings. Thus, the following macro @example #+MACRO: gnustamp (eval (concat "GNU/" (capitalize $1))) @end example @noindent turns @samp{@{@{@{gnustamp(linux)@}@}@}} into @samp{GNU/Linux} during export. Org recognizes macro references in following Org markup areas: paragraphs, headlines, verse blocks, tables cells and lists. Org also recognizes macro references in keywords, such as @samp{CAPTION}, @samp{TITLE}, @samp{AUTHOR}, @samp{DATE}, and for some back-end specific export options. Org comes with following pre-defined macros: @table @asis @item @samp{@{@{@{keyword(NAME)@}@}@}} @itemx @samp{@{@{@{title@}@}@}} @itemx @samp{@{@{@{author@}@}@}} @itemx @samp{@{@{@{email@}@}@}} @cindex @samp{keyword}, macro @cindex @samp{title}, macro @cindex @samp{author}, macro @cindex @samp{email}, macro The @samp{keyword} macro collects all values from @var{NAME} keywords throughout the buffer, separated with white space. @samp{title}, @samp{author} and @samp{email} macros are shortcuts for, respectively, @samp{@{@{@{keyword(TITLE)@}@}@}}, @samp{@{@{@{keyword(AUTHOR)@}@}@}} and @samp{@{@{@{keyword(EMAIL)@}@}@}}. @item @samp{@{@{@{date@}@}@}} @itemx @samp{@{@{@{date(FORMAT)@}@}@}} @cindex @samp{date}, macro This macro refers to the @samp{DATE} keyword. @var{FORMAT} is an optional argument to the @samp{date} macro that is used only if @samp{DATE} is a single timestamp. @var{FORMAT} should be a format string understood by @code{format-time-string}. @item @samp{@{@{@{time(FORMAT)@}@}@}} @itemx @samp{@{@{@{modification-time(FORMAT, VC)@}@}@}} @cindex @samp{time}, macro @cindex @samp{modification-time}, macro These macros refer to the document's date and time of export and date and time of modification. @var{FORMAT} is a string understood by @code{format-time-string}. If the second argument to the @code{modification-time} macro is non-@code{nil}, Org uses @samp{vc.el} to retrieve the document's modification time from the version control system. Otherwise Org reads the file attributes. @item @samp{@{@{@{input-file@}@}@}} @cindex @samp{input-file}, macro This macro refers to the filename of the exported file. @item @samp{@{@{@{property(PROPERTY-NAME)@}@}@}} @itemx @samp{@{@{@{property(PROPERTY-NAME, SEARCH OPTION)@}@}@}} @cindex @samp{property}, macro This macro returns the value of property @var{PROPERTY-NAME} in the current entry. If @var{SEARCH-OPTION} (see @ref{Search Options}) refers to a remote entry, use it instead. @item @samp{@{@{@{n@}@}@}} @itemx @samp{@{@{@{n(NAME)@}@}@}} @itemx @samp{@{@{@{n(NAME, ACTION)@}@}@}} @cindex @samp{n}, macro @cindex counter, macro This macro implements custom counters by returning the number of times the macro has been expanded so far while exporting the buffer. You can create more than one counter using different @var{NAME} values. If @var{ACTION} is @samp{-}, previous value of the counter is held, i.e., the specified counter is not incremented. If the value is a number, the specified counter is set to that value. If it is any other non-empty string, the specified counter is reset to 1. You may leave @var{NAME} empty to reset the default counter. @end table @cindex @samp{results}, macro Moreover, inline source blocks (see @ref{Structure of Code Blocks}) use the special @samp{results} macro to mark their output. As such, you are advised against re-defining it, unless you know what you are doing. @vindex org-hide-macro-markers The surrounding brackets can be made invisible by setting @code{org-hide-macro-markers} to a non-@code{nil} value. Org expands macros at the very beginning of the export process. @node Comment Lines @section Comment Lines @cindex exporting, not @cindex comment lines Lines starting with zero or more whitespace characters followed by one @samp{#} and a whitespace are treated as comments and, as such, are not exported. @cindex @samp{BEGIN_COMMENT} @cindex comment block Likewise, regions surrounded by @samp{#+BEGIN_COMMENT} @dots{} @samp{#+END_COMMENT} are not exported. @cindex comment trees Finally, a @samp{COMMENT} keyword at the beginning of an entry, but after any other keyword or priority cookie, comments out the entire subtree. In this case, the subtree is not exported and no code block within it is executed either@footnote{For a less drastic behavior, consider using a select tag (see @ref{Export Settings}) instead.}. The command below helps changing the comment status of a headline. @table @asis @item @kbd{C-c ;} (@code{org-toggle-comment}) @kindex C-c ; @findex org-toggle-comment Toggle the @samp{COMMENT} keyword at the beginning of an entry. @end table @node ASCII/Latin-1/UTF-8 export @section ASCII/Latin-1/UTF-8 export @cindex ASCII export @cindex Latin-1 export @cindex UTF-8 export ASCII export produces an output file containing only plain ASCII characters. This is the simplest and most direct text output. It does not contain any Org markup. Latin-1 and UTF-8 export use additional characters and symbols available in these encoding standards. All three of these export formats offer the most basic of text output for maximum portability. @vindex org-ascii-text-width On export, Org fills and justifies text according to the text width set in @code{org-ascii-text-width}. @vindex org-ascii-links-to-notes Org exports links using a footnote-like style where the descriptive part is in the text and the link is in a note before the next heading. See the variable @code{org-ascii-links-to-notes} for details. @anchor{ASCII export commands} @subheading ASCII export commands @table @asis @item @kbd{C-c C-e t a} (@code{org-ascii-export-to-ascii}) @itemx @kbd{C-c C-e t l} @itemx @kbd{C-c C-e t u} @kindex C-c C-e t a @kindex C-c C-e t l @kindex C-c C-e t u @findex org-ascii-export-to-ascii Export as an ASCII file with a @samp{.txt} extension. For @samp{myfile.org}, Org exports to @samp{myfile.txt}, overwriting without warning. For @samp{myfile.txt}, Org exports to @samp{myfile.txt.txt} in order to prevent data loss. @item @kbd{C-c C-e t A} (@code{org-ascii-export-to-ascii}) @itemx @kbd{C-c C-e t L} @itemx @kbd{C-c C-e t U} @kindex C-c C-e t A @kindex C-c C-e t L @kindex C-c C-e t U @findex org-ascii-export-as-ascii Export to a temporary buffer. Does not create a file. @end table @anchor{ASCII specific export settings} @subheading ASCII specific export settings The ASCII export back-end has one extra keyword for customizing ASCII output. Setting this keyword works similar to the general options (see @ref{Export Settings}). @table @asis @item @samp{SUBTITLE} @cindex @samp{SUBTITLE}, keyword The document subtitle. For long subtitles, use multiple @samp{#+SUBTITLE} lines in the Org file. Org prints them on one continuous line, wrapping into multiple lines if necessary. @end table @anchor{Header and sectioning structure} @subheading Header and sectioning structure Org converts the first three outline levels into headlines for ASCII export. The remaining levels are turned into lists. To change this cut-off point where levels become lists, see @ref{Export Settings}. @anchor{Quoting ASCII text} @subheading Quoting ASCII text To insert text within the Org file by the ASCII back-end, use one the following constructs, inline, keyword, or export block: @cindex @samp{ASCII}, keyword @cindex @samp{BEGIN_EXPORT ascii} @example Inline text @@@@ascii:and additional text@@@@ within a paragraph. #+ASCII: Some text #+BEGIN_EXPORT ascii Org exports text in this block only when using ASCII back-end. #+END_EXPORT @end example @anchor{ASCII specific attributes} @subheading ASCII specific attributes @cindex @samp{ATTR_ASCII}, keyword @cindex horizontal rules, in ASCII export ASCII back-end recognizes only one attribute, @samp{:width}, which specifies the width of a horizontal rule in number of characters. The keyword and syntax for specifying widths is: @example #+ATTR_ASCII: :width 10 ----- @end example @anchor{ASCII special blocks} @subheading ASCII special blocks @cindex special blocks, in ASCII export @cindex @samp{BEGIN_JUSTIFYLEFT} @cindex @samp{BEGIN_JUSTIFYRIGHT} Besides @samp{#+BEGIN_CENTER} blocks (see @ref{Paragraphs}), ASCII back-end has these two left and right justification blocks: @example #+BEGIN_JUSTIFYLEFT It's just a jump to the left... #+END_JUSTIFYLEFT #+BEGIN_JUSTIFYRIGHT ...and then a step to the right. #+END_JUSTIFYRIGHT @end example @node Beamer Export @section Beamer Export @cindex Beamer export Org uses Beamer export to convert an Org file tree structure into high-quality interactive slides for presentations. Beamer is a @LaTeX{} document class for creating presentations in PDF, HTML, and other popular display formats. @menu * Beamer export commands:: For creating Beamer documents. * Beamer specific export settings:: For customizing Beamer export. * Frames and Blocks in Beamer:: For composing Beamer slides. * Beamer specific syntax:: For using in Org documents. * Editing support:: Editing support. * A Beamer example:: A complete presentation. @end menu @node Beamer export commands @subsection Beamer export commands @table @asis @item @kbd{C-c C-e l b} (@code{org-beamer-export-to-latex}) @kindex C-c C-e l b @findex org-beamer-export-to-latex Export as @LaTeX{} file with a @samp{.tex} extension. For @samp{myfile.org}, Org exports to @samp{myfile.tex}, overwriting without warning. @item @kbd{C-c C-e l B} (@code{org-beamer-export-as-latex}) @kindex C-c C-e l B @findex org-beamer-export-as-latex Export to a temporary buffer. Does not create a file. @item @kbd{C-c C-e l P} (@code{org-beamer-export-to-pdf}) @kindex C-c C-e l P @findex org-beamer-export-to-pdf Export as @LaTeX{} file and then convert it to PDF format. @item @kbd{C-c C-e l O} @kindex C-c C-e l O Export as @LaTeX{} file, convert it to PDF format, and then open the PDF file. @end table @node Beamer specific export settings @subsection Beamer specific export settings Beamer export back-end has several additional keywords for customizing Beamer output. These keywords work similar to the general options settings (see @ref{Export Settings}). @table @asis @item @samp{BEAMER_THEME} @cindex @samp{BEAMER_THEME}, keyword @vindex org-beamer-theme The Beamer layout theme (@code{org-beamer-theme}). Use square brackets for options. For example: @example #+BEAMER_THEME: Rochester [height=20pt] @end example @item @samp{BEAMER_FONT_THEME} @cindex @samp{BEAMER_FONT_THEME}, keyword The Beamer font theme. @item @samp{BEAMER_INNER_THEME} @cindex @samp{BEAMER_INNER_THEME}, keyword The Beamer inner theme. @item @samp{BEAMER_OUTER_THEME} @cindex @samp{BEAMER_OUTER_THEME}, keyword The Beamer outer theme. @item @samp{BEAMER_HEADER} @cindex @samp{BEAMER_HEADER}, keyword Arbitrary lines inserted in the preamble, just before the @samp{hyperref} settings. @item @samp{DESCRIPTION} @cindex @samp{DESCRIPTION}, keyword The document description. For long descriptions, use multiple @samp{DESCRIPTION} keywords. By default, @samp{hyperref} inserts @samp{DESCRIPTION} as metadata. Use @code{org-latex-hyperref-template} to configure document metadata. Use @code{org-latex-title-command} to configure typesetting of description as part of front matter. @item @samp{KEYWORDS} @cindex @samp{KEYWORDS}, keyword The keywords for defining the contents of the document. Use multiple @samp{KEYWORDS} lines if necessary. By default, @samp{hyperref} inserts @samp{KEYWORDS} as metadata. Use @code{org-latex-hyperref-template} to configure document metadata. Use @code{org-latex-title-command} to configure typesetting of keywords as part of front matter. @item @samp{SUBTITLE} @cindex @samp{SUBTITLE}, keyword Document's subtitle. For typesetting, use @code{org-beamer-subtitle-format} string. Use @code{org-latex-hyperref-template} to configure document metadata. Use @code{org-latex-title-command} to configure typesetting of subtitle as part of front matter. @end table @node Frames and Blocks in Beamer @subsection Frames and Blocks in Beamer Org transforms heading levels into Beamer's sectioning elements, frames and blocks. Any Org tree with a not-too-deep-level nesting should in principle be exportable as a Beamer presentation. @itemize @item @vindex org-beamer-frame-level Org headlines become Beamer frames when the heading level in Org is equal to @code{org-beamer-frame-level} or @samp{H} value in a @samp{OPTIONS} line (see @ref{Export Settings}). @cindex @samp{BEAMER_ENV}, property Org overrides headlines to frames conversion for the current tree of an Org file if it encounters the @samp{BEAMER_ENV} property set to @samp{frame} or @samp{fullframe}. Org ignores whatever @code{org-beamer-frame-level} happens to be for that headline level in the Org tree. In Beamer terminology, a full frame is a frame without its title. @item Org exports a Beamer frame's objects as block environments. Org can enforce wrapping in special block types when @samp{BEAMER_ENV} property is set@footnote{If @samp{BEAMER_ENV} is set, Org export adds @samp{B_environment} tag to make it visible. The tag serves as a visual aid and has no semantic relevance.}. For valid values see @code{org-beamer-environments-default}. To add more values, see @code{org-beamer-environments-extra}. @vindex org-beamer-environments-default @vindex org-beamer-environments-extra @item @cindex @samp{BEAMER_REF}, property If @samp{BEAMER_ENV} is set to @samp{appendix}, Org exports the entry as an appendix. When set to @samp{note}, Org exports the entry as a note within the frame or between frames, depending on the entry's heading level. When set to @samp{noteNH}, Org exports the entry as a note without its title. When set to @samp{againframe}, Org exports the entry with @samp{\againframe} command, which makes setting the @samp{BEAMER_REF} property mandatory because @samp{\againframe} needs frame to resume. When @samp{ignoreheading} is set, Org export ignores the entry's headline but not its content. This is useful for inserting content between frames. It is also useful for properly closing a @samp{column} environment. @@end itemize @cindex @samp{BEAMER_ACT}, property @cindex @samp{BEAMER_OPT}, property When @samp{BEAMER_ACT} is set for a headline, Org export translates that headline as an overlay or action specification. When enclosed in square brackets, Org export makes the overlay specification a default. Use @samp{BEAMER_OPT} to set any options applicable to the current Beamer frame or block. The Beamer export back-end wraps with appropriate angular or square brackets. It also adds the @samp{fragile} option for any code that may require a verbatim block. @cindex @samp{BEAMER_COL}, property To create a column on the Beamer slide, use the @samp{BEAMER_COL} property for its headline in the Org file. Set the value of @samp{BEAMER_COL} to a decimal number representing the fraction of the total text width. Beamer export uses this value to set the column's width and fills the column with the contents of the Org entry. If the Org entry has no specific environment defined, Beamer export ignores the heading. If the Org entry has a defined environment, Beamer export uses the heading as title. Behind the scenes, Beamer export automatically handles @LaTeX{} column separations for contiguous headlines. To manually adjust them for any unique configurations needs, use the @samp{BEAMER_ENV} property. @end itemize @node Beamer specific syntax @subsection Beamer specific syntax Since Org's Beamer export back-end is an extension of the @LaTeX{} back-end, it recognizes other @LaTeX{} specific syntax---for example, @samp{#+LATEX:} or @samp{#+ATTR_LATEX:}. See @ref{@LaTeX{} Export}, for details. Beamer export wraps the table of contents generated with @samp{toc:t} @samp{OPTION} keyword in a @samp{frame} environment. Beamer export does not wrap the table of contents generated with @samp{TOC} keyword (see @ref{Table of Contents}). Use square brackets for specifying options. @example #+TOC: headlines [currentsection] @end example Insert Beamer-specific code using the following constructs: @cindex @samp{BEAMER}, keyword @cindex @samp{BEGIN_EXPORT beamer} @example #+BEAMER: \pause #+BEGIN_EXPORT beamer Only Beamer export back-end exports this. #+END_BEAMER Text @@@@beamer:some code@@@@ within a paragraph. @end example Inline constructs, such as the last one above, are useful for adding overlay specifications to objects with @code{bold}, @code{item}, @code{link}, @code{radio-target} and @code{target} types. Enclose the value in angular brackets and place the specification at the beginning of the object as shown in this example: @example A *@@@@beamer:<2->@@@@useful* feature @end example @cindex @samp{ATTR_BEAMER}, keyword Beamer export recognizes the @samp{ATTR_BEAMER} keyword with the following attributes from Beamer configurations: @samp{:environment} for changing local Beamer environment, @samp{:overlay} for specifying Beamer overlays in angular or square brackets, and @samp{:options} for inserting optional arguments. @example #+ATTR_BEAMER: :environment nonindentlist - item 1, not indented - item 2, not indented - item 3, not indented @end example @example #+ATTR_BEAMER: :overlay <+-> - item 1 - item 2 @end example @example #+ATTR_BEAMER: :options [Lagrange] Let $G$ be a finite group, and let $H$ be a subgroup of $G$. Then the order of $H$ divides the order of $G$. @end example @node Editing support @subsection Editing support Org Beamer mode is a special minor mode for faster editing of Beamer documents. @example #+STARTUP: beamer @end example @table @asis @item @kbd{C-c C-b} (@code{org-beamer-select-environment}) @kindex C-c C-b @findex org-beamer-select-environment Org Beamer mode provides this key for quicker selections in Beamer normal environments, and for selecting the @samp{BEAMER_COL} property. @end table @node A Beamer example @subsection A Beamer example Here is an example of an Org document ready for Beamer export. @example #+TITLE: Example Presentation #+AUTHOR: Carsten Dominik #+OPTIONS: H:2 toc:t num:t #+LATEX_CLASS: beamer #+LATEX_CLASS_OPTIONS: [presentation] #+BEAMER_THEME: Madrid #+COLUMNS: %45ITEM %10BEAMER_ENV(Env) %10BEAMER_ACT(Act) %4BEAMER_COL(Col) * This is the first structural section ** Frame 1 *** Thanks to Eric Fraga :B_block: :PROPERTIES: :BEAMER_COL: 0.48 :BEAMER_ENV: block :END: for the first viable Beamer setup in Org *** Thanks to everyone else :B_block: :PROPERTIES: :BEAMER_COL: 0.48 :BEAMER_ACT: <2-> :BEAMER_ENV: block :END: for contributing to the discussion **** This will be formatted as a beamer note :B_note: :PROPERTIES: :BEAMER_env: note :END: ** Frame 2 (where we will not use columns) *** Request Please test this stuff! @end example @node HTML Export @section HTML Export @cindex HTML export Org mode contains an HTML exporter with extensive HTML formatting compatible with XHTML 1.0 strict standard. @menu * HTML export commands:: Invoking HTML export. * HTML specific export settings:: Settings for HTML export. * HTML doctypes:: Exporting various (X)HTML flavors. * HTML preamble and postamble:: Inserting preamble and postamble. * Quoting HTML tags:: Using direct HTML in Org files. * Headlines in HTML export:: Formatting headlines. * Links in HTML export:: Inserting and formatting links. * Tables in HTML export:: How to modify the formatting of tables. * Images in HTML export:: How to insert figures into HTML output. * Math formatting in HTML export:: Beautiful math also on the web. * Text areas in HTML export:: An alternate way to show an example. * CSS support:: Changing the appearance of the output. * JavaScript support:: Info and folding in a web browser. @end menu @node HTML export commands @subsection HTML export commands @table @asis @item @kbd{C-c C-e h h} (@code{org-html-export-to-html}) @kindex C-c C-e h h @kindex C-c C-e h o @findex org-html-export-to-html Export as HTML file with a @samp{.html} extension. For @samp{myfile.org}, Org exports to @samp{myfile.html}, overwriting without warning. @{@{@{kbd@{C-c C-e h o)@}@}@} exports to HTML and opens it in a web browser. @item @kbd{C-c C-e h H} (@code{org-html-export-as-html}) @kindex C-c C-e h H @findex org-html-export-as-html Exports to a temporary buffer. Does not create a file. @end table @node HTML specific export settings @subsection HTML specific export settings HTML export has a number of keywords, similar to the general options settings described in @ref{Export Settings}. @table @asis @item @samp{DESCRIPTION} @cindex @samp{DESCRIPTION}, keyword This is the document's description, which the HTML exporter inserts it as a HTML meta tag in the HTML file. For long descriptions, use multiple @samp{DESCRIPTION} lines. The exporter takes care of wrapping the lines properly. @item @samp{HTML_DOCTYPE} @cindex @samp{HTML_DOCTYPE}, keyword @vindex org-html-doctype Specify the document type, for example: HTML5 (@code{org-html-doctype}). @item @samp{HTML_CONTAINER} @cindex @samp{HTML_CONTAINER}, keyword @vindex org-html-container-element Specify the HTML container, such as @samp{div}, for wrapping sections and elements (@code{org-html-container-element}). @item @samp{HTML_LINK_HOME} @cindex @samp{HTML_LINK_HOME}, keyword @vindex org-html-link-home The URL for home link (@code{org-html-link-home}). @item @samp{HTML_LINK_UP} @cindex @samp{HTML_LINK_UP}, keyword @vindex org-html-link-up The URL for the up link of exported HTML pages (@code{org-html-link-up}). @item @samp{HTML_MATHJAX} @cindex @samp{HTML_MATHJAX}, keyword @vindex org-html-mathjax-options Options for MathJax (@code{org-html-mathjax-options}). MathJax is used to typeset @LaTeX{} math in HTML documents. See @ref{Math formatting in HTML export}, for an example. @item @samp{HTML_HEAD} @cindex @samp{HTML_HEAD}, keyword @vindex org-html-head Arbitrary lines for appending to the HTML document's head (@code{org-html-head}). @item @samp{HTML_HEAD_EXTRA} @cindex @samp{HTML_HEAD_EXTRA}, keyword @vindex org-html-head-extra More arbitrary lines for appending to the HTML document's head (@code{org-html-head-extra}). @item @samp{KEYWORDS} @cindex @samp{KEYWORDS}, keyword Keywords to describe the document's content. HTML exporter inserts these keywords as HTML meta tags. For long keywords, use multiple @samp{KEYWORDS} lines. @item @samp{LATEX_HEADER} @cindex @samp{LATEX_HEADER}, keyword Arbitrary lines for appending to the preamble; HTML exporter appends when transcoding @LaTeX{} fragments to images (see @ref{Math formatting in HTML export}). @item @samp{SUBTITLE} @cindex @samp{SUBTITLE}, keyword The document's subtitle. HTML exporter formats subtitle if document type is @samp{HTML5} and the CSS has a @samp{subtitle} class. @end table Some of these keywords are explained in more detail in the following sections of the manual. @node HTML doctypes @subsection HTML doctypes Org can export to various (X)HTML flavors. @vindex org-html-doctype @vindex org-html-doctype-alist Set the @code{org-html-doctype} variable for different (X)HTML variants. Depending on the variant, the HTML exporter adjusts the syntax of HTML conversion accordingly. Org includes the following ready-made variants: @itemize @item @code{"html4-strict"} @item @code{"html4-transitional"} @item @code{"html4-frameset"} @item @code{"xhtml-strict"} @item @code{"xhtml-transitional"} @item @code{"xhtml-frameset"} @item @code{"xhtml-11"} @item @code{"html5"} @item @code{"xhtml5"} @end itemize @noindent See the variable @code{org-html-doctype-alist} for details. The default is @code{"xhtml-strict"}. @vindex org-html-html5-fancy @cindex @samp{HTML5}, export new elements Org's HTML exporter does not by default enable new block elements introduced with the HTML5 standard. To enable them, set @code{org-html-html5-fancy} to non-@code{nil}. Or use an @samp{OPTIONS} line in the file to set @samp{html5-fancy}. HTML5 documents can now have arbitrary @samp{#+BEGIN} @dots{} @samp{#+END} blocks. For example: @example #+BEGIN_aside Lorem ipsum #+END_aside @end example @noindent exports to: @example @end example @noindent while this: @example #+ATTR_HTML: :controls controls :width 350 #+BEGIN_video #+HTML: #+HTML: Your browser does not support the video tag. #+END_video @end example @noindent exports to: @example @end example @vindex org-html-html5-elements When special blocks do not have a corresponding HTML5 element, the HTML exporter reverts to standard translation (see @code{org-html-html5-elements}). For example, @samp{#+BEGIN_lederhosen} exports to @code{
}. Special blocks cannot have headlines. For the HTML exporter to wrap the headline and its contents in @code{
} or @code{
} tags, set the @samp{HTML_CONTAINER} property for the headline. @node HTML preamble and postamble @subsection HTML preamble and postamble @vindex org-html-preamble @vindex org-html-postamble @vindex org-html-preamble-format @vindex org-html-postamble-format @vindex org-html-validation-link @vindex org-export-creator-string @vindex org-export-time-stamp-file The HTML exporter has delineations for preamble and postamble. The default value for @code{org-html-preamble} is @code{t}, which makes the HTML exporter insert the preamble. See the variable @code{org-html-preamble-format} for the format string. Set @code{org-html-preamble} to a string to override the default format string. If the string is a function, the HTML exporter expects the function to return a string upon execution. The HTML exporter inserts this string in the preamble. The HTML exporter does not insert a preamble if @code{org-html-preamble} is set @code{nil}. The default value for @code{org-html-postamble} is @code{auto}, which makes the HTML exporter build a postamble from looking up author's name, email address, creator's name, and date. Set @code{org-html-postamble} to @code{t} to insert the postamble in the format specified in the @code{org-html-postamble-format} variable. The HTML exporter does not insert a postamble if @code{org-html-postamble} is set to @code{nil}. @node Quoting HTML tags @subsection Quoting HTML tags The HTML export back-end transforms @samp{<} and @samp{>} to @samp{<} and @samp{>}. To include raw HTML code in the Org file so the HTML export back-end can insert that HTML code in the output, use this inline syntax: @samp{@@@@html:...@@@@}. For example: @example @@@@html:@@@@bold text@@@@html:@@@@ @end example @cindex @samp{HTML}, keyword @cindex @samp{BEGIN_EXPORT html} For larger raw HTML code blocks, use these HTML export code blocks: @example #+HTML: Literal HTML code for export #+BEGIN_EXPORT html All lines between these markers are exported literally #+END_EXPORT @end example @node Headlines in HTML export @subsection Headlines in HTML export @cindex headlines, in HTML export Headlines are exported to @samp{

}, @samp{

}, etc. Each headline gets the @samp{id} attribute from @samp{CUSTOM_ID} property, or a unique generated value, see @ref{Internal Links}. @vindex org-html-self-link-headlines When @code{org-html-self-link-headlines} is set to a non-@code{nil} value, the text of the headlines is also wrapped in @samp{} tags. These tags have a @samp{href} attribute making the headlines link to themselves. @node Links in HTML export @subsection Links in HTML export @cindex links, in HTML export @cindex internal links, in HTML export @cindex external links, in HTML export The HTML export back-end transforms Org's internal links (see @ref{Internal Links}) to equivalent HTML links in the output. The back-end similarly handles Org's automatic links created by radio targets (see @ref{Radio Targets}) similarly. For Org links to external files, the back-end transforms the links to @emph{relative} paths. @vindex org-html-link-org-files-as-html For Org links to other @samp{.org} files, the back-end automatically changes the file extension to @samp{.html} and makes file paths relative. If the @samp{.org} files have an equivalent @samp{.html} version at the same location, then the converted links should work without any further manual intervention. However, to disable this automatic path translation, set @code{org-html-link-org-files-as-html} to @code{nil}. When disabled, the HTML export back-end substitutes the ID-based links in the HTML output. For more about linking files when publishing to a directory, see @ref{Publishing links}. Org files can also have special directives to the HTML export back-end. For example, by using @samp{#+ATTR_HTML} lines to specify new format attributes to @code{} or @code{} tags. This example shows changing the link's title and style: @cindex @samp{ATTR_HTML}, keyword @example #+ATTR_HTML: :title The Org mode homepage :style color:red; [[https://orgmode.org]] @end example @node Tables in HTML export @subsection Tables in HTML export @cindex tables, in HTML @vindex org-export-html-table-tag The HTML export back-end uses @code{org-html-table-default-attributes} when exporting Org tables to HTML@. By default, the exporter does not draw frames and cell borders. To change for this for a table, use the following lines before the table in the Org file: @cindex @samp{CAPTION}, keyword @cindex @samp{ATTR_HTML}, keyword @example #+CAPTION: This is a table with lines around and between cells #+ATTR_HTML: :border 2 :rules all :frame border @end example The HTML export back-end preserves column groupings in Org tables (see @ref{Column Groups}) when exporting to HTML@. Additional options for customizing tables for HTML export. @table @asis @item @code{org-html-table-align-individual-fields} @vindex org-html-table-align-individual-fields Non-@code{nil} attaches style attributes for alignment to each table field. @item @code{org-html-table-caption-above} @vindex org-html-table-caption-above Non-@code{nil} places caption string at the beginning of the table. @item @code{org-html-table-data-tags} @vindex org-html-table-data-tags Opening and ending tags for table data fields. @item @code{org-html-table-default-attributes} @vindex org-html-table-default-attributes Default attributes and values for table tags. @item @code{org-html-table-header-tags} @vindex org-html-table-header-tags Opening and ending tags for table's header fields. @item @code{org-html-table-row-tags} @vindex org-html-table-row-tags Opening and ending tags for table rows. @item @code{org-html-table-use-header-tags-for-first-column} @vindex org-html-table-use-header-tags-for-first-column Non-@code{nil} formats column one in tables with header tags. @end table @node Images in HTML export @subsection Images in HTML export @cindex images, inline in HTML @cindex inlining images in HTML The HTML export back-end has features to convert Org image links to HTML inline images and HTML clickable image links. @vindex org-html-inline-images When the link in the Org file has no description, the HTML export back-end by default in-lines that image. For example: @samp{[[file:myimg.jpg]]} is in-lined, while @samp{[[file:myimg.jpg][the image]]} links to the text, @samp{the image}. For more details, see the variable @code{org-html-inline-images}. On the other hand, if the description part of the Org link is itself another link, such as @samp{file:} or @samp{http:} URL pointing to an image, the HTML export back-end in-lines this image and links to the main image. This Org syntax enables the back-end to link low-resolution thumbnail to the high-resolution version of the image, as shown in this example: @example [[file:highres.jpg][file:thumb.jpg]] @end example To change attributes of in-lined images, use @samp{#+ATTR_HTML} lines in the Org file. This example shows realignment to right, and adds @code{alt} and @code{title} attributes in support of text viewers and modern web accessibility standards. @cindex @samp{CAPTION}, keyword @cindex @samp{ATTR_HTML}, keyword @example #+CAPTION: A black cat stalking a spider #+ATTR_HTML: :alt cat/spider image :title Action! :align right [[./img/a.jpg]] @end example The HTML export back-end copies the @samp{http} links from the Org file as-is. @node Math formatting in HTML export @subsection Math formatting in HTML export @cindex MathJax @cindex dvipng @cindex dvisvgm @cindex ImageMagick @vindex org-html-mathjax-options~ @LaTeX{} math snippets (see @ref{@LaTeX{} fragments}) can be displayed in two different ways on HTML pages. The default is to use the @uref{http://www.mathjax.org, MathJax}, which should work out of the box with Org@footnote{By default Org loads MathJax from @uref{https://cdnjs.com, cdnjs.com} as recommended by @uref{http://www.mathjax.org, MathJax}.}@footnote{Please note that exported formulas are part of an HTML document, and that signs such as @samp{<}, @samp{>}, or @samp{&} have special meanings. See @uref{http://docs.mathjax.org/en/latest/tex.html#tex-and-latex-in-html-documents, MathJax @TeX{} and @LaTeX{} support}.}. Some MathJax display options can be configured via @code{org-html-mathjax-options}, or in the buffer. For example, with the following settings, @example #+HTML_MATHJAX: align: left indent: 5em tagside: left font: Neo-Euler #+HTML_MATHJAX: cancel.js noErrors.js @end example @noindent equation labels are displayed on the left margin and equations are five em from the left margin. In addition, it loads the two MathJax extensions @samp{cancel.js} and @samp{noErrors.js}@footnote{See @uref{http://docs.mathjax.org/en/latest/tex.html#tex-extensions, @TeX{} and @LaTeX{} extensions} in the @uref{http://docs.mathjax.org, MathJax manual} to learn about extensions.}. @vindex org-html-mathjax-template See the docstring of @code{org-html-mathjax-options} for all supported variables. The MathJax template can be configure via @code{org-html-mathjax-template}. If you prefer, you can also request that @LaTeX{} fragments are processed into small images that will be inserted into the browser page. Before the availability of MathJax, this was the default method for Org files. This method requires that the dvipng program, dvisvgm or ImageMagick suite is available on your system. You can still get this processing with @example #+OPTIONS: tex:dvipng @end example @example #+OPTIONS: tex:dvisvgm @end example @noindent or @example #+OPTIONS: tex:imagemagick @end example @node Text areas in HTML export @subsection Text areas in HTML export @cindex text areas, in HTML Before Org mode's Babel, one popular approach to publishing code in HTML was by using @samp{:textarea}. The advantage of this approach was that copying and pasting was built into browsers with simple JavaScript commands. Even editing before pasting was made simple. The HTML export back-end can create such text areas. It requires an @samp{#+ATTR_HTML} line as shown in the example below with the @samp{:textarea} option. This must be followed by either an example or a source code block. Other Org block types do not honor the @samp{:textarea} option. By default, the HTML export back-end creates a text area 80 characters wide and height just enough to fit the content. Override these defaults with @samp{:width} and @samp{:height} options on the @samp{#+ATTR_HTML} line. @example #+ATTR_HTML: :textarea t :width 40 #+BEGIN_EXAMPLE (defun org-xor (a b) "Exclusive or." (if a (not b) b)) #+END_EXAMPLE @end example @node CSS support @subsection CSS support @cindex CSS, for HTML export @cindex HTML export, CSS @vindex org-export-html-todo-kwd-class-prefix @vindex org-export-html-tag-class-prefix You can modify the CSS style definitions for the exported file. The HTML exporter assigns the following special CSS classes@footnote{If the classes on TODO keywords and tags lead to conflicts, use the variables @code{org-html-todo-kwd-class-prefix} and @code{org-html-tag-class-prefix} to make them unique.} to appropriate parts of the document---your style specifications may change these, in addition to any of the standard classes like for headlines, tables, etc. @multitable {aaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaa} {aaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaa} @item @code{p.author} @tab author information, including email @item @code{p.date} @tab publishing date @item @code{p.creator} @tab creator info, about org mode version @item @code{.title} @tab document title @item @code{.subtitle} @tab document subtitle @item @code{.todo} @tab TODO keywords, all not-done states @item @code{.done} @tab the DONE keywords, all states that count as done @item @code{.WAITING} @tab each TODO keyword also uses a class named after itself @item @code{.timestamp} @tab timestamp @item @code{.timestamp-kwd} @tab keyword associated with a timestamp, like @samp{SCHEDULED} @item @code{.timestamp-wrapper} @tab span around keyword plus timestamp @item @code{.tag} @tab tag in a headline @item @code{._HOME} @tab each tag uses itself as a class, ``@@'' replaced by ``_'' @item @code{.target} @tab target for links @item @code{.linenr} @tab the line number in a code example @item @code{.code-highlighted} @tab for highlighting referenced code lines @item @code{div.outline-N} @tab div for outline level N (headline plus text) @item @code{div.outline-text-N} @tab extra div for text at outline level N @item @code{.section-number-N} @tab section number in headlines, different for each level @item @code{.figure-number} @tab label like ``Figure 1:'' @item @code{.table-number} @tab label like ``Table 1:'' @item @code{.listing-number} @tab label like ``Listing 1:'' @item @code{div.figure} @tab how to format an in-lined image @item @code{pre.src} @tab formatted source code @item @code{pre.example} @tab normal example @item @code{p.verse} @tab verse paragraph @item @code{div.footnotes} @tab footnote section headline @item @code{p.footnote} @tab footnote definition paragraph, containing a footnote @item @code{.footref} @tab a footnote reference number (always a ) @item @code{.footnum} @tab footnote number in footnote definition (always ) @item @code{.org-svg} @tab default class for a linked @samp{.svg} image @end multitable @vindex org-html-style-default @vindex org-html-head @vindex org-html-head-extra @cindex @samp{HTML_INCLUDE_STYLE}, keyword The HTML export back-end includes a compact default style in each exported HTML file. To override the default style with another style, use these keywords in the Org file. They will replace the global defaults the HTML exporter uses. @cindex @samp{HTML_HEAD}, keyword @cindex @samp{HTML_HEAD_EXTRA}, keyword @example #+HTML_HEAD: #+HTML_HEAD_EXTRA: @end example @vindex org-html-head-include-default-style To just turn off the default style, customize @code{org-html-head-include-default-style} variable, or use this option line in the Org file. @cindex @samp{html-style}, @samp{OPTIONS} item @example #+OPTIONS: html-style:nil @end example For longer style definitions, either use several @samp{HTML_HEAD} and @samp{HTML_HEAD_EXTRA} keywords, or use @code{} blocks around them. Both of these approaches can avoid referring to an external file. @cindex @samp{HTML_CONTAINER_CLASS}, property @cindex @samp{HTML_HEADLINE_CLASS}, property In order to add styles to a sub-tree, use the @samp{HTML_CONTAINER_CLASS} property to assign a class to the tree. In order to specify CSS styles for a particular headline, you can use the ID specified in a @samp{CUSTOM_ID} property. You can also assign a specific class to a headline with the @samp{HTML_HEADLINE_CLASS} property. Never change the @code{org-html-style-default} constant. Instead use other simpler ways of customizing as described above. @node JavaScript support @subsection JavaScript supported display of web pages Sebastian Rose has written a JavaScript program especially designed to allow two different ways of viewing HTML files created with Org. One is an @emph{Info}-like mode where each section is displayed separately and navigation can be done with the @kbd{n} and @kbd{p} keys, and some other keys as well, press @kbd{?} for an overview of the available keys. The second one has a @emph{folding} view, much like Org provides inside Emacs. The script is available at @uref{https://orgmode.org/org-info.js} and the documentation at @uref{https://orgmode.org/worg/code/org-info-js/}. The script is hosted on @uref{https://orgmode.org}, but for reliability, prefer installing it on your own web server. To use this program, just add this line to the Org file: @cindex @samp{INFOJS_OPT}, keyword @example #+INFOJS_OPT: view:info toc:nil @end example @noindent The HTML header now has the code needed to automatically invoke the script. For setting options, use the syntax from the above line for options described below: @table @asis @item @samp{path:} The path to the script. The default is to grab the script from @uref{https://orgmode.org/org-info.js}, but you might want to have a local copy and use a path like @samp{../scripts/org-info.js}. @item @samp{view:} Initial view when the website is first shown. Possible values are: @multitable {aaaaaaaaaa} {aaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaa} @item @samp{info} @tab Info-like interface with one section per page @item @samp{overview} @tab Folding interface, initially showing only top-level @item @samp{content} @tab Folding interface, starting with all headlines visible @item @samp{showall} @tab Folding interface, all headlines and text visible @end multitable @item @samp{sdepth:} Maximum headline level still considered as an independent section for info and folding modes. The default is taken from @code{org-export-headline-levels}, i.e., the @samp{H} switch in @samp{OPTIONS}. If this is smaller than in @code{org-export-headline-levels}, each info/folding section can still contain child headlines. @item @samp{toc:} Should the table of contents @emph{initially} be visible? Even when @samp{nil}, you can always get to the ``toc'' with @kbd{i}. @item @samp{tdepth:} The depth of the table of contents. The defaults are taken from the variables @code{org-export-headline-levels} and @code{org-export-with-toc}. @item @samp{ftoc:} Does the CSS of the page specify a fixed position for the ``toc''? If yes, the toc is displayed as a section. @item @samp{ltoc:} Should there be short contents (children) in each section? Make this @samp{above} if the section should be above initial text. @item @samp{mouse:} Headings are highlighted when the mouse is over them. Should be @samp{underline} (default) or a background color like @samp{#cccccc}. @item @samp{buttons:} Should view-toggle buttons be everywhere? When @samp{nil} (the default), only one such button is present. @end table @vindex org-infojs-options @vindex org-export-html-use-infojs You can choose default values for these options by customizing the variable @code{org-infojs-options}. If you always want to apply the script to your pages, configure the variable @code{org-export-html-use-infojs}. @node @LaTeX{} Export @section @LaTeX{} Export @cindex @LaTeX{} export @cindex PDF export The @LaTeX{} export back-end can handle complex documents, incorporate standard or custom @LaTeX{} document classes, generate documents using alternate @LaTeX{} engines, and produce fully linked PDF files with indexes, bibliographies, and tables of contents, destined for interactive online viewing or high-quality print publication. While the details are covered in-depth in this section, here are some quick references to variables for the impatient: for engines, see @code{org-latex-compiler}; for build sequences, see @code{org-latex-pdf-process}; for packages, see @code{org-latex-default-packages-alist} and @code{org-latex-packages-alist}. An important note about the @LaTeX{} export back-end: it is sensitive to blank lines in the Org document. That's because @LaTeX{} itself depends on blank lines to tell apart syntactical elements, such as paragraphs. @menu * @LaTeX{}/PDF export commands:: For producing @LaTeX{} and PDF documents. * @LaTeX{} specific export settings:: Unique to this @LaTeX{} back-end. * @LaTeX{} header and sectioning:: Setting up the export file structure. * Quoting @LaTeX{} code:: Incorporating literal @LaTeX{} code. * Tables in @LaTeX{} export:: Options for exporting tables to @LaTeX{}. * Images in @LaTeX{} export:: How to insert figures into @LaTeX{} output. * Plain lists in @LaTeX{} export:: Attributes specific to lists. * Source blocks in @LaTeX{} export:: Attributes specific to source code blocks. * Example blocks in @LaTeX{} export:: Attributes specific to example blocks. * Special blocks in @LaTeX{} export:: Attributes specific to special blocks. * Horizontal rules in @LaTeX{} export:: Attributes specific to horizontal rules. @end menu @node @LaTeX{}/PDF export commands @subsection @LaTeX{}/PDF export commands @table @asis @item @kbd{C-c C-e l l} (@code{org-latex-export-to-latex}) @kindex C-c C-e l l @findex org-latex-export-to-latex~ Export to a @LaTeX{} file with a @samp{.tex} extension. For @samp{myfile.org}, Org exports to @samp{myfile.tex}, overwriting without warning. @item @kbd{C-c C-e l L} (@code{org-latex-export-as-latex}) @kindex C-c C-e l L @findex org-latex-export-as-latex Export to a temporary buffer. Do not create a file. @item @kbd{C-c C-e l p} (@code{org-latex-export-to-pdf}) @kindex C-c C-e l p @findex org-latex-export-to-pdf Export as @LaTeX{} file and convert it to PDF file. @item @kbd{C-c C-e l o} @kindex C-c C-e l o Export as @LaTeX{} file and convert it to PDF, then open the PDF using the default viewer. @item @kbd{M-x org-export-region-as-latex} Convert the region to @LaTeX{} under the assumption that it was in Org mode syntax before. This is a global command that can be invoked in any buffer. @end table @vindex org-latex-compiler @vindex org-latex-bibtex-compiler @vindex org-latex-default-packages-alist @cindex pdflatex @cindex xelatex @cindex lualatex @cindex @samp{LATEX_COMPILER}, keyword The @LaTeX{} export back-end can use any of these @LaTeX{} engines: @samp{pdflatex}, @samp{xelatex}, and @samp{lualatex}. These engines compile @LaTeX{} files with different compilers, packages, and output options. The @LaTeX{} export back-end finds the compiler version to use from @code{org-latex-compiler} variable or the @samp{#+LATEX_COMPILER} keyword in the Org file. See the docstring for the @code{org-latex-default-packages-alist} for loading packages with certain compilers. Also see @code{org-latex-bibtex-compiler} to set the bibliography compiler@footnote{This does not allow setting different bibliography compilers for different files. However, ``smart'' @LaTeX{} compilation systems, such as latexmk, can select the correct bibliography compiler.}. @node @LaTeX{} specific export settings @subsection @LaTeX{} specific export settings The @LaTeX{} export back-end has several additional keywords for customizing @LaTeX{} output. Setting these keywords works similar to the general options (see @ref{Export Settings}). @table @asis @item @samp{DESCRIPTION} @cindex @samp{DESCRIPTION}, keyword @vindex org-latex-hyperref-template @vindex org-latex-title-command The document's description. The description along with author name, keywords, and related file metadata are inserted in the output file by the hyperref package. See @code{org-latex-hyperref-template} for customizing metadata items. See @code{org-latex-title-command} for typesetting description into the document's front matter. Use multiple @samp{DESCRIPTION} keywords for long descriptions. @item @samp{LANGUAGE} @cindex @samp{LANGUAGE}, keyword @vindex org-latex-packages-alist In order to be effective, the @samp{babel} or @samp{polyglossia} packages---according to the @LaTeX{} compiler used---must be loaded with the appropriate language as argument. This can be accomplished by modifying the @code{org-latex-packages-alist} variable, e.g., with the following snippet: @lisp (add-to-list 'org-latex-packages-alist '("AUTO" "babel" t ("pdflatex"))) (add-to-list 'org-latex-packages-alist '("AUTO" "polyglossia" t ("xelatex" "lualatex"))) @end lisp @item @samp{LATEX_CLASS} @cindex @samp{LATEX_CLASS}, keyword @vindex org-latex-default-class @vindex org-latex-classes This is @LaTeX{} document class, such as @emph{article}, @emph{report}, @emph{book}, and so on, which contain predefined preamble and headline level mapping that the @LaTeX{} export back-end needs. The back-end reads the default class name from the @code{org-latex-default-class} variable. Org has @emph{article} as the default class. A valid default class must be an element of @code{org-latex-classes}. @item @samp{LATEX_CLASS_OPTIONS} @cindex @samp{LATEX_CLASS_OPTIONS}, keyword Options the @LaTeX{} export back-end uses when calling the @LaTeX{} document class. @item @samp{LATEX_COMPILER} @cindex @samp{LATEX_COMPILER}, keyword @vindex org-latex-compiler The compiler, such as @samp{pdflatex}, @samp{xelatex}, @samp{lualatex}, for producing the PDF@. See @code{org-latex-compiler}. @item @samp{LATEX_HEADER} @itemx @samp{LATEX_HEADER_EXTRA} @cindex @samp{LATEX_HEADER}, keyword @cindex @samp{LATEX_HEADER_EXTRA}, keyword @vindex org-latex-classes Arbitrary lines to add to the document's preamble, before the hyperref settings. See @code{org-latex-classes} for adjusting the structure and order of the @LaTeX{} headers. @item @samp{KEYWORDS} @cindex @samp{KEYWORDS}, keyword @vindex org-latex-hyperref-template @vindex org-latex-title-command The keywords for the document. The description along with author name, keywords, and related file metadata are inserted in the output file by the hyperref package. See @code{org-latex-hyperref-template} for customizing metadata items. See @code{org-latex-title-command} for typesetting description into the document's front matter. Use multiple @samp{KEYWORDS} lines if necessary. @item @samp{SUBTITLE} @cindex @samp{SUBTITLE}, keyword @vindex org-latex-subtitle-separate @vindex org-latex-subtitle-format The document's subtitle. It is typeset as per @code{org-latex-subtitle-format}. If @code{org-latex-subtitle-separate} is non-@code{nil}, it is typed outside of the @code{\title} macro. See @code{org-latex-hyperref-template} for customizing metadata items. See @code{org-latex-title-command} for typesetting description into the document's front matter. @end table The following sections have further details. @node @LaTeX{} header and sectioning @subsection @LaTeX{} header and sectioning structure @cindex @LaTeX{} class @cindex @LaTeX{} sectioning structure @cindex @LaTeX{} header @cindex header, for @LaTeX{} files @cindex sectioning structure, for @LaTeX{} export The @LaTeX{} export back-end converts the first three of Org's outline levels into @LaTeX{} headlines. The remaining Org levels are exported as lists. To change this globally for the cut-off point between levels and lists, (see @ref{Export Settings}). By default, the @LaTeX{} export back-end uses the @emph{article} class. @vindex org-latex-default-class @vindex org-latex-classes @vindex org-latex-default-packages-alist @vindex org-latex-packages-alist To change the default class globally, edit @code{org-latex-default-class}. To change the default class locally in an Org file, add option lines @samp{#+LATEX_CLASS: myclass}. To change the default class for just a part of the Org file, set a sub-tree property, @samp{EXPORT_LATEX_CLASS}. The class name entered here must be valid member of @code{org-latex-classes}. This variable defines a header template for each class into which the exporter splices the values of @code{org-latex-default-packages-alist} and @code{org-latex-packages-alist}. Use the same three variables to define custom sectioning or custom classes. @cindex @samp{LATEX_CLASS}, keyword @cindex @samp{LATEX_CLASS_OPTIONS}, keyword @cindex @samp{EXPORT_LATEX_CLASS}, property @cindex @samp{EXPORT_LATEX_CLASS_OPTIONS}, property The @LaTeX{} export back-end sends the @samp{LATEX_CLASS_OPTIONS} keyword and @samp{EXPORT_LATEX_CLASS_OPTIONS} property as options to the @LaTeX{} @code{\documentclass} macro. The options and the syntax for specifying them, including enclosing them in square brackets, follow @LaTeX{} conventions. @example #+LATEX_CLASS_OPTIONS: [a4paper,11pt,twoside,twocolumn] @end example @cindex @samp{LATEX_HEADER}, keyword @cindex @samp{LATEX_HEADER_EXTRA}, keyword The @LaTeX{} export back-end appends values from @samp{LATEX_HEADER} and @samp{LATEX_HEADER_EXTRA} keywords to the @LaTeX{} header. The docstring for @code{org-latex-classes} explains in more detail. Also note that @LaTeX{} export back-end does not append @samp{LATEX_HEADER_EXTRA} to the header when previewing @LaTeX{} snippets (see @ref{Previewing @LaTeX{} fragments}). A sample Org file with the above headers: @example #+LATEX_CLASS: article #+LATEX_CLASS_OPTIONS: [a4paper] #+LATEX_HEADER: \usepackage@{xyz@} * Headline 1 some text * Headline 2 some more text @end example @node Quoting @LaTeX{} code @subsection Quoting @LaTeX{} code The @LaTeX{} export back-end can insert any arbitrary @LaTeX{} code, see @ref{Embedded @LaTeX{}}. There are three ways to embed such code in the Org file and they all use different quoting syntax. @cindex inline, in @LaTeX{} export Inserting in-line quoted with @@ symbols: @example Code embedded in-line @@@@latex:any arbitrary LaTeX code@@@@ in a paragraph. @end example @cindex @samp{LATEX}, keyword Inserting as one or more keyword lines in the Org file: @example #+LATEX: any arbitrary LaTeX code @end example @cindex @samp{BEGIN_EXPORT latex} Inserting as an export block in the Org file, where the back-end exports any code between begin and end markers: @example #+BEGIN_EXPORT latex any arbitrary LaTeX code #+END_EXPORT @end example @node Tables in @LaTeX{} export @subsection Tables in @LaTeX{} export @cindex tables, in @LaTeX{} export The @LaTeX{} export back-end can pass several @LaTeX{} attributes for table contents and layout. Besides specifying a label (see @ref{Internal Links}) and a caption (see @ref{Captions}), the other valid @LaTeX{} attributes include: @table @asis @item @samp{:mode} @vindex org-latex-default-table-mode The @LaTeX{} export back-end wraps the table differently depending on the mode for accurate rendering of math symbols. Mode is either @samp{table}, @samp{math}, @samp{inline-math} or @samp{verbatim}. For @samp{math} or @samp{inline-math} mode, @LaTeX{} export back-end wraps the table in a math environment, but every cell in it is exported as-is. The @LaTeX{} export back-end determines the default mode from @code{org-latex-default-table-mode}. The @LaTeX{} export back-end merges contiguous tables in the same mode into a single environment. @item @samp{:environment} @vindex org-latex-default-table-environment Set the default @LaTeX{} table environment for the @LaTeX{} export back-end to use when exporting Org tables. Common @LaTeX{} table environments are provided by these packages: tabularx, longtable, array, tabu, and bmatrix. For packages, such as tabularx and tabu, or any newer replacements, include them in the @code{org-latex-packages-alist} variable so the @LaTeX{} export back-end can insert the appropriate load package headers in the converted @LaTeX{} file. Look in the docstring for the @code{org-latex-packages-alist} variable for configuring these packages for @LaTeX{} snippet previews, if any. @item @samp{:caption} Use @samp{CAPTION} keyword to set a simple caption for a table (see @ref{Captions}). For custom captions, use @samp{:caption} attribute, which accepts raw @LaTeX{} code. @samp{:caption} value overrides @samp{CAPTION} value. @item @samp{:float} @itemx @samp{:placement} The table environments by default are not floats in @LaTeX{}. To make them floating objects use @samp{:float} with one of the following options: @samp{sideways}, @samp{multicolumn}, @samp{t}, and @samp{nil}. @LaTeX{} floats can also have additional layout @samp{:placement} attributes. These are the usual @samp{[h t b p ! H]} permissions specified in square brackets. Note that for @samp{:float sideways} tables, the @LaTeX{} export back-end ignores @samp{:placement} attributes. @item @samp{:align} @itemx @samp{:font} @itemx @samp{:width} The @LaTeX{} export back-end uses these attributes for regular tables to set their alignments, fonts, and widths. @item @samp{:spread} When @samp{:spread} is non-@code{nil}, the @LaTeX{} export back-end spreads or shrinks the table by the @samp{:width} for tabu and longtabu environments. @samp{:spread} has no effect if @samp{:width} is not set. @item @samp{:booktabs} @itemx @samp{:center} @itemx @samp{:rmlines} @vindex org-latex-tables-booktabs @vindex org-latex-tables-centered All three commands are toggles. @samp{:booktabs} brings in modern typesetting enhancements to regular tables. The booktabs package has to be loaded through @code{org-latex-packages-alist}. @samp{:center} is for centering the table. @samp{:rmlines} removes all but the very first horizontal line made of ASCII characters from ``table.el'' tables only. @item @samp{:math-prefix} @itemx @samp{:math-suffix} @itemx @samp{:math-arguments} The @LaTeX{} export back-end inserts @samp{:math-prefix} string value in a math environment before the table. The @LaTeX{} export back-end inserts @samp{:math-suffix} string value in a math environment after the table. The @LaTeX{} export back-end inserts @samp{:math-arguments} string value between the macro name and the table's contents. @samp{:math-arguments} comes in use for matrix macros that require more than one argument, such as @samp{qbordermatrix}. @end table @LaTeX{} table attributes help formatting tables for a wide range of situations, such as matrix product or spanning multiple pages: @example #+ATTR_LATEX: :environment longtable :align l|lp@{3cm@}r|l | ... | ... | | ... | ... | #+ATTR_LATEX: :mode math :environment bmatrix :math-suffix \times | a | b | | c | d | #+ATTR_LATEX: :mode math :environment bmatrix | 1 | 2 | | 3 | 4 | @end example Set the caption with the @LaTeX{} command @samp{\bicaption@{HeadingA@}@{HeadingB@}}: @example #+ATTR_LATEX: :caption \bicaption@{HeadingA@}@{HeadingB@} | ... | ... | | ... | ... | @end example @node Images in @LaTeX{} export @subsection Images in @LaTeX{} export @cindex images, inline in LaTeX @cindex inlining images in LaTeX @cindex @samp{ATTR_LATEX}, keyword The @LaTeX{} export back-end processes image links in Org files that do not have descriptions, such as these links @samp{[[file:img.jpg]]} or @samp{[[./img.jpg]]}, as direct image insertions in the final PDF output. In the PDF, they are no longer links but actual images embedded on the page. The @LaTeX{} export back-end uses @samp{\includegraphics} macro to insert the image. But for TikZ (@uref{http://sourceforge.net/projects/pgf/}) images, the back-end uses an @code{\input} macro wrapped within a @code{tikzpicture} environment. For specifying image @samp{:width}, @samp{:height}, @samp{:scale} and other @samp{:options}, use this syntax: @example #+ATTR_LATEX: :width 5cm :options angle=90 [[./img/sed-hr4049.pdf]] @end example A @samp{:scale} attribute overrides both @samp{:width} and @samp{:height} attributes. For custom commands for captions, use the @samp{:caption} attribute. It overrides the default @samp{#+CAPTION} value: @example #+ATTR_LATEX: :caption \bicaption@{HeadingA@}@{HeadingB@} [[./img/sed-hr4049.pdf]] @end example When captions follow the method as described in @ref{Captions}, the @LaTeX{} export back-end wraps the picture in a floating @samp{figure} environment. To float an image without specifying a caption, set the @samp{:float} attribute to one of the following: @table @asis @item @samp{t} For a standard @samp{figure} environment; used by default whenever an image has a caption. @item @samp{multicolumn} To span the image across multiple columns of a page; the back-end wraps the image in a @samp{figure*} environment. @item @samp{wrap} For text to flow around the image on the right; the figure occupies the left half of the page. @item @samp{sideways} For a new page with the image sideways, rotated ninety degrees, in a @samp{sidewaysfigure} environment; overrides @samp{:placement} setting. @item @samp{nil} To avoid a @samp{:float} even if using a caption. @end table Use the @samp{placement} attribute to modify a floating environment's placement. @example #+ATTR_LATEX: :float wrap :width 0.38\textwidth :placement @{r@}@{0.4\textwidth@} [[./img/hst.png]] @end example @vindex org-latex-images-centered @cindex center image in LaTeX export @cindex image, centering in LaTeX export The @LaTeX{} export back-end centers all images by default. Setting @samp{:center} to @samp{nil} disables centering. To disable centering globally, set @code{org-latex-images-centered} to @samp{t}. Set the @samp{:comment-include} attribute to non-@code{nil} value for the @LaTeX{} export back-end to comment out the @samp{\includegraphics} macro. @node Plain lists in @LaTeX{} export @subsection Plain lists in @LaTeX{} export @cindex plain lists, in @LaTeX{} export @cindex @samp{ATTR_LATEX}, keyword The @LaTeX{} export back-end accepts the @samp{environment} and @samp{options} attributes for plain lists. Both attributes work together for customizing lists, as shown in the examples: @example #+LATEX_HEADER: \usepackage[inline]@{enumitem@} Some ways to say "Hello": #+ATTR_LATEX: :environment itemize* #+ATTR_LATEX: :options [label=@{@}, itemjoin=@{,@}, itemjoin*=@{, and@}] - Hola - Bonjour - Guten Tag. @end example Since @LaTeX{} supports only four levels of nesting for lists, use an external package, such as @samp{enumitem} in @LaTeX{}, for levels deeper than four: @example #+LATEX_HEADER: \usepackage@{enumitem@} #+LATEX_HEADER: \renewlist@{itemize@}@{itemize@}@{9@} #+LATEX_HEADER: \setlist[itemize]@{label=$\circ$@} - One - Two - Three - Four - Five @end example @node Source blocks in @LaTeX{} export @subsection Source blocks in @LaTeX{} export @cindex source blocks, in @LaTeX{} export @cindex @samp{ATTR_LATEX}, keyword The @LaTeX{} export back-end can make source code blocks into floating objects through the attributes @samp{:float} and @samp{:options}. For @samp{:float}: @table @asis @item @samp{t} Makes a source block float; by default floats any source block with a caption. @item @samp{multicolumn} Spans the source block across multiple columns of a page. @item @samp{nil} Avoids a @samp{:float} even if using a caption; useful for source code blocks that may not fit on a page. @end table @example #+ATTR_LATEX: :float nil #+BEGIN_SRC emacs-lisp Lisp code that may not fit in a single page. #+END_SRC @end example @vindex org-latex-listings-options @vindex org-latex-minted-options The @LaTeX{} export back-end passes string values in @samp{:options} to @LaTeX{} packages for customization of that specific source block. In the example below, the @samp{:options} are set for Minted. Minted is a source code highlighting @LaTeX{} package with many configurable options. @example #+ATTR_LATEX: :options commentstyle=\bfseries #+BEGIN_SRC emacs-lisp (defun Fib (n) (if (< n 2) n (+ (Fib (- n 1)) (Fib (- n 2))))) #+END_SRC @end example To apply similar configuration options for all source blocks in a file, use the @code{org-latex-listings-options} and @code{org-latex-minted-options} variables. @node Example blocks in @LaTeX{} export @subsection Example blocks in @LaTeX{} export @cindex example blocks, in @LaTeX{} export @cindex verbatim blocks, in @LaTeX{} export @cindex @samp{ATTR_LATEX}, keyword The @LaTeX{} export back-end wraps the contents of example blocks in a @samp{verbatim} environment. To change this behavior to use another environment globally, specify an appropriate export filter (see @ref{Advanced Export Configuration}). To change this behavior to use another environment for each block, use the @samp{:environment} parameter to specify a custom environment. @example #+ATTR_LATEX: :environment myverbatim #+BEGIN_EXAMPLE This sentence is false. #+END_EXAMPLE @end example @node Special blocks in @LaTeX{} export @subsection Special blocks in @LaTeX{} export @cindex special blocks, in @LaTeX{} export @cindex abstract, in @LaTeX{} export @cindex proof, in @LaTeX{} export @cindex @samp{ATTR_LATEX}, keyword For other special blocks in the Org file, the @LaTeX{} export back-end makes a special environment of the same name. The back-end also takes @samp{:options}, if any, and appends as-is to that environment's opening string. For example: @example #+BEGIN_abstract We demonstrate how to solve the Syracuse problem. #+END_abstract #+ATTR_LATEX: :options [Proof of important theorem] #+BEGIN_proof ... Therefore, any even number greater than 2 is the sum of two primes. #+END_proof @end example @noindent exports to @example \begin@{abstract@} We demonstrate how to solve the Syracuse problem. \end@{abstract@} \begin@{proof@}[Proof of important theorem] ... Therefore, any even number greater than 2 is the sum of two primes. \end@{proof@} @end example If you need to insert a specific caption command, use @samp{:caption} attribute. It overrides standard @samp{CAPTION} value, if any. For example: @example #+ATTR_LATEX: :caption \MyCaption@{HeadingA@} #+BEGIN_proof ... #+END_proof @end example @node Horizontal rules in @LaTeX{} export @subsection Horizontal rules in @LaTeX{} export @cindex horizontal rules, in @LaTeX{} export @cindex @samp{ATTR_LATEX}, keyword The @LaTeX{} export back-end converts horizontal rules by the specified @samp{:width} and @samp{:thickness} attributes. For example: @example #+ATTR_LATEX: :width .6\textwidth :thickness 0.8pt ----- @end example @node Markdown Export @section Markdown Export @cindex Markdown export The Markdown export back-end, ``md'', converts an Org file to Markdown format, as defined at @uref{http://daringfireball.net/projects/markdown/}. Since it is built on top of the HTML back-end (see @ref{HTML Export}), it converts every Org construct not defined in Markdown syntax, such as tables, to HTML@. @anchor{Markdown export commands} @subheading Markdown export commands @table @asis @item @kbd{C-c C-e m m} (@code{org-md-export-to-markdown}) @kindex C-c C-c m m @findex org-md-export-to-markdown Export to a text file with Markdown syntax. For @samp{myfile.org}, Org exports to @samp{myfile.md}, overwritten without warning. @item @kbd{C-c C-e m M} (@code{org-md-export-as-markdown}) @kindex C-c C-c m M @findex org-md-export-as-markdown Export to a temporary buffer. Does not create a file. @item @kbd{C-c C-e m o} @kindex C-c C-e m o Export as a text file with Markdown syntax, then open it. @end table @anchor{Header and sectioning structure (1)} @subheading Header and sectioning structure @vindex org-md-headline-style Based on @code{org-md-headline-style}, Markdown export can generate headlines of both @emph{atx} and @emph{setext} types. @emph{atx} limits headline levels to two whereas @emph{setext} limits headline levels to six. Beyond these limits, the export back-end converts headlines to lists. To set a limit to a level before the absolute limit (see @ref{Export Settings}). @node OpenDocument Text Export @section OpenDocument Text Export @cindex ODT @cindex OpenDocument @cindex export, OpenDocument @cindex LibreOffice The ODT export back-end handles creating of OpenDocument Text (ODT) format. Documents created by this exporter use the @cite{OpenDocument-v1.2 specification}@footnote{See @uref{http://docs.oasis-open.org/office/v1.2/OpenDocument-v1.2.html, Open Document Format for Office Applications (OpenDocument) Version 1.2}.} and are compatible with LibreOffice 3.4. @menu * Pre-requisites for ODT export:: Required packages. * ODT export commands:: Invoking export. * ODT specific export settings:: Configuration options. * Extending ODT export:: Producing DOC, PDF files. * Applying custom styles:: Styling the output. * Links in ODT export:: Handling and formatting links. * Tables in ODT export:: Org tables conversions. * Images in ODT export:: Inserting images. * Math formatting in ODT export:: Formatting @LaTeX{} fragments. * Labels and captions in ODT export:: Rendering objects. * Literal examples in ODT export:: For source code and example blocks. * Advanced topics in ODT export:: For power users. @end menu @node Pre-requisites for ODT export @subsection Pre-requisites for ODT export @cindex zip The ODT export back-end relies on the zip program to create the final compressed ODT output. Check if @samp{zip} is locally available and executable. Without it, export cannot finish. @node ODT export commands @subsection ODT export commands @table @asis @item @kbd{C-c C-e o o} (@code{org-export-to-odt}) @kindex C-c C-e o o @findex org-export-to-odt Export as OpenDocument Text file. @cindex @samp{EXPORT_FILE_NAME}, property @vindex org-odt-preferred-output-format If @code{org-odt-preferred-output-format} is specified, the ODT export back-end automatically converts the exported file to that format. For @samp{myfile.org}, Org exports to @samp{myfile.odt}, overwriting without warning. The ODT export back-end exports a region only if a region was active. If the selected region is a single tree, the ODT export back-end makes the tree head the document title. Incidentally, @kbd{C-c @@} selects the current sub-tree. If the tree head entry has, or inherits, an @samp{EXPORT_FILE_NAME} property, the ODT export back-end uses that for file name. @item @kbd{C-c C-e o O} @kindex C-c C-e o O Export as an OpenDocument Text file and open the resulting file. @vindex org-export-odt-preferred-output-format If @code{org-export-odt-preferred-output-format} is specified, open the converted file instead. See @ref{Automatically exporting to other formats}. @end table @node ODT specific export settings @subsection ODT specific export settings The ODT export back-end has several additional keywords for customizing ODT output. Setting these keywords works similar to the general options (see @ref{Export Settings}). @table @asis @item @samp{DESCRIPTION} @cindex @samp{DESCRIPTION}, keyword This is the document's description, which the ODT export back-end inserts as document metadata. For long descriptions, use multiple lines, prefixed with @samp{DESCRIPTION}. @item @samp{KEYWORDS} @cindex @samp{KEYWORDS}, keyword The keywords for the document. The ODT export back-end inserts the description along with author name, keywords, and related file metadata as metadata in the output file. Use multiple @samp{KEYWORDS} if necessary. @item @samp{ODT_STYLES_FILE} @cindex @samp{ODT_STYLES_FILE}, keyword @vindex org-odt-styles-file The ODT export back-end uses the @code{org-odt-styles-file} by default. See @ref{Applying custom styles} for details. @item @samp{SUBTITLE} @cindex @samp{SUBTITLE}, keyword The document subtitle. @end table @node Extending ODT export @subsection Extending ODT export The ODT export back-end can produce documents in other formats besides ODT using a specialized ODT converter process. Its common interface works with popular converters to produce formats such as @samp{doc}, or convert a document from one format, say @samp{csv}, to another format, say @samp{xls}. @cindex @file{unoconv} @vindex org-odt-convert-process Customize @code{org-odt-convert-process} variable to point to @samp{unoconv}, which is the ODT's preferred converter. Working installations of LibreOffice would already have @samp{unoconv} installed. Alternatively, other converters may be substituted here. See @ref{Configuring a document converter}. @anchor{Automatically exporting to other formats} @subsubheading Automatically exporting to other formats @vindex org-odt-preferred-output-format If ODT format is just an intermediate step to get to other formats, such as @samp{doc}, @samp{docx}, @samp{rtf}, or @samp{pdf}, etc., then extend the ODT export back-end to directly produce that format. Specify the final format in the @code{org-odt-preferred-output-format} variable. This is one way to extend (see @ref{ODT export commands}). @anchor{Converting between document formats} @subsubheading Converting between document formats The Org export back-end is made to be inter-operable with a wide range of text document format converters. Newer generation converters, such as LibreOffice and Pandoc, can handle hundreds of formats at once. Org provides a consistent interaction with whatever converter is installed. Here are some generic commands: @table @asis @item @kbd{M-x org-odt-convert} @findex org-odt-convert Convert an existing document from one format to another. With a prefix argument, opens the newly produced file. @end table @node Applying custom styles @subsection Applying custom styles @cindex styles, custom @cindex template, custom The ODT export back-end comes with many OpenDocument styles (see @ref{Working with OpenDocument style files}). To expand or further customize these built-in style sheets, either edit the style sheets directly or generate them using an application such as LibreOffice. The example here shows creating a style using LibreOffice. @anchor{Applying custom styles the easy way} @subsubheading Applying custom styles: the easy way @enumerate @item Create a sample @samp{example.org} file with settings as shown below, and export it to ODT format. @example #+OPTIONS: H:10 num:t @end example @item Open the above @samp{example.odt} using LibreOffice. Use the @emph{Stylist} to locate the target styles, which typically have the ``Org'' prefix. Open one, modify, and save as either OpenDocument Text (ODT) or OpenDocument Template (OTT) file. @item @vindex org-odt-styles-file Customize the variable @code{org-odt-styles-file} and point it to the newly created file. For additional configuration options, see @ref{x-overriding-factory-styles, , Overriding factory styles}. @cindex @samp{ODT_STYLES_FILE}, keyword To apply an ODT style to a particular file, use the @samp{ODT_STYLES_FILE} keyword as shown in the example below: @example #+ODT_STYLES_FILE: "/path/to/example.ott" @end example @noindent or @example #+ODT_STYLES_FILE: ("/path/to/file.ott" ("styles.xml" "image/hdr.png")) @end example @end enumerate @anchor{Using third-party styles and templates} @subsubheading Using third-party styles and templates The ODT export back-end relies on many templates and style names. Using third-party styles and templates can lead to mismatches. Templates derived from built in ODT templates and styles seem to have fewer problems. @node Links in ODT export @subsection Links in ODT export @cindex links, in ODT export ODT exporter creates native cross-references for internal links. It creates Internet-style links for all other links. A link with no description and pointing to a regular, un-itemized, outline heading is replaced with a cross-reference and section number of the heading. A @samp{\ref@{label@}}-style reference to an image, table etc., is replaced with a cross-reference and sequence number of the labeled entity. See @ref{Labels and captions in ODT export}. @node Tables in ODT export @subsection Tables in ODT export @cindex tables, in ODT export The ODT export back-end handles native Org mode tables (see @ref{Tables}) and simple @samp{table.el} tables. Complex @samp{table.el} tables having column or row spans are not supported. Such tables are stripped from the exported document. By default, the ODT export back-end exports a table with top and bottom frames and with ruled lines separating row and column groups (see @ref{Column Groups}). All tables are typeset to occupy the same width. The ODT export back-end honors any table alignments and relative widths for columns (see @ref{Column Width and Alignment}). Note that the ODT export back-end interprets column widths as weighted ratios, the default weight being 1. @cindex @samp{ATTR_ODT}, keyword Specifying @samp{:rel-width} property on an @samp{ATTR_ODT} line controls the width of the table. For example: @example #+ATTR_ODT: :rel-width 50 | Area/Month | Jan | Feb | Mar | Sum | |---------------+-------+-------+-------+-------| | / | < | | | < | | | | | | | | North America | 1 | 21 | 926 | 948 | | Middle East | 6 | 75 | 844 | 925 | | Asia Pacific | 9 | 27 | 790 | 826 | |---------------+-------+-------+-------+-------| | Sum | 16 | 123 | 2560 | 2699 | @end example On export, the above table takes 50% of text width area. The exporter sizes the columns in the ratio: 13:5:5:5:6. The first column is left-aligned and rest of the columns, right-aligned. Vertical rules separate the header and the last column. Horizontal rules separate the header and the last row. For even more customization, create custom table styles and associate them with a table using the @samp{ATTR_ODT} keyword. See @ref{Customizing tables in ODT export}. @node Images in ODT export @subsection Images in ODT export @cindex images, embedding in ODT @cindex embedding images in ODT @anchor{Embedding images} @subsubheading Embedding images The ODT export back-end processes image links in Org files that do not have descriptions, such as these links @samp{[[file:img.jpg]]} or @samp{[[./img.jpg]]}, as direct image insertions in the final output. Either of these examples works: @example [[file:img.png]] @end example @example [[./img.png]] @end example @anchor{Embedding clickable images} @subsubheading Embedding clickable images For clickable images, provide a link whose description is another link to an image file. For example, to embed an image @samp{org-mode-unicorn.png} which when clicked jumps to @uref{https://orgmode.org} website, do the following @example [[https://orgmode.org][./org-mode-unicorn.png]] @end example @anchor{Sizing and scaling of embedded images} @subsubheading Sizing and scaling of embedded images @cindex @samp{ATTR_ODT}, keyword Control the size and scale of the embedded images with the @samp{ATTR_ODT} attribute. @cindex identify, ImageMagick @vindex org-odt-pixels-per-inch The ODT export back-end starts with establishing the size of the image in the final document. The dimensions of this size are measured in centimeters. The back-end then queries the image file for its dimensions measured in pixels. For this measurement, the back-end relies on ImageMagick's identify program or Emacs @code{create-image} and @code{image-size} API@. ImageMagick is the preferred choice for large file sizes or frequent batch operations. The back-end then converts the pixel dimensions using @code{org-odt-pixels-per-inch} into the familiar 72 dpi or 96 dpi. The default value for this is in @code{display-pixels-per-inch}, which can be tweaked for better results based on the capabilities of the output device. Here are some common image scaling operations: @table @asis @item Explicitly size the image To embed @samp{img.png} as a 10 cm x 10 cm image, do the following: @example #+ATTR_ODT: :width 10 :height 10 [[./img.png]] @end example @item Scale the image To embed @samp{img.png} at half its size, do the following: @example #+ATTR_ODT: :scale 0.5 [[./img.png]] @end example @item Scale the image to a specific width To embed @samp{img.png} with a width of 10 cm while retaining the original height:width ratio, do the following: @example #+ATTR_ODT: :width 10 [[./img.png]] @end example @item Scale the image to a specific height To embed @samp{img.png} with a height of 10 cm while retaining the original height:width ratio, do the following: @example #+ATTR_ODT: :height 10 [[./img.png]] @end example @end table @anchor{Anchoring of images} @subsubheading Anchoring of images @cindex @samp{ATTR_ODT}, keyword The ODT export back-end can anchor images to @samp{as-char}, @samp{paragraph}, or @samp{page}. Set the preferred anchor using the @samp{:anchor} property of the @samp{ATTR_ODT} line. To create an image that is anchored to a page: @example #+ATTR_ODT: :anchor page [[./img.png]] @end example @node Math formatting in ODT export @subsection Math formatting in ODT export The ODT exporter has special support for handling math. @menu * @LaTeX{} math snippets:: Embedding in @LaTeX{} format. * MathML and OpenDocument formula files:: Embedding in native format. @end menu @node @LaTeX{} math snippets @subsubsection @LaTeX{} math snippets @LaTeX{} math snippets (see @ref{@LaTeX{} fragments}) can be embedded in the ODT document in one of the following ways: @table @asis @item MathML @cindex MathML Add this line to the Org file. This option is activated on a per-file basis. @example #+OPTIONS: tex:t @end example With this option, @LaTeX{} fragments are first converted into MathML fragments using an external @LaTeX{}-to-MathML converter program. The resulting MathML fragments are then embedded as an OpenDocument Formula in the exported document. @vindex org-latex-to-mathml-convert-command @vindex org-latex-to-mathml-jar-file You can specify the @LaTeX{}-to-MathML converter by customizing the variables @code{org-latex-to-mathml-convert-command} and @code{org-latex-to-mathml-jar-file}. If you prefer to use MathToWeb@footnote{See @uref{http://www.mathtoweb.com/cgi-bin/mathtoweb_home.pl, MathToWeb}.} as your converter, you can configure the above variables as shown below. @lisp (setq org-latex-to-mathml-convert-command "java -jar %j -unicode -force -df %o %I" org-latex-to-mathml-jar-file "/path/to/mathtoweb.jar") @end lisp @noindent or, to use @LaTeX{}​ML@footnote{See @uref{http://dlmf.nist.gov/LaTeXML/}.} instead, @lisp (setq org-latex-to-mathml-convert-command "latexmlmath \"%i\" --presentationmathml=%o") @end lisp To quickly verify the reliability of the @LaTeX{}-to-MathML converter, use the following commands: @table @asis @item @kbd{M-x org-export-as-odf} Convert a @LaTeX{} math snippet to an OpenDocument formula (@samp{.odf}) file. @item @kbd{M-x org-export-as-odf-and-open} Convert a @LaTeX{} math snippet to an OpenDocument formula (@samp{.odf}) file and open the formula file with the system-registered application. @end table @item PNG images @cindex dvipng @cindex dvisvgm @cindex ImageMagick Add this line to the Org file. This option is activated on a per-file basis. @example #+OPTIONS: tex:dvipng @end example @example #+OPTIONS: tex:dvisvgm @end example @noindent or @example #+OPTIONS: tex:imagemagick @end example Under this option, @LaTeX{} fragments are processed into PNG or SVG images and the resulting images are embedded in the exported document. This method requires dvipng program, dvisvgm or ImageMagick programs. @end table @node MathML and OpenDocument formula files @subsubsection MathML and OpenDocument formula files When embedding @LaTeX{} math snippets in ODT documents is not reliable, there is one more option to try. Embed an equation by linking to its MathML (@samp{.mml}) source or its OpenDocument formula (@samp{.odf}) file as shown below: @example [[./equation.mml]] @end example @noindent or @example [[./equation.odf]] @end example @node Labels and captions in ODT export @subsection Labels and captions in ODT export ODT format handles labeling and captioning of objects based on their types. Inline images, tables, @LaTeX{} fragments, and Math formulas are numbered and captioned separately. Each object also gets a unique sequence number based on its order of first appearance in the Org file. Each category has its own sequence. A caption is just a label applied to these objects. @example #+CAPTION: Bell curve #+NAME: fig:SED-HR4049 [[./img/a.png]] @end example When rendered, it may show as follows in the exported document: @example Figure 2: Bell curve @end example @vindex org-odt-category-map-alist To modify the category component of the caption, customize the option @code{org-odt-category-map-alist}. For example, to tag embedded images with the string ``Illustration'' instead of the default string ``Figure'', use the following setting: @lisp (setq org-odt-category-map-alist '(("__Figure__" "Illustration" "value" "Figure" org-odt--enumerable-image-p))) @end lisp With the above modification, the previous example changes to: @example Illustration 2: Bell curve @end example @node Literal examples in ODT export @subsection Literal examples in ODT export The ODT export back-end supports literal examples (see @ref{Literal Examples}) with full fontification. Internally, the ODT export back-end relies on @samp{htmlfontify.el} to generate the style definitions needed for fancy listings. The auto-generated styles get @samp{OrgSrc} prefix and inherit colors from the faces used by Emacs Font Lock library for that source language. @vindex org-odt-fontify-srcblocks For custom fontification styles, customize the @code{org-odt-create-custom-styles-for-srcblocks} option. @vindex org-odt-create-custom-styles-for-srcblocks To turn off fontification of literal examples, customize the @code{org-odt-fontify-srcblocks} option. @node Advanced topics in ODT export @subsection Advanced topics in ODT export The ODT export back-end has extensive features useful for power users and frequent uses of ODT formats. @anchor{Configuring a document converter} @subsubheading Configuring a document converter @cindex convert @cindex doc, docx, rtf @cindex converter The ODT export back-end works with popular converters with little or no extra configuration. See @ref{Extending ODT export}. The following is for unsupported converters or tweaking existing defaults. @table @asis @item Register the converter @vindex org-export-odt-convert-processes Add the name of the converter to the @code{org-odt-convert-processes} variable. Note that it also requires how the converter is invoked on the command line. See the variable's docstring for details. @item Configure its capabilities @vindex org-export-odt-convert-capabilities Specify which formats the converter can handle by customizing the variable @code{org-odt-convert-capabilities}. Use the entry for the default values in this variable for configuring the new converter. Also see its docstring for details. @item Choose the converter @vindex org-export-odt-convert-process Select the newly added converter as the preferred one by customizing the option @code{org-odt-convert-process}. @end table @anchor{Working with OpenDocument style files} @subsubheading Working with OpenDocument style files @cindex styles, custom @cindex template, custom This section explores the internals of the ODT exporter; the means by which it produces styled documents; the use of automatic and custom OpenDocument styles. The ODT exporter relies on two files for generating its output. These files are bundled with the distribution under the directory pointed to by the variable @code{org-odt-styles-dir}. The two files are: @table @asis @item @samp{OrgOdtStyles.xml} @anchor{x-orgodtstyles-xml} This file contributes to the @samp{styles.xml} file of the final ODT document. This file gets modified for the following purposes: @enumerate @item To control outline numbering based on user settings; @item To add styles generated by @samp{htmlfontify.el} for fontification of code blocks. @end enumerate @item @samp{OrgOdtContentTemplate.xml} @anchor{x-orgodtcontenttemplate-xml} This file contributes to the @samp{content.xml} file of the final ODT document. The contents of the Org outline are inserted between the @samp{} @dots{} @samp{} elements of this file. Apart from serving as a template file for the final @samp{content.xml}, the file serves the following purposes: @enumerate @item It contains automatic styles for formatting of tables which are referenced by the exporter; @item It contains @samp{} @dots{} @samp{} elements that control numbering of tables, images, equations, and similar entities. @end enumerate @end table @anchor{x-overriding-factory-styles} The following two variables control the location from where the ODT exporter picks up the custom styles and content template files. Customize these variables to override the factory styles used by the exporter. @table @asis @item @code{org-odt-styles-file} The ODT export back-end uses the file pointed to by this variable, such as @samp{styles.xml}, for the final output. It can take one of the following values: @table @asis @item @samp{FILE.xml} Use this file instead of the default @samp{styles.xml} @item @samp{FILE.odt} or @samp{FILE.ott} Use the @samp{styles.xml} contained in the specified OpenDocument Text or Template file @item @samp{FILE.odt} or @samp{FILE.ott} and a subset of included files Use the @samp{styles.xml} contained in the specified OpenDocument Text or Template file. Additionally extract the specified member files and embed those within the final ODT document. Use this option if the @samp{styles.xml} file references additional files like header and footer images. @item @code{nil} Use the default @samp{styles.xml}. @end table @item @code{org-odt-content-template-file} Use this variable to specify the blank @samp{content.xml} used in the final output. @end table @anchor{Creating one-off styles} @subsubheading Creating one-off styles The ODT export back-end can read embedded raw OpenDocument XML from the Org file. Such direct formatting is useful for one-off instances. @table @asis @item Embedding ODT tags as part of regular text Enclose OpenDocument syntax in @samp{@@@@odt:...@@@@} for inline markup. For example, to highlight a region of text do the following: @example @@@@odt:This is highlighted text@@@@. But this is regular text. @end example @strong{Hint:} To see the above example in action, edit the @samp{styles.xml} (see @ref{x-orgodtstyles-xml, , Factory styles}) and add a custom @emph{Highlight} style as shown below: @example @end example @item Embedding a one-line OpenDocument XML @cindex @samp{ODT}, keyword The ODT export back-end can read one-liner options with @samp{#+ODT:} in the Org file. For example, to force a page break: @example #+ODT: @end example @strong{Hint:} To see the above example in action, edit your @samp{styles.xml} (see @ref{x-orgodtstyles-xml, , Factory styles}) and add a custom @samp{PageBreak} style as shown below. @example @end example @item Embedding a block of OpenDocument XML The ODT export back-end can also read ODT export blocks for OpenDocument XML@. Such blocks use the @samp{#+BEGIN_EXPORT odt} @dots{} @samp{#+END_EXPORT} constructs. For example, to create a one-off paragraph that uses bold text, do the following: @example #+BEGIN_EXPORT odt This paragraph is specially formatted and uses bold text. #+END_EXPORT @end example @end table @anchor{Customizing tables in ODT export} @subsubheading Customizing tables in ODT export @cindex tables, in ODT export @cindex @samp{ATTR_ODT}, keyword Override the default table format by specifying a custom table style with the @samp{#+ATTR_ODT} line. For a discussion on default formatting of tables, see @ref{Tables in ODT export}. This feature closely mimics the way table templates are defined in the OpenDocument-v1.2 specification@footnote{@uref{http://docs.oasis-open.org/office/v1.2/OpenDocument-v1.2.html, OpenDocument-v1.2 Specification}}. @vindex org-odt-table-styles For quick preview of this feature, install the settings below and export the table that follows: @lisp (setq org-export-odt-table-styles (append org-export-odt-table-styles '(("TableWithHeaderRowAndColumn" "Custom" ((use-first-row-styles . t) (use-first-column-styles . t))) ("TableWithFirstRowandLastRow" "Custom" ((use-first-row-styles . t) (use-last-row-styles . t)))))) @end lisp @example #+ATTR_ODT: :style TableWithHeaderRowAndColumn | Name | Phone | Age | | Peter | 1234 | 17 | | Anna | 4321 | 25 | @end example The example above used @samp{Custom} template and installed two table styles @samp{TableWithHeaderRowAndColumn} and @samp{TableWithFirstRowandLastRow}. @strong{Important:} The OpenDocument styles needed for producing the above template were pre-defined. They are available in the section marked @samp{Custom Table Template} in @samp{OrgOdtContentTemplate.xml} (see @ref{x-orgodtcontenttemplate-xml, , Factory styles}). For adding new templates, define new styles there. To use this feature proceed as follows: @enumerate @item Create a table template@footnote{See the @samp{} element of the OpenDocument-v1.2 specification.}. A table template is set of @samp{table-cell} and @samp{paragraph} styles for each of the following table cell categories: @itemize @item Body @item First column @item Last column @item First row @item Last row @item Even row @item Odd row @item Even column @item Odd Column @end itemize The names for the above styles must be chosen based on the name of the table template using a well-defined convention. The naming convention is better illustrated with an example. For a table template with the name @samp{Custom}, the needed style names are listed in the following table. @multitable {aaaaaaaaaaaa} {aaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaa} {aaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaa} @headitem Cell type @tab Cell style @tab Paragraph style @item Body @tab @samp{CustomTableCell} @tab @samp{CustomTableParagraph} @item First column @tab @samp{CustomFirstColumnTableCell} @tab @samp{CustomFirstColumnTableParagraph} @item Last column @tab @samp{CustomLastColumnTableCell} @tab @samp{CustomLastColumnTableParagraph} @item First row @tab @samp{CustomFirstRowTableCell} @tab @samp{CustomFirstRowTableParagraph} @item Last row @tab @samp{CustomLastRowTableCell} @tab @samp{CustomLastRowTableParagraph} @item Even row @tab @samp{CustomEvenRowTableCell} @tab @samp{CustomEvenRowTableParagraph} @item Odd row @tab @samp{CustomOddRowTableCell} @tab @samp{CustomOddRowTableParagraph} @item Even column @tab @samp{CustomEvenColumnTableCell} @tab @samp{CustomEvenColumnTableParagraph} @item Odd column @tab @samp{CustomOddColumnTableCell} @tab @samp{CustomOddColumnTableParagraph} @end multitable To create a table template with the name @samp{Custom}, define the above styles in the @samp{} @dots{} @samp{} element of the content template file (see @ref{x-orgodtcontenttemplate-xml, , Factory styles}). @item Define a table style@footnote{See the attributes @samp{table:template-name}, @samp{table:use-first-row-styles}, @samp{table:use-last-row-styles}, @samp{table:use-first-column-styles}, @samp{table:use-last-column-styles}, @samp{table:use-banding-rows-styles}, and @samp{table:use-banding-column-styles} of the @samp{} element in the OpenDocument-v1.2 specification.}. @vindex org-odt-table-styles To define a table style, create an entry for the style in the variable @code{org-odt-table-styles} and specify the following: @itemize @item the name of the table template created in step (1), @item the set of cell styles in that template that are to be activated. @end itemize For example, the entry below defines two different table styles @samp{TableWithHeaderRowAndColumn} and @samp{TableWithFirstRowandLastRow} based on the same template @samp{Custom}. The styles achieve their intended effect by selectively activating the individual cell styles in that template. @lisp (setq org-export-odt-table-styles (append org-export-odt-table-styles '(("TableWithHeaderRowAndColumn" "Custom" ((use-first-row-styles . t) (use-first-column-styles . t))) ("TableWithFirstRowandLastRow" "Custom" ((use-first-row-styles . t) (use-last-row-styles . t)))))) @end lisp @item Associate a table with the table style. To do this, specify the table style created in step (2) as part of the @samp{ATTR_ODT} line as shown below. @example #+ATTR_ODT: :style TableWithHeaderRowAndColumn | Name | Phone | Age | | Peter | 1234 | 17 | | Anna | 4321 | 25 | @end example @end enumerate @anchor{Validating OpenDocument XML} @subsubheading Validating OpenDocument XML Sometimes ODT format files may not open due to @samp{.odt} file corruption. To verify if such a file is corrupt, validate it against the OpenDocument Relax NG Compact (RNC) syntax schema. But first the @samp{.odt} files have to be decompressed using @samp{zip}. Note that @samp{.odt} files are ZIP archives: @ref{File Archives,,,emacs,}. The contents of ODT files are in XML@. For general help with validation---and schema-sensitive editing---of XML files: @ref{Introduction,,,nxml-mode,}. @vindex org-export-odt-schema-dir Customize @code{org-odt-schema-dir} to point to a directory with OpenDocument RNC files and the needed schema-locating rules. The ODT export back-end takes care of updating the @code{rng-schema-locating-files}. @node Org Export @section Org Export @cindex Org export @emph{org} export back-end creates a normalized version of the Org document in current buffer. The exporter evaluates Babel code (see @ref{Evaluating Code Blocks}) and removes content specific to other back-ends. @anchor{Org export commands} @subheading Org export commands @table @asis @item @kbd{C-c C-e O o} (@code{org-org-export-to-org}) @kindex C-c C-e O o @findex org-org-export-to-org Export as an Org file with a @samp{.org} extension. For @samp{myfile.org}, Org exports to @samp{myfile.org.org}, overwriting without warning. @item @kbd{C-c C-e O v} (~~) @kindex C-c C-e O v Export to an Org file, then open it. @end table @node Texinfo Export @section Texinfo Export @menu * Texinfo export commands:: Invoking commands. * Texinfo specific export settings:: Setting the environment. * Texinfo file header:: Generating the header. * Texinfo title and copyright page:: Creating preamble pages. * Info directory file:: Installing a manual in Info file hierarchy. * Headings and sectioning structure:: Building document structure. * Indices:: Creating indices. * Quoting Texinfo code:: Incorporating literal Texinfo code. * Plain lists in Texinfo export:: List attributes. * Tables in Texinfo export:: Table attributes. * Images in Texinfo export:: Image attributes. * Quotations in Texinfo export:: Quote block attributes. * Special blocks in Texinfo export:: Special block attributes. * A Texinfo example:: Processing Org to Texinfo. @end menu @node Texinfo export commands @subsection Texinfo export commands @table @asis @item @kbd{C-c C-e i t} (@code{org-texinfo-export-to-texinfo}) @kindex C-c C-e i t @findex org-texinfo-export-to-texinfo Export as a Texinfo file with @samp{.texi} extension. For @samp{myfile.org}, Org exports to @samp{myfile.texi}, overwriting without warning. @item @kbd{C-c C-e i i} (@code{org-texinfo-export-to-info}) @kindex C-c C-e i i @findex org-texinfo-export-to-info @vindex org-texinfo-info-process Export to Texinfo format first and then process it to make an Info file. To generate other formats, such as DocBook, customize the @code{org-texinfo-info-process} variable. @end table @node Texinfo specific export settings @subsection Texinfo specific export settings The Texinfo export back-end has several additional keywords for customizing Texinfo output. Setting these keywords works similar to the general options (see @ref{Export Settings}). @table @asis @item @samp{SUBTITLE} @cindex @samp{SUBTITLE}, keyword The document subtitle. @item @samp{SUBAUTHOR} @cindex @samp{SUBAUTHOR}, keyword Additional authors for the document. @item @samp{TEXINFO_FILENAME} @cindex @samp{TEXINFO_FILENAME}, keyword The Texinfo filename. @item @samp{TEXINFO_CLASS} @cindex @samp{TEXINFO_CLASS}, keyword @vindex org-texinfo-default-class The default document class (@code{org-texinfo-default-class}), which must be a member of @code{org-texinfo-classes}. @item @samp{TEXINFO_HEADER} @cindex @samp{TEXINFO_HEADER}, keyword Arbitrary lines inserted at the end of the header. @item @samp{TEXINFO_POST_HEADER} @cindex @samp{TEXINFO_POST_HEADER}, keyword Arbitrary lines inserted after the end of the header. @item @samp{TEXINFO_DIR_CATEGORY} @cindex @samp{TEXINFO_DIR_CATEGORY}, keyword The directory category of the document. @item @samp{TEXINFO_DIR_TITLE} @cindex @samp{TEXINFO_DIR_TITLE}, keyword The directory title of the document. @item @samp{TEXINFO_DIR_DESC} @cindex @samp{TEXINFO_DIR_DESC}, keyword The directory description of the document. @item @samp{TEXINFO_PRINTED_TITLE} @cindex @samp{TEXINFO_PRINTED_TITLE}, keyword The printed title of the document. @end table @node Texinfo file header @subsection Texinfo file header @cindex @samp{TEXINFO_FILENAME}, keyword After creating the header for a Texinfo file, the Texinfo back-end automatically generates a name and destination path for the Info file. To override this default with a more sensible path and name, specify the @samp{TEXINFO_FILENAME} keyword. @vindex org-texinfo-coding-system @cindex @samp{TEXINFO_HEADER}, keyword Along with the output's file name, the Texinfo header also contains language details (see @ref{Export Settings}) and encoding system as set in the @code{org-texinfo-coding-system} variable. Insert @samp{TEXINFO_HEADER} keywords for each additional command in the header, for example: @example #+TEXINFO_HEADER: @@synindex @end example @cindex @samp{TEXINFO_CLASS}, keyword @vindex org-texinfo-classes Instead of repeatedly installing the same set of commands, define a class in @code{org-texinfo-classes} once, and then activate it in the document by setting the @samp{TEXINFO_CLASS} keyword to that class. @node Texinfo title and copyright page @subsection Texinfo title and copyright page @cindex @samp{TEXINFO_PRINTED_TITLE}, keyword The default template for hard copy output has a title page with @samp{TITLE} and @samp{AUTHOR} keywords (see @ref{Export Settings}). To replace the regular title with something different for the printed version, use the @samp{TEXINFO_PRINTED_TITLE} and @samp{SUBTITLE} keywords. Both expect raw Texinfo code for setting their values. @cindex @samp{SUBAUTHOR}, keyword If one @samp{AUTHOR} line is not sufficient, add multiple @samp{SUBAUTHOR} keywords. They have to be set in raw Texinfo code. @example #+AUTHOR: Jane Smith #+SUBAUTHOR: John Doe #+TEXINFO_PRINTED_TITLE: This Long Title@@@@inlinefmt@{tex,@@*@} Is Broken in @@TeX@{@} @end example @cindex @samp{COPYING}, property Copying material is defined in a dedicated headline with a non-@code{nil} @samp{COPYING} property. The back-end inserts the contents within a @samp{@@copying} command at the beginning of the document. The heading itself does not appear in the structure of the document. Copyright information is printed on the back of the title page. @example * Legalese :PROPERTIES: :COPYING: t :END: This is a short example of a complete Texinfo file, version 1.0. Copyright \copy 2016 Free Software Foundation, Inc. @end example @node Info directory file @subsection Info directory file @cindex @samp{dir} file, in Texinfo export @cindex Info directory file, in Texinfo export @cindex @code{install-info}, in Texinfo export @cindex @samp{TEXINFO_DIR_CATEGORY}, keyword @cindex @samp{TEXINFO_DIR_TITLE}, keyword @cindex @samp{TEXINFO_DIR_DESC}, keyword The end result of the Texinfo export process is the creation of an Info file. This Info file's metadata has variables for category, title, and description: @samp{TEXINFO_DIR_CATEGORY}, @samp{TEXINFO_DIR_TITLE}, and @samp{TEXINFO_DIR_DESC} keywords that establish where in the Info hierarchy the file fits. Here is an example that writes to the Info directory file: @example #+TEXINFO_DIR_CATEGORY: Emacs #+TEXINFO_DIR_TITLE: Org Mode: (org) #+TEXINFO_DIR_DESC: Outline-based notes management and organizer @end example @node Headings and sectioning structure @subsection Headings and sectioning structure @vindex org-texinfo-classes @vindex org-texinfo-default-class @cindex @samp{TEXINFO_CLASS}, keyword The Texinfo export back-end uses a pre-defined scheme to convert Org headlines to equivalent Texinfo structuring commands. A scheme like this maps top-level headlines to numbered chapters tagged as @code{@@chapter} and lower-level headlines to unnumbered chapters tagged as @code{@@unnumbered}. To override such mappings to introduce @code{@@part} or other Texinfo structuring commands, define a new class in @code{org-texinfo-classes}. Activate the new class with the @samp{TEXINFO_CLASS} keyword. When no new class is defined and activated, the Texinfo export back-end defaults to the @code{org-texinfo-default-class}. If an Org headline's level has no associated Texinfo structuring command, or is below a certain threshold (see @ref{Export Settings}), then the Texinfo export back-end makes it into a list item. @cindex @samp{APPENDIX}, property The Texinfo export back-end makes any headline with a non-@code{nil} @samp{APPENDIX} property into an appendix. This happens independent of the Org headline level or the @samp{TEXINFO_CLASS} keyword. @cindex @samp{ALT_TITLE}, property @cindex @samp{DESCRIPTION}, property The Texinfo export back-end creates a menu entry after the Org headline for each regular sectioning structure. To override this with a shorter menu entry, use the @samp{ALT_TITLE} property (see @ref{Table of Contents}). Texinfo menu entries also have an option for a longer @samp{DESCRIPTION} property. Here's an example that uses both to override the default menu entry: @example * Controlling Screen Display :PROPERTIES: :ALT_TITLE: Display :DESCRIPTION: Controlling Screen Display :END: @end example @cindex Top node, in Texinfo export The text before the first headline belongs to the @emph{Top} node, i.e., the node in which a reader enters an Info manual. As such, it is expected not to appear in printed output generated from the @samp{.texi} file. See @ref{The Top Node,,,texinfo,}, for more information. @node Indices @subsection Indices @cindex @samp{CINDEX}, keyword @cindex concept index, in Texinfo export @cindex @samp{FINDEX}, keyword @cindex function index, in Texinfo export @cindex @samp{KINDEX}, keyword @cindex keystroke index, in Texinfo export @cindex @samp{PINDEX}, keyword @cindex program index, in Texinfo export @cindex @samp{TINDEX}, keyword @cindex data type index, in Texinfo export @cindex @samp{VINDEX}, keyword @cindex variable index, in Texinfo export The Texinfo export back-end recognizes these indexing keywords if used in the Org file: @samp{CINDEX}, @samp{FINDEX}, @samp{KINDEX}, @samp{PINDEX}, @samp{TINDEX} and @samp{VINDEX}. Write their value as verbatim Texinfo code; in particular, @samp{@{}, @samp{@}} and @samp{@@} characters need to be escaped with @samp{@@} if they do not belong to a Texinfo command. @example #+CINDEX: Defining indexing entries @end example @cindex @samp{INDEX}, property For the back-end to generate an index entry for a headline, set the @samp{INDEX} property to @samp{cp} or @samp{vr}. These abbreviations come from Texinfo that stand for concept index and variable index. The Texinfo manual has abbreviations for all other kinds of indexes. The back-end exports the headline as an unnumbered chapter or section command, and then inserts the index after its contents. @example * Concept Index :PROPERTIES: :INDEX: cp :END: @end example @node Quoting Texinfo code @subsection Quoting Texinfo code Use any of the following three methods to insert or escape raw Texinfo code: @cindex @samp{TEXINFO}, keyword @cindex @samp{BEGIN_EXPORT texinfo} @example Richard @@@@texinfo:@@sc@{@@@@Stallman@@@@texinfo:@}@@@@ commence' GNU. #+TEXINFO: @@need800 This paragraph is preceded by... #+BEGIN_EXPORT texinfo @@auindex Johnson, Mark @@auindex Lakoff, George #+END_EXPORT @end example @node Plain lists in Texinfo export @subsection Plain lists in Texinfo export @cindex @samp{ATTR_TEXINFO}, keyword @cindex two-column tables, in Texinfo export @cindex table-type, Texinfo attribute The Texinfo export back-end by default converts description lists in the Org file using the default command @samp{@@table}, which results in a table with two columns. To change this behavior, set @samp{:table-type} attribute to either @samp{ftable} or @samp{vtable} value. For more information, see @ref{Two-column Tables,,,texinfo,}. @vindex org-texinfo-table-default-markup @cindex indic, Texinfo attribute The Texinfo export back-end by default also applies a text highlight based on the defaults stored in @code{org-texinfo-table-default-markup}. To override the default highlight command, specify another one with the @samp{:indic} attribute. @cindex multiple items in Texinfo lists @cindex sep, Texinfo attribute Org syntax is limited to one entry per list item. Nevertheless, the Texinfo export back-end can split that entry according to any text provided through the @samp{:sep} attribute. Each part then becomes a new entry in the first column of the table. The following example illustrates all the attributes above: @example #+ATTR_TEXINFO: :table-type vtable :sep , :indic asis - foo, bar :: This is the common text for variables foo and bar. @end example @noindent becomes @example @@vtable @@asis @@item foo @@itemx bar This is the common text for variables foo and bar. @@end table @end example @cindex lettered lists, in Texinfo export @cindex enum, Texinfo attribute Ordered lists are numbered when exported to Texinfo format. Such numbering obeys any counter (see @ref{Plain Lists}) in the first item of the list. The @samp{:enum} attribute also let you start the list at a specific number, or switch to a lettered list, as illustrated here @example #+ATTR_TEXINFO: :enum A 1. Alpha 2. Bravo 3. Charlie @end example @node Tables in Texinfo export @subsection Tables in Texinfo export @cindex @samp{ATTR_TEXINFO}, keyword When exporting tables, the Texinfo export back-end uses the widest cell width in each column. To override this and instead specify as fractions of line length, use the @samp{:columns} attribute. See example below. @example #+ATTR_TEXINFO: :columns .5 .5 | a cell | another cell | @end example @node Images in Texinfo export @subsection Images in Texinfo export @cindex @samp{ATTR_TEXINFO}, keyword Insert a file link to the image in the Org file, and the Texinfo export back-end inserts the image. These links must have the usual supported image extensions and no descriptions. To scale the image, use @samp{:width} and @samp{:height} attributes. For alternate text, use @samp{:alt} and specify the text using Texinfo code, as shown in the example: @example #+ATTR_TEXINFO: :width 1in :alt Alternate @@i@{text@} [[ridt.pdf]] @end example @node Quotations in Texinfo export @subsection Quotations in Texinfo export @cindex @samp{ATTR_TEXINFO}, keyword You can write the text of a quotation within a quote block (see @ref{Paragraphs}). You may also emphasize some text at the beginning of the quotation with the @samp{:tag} attribute. @example #+ATTR_TEXINFO: :tag Warning #+BEGIN_QUOTE Striking your thumb with a hammer may cause severe pain and discomfort. #+END_QUOTE @end example To specify the author of the quotation, use the @samp{:author} attribute. @example #+ATTR_TEXINFO: :author King Arthur #+BEGIN_QUOTE The Lady of the Lake, her arm clad in the purest shimmering samite, held aloft Excalibur from the bosom of the water, signifying by divine providence that I, Arthur, was to carry Excalibur. That is why I am your king. #+END_QUOTE @end example @node Special blocks in Texinfo export @subsection Special blocks in Texinfo export @cindex @samp{ATTR_TEXINFO}, keyword The Texinfo export back-end converts special blocks to commands with the same name. It also adds any @samp{:options} attributes to the end of the command, as shown in this example: @example #+ATTR_TEXINFO: :options org-org-export-to-org ... #+BEGIN_defun A somewhat obsessive function name. #+END_defun @end example @noindent becomes @example @@defun org-org-export-to-org ... A somewhat obsessive function name. @@end defun @end example @node A Texinfo example @subsection A Texinfo example Here is a more detailed example Org file. See @ref{GNU Sample Texts,,,texinfo,} for an equivalent example using Texinfo code. @example #+TITLE: GNU Sample @{@{@{version@}@}@} #+SUBTITLE: for version @{@{@{version@}@}@}, @{@{@{updated@}@}@} #+AUTHOR: A.U. Thor #+EMAIL: bug-sample@@gnu.org #+OPTIONS: ':t toc:t author:t email:t #+LANGUAGE: en #+MACRO: version 2.0 #+MACRO: updated last updated 4 March 2014 #+TEXINFO_FILENAME: sample.info #+TEXINFO_HEADER: @@syncodeindex pg cp #+TEXINFO_DIR_CATEGORY: Texinfo documentation system #+TEXINFO_DIR_TITLE: sample: (sample) #+TEXINFO_DIR_DESC: Invoking sample #+TEXINFO_PRINTED_TITLE: GNU Sample This manual is for GNU Sample (version @{@{@{version@}@}@}, @{@{@{updated@}@}@}). * Copying :PROPERTIES: :COPYING: t :END: This manual is for GNU Sample (version @{@{@{version@}@}@}, @{@{@{updated@}@}@}), which is an example in the Texinfo documentation. Copyright \copy 2016 Free Software Foundation, Inc. #+BEGIN_QUOTE Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.3 or any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with no Invariant Sections, with no Front-Cover Texts, and with no Back-Cover Texts. A copy of the license is included in the section entitled "GNU Free Documentation License". #+END_QUOTE * Invoking sample #+PINDEX: sample #+CINDEX: invoking @@command@{sample@} This is a sample manual. There is no sample program to invoke, but if there were, you could see its basic usage and command line options here. * GNU Free Documentation License :PROPERTIES: :APPENDIX: t :END: #+INCLUDE: fdl.org * Index :PROPERTIES: :INDEX: cp :END: @end example @node iCalendar Export @section iCalendar Export @cindex iCalendar export A large part of Org mode's interoperability success is its ability to easily export to or import from external applications. The iCalendar export back-end takes calendar data from Org files and exports to the standard iCalendar format. @vindex org-icalendar-include-todo @vindex org-icalendar-use-deadline @vindex org-icalendar-use-scheduled The iCalendar export back-end can also incorporate TODO entries based on the configuration of the @code{org-icalendar-include-todo} variable. The back-end exports plain timestamps as @samp{VEVENT}, TODO items as @samp{VTODO}, and also create events from deadlines that are in non-TODO items. The back-end uses the deadlines and scheduling dates in Org TODO items for setting the start and due dates for the iCalendar TODO entry. Consult the @code{org-icalendar-use-deadline} and @code{org-icalendar-use-scheduled} variables for more details. @vindex org-icalendar-categories @vindex org-icalendar-alarm-time For tags on the headline, the iCalendar export back-end makes them into iCalendar categories. To tweak the inheritance of tags and TODO states, configure the variable @code{org-icalendar-categories}. To assign clock alarms based on time, configure the @code{org-icalendar-alarm-time} variable. @vindex org-icalendar-store-UID @cindex @samp{ID}, property The iCalendar format standard requires globally unique identifier---or UID---for each entry. The iCalendar export back-end creates UIDs during export. To save a copy of the UID in the Org file set the variable @code{org-icalendar-store-UID}. The back-end looks for the @samp{ID} property of the entry for re-using the same UID for subsequent exports. Since a single Org entry can result in multiple iCalendar entries---timestamp, deadline, scheduled item, or TODO item---Org adds prefixes to the UID, depending on which part of the Org entry triggered the creation of the iCalendar entry. Prefixing ensures UIDs remains unique, yet enable synchronization programs trace the connections. @table @asis @item @kbd{C-c C-e c f} (@code{org-icalendar-export-to-ics}) @kindex C-c C-e c f @findex org-icalendar-export-to-ics Create iCalendar entries from the current Org buffer and store them in the same directory, using a file extension @samp{.ics}. @item @kbd{C-c C-e c a} (@code{org-icalendar-export-agenda-files}) @kindex C-c C-e c a @findex org-icalendar-export-agenda-files Create iCalendar entries from Org files in @code{org-agenda-files} and store in a separate iCalendar file for each Org file. @item @kbd{C-c C-e c c} (@code{org-icalendar-combine-agenda-files}) @kindex C-c C-e c c @findex org-icalendar-combine-agenda-files @vindex org-icalendar-combined-agenda-file Create a combined iCalendar file from Org files in @code{org-agenda-files} and write it to @code{org-icalendar-combined-agenda-file} file name. @end table @cindex @samp{SUMMARY}, property @cindex @samp{DESCRIPTION}, property @cindex @samp{LOCATION}, property @cindex @samp{TIMEZONE}, property @cindex @samp{CLASS}, property The iCalendar export back-end includes @samp{SUMMARY}, @samp{DESCRIPTION}, @samp{LOCATION}, @samp{TIMEZONE} and @samp{CLASS} properties from the Org entries when exporting. To force the back-end to inherit the @samp{LOCATION}, @samp{TIMEZONE} and @samp{CLASS} properties, configure the @code{org-use-property-inheritance} variable. @vindex org-icalendar-include-body When Org entries do not have @samp{SUMMARY}, @samp{DESCRIPTION}, @samp{LOCATION} and @samp{CLASS} properties, the iCalendar export back-end derives the summary from the headline, and derives the description from the body of the Org item. The @code{org-icalendar-include-body} variable limits the maximum number of characters of the content are turned into its description. The @samp{TIMEZONE} property can be used to specify a per-entry time zone, and is applied to any entry with timestamp information. Time zones should be specified as per the IANA time zone database format, e.g., @samp{Asia/Almaty}. Alternately, the property value can be @samp{UTC}, to force UTC time for this entry only. The @samp{CLASS} property can be used to specify a per-entry visibility class or access restrictions, and is applied to any entry with class information. The iCalendar standard defines three visibility classes: @table @asis @item @samp{PUBLIC} The entry is publicly visible (this is the default). @item @samp{CONFIDENTIAL} Only a limited group of clients get access to the event. @item @samp{PRIVATE} The entry can be retrieved only by its owner. @end table The server should treat unknown class properties the same as @samp{PRIVATE}. Exporting to iCalendar format depends in large part on the capabilities of the destination application. Some are more lenient than others. Consult the Org mode FAQ for advice on specific applications. @node Other Built-in Back-ends @section Other Built-in Back-ends Other export back-ends included with Org are: @itemize @item @samp{ox-man.el}: Export to a man page. @end itemize To activate such back-ends, either customize @code{org-export-backends} or load directly with @samp{(require 'ox-man)}. On successful load, the back-end adds new keys in the export dispatcher (see @ref{The Export Dispatcher}). Follow the comment section of such files, for example, @samp{ox-man.el}, for usage and configuration details. @node Advanced Export Configuration @section Advanced Export Configuration @anchor{Hooks} @subheading Hooks @vindex org-export-before-processing-hook @vindex org-export-before-parsing-hook The export process executes two hooks before the actual exporting begins. The first hook, @code{org-export-before-processing-hook}, runs before any expansions of macros, Babel code, and include keywords in the buffer. The second hook, @code{org-export-before-parsing-hook}, runs before the buffer is parsed. Functions added to these hooks are called with a single argument: the export back-end actually used, as a symbol. You may use them for heavy duty structural modifications of the document. For example, you can remove every headline in the buffer during export like this: @lisp (defun my-headline-removal (backend) "Remove all headlines in the current buffer. BACKEND is the export back-end being used, as a symbol." (org-map-entries (lambda () (delete-region (point) (line-beginning-position 2))))) (add-hook 'org-export-before-parsing-hook 'my-headline-removal) @end lisp @anchor{Filters} @subheading Filters @cindex Filters, exporting Filters are lists of functions to be applied to certain parts for a given back-end. The output from the first function in the filter is passed on to the next function in the filter. The final output is the output from the final function in the filter. The Org export process has many filter sets applicable to different types of objects, plain text, parse trees, export options, and final output formats. The filters are named after the element type or object type: @code{org-export-filter-TYPE-functions}, where @var{TYPE} is the type targeted by the filter. Valid types are: @multitable @columnfractions 0.33 0.33 0.33 @item body @tab bold @tab babel-call @item center-block @tab clock @tab code @item diary-sexp @tab drawer @tab dynamic-block @item entity @tab example-block @tab export-block @item export-snippet @tab final-output @tab fixed-width @item footnote-definition @tab footnote-reference @tab headline @item horizontal-rule @tab inline-babel-call @tab inline-src-block @item inlinetask @tab italic @tab item @item keyword @tab latex-environment @tab latex-fragment @item line-break @tab link @tab node-property @item options @tab paragraph @tab parse-tree @item plain-list @tab plain-text @tab planning @item property-drawer @tab quote-block @tab radio-target @item section @tab special-block @tab src-block @item statistics-cookie @tab strike-through @tab subscript @item superscript @tab table @tab table-cell @item table-row @tab target @tab timestamp @item underline @tab verbatim @tab verse-block @end multitable Here is an example filter that replaces non-breaking spaces @code{ } in the Org buffer with @samp{~} for the @LaTeX{} back-end. @lisp (defun my-latex-filter-nobreaks (text backend info) "Ensure \" \" are properly handled in LaTeX export." (when (org-export-derived-backend-p backend 'latex) (replace-regexp-in-string " " "~" text))) (add-to-list 'org-export-filter-plain-text-functions 'my-latex-filter-nobreaks) @end lisp A filter requires three arguments: the code to be transformed, the name of the back-end, and some optional information about the export process. The third argument can be safely ignored. Note the use of @code{org-export-derived-backend-p} predicate that tests for @emph{latex} back-end or any other back-end, such as @emph{beamer}, derived from @emph{latex}. @anchor{Defining filters for individual files} @subheading Defining filters for individual files The Org export can filter not just for back-ends, but also for specific files through the @samp{BIND} keyword. Here is an example with two filters; one removes brackets from time stamps, and the other removes strike-through text. The filter functions are defined in a code block in the same Org file, which is a handy location for debugging. @example #+BIND: org-export-filter-timestamp-functions (tmp-f-timestamp) #+BIND: org-export-filter-strike-through-functions (tmp-f-strike-through) #+BEGIN_SRC emacs-lisp :exports results :results none (defun tmp-f-timestamp (s backend info) (replace-regexp-in-string "&[lg]t;\\|[][]" "" s)) (defun tmp-f-strike-through (s backend info) "") #+END_SRC @end example @anchor{Extending an existing back-end} @subheading Extending an existing back-end Some parts of the conversion process can be extended for certain elements so as to introduce a new or revised translation. That is how the HTML export back-end was extended to handle Markdown format. The extensions work seamlessly so any aspect of filtering not done by the extended back-end is handled by the original back-end. Of all the export customization in Org, extending is very powerful as it operates at the parser level. For this example, make the @emph{ascii} back-end display the language used in a source code block. Also make it display only when some attribute is non-@code{nil}, like the following: @example #+ATTR_ASCII: :language t @end example Then extend ASCII back-end with a custom ``my-ascii'' back-end. @lisp (defun my-ascii-src-block (src-block contents info) "Transcode a SRC-BLOCK element from Org to ASCII. CONTENTS is nil. INFO is a plist used as a communication channel." (if (not (org-export-read-attribute :attr_ascii src-block :language)) (org-export-with-backend 'ascii src-block contents info) (concat (format ",--[ %s ]--\n%s`----" (org-element-property :language src-block) (replace-regexp-in-string "^" "| " (org-element-normalize-string (org-export-format-code-default src-block info))))))) (org-export-define-derived-backend 'my-ascii 'ascii :translate-alist '((src-block . my-ascii-src-block))) @end lisp The @code{my-ascii-src-block} function looks at the attribute above the current element. If not true, hands over to @emph{ascii} back-end. If true, which it is in this example, it creates a box around the code and leaves room for the inserting a string for language. The last form creates the new back-end that springs to action only when translating @code{src-block} type elements. To use the newly defined back-end, evaluate the following from an Org buffer: @lisp (org-export-to-buffer 'my-ascii "*Org MY-ASCII Export*") @end lisp Further steps to consider would be an interactive function, self-installing an item in the export dispatcher menu, and other user-friendly improvements. @node Export in Foreign Buffers @section Export in Foreign Buffers The export back-ends in Org often include commands to convert selected regions. A convenient feature of this in-place conversion is that the exported output replaces the original source. Here are such functions: @table @asis @item @code{org-ascii-convert-region-to-ascii} @findex org-ascii-convert-region-to-ascii Convert the selected region into ASCII@. @item @code{org-ascii-convert-region-to-utf8} @findex org-ascii-convert-region-to-utf8 Convert the selected region into UTF-8. @item @code{org-html-convert-region-to-html} @findex org-html-convert-region-to-html Convert the selected region into HTML@. @item @code{org-latex-convert-region-to-latex} @findex org-latex-convert-region-to-latex Convert the selected region into @LaTeX{}. @item @code{org-texinfo-convert-region-to-texinfo} @findex org-texinfo-convert-region-to-texinfo Convert the selected region into Texinfo. @item @code{org-md-convert-region-to-md} @findex org-md-convert-region-to-md Convert the selected region into Markdown. @end table In-place conversions are particularly handy for quick conversion of tables and lists in foreign buffers. For example, in an HTML buffer, write a list in Org syntax, select it, and convert it to HTML with @kbd{M-x org-html-convert-region-to-html}. @menu * Bare HTML:: Exporting HTML without CSS, Javascript, etc. @end menu @node Bare HTML @subsection Exporting to minimal HTML If you want to output a minimal HTML file, with no CSS, no Javascript, no preamble or postamble, here are the variable you would need to set: @vindex org-html-head @vindex org-html-head-extra @vindex org-html-head-include-default-style @vindex org-html-head-include-scripts @vindex org-html-preamble @vindex org-html-postamble @vindex org-html-use-infojs @lisp (setq org-html-head "" org-html-head-extra "" org-html-head-include-default-style nil org-html-head-include-scripts nil org-html-preamble nil org-html-postamble nil org-html-use-infojs nil) @end lisp @node Publishing @chapter Publishing @cindex publishing Org includes a publishing management system that allows you to configure automatic HTML conversion of @emph{projects} composed of interlinked Org files. You can also configure Org to automatically upload your exported HTML pages and related attachments, such as images and source code files, to a web server. You can also use Org to convert files into PDF, or even combine HTML and PDF conversion so that files are available in both formats on the server. Publishing has been contributed to Org by David O'Toole. @menu * Configuration:: Defining projects. * Uploading Files:: How to get files up on the server. * Sample Configuration:: Example projects. * Triggering Publication:: Publication commands. @end menu @node Configuration @section Configuration Publishing needs significant configuration to specify files, destination and many other properties of a project. @menu * Project alist:: The central configuration variable. * Sources and destinations:: From here to there. * Selecting files:: What files are part of the project? * Publishing action:: Setting the function doing the publishing. * Publishing options:: Tweaking HTML/@LaTeX{} export. * Publishing links:: Which links keep working after publishing? * Site map:: Generating a list of all pages. * Generating an index:: An index that reaches across pages. @end menu @node Project alist @subsection The variable @code{org-publish-project-alist} @cindex projects, for publishing @vindex org-publish-project-alist Publishing is configured almost entirely through setting the value of one variable, called @code{org-publish-project-alist}. Each element of the list configures one project, and may be in one of the two following forms: @lisp ("project-name" :property value :property value ...) @end lisp @noindent i.e., a well-formed property list with alternating keys and values, or: @lisp ("project-name" :components ("project-name" "project-name" ...)) @end lisp In both cases, projects are configured by specifying property values. A project defines the set of files that are to be published, as well as the publishing configuration to use when publishing those files. When a project takes the second form listed above, the individual members of the @code{:components} property are taken to be sub-projects, which group together files requiring different publishing options. When you publish such a ``meta-project'', all the components are also published, in the sequence given. @node Sources and destinations @subsection Sources and destinations for files @cindex directories, for publishing Most properties are optional, but some should always be set. In particular, Org needs to know where to look for source files, and where to put published files. @table @asis @item @code{:base-directory} Directory containing publishing source files. @item @code{:publishing-directory} Directory where output files are published. You can directly publish to a webserver using a file name syntax appropriate for the Emacs tramp package. Or you can publish to a local directory and use external tools to upload your website (see @ref{Uploading Files}). @item @code{:preparation-function} Function or list of functions to be called before starting the publishing process, for example, to run @samp{make} for updating files to be published. Each preparation function is called with a single argument, the project property list. @item @code{:completion-function} Function or list of functions called after finishing the publishing process, for example, to change permissions of the resulting files. Each completion function is called with a single argument, the project property list. @end table @node Selecting files @subsection Selecting files @cindex files, selecting for publishing By default, all files with extension @samp{.org} in the base directory are considered part of the project. This can be modified by setting the following properties @table @asis @item @code{:base-extension} Extension---without the dot---of source files. This actually is a regular expression. Set this to the symbol @code{any} if you want to get all files in @code{:base-directory}, even without extension. @item @code{:exclude} Regular expression to match file names that should not be published, even though they have been selected on the basis of their extension. @item @code{:include} List of files to be included regardless of @code{:base-extension} and @code{:exclude}. @item @code{:recursive} Non-@code{nil} means, check base-directory recursively for files to publish. @end table @node Publishing action @subsection Publishing action @cindex action, for publishing Publishing means that a file is copied to the destination directory and possibly transformed in the process. The default transformation is to export Org files as HTML files, and this is done by the function @code{org-publish-org-to-html} which calls the HTML exporter (see @ref{HTML Export}). But you can also publish your content as PDF files using @code{org-publish-org-to-pdf}, or as ASCII, Texinfo, etc., using the corresponding functions. If you want to publish the Org file as an @samp{.org} file but with @emph{archived}, @emph{commented}, and @emph{tag-excluded} trees removed, use @code{org-publish-org-to-org}. This produces @samp{file.org} and put it in the publishing directory. If you want a htmlized version of this file, set the parameter @code{:htmlized-source} to @code{t}. It produces @samp{file.org.html} in the publishing directory@footnote{If the publishing directory is the same as the source directory, @samp{file.org} is exported as @samp{file.org.org}, so you probably do not want to do this.}. Other files like images only need to be copied to the publishing destination; for this you can use @code{org-publish-attachment}. For non-Org files, you always need to specify the publishing function: @table @asis @item @code{:publishing-function} Function executing the publication of a file. This may also be a list of functions, which are all called in turn. @item @code{:htmlized-source} Non-@code{nil} means, publish htmlized source. @end table The function must accept three arguments: a property list containing at least a @code{:publishing-directory} property, the name of the file to be published, and the path to the publishing directory of the output file. It should take the specified file, make the necessary transformation, if any, and place the result into the destination folder. @node Publishing options @subsection Options for the exporters @cindex options, for publishing @cindex publishing options The property list can be used to set many export options for the HTML and @LaTeX{} exporters. In most cases, these properties correspond to user variables in Org. The table below lists these properties along with the variable they belong to. See the documentation string for the respective variable for details. @vindex org-publish-project-alist When a property is given a value in @code{org-publish-project-alist}, its setting overrides the value of the corresponding user variable, if any, during publishing. Options set within a file (see @ref{Export Settings}), however, override everything. @anchor{Generic properties} @subsubheading Generic properties @multitable {aaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaa} {aaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaa} @item @code{:archived-trees} @tab @code{org-export-with-archived-trees} @item @code{:exclude-tags} @tab @code{org-export-exclude-tags} @item @code{:headline-levels} @tab @code{org-export-headline-levels} @item @code{:language} @tab @code{org-export-default-language} @item @code{:preserve-breaks} @tab @code{org-export-preserve-breaks} @item @code{:section-numbers} @tab @code{org-export-with-section-numbers} @item @code{:select-tags} @tab @code{org-export-select-tags} @item @code{:with-author} @tab @code{org-export-with-author} @item @code{:with-broken-links} @tab @code{org-export-with-broken-links} @item @code{:with-clocks} @tab @code{org-export-with-clocks} @item @code{:with-creator} @tab @code{org-export-with-creator} @item @code{:with-date} @tab @code{org-export-with-date} @item @code{:with-drawers} @tab @code{org-export-with-drawers} @item @code{:with-email} @tab @code{org-export-with-email} @item @code{:with-emphasize} @tab @code{org-export-with-emphasize} @item @code{:with-fixed-width} @tab @code{org-export-with-fixed-width} @item @code{:with-footnotes} @tab @code{org-export-with-footnotes} @item @code{:with-latex} @tab @code{org-export-with-latex} @item @code{:with-planning} @tab @code{org-export-with-planning} @item @code{:with-priority} @tab @code{org-export-with-priority} @item @code{:with-properties} @tab @code{org-export-with-properties} @item @code{:with-special-strings} @tab @code{org-export-with-special-strings} @item @code{:with-sub-superscript} @tab @code{org-export-with-sub-superscripts} @item @code{:with-tables} @tab @code{org-export-with-tables} @item @code{:with-tags} @tab @code{org-export-with-tags} @item @code{:with-tasks} @tab @code{org-export-with-tasks} @item @code{:with-timestamps} @tab @code{org-export-with-timestamps} @item @code{:with-title} @tab @code{org-export-with-title} @item @code{:with-toc} @tab @code{org-export-with-toc} @item @code{:with-todo-keywords} @tab @code{org-export-with-todo-keywords} @end multitable @anchor{ASCII specific properties} @subsubheading ASCII specific properties @multitable {aaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaa} {aaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaa} @item @code{:ascii-bullets} @tab @code{org-ascii-bullets} @item @code{:ascii-caption-above} @tab @code{org-ascii-caption-above} @item @code{:ascii-charset} @tab @code{org-ascii-charset} @item @code{:ascii-global-margin} @tab @code{org-ascii-global-margin} @item @code{:ascii-format-drawer-function} @tab @code{org-ascii-format-drawer-function} @item @code{:ascii-format-inlinetask-function} @tab @code{org-ascii-format-inlinetask-function} @item @code{:ascii-headline-spacing} @tab @code{org-ascii-headline-spacing} @item @code{:ascii-indented-line-width} @tab @code{org-ascii-indented-line-width} @item @code{:ascii-inlinetask-width} @tab @code{org-ascii-inlinetask-width} @item @code{:ascii-inner-margin} @tab @code{org-ascii-inner-margin} @item @code{:ascii-links-to-notes} @tab @code{org-ascii-links-to-notes} @item @code{:ascii-list-margin} @tab @code{org-ascii-list-margin} @item @code{:ascii-paragraph-spacing} @tab @code{org-ascii-paragraph-spacing} @item @code{:ascii-quote-margin} @tab @code{org-ascii-quote-margin} @item @code{:ascii-table-keep-all-vertical-lines} @tab @code{org-ascii-table-keep-all-vertical-lines} @item @code{:ascii-table-use-ascii-art} @tab @code{org-ascii-table-use-ascii-art} @item @code{:ascii-table-widen-columns} @tab @code{org-ascii-table-widen-columns} @item @code{:ascii-text-width} @tab @code{org-ascii-text-width} @item @code{:ascii-underline} @tab @code{org-ascii-underline} @item @code{:ascii-verbatim-format} @tab @code{org-ascii-verbatim-format} @end multitable @anchor{Beamer specific properties} @subsubheading Beamer specific properties @multitable {aaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaa} {aaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaa} @item @code{:beamer-theme} @tab @code{org-beamer-theme} @item @code{:beamer-column-view-format} @tab @code{org-beamer-column-view-format} @item @code{:beamer-environments-extra} @tab @code{org-beamer-environments-extra} @item @code{:beamer-frame-default-options} @tab @code{org-beamer-frame-default-options} @item @code{:beamer-outline-frame-options} @tab @code{org-beamer-outline-frame-options} @item @code{:beamer-outline-frame-title} @tab @code{org-beamer-outline-frame-title} @item @code{:beamer-subtitle-format} @tab @code{org-beamer-subtitle-format} @end multitable @anchor{HTML specific properties} @subsubheading HTML specific properties @multitable {aaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaa} {aaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaa} @item @code{:html-allow-name-attribute-in-anchors} @tab @code{org-html-allow-name-attribute-in-anchors} @item @code{:html-checkbox-type} @tab @code{org-html-checkbox-type} @item @code{:html-container} @tab @code{org-html-container-element} @item @code{:html-divs} @tab @code{org-html-divs} @item @code{:html-doctype} @tab @code{org-html-doctype} @item @code{:html-extension} @tab @code{org-html-extension} @item @code{:html-footnote-format} @tab @code{org-html-footnote-format} @item @code{:html-footnote-separator} @tab @code{org-html-footnote-separator} @item @code{:html-footnotes-section} @tab @code{org-html-footnotes-section} @item @code{:html-format-drawer-function} @tab @code{org-html-format-drawer-function} @item @code{:html-format-headline-function} @tab @code{org-html-format-headline-function} @item @code{:html-format-inlinetask-function} @tab @code{org-html-format-inlinetask-function} @item @code{:html-head-extra} @tab @code{org-html-head-extra} @item @code{:html-head-include-default-style} @tab @code{org-html-head-include-default-style} @item @code{:html-head-include-scripts} @tab @code{org-html-head-include-scripts} @item @code{:html-head} @tab @code{org-html-head} @item @code{:html-home/up-format} @tab @code{org-html-home/up-format} @item @code{:html-html5-fancy} @tab @code{org-html-html5-fancy} @item @code{:html-indent} @tab @code{org-html-indent} @item @code{:html-infojs-options} @tab @code{org-html-infojs-options} @item @code{:html-infojs-template} @tab @code{org-html-infojs-template} @item @code{:html-inline-image-rules} @tab @code{org-html-inline-image-rules} @item @code{:html-inline-images} @tab @code{org-html-inline-images} @item @code{:html-link-home} @tab @code{org-html-link-home} @item @code{:html-link-org-files-as-html} @tab @code{org-html-link-org-files-as-html} @item @code{:html-link-up} @tab @code{org-html-link-up} @item @code{:html-link-use-abs-url} @tab @code{org-html-link-use-abs-url} @item @code{:html-mathjax-options} @tab @code{org-html-mathjax-options} @item @code{:html-mathjax-template} @tab @code{org-html-mathjax-template} @item @code{:html-equation-reference-format} @tab @code{org-html-equation-reference-format} @item @code{:html-metadata-timestamp-format} @tab @code{org-html-metadata-timestamp-format} @item @code{:html-postamble-format} @tab @code{org-html-postamble-format} @item @code{:html-postamble} @tab @code{org-html-postamble} @item @code{:html-preamble-format} @tab @code{org-html-preamble-format} @item @code{:html-preamble} @tab @code{org-html-preamble} @item @code{:html-self-link-headlines} @tab @code{org-html-self-link-headlines} @item @code{:html-table-align-individual-field} @tab @code{de@{org-html-table-align-individual-fields} @item @code{:html-table-attributes} @tab @code{org-html-table-default-attributes} @item @code{:html-table-caption-above} @tab @code{org-html-table-caption-above} @item @code{:html-table-data-tags} @tab @code{org-html-table-data-tags} @item @code{:html-table-header-tags} @tab @code{org-html-table-header-tags} @item @code{:html-table-row-tags} @tab @code{org-html-table-row-tags} @item @code{:html-table-use-header-tags-for-first-column} @tab @code{org-html-table-use-header-tags-for-first-column} @item @code{:html-tag-class-prefix} @tab @code{org-html-tag-class-prefix} @item @code{:html-text-markup-alist} @tab @code{org-html-text-markup-alist} @item @code{:html-todo-kwd-class-prefix} @tab @code{org-html-todo-kwd-class-prefix} @item @code{:html-toplevel-hlevel} @tab @code{org-html-toplevel-hlevel} @item @code{:html-use-infojs} @tab @code{org-html-use-infojs} @item @code{:html-validation-link} @tab @code{org-html-validation-link} @item @code{:html-viewport} @tab @code{org-html-viewport} @item @code{:html-wrap-src-lines} @tab @code{org-html-wrap-src-lines} @item @code{:html-xml-declaration} @tab @code{org-html-xml-declaration} @end multitable @anchor{@LaTeX{} specific properties} @subsubheading @LaTeX{} specific properties @multitable {aaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaa} {aaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaa} @item @code{:latex-active-timestamp-format} @tab @code{org-latex-active-timestamp-format} @item @code{:latex-caption-above} @tab @code{org-latex-caption-above} @item @code{:latex-classes} @tab @code{org-latex-classes} @item @code{:latex-class} @tab @code{org-latex-default-class} @item @code{:latex-compiler} @tab @code{org-latex-compiler} @item @code{:latex-default-figure-position} @tab @code{org-latex-default-figure-position} @item @code{:latex-default-table-environment} @tab @code{org-latex-default-table-environment} @item @code{:latex-default-table-mode} @tab @code{org-latex-default-table-mode} @item @code{:latex-diary-timestamp-format} @tab @code{org-latex-diary-timestamp-format} @item @code{:latex-footnote-defined-format} @tab @code{org-latex-footnote-defined-format} @item @code{:latex-footnote-separator} @tab @code{org-latex-footnote-separator} @item @code{:latex-format-drawer-function} @tab @code{org-latex-format-drawer-function} @item @code{:latex-format-headline-function} @tab @code{org-latex-format-headline-function} @item @code{:latex-format-inlinetask-function} @tab @code{org-latex-format-inlinetask-function} @item @code{:latex-hyperref-template} @tab @code{org-latex-hyperref-template} @item @code{:latex-image-default-height} @tab @code{org-latex-image-default-height} @item @code{:latex-image-default-option} @tab @code{org-latex-image-default-option} @item @code{:latex-image-default-width} @tab @code{org-latex-image-default-width} @item @code{:latex-images-centered} @tab @code{org-latex-images-centered} @item @code{:latex-inactive-timestamp-format} @tab @code{org-latex-inactive-timestamp-format} @item @code{:latex-inline-image-rules} @tab @code{org-latex-inline-image-rules} @item @code{:latex-link-with-unknown-path-format} @tab @code{org-latex-link-with-unknown-path-format} @item @code{:latex-listings-langs} @tab @code{org-latex-listings-langs} @item @code{:latex-listings-options} @tab @code{org-latex-listings-options} @item @code{:latex-listings} @tab @code{org-latex-listings} @item @code{:latex-minted-langs} @tab @code{org-latex-minted-langs} @item @code{:latex-minted-options} @tab @code{org-latex-minted-options} @item @code{:latex-prefer-user-labels} @tab @code{org-latex-prefer-user-labels} @item @code{:latex-subtitle-format} @tab @code{org-latex-subtitle-format} @item @code{:latex-subtitle-separate} @tab @code{org-latex-subtitle-separate} @item @code{:latex-table-scientific-notation} @tab @code{org-latex-table-scientific-notation} @item @code{:latex-tables-booktabs} @tab @code{org-latex-tables-booktabs} @item @code{:latex-tables-centered} @tab @code{org-latex-tables-centered} @item @code{:latex-text-markup-alist} @tab @code{org-latex-text-markup-alist} @item @code{:latex-title-command} @tab @code{org-latex-title-command} @item @code{:latex-toc-command} @tab @code{org-latex-toc-command} @end multitable @anchor{Markdown specific properties} @subsubheading Markdown specific properties @multitable {aaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaa} {aaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaa} @item @code{:md-footnote-format} @tab @code{org-md-footnote-format} @item @code{:md-footnotes-section} @tab @code{org-md-footnotes-section} @item @code{:md-headline-style} @tab @code{org-md-headline-style} @end multitable @anchor{ODT specific properties} @subsubheading ODT specific properties @multitable {aaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaa} {aaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaa} @item @code{:odt-content-template-file} @tab @code{org-odt-content-template-file} @item @code{:odt-display-outline-level} @tab @code{org-odt-display-outline-level} @item @code{:odt-fontify-srcblocks} @tab @code{org-odt-fontify-srcblocks} @item @code{:odt-format-drawer-function} @tab @code{org-odt-format-drawer-function} @item @code{:odt-format-headline-function} @tab @code{org-odt-format-headline-function} @item @code{:odt-format-inlinetask-function} @tab @code{org-odt-format-inlinetask-function} @item @code{:odt-inline-formula-rules} @tab @code{org-odt-inline-formula-rules} @item @code{:odt-inline-image-rules} @tab @code{org-odt-inline-image-rules} @item @code{:odt-pixels-per-inch} @tab @code{org-odt-pixels-per-inch} @item @code{:odt-styles-file} @tab @code{org-odt-styles-file} @item @code{:odt-table-styles} @tab @code{org-odt-table-styles} @item @code{:odt-use-date-fields} @tab @code{org-odt-use-date-fields} @end multitable @anchor{Texinfo specific properties} @subsubheading Texinfo specific properties @multitable {aaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaa} {aaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaa} @item @code{:texinfo-active-timestamp-format} @tab @code{org-texinfo-active-timestamp-format} @item @code{:texinfo-classes} @tab @code{org-texinfo-classes} @item @code{:texinfo-class} @tab @code{org-texinfo-default-class} @item @code{:texinfo-table-default-markup} @tab @code{org-texinfo-table-default-markup} @item @code{:texinfo-diary-timestamp-format} @tab @code{org-texinfo-diary-timestamp-format} @item @code{:texinfo-filename} @tab @code{org-texinfo-filename} @item @code{:texinfo-format-drawer-function} @tab @code{org-texinfo-format-drawer-function} @item @code{:texinfo-format-headline-function} @tab @code{org-texinfo-format-headline-function} @item @code{:texinfo-format-inlinetask-function} @tab @code{org-texinfo-format-inlinetask-function} @item @code{:texinfo-inactive-timestamp-format} @tab @code{org-texinfo-inactive-timestamp-format} @item @code{:texinfo-link-with-unknown-path-format} @tab @code{org-texinfo-link-with-unknown-path-format} @item @code{:texinfo-node-description-column} @tab @code{org-texinfo-node-description-column} @item @code{:texinfo-table-scientific-notation} @tab @code{org-texinfo-table-scientific-notation} @item @code{:texinfo-tables-verbatim} @tab @code{org-texinfo-tables-verbatim} @item @code{:texinfo-text-markup-alist} @tab @code{org-texinfo-text-markup-alist} @end multitable @node Publishing links @subsection Publishing links @cindex links, publishing To create a link from one Org file to another, you would use something like @samp{[[file:foo.org][The foo]]} or simply @samp{[[file:foo.org]]} (see @ref{External Links}). When published, this link becomes a link to @samp{foo.html}. You can thus interlink the pages of your ``Org web'' project and the links will work as expected when you publish them to HTML@. If you also publish the Org source file and want to link to it, use an @samp{http} link instead of a @samp{file:} link, because @samp{file} links are converted to link to the corresponding @samp{.html} file. You may also link to related files, such as images. Provided you are careful with relative file names, and provided you have also configured Org to upload the related files, these links will work too. See @ref{Complex example}, for an example of this usage. Eventually, links between published documents can contain some search options (see @ref{Search Options}), which will be resolved to the appropriate location in the linked file. For example, once published to HTML, the following links all point to a dedicated anchor in @samp{foo.html}. @example [[file:foo.org::*heading]] [[file:foo.org::#custom-id]] [[file:foo.org::target]] @end example @node Site map @subsection Generating a sitemap @cindex sitemap, of published pages The following properties may be used to control publishing of a map of files for a given project. @table @asis @item @code{:auto-sitemap} When non-@code{nil}, publish a sitemap during @code{org-publish-current-project} or @code{org-publish-all}. @item @code{:sitemap-filename} Filename for output of sitemap. Defaults to @samp{sitemap.org}, which becomes @samp{sitemap.html}. @item @code{:sitemap-title} Title of sitemap page. Defaults to name of file. @item @code{:sitemap-format-entry} @findex org-publish-find-date @findex org-publish-find-property @findex org-publish-find-title With this option one can tell how a site-map entry is formatted in the site-map. It is a function called with three arguments: the file or directory name relative to base directory of the project, the site-map style and the current project. It is expected to return a string. Default value turns file names into links and use document titles as descriptions. For specific formatting needs, one can use @code{org-publish-find-date}, @code{org-publish-find-title} and @code{org-publish-find-property}, to retrieve additional information about published documents. @item @code{:sitemap-function} Plug-in function to use for generation of the sitemap. It is called with two arguments: the title of the site-map and a representation of the files and directories involved in the project as a nested list, which can further be transformed using @code{org-list-to-generic}, @code{org-list-to-subtree} and alike. Default value generates a plain list of links to all files in the project. @item @code{:sitemap-sort-folders} Where folders should appear in the sitemap. Set this to @code{first} (default) or @code{last} to display folders first or last, respectively. When set to @code{ignore}, folders are ignored altogether. Any other value mixes files and folders. This variable has no effect when site-map style is @code{tree}. @item @code{:sitemap-sort-files} How the files are sorted in the site map. Set this to @code{alphabetically} (default), @code{chronologically} or @code{anti-chronologically}. @code{chronologically} sorts the files with older date first while @code{anti-chronologically} sorts the files with newer date first. @code{alphabetically} sorts the files alphabetically. The date of a file is retrieved with @code{org-publish-find-date}. @item @code{:sitemap-ignore-case} Should sorting be case-sensitive? Default @code{nil}. @item @code{:sitemap-file-entry-format} With this option one can tell how a sitemap's entry is formatted in the sitemap. This is a format string with some escape sequences: @code{%t} stands for the title of the file, @code{%a} stands for the author of the file and @code{%d} stands for the date of the file. The date is retrieved with the @code{org-publish-find-date} function and formatted with @code{org-publish-sitemap-date-format}. Default @code{%t}. @item @code{:sitemap-date-format} Format string for the @code{format-time-string} function that tells how a sitemap entry's date is to be formatted. This property bypasses @code{org-publish-sitemap-date-format} which defaults to @code{%Y-%m-%d}. @end table @node Generating an index @subsection Generating an index @cindex index, in a publishing project Org mode can generate an index across the files of a publishing project. @table @asis @item @code{:makeindex} When non-@code{nil}, generate in index in the file @samp{theindex.org} and publish it as @samp{theindex.html}. @end table The file is created when first publishing a project with the @code{:makeindex} set. The file only contains a statement @samp{#+INCLUDE: "theindex.inc"}. You can then build around this include statement by adding a title, style information, etc. @cindex @samp{INDEX}, keyword Index entries are specified with @samp{INDEX} keyword. An entry that contains an exclamation mark creates a sub item. @example *** Curriculum Vitae #+INDEX: CV #+INDEX: Application!CV @end example @node Uploading Files @section Uploading Files @cindex rsync @cindex unison For those people already utilizing third party sync tools such as Rsync or Unison, it might be preferable not to use the built-in remote publishing facilities of Org mode which rely heavily on Tramp. Tramp, while very useful and powerful, tends not to be so efficient for multiple file transfer and has been known to cause problems under heavy usage. Specialized synchronization utilities offer several advantages. In addition to timestamp comparison, they also do content and permissions/attribute checks. For this reason you might prefer to publish your web to a local directory---possibly even @emph{in place} with your Org files---and then use Unison or Rsync to do the synchronization with the remote host. Since Unison, for example, can be configured as to which files to transfer to a certain remote destination, it can greatly simplify the project publishing definition. Simply keep all files in the correct location, process your Org files with @code{org-publish} and let the synchronization tool do the rest. You do not need, in this scenario, to include attachments such as JPG, CSS or PNG files in the project definition since the third-party tool syncs them. Publishing to a local directory is also much faster than to a remote one, so that you can afford more easily to republish entire projects. If you set @code{org-publish-use-timestamps-flag} to @code{nil}, you gain the main benefit of re-including any changed external files such as source example files you might include with @samp{INCLUDE} keyword. The timestamp mechanism in Org is not smart enough to detect if included files have been modified. @node Sample Configuration @section Sample Configuration Below we provide two example configurations. The first one is a simple project publishing only a set of Org files. The second example is more complex, with a multi-component project. @menu * Simple example:: One-component publishing. * Complex example:: A multi-component publishing example. @end menu @node Simple example @subsection Example: simple publishing configuration This example publishes a set of Org files to the @samp{public_html} directory on the local machine. @lisp (setq org-publish-project-alist '(("org" :base-directory "~/org/" :publishing-directory "~/public_html" :section-numbers nil :table-of-contents nil :style ""))) @end lisp @node Complex example @subsection Example: complex publishing configuration This more complicated example publishes an entire website, including Org files converted to HTML, image files, Emacs Lisp source code, and style sheets. The publishing directory is remote and private files are excluded. To ensure that links are preserved, care should be taken to replicate your directory structure on the web server, and to use relative file paths. For example, if your Org files are kept in @samp{~/org/} and your publishable images in @samp{~/images/}, you would link to an image with @example file:../images/myimage.png @end example On the web server, the relative path to the image should be the same. You can accomplish this by setting up an @samp{images/} folder in the right place on the web server, and publishing images to it. @lisp (setq org-publish-project-alist '(("orgfiles" :base-directory "~/org/" :base-extension "org" :publishing-directory "/ssh:user@@host:~/html/notebook/" :publishing-function org-html-publish-to-html :exclude "PrivatePage.org" ;; regexp :headline-levels 3 :section-numbers nil :with-toc nil :html-head "" :html-preamble t) ("images" :base-directory "~/images/" :base-extension "jpg\\|gif\\|png" :publishing-directory "/ssh:user@@host:~/html/images/" :publishing-function org-publish-attachment) ("other" :base-directory "~/other/" :base-extension "css\\|el" :publishing-directory "/ssh:user@@host:~/html/other/" :publishing-function org-publish-attachment) ("website" :components ("orgfiles" "images" "other")))) @end lisp @node Triggering Publication @section Triggering Publication Once properly configured, Org can publish with the following commands: @table @asis @item @kbd{C-c C-e P x} (@code{org-publish}) @kindex C-c C-e P x @findex org-publish Prompt for a specific project and publish all files that belong to it. @item @kbd{C-c C-e P p} (@code{org-publish-current-project}) @kindex C-c C-e P p @findex org-publish-current-project Publish the project containing the current file. @item @kbd{C-c C-e P f} (@code{org-publish-current-file}) @kindex C-c C-e P f @findex org-publish-current-file Publish only the current file. @item @kbd{C-c C-e P a} (@code{org-publish-all}) @kindex C-c C-e P a @findex org-publish-all Publish every project. @end table @vindex org-publish-use-timestamps-flag Org uses timestamps to track when a file has changed. The above functions normally only publish changed files. You can override this and force publishing of all files by giving a prefix argument to any of the commands above, or by customizing the variable @code{org-publish-use-timestamps-flag}. This may be necessary in particular if files include other files via @samp{SETUPFILE} or @samp{INCLUDE} keywords. @node Working with Source Code @chapter Working with Source Code @cindex source code, working with Source code here refers to any plain text collection of computer instructions, possibly with comments, written using a human-readable programming language. Org can manage source code in an Org document when the source code is identified with begin and end markers. Working with source code begins with identifying source code blocks. A source code block can be placed almost anywhere in an Org document; it is not restricted to the preamble or the end of the document. However, Org cannot manage a source code block if it is placed inside an Org comment or within a fixed width section. Here is an example source code block in the Emacs Lisp language: @example #+BEGIN_SRC emacs-lisp (defun org-xor (a b) "Exclusive or." (if a (not b) b)) #+END_SRC @end example Source code blocks are one of many Org block types, which also include ``center'', ``comment'', ``dynamic'', ``example'', ``export'', ``quote'', ``special'', and ``verse''. This section pertains to blocks between @samp{#+BEGIN_SRC} and @samp{#+END_SRC}. Details of Org's facilities for working with source code are described in the following sections. @menu * Features Overview:: Enjoy the versatility of source blocks. * Structure of Code Blocks:: Code block syntax described. * Using Header Arguments:: Different ways to set header arguments. * Environment of a Code Block:: Arguments, sessions, working directory... * Evaluating Code Blocks:: Place results of evaluation in the Org buffer. * Results of Evaluation:: Choosing a results type, post-processing... * Exporting Code Blocks:: Export contents and/or results. * Extracting Source Code:: Create pure source code files. * Languages:: List of supported code block languages. * Editing Source Code:: Language major-mode editing. * Noweb Reference Syntax:: Literate programming in Org mode. * Library of Babel:: Use and contribute to a library of useful code blocks. * Key bindings and Useful Functions:: Work quickly with code blocks. * Batch Execution:: Call functions from the command line. @end menu @node Features Overview @section Features Overview Org can manage the source code in the block delimited by @samp{#+BEGIN_SRC} @dots{} @samp{#+END_SRC} in several ways that can simplify housekeeping tasks essential to modern source code maintenance. Org can edit, format, extract, export, and publish source code blocks. Org can also compile and execute a source code block, then capture the results. The Org mode literature sometimes refers to source code blocks as @emph{live code} blocks because they can alter the content of the Org document or the material that it exports. Users can control how live they want each source code block by tweaking the header arguments (see @ref{Using Header Arguments}) for compiling, execution, extraction, and exporting. For editing and formatting a source code block, Org uses an appropriate Emacs major mode that includes features specifically designed for source code in that language. Org can extract one or more source code blocks and write them to one or more source files---a process known as @emph{tangling} in literate programming terminology. For exporting and publishing, Org's back-ends can format a source code block appropriately, often with native syntax highlighting. For executing and compiling a source code block, the user can configure Org to select the appropriate compiler. Org provides facilities to collect the result of the execution or compiler output, insert it into the Org document, and/or export it. In addition to text results, Org can insert links to other data types, including audio, video, and graphics. Org can also link a compiler error message to the appropriate line in the source code block. An important feature of Org's management of source code blocks is the ability to pass variables, functions, and results to one another using a common syntax for source code blocks in any language. Although most literate programming facilities are restricted to one language or another, Org's language-agnostic approach lets the literate programmer match each programming task with the appropriate computer language and to mix them all together in a single Org document. This interoperability among languages explains why Org's source code management facility was named @emph{Org Babel} by its originators, Eric Schulte and Dan Davison. Org mode fulfills the promise of easy verification and maintenance of publishing reproducible research by keeping text, data, code, configuration settings of the execution environment, the results of the execution, and associated narratives, claims, references, and internal and external links in a single Org document. @node Structure of Code Blocks @section Structure of Code Blocks @cindex code block, structure @cindex source code, block structure @cindex @samp{NAME} keyword, in source blocks @cindex @samp{BEGIN_SRC} Org offers two ways to structure source code in Org documents: in a source code block, and directly inline. Both specifications are shown below. A source code block conforms to this structure: @example #+NAME: #+BEGIN_SRC
#+END_SRC @end example Do not be put-off by having to remember the source block syntax. Org mode offers a command for wrapping existing text in a block (see @ref{Structure Templates}). Org also works with other completion systems in Emacs, some of which predate Org and have custom domain-specific languages for defining templates. Regular use of templates reduces errors, increases accuracy, and maintains consistency. @cindex source code, inline An inline code block conforms to this structure: @example src_@{@} @end example @noindent or @example src_[
]@{@} @end example @table @asis @item @samp{#+NAME: } Optional. Names the source block so it can be called, like a function, from other source blocks or inline code to evaluate or to capture the results. Code from other blocks, other files, and from table formulas (see @ref{The Spreadsheet}) can use the name to reference a source block. This naming serves the same purpose as naming Org tables. Org mode requires unique names. For duplicate names, Org mode's behavior is undefined. @item @samp{#+BEGIN_SRC} @dots{} @samp{#+END_SRC} Mandatory. They mark the start and end of a block that Org requires. The @samp{#+BEGIN_SRC} line takes additional arguments, as described next. @item @samp{} @cindex language, in code blocks Mandatory. It is the identifier of the source code language in the block. See @ref{Languages}, for identifiers of supported languages. @item @samp{} @cindex switches, in code blocks Optional. Switches provide finer control of the code execution, export, and format (see the discussion of switches in @ref{Literal Examples}). @item @samp{
} @cindex header arguments, in code blocks Optional. Heading arguments control many aspects of evaluation, export and tangling of code blocks (see @ref{Using Header Arguments}). Using Org's properties feature, header arguments can be selectively applied to the entire buffer or specific sub-trees of the Org document. @item @samp{} Source code in the dialect of the specified language identifier. @end table @node Using Header Arguments @section Using Header Arguments Org comes with many header arguments common to all languages. New header arguments are added for specific languages as they become available for use in source code blocks. A header argument is specified with an initial colon followed by the argument's name in lowercase. Since header arguments can be set in several ways, Org prioritizes them in case of overlaps or conflicts by giving local settings a higher priority. Header values in function calls, for example, override header values from global defaults. @anchor{System-wide header arguments} @subheading System-wide header arguments @vindex org-babel-default-header-args @vindex org-babel-default-header-args System-wide values of header arguments can be specified by customizing the @code{org-babel-default-header-args} variable, which defaults to the following values: @example :session => "none" :results => "replace" :exports => "code" :cache => "no" :noweb => "no" @end example The example below sets @samp{:noweb} header arguments to @samp{yes}, which makes Org expand @samp{:noweb} references by default. @lisp (setq org-babel-default-header-args (cons '(:noweb . "yes") (assq-delete-all :noweb org-babel-default-header-args))) @end lisp @cindex language specific default header arguments @cindex default header arguments per language Each language can have separate default header arguments by customizing the variable @code{org-babel-default-header-args:}, where @var{} is the name of the language. For details, see the language-specific online documentation at @uref{https://orgmode.org/worg/org-contrib/babel/}. @anchor{Header arguments in Org mode properties} @subheading Header arguments in Org mode properties For header arguments applicable to the buffer, use @samp{PROPERTY} keyword anywhere in the Org file (see @ref{Property Syntax}). The following example makes all the R code blocks execute in the same session. Setting @samp{:results} to @samp{silent} ignores the results of executions for all blocks, not just R code blocks; no results inserted for any block. @example #+PROPERTY: header-args:R :session *R* #+PROPERTY: header-args :results silent @end example @vindex org-use-property-inheritance Header arguments set through Org's property drawers (see @ref{Property Syntax}) apply at the sub-tree level on down. Since these property drawers can appear anywhere in the file hierarchy, Org uses outermost call or source block to resolve the values. Org ignores @code{org-use-property-inheritance} setting. In this example, @samp{:cache} defaults to @samp{yes} for all code blocks in the sub-tree. @example * sample header :PROPERTIES: :header-args: :cache yes :END: @end example @kindex C-c C-x p @findex org-set-property Properties defined through @code{org-set-property} function, bound to @kbd{C-c C-x p}, apply to all active languages. They override properties set in @code{org-babel-default-header-args}. @cindex language specific header arguments properties @cindex header arguments per language Language-specific header arguments are also read from properties @samp{header-args:} where @var{} is the language identifier. For example, @example * Heading :PROPERTIES: :header-args:clojure: :session *clojure-1* :header-args:R: :session *R* :END: ** Subheading :PROPERTIES: :header-args:clojure: :session *clojure-2* :END: @end example @noindent would force separate sessions for Clojure blocks in @samp{Heading} and @samp{Subheading}, but use the same session for all R blocks. Blocks in @samp{Subheading} inherit settings from @samp{Heading}. @anchor{Code block specific header arguments} @subheading Code block specific header arguments Header arguments are most commonly set at the source code block level, on the @samp{#+BEGIN_SRC} line. Arguments set at this level take precedence over those set in the @code{org-babel-default-header-args} variable, and also those set as header properties. In the following example, setting @samp{:results} to @samp{silent} makes it ignore results of the code execution. Setting @samp{:exports} to @samp{code} exports only the body of the code block to HTML or @LaTeX{}. @example #+NAME: factorial #+BEGIN_SRC haskell :results silent :exports code :var n=0 fac 0 = 1 fac n = n * fac (n-1) #+END_SRC @end example The same header arguments in an inline code block: @example src_haskell[:exports both]@{fac 5@} @end example @cindex @samp{HEADER}, keyword Code block header arguments can span multiple lines using @samp{#+HEADER:} on each line. Note that Org currently accepts the plural spelling of @samp{#+HEADER:} only as a convenience for backward-compatibility. It may be removed at some point. Multi-line header arguments on an unnamed code block: @example #+HEADER: :var data1=1 #+BEGIN_SRC emacs-lisp :var data2=2 (message "data1:%S, data2:%S" data1 data2) #+END_SRC #+RESULTS: : data1:1, data2:2 @end example Multi-line header arguments on a named code block: @example #+NAME: named-block #+HEADER: :var data=2 #+BEGIN_SRC emacs-lisp (message "data:%S" data) #+END_SRC #+RESULTS: named-block : data:2 @end example @anchor{Header arguments in function calls} @subheading Header arguments in function calls Header arguments in function calls are the most specific and override all other settings in case of an overlap. They get the highest priority. Two @samp{#+CALL:} examples are shown below. For the complete syntax of @samp{CALL} keyword, see @ref{Evaluating Code Blocks}. In this example, @samp{:exports results} header argument is applied to the evaluation of the @samp{#+CALL:} line. @example #+CALL: factorial(n=5) :exports results @end example In this example, @samp{:session special} header argument is applied to the evaluation of @samp{factorial} code block. @example #+CALL: factorial[:session special](n=5) @end example @node Environment of a Code Block @section Environment of a Code Block @anchor{Passing arguments} @subheading Passing arguments @cindex passing arguments to code blocks @cindex arguments, in code blocks @cindex @samp{var}, header argument Use @samp{var} for passing arguments to source code blocks. The specifics of variables in code blocks vary by the source language and are covered in the language-specific documentation. The syntax for @samp{var}, however, is the same for all languages. This includes declaring a variable, and assigning a default value. The following syntax is used to pass arguments to code blocks using the @samp{var} header argument. @example :var NAME=ASSIGN @end example @noindent @var{NAME} is the name of the variable bound in the code block body. @var{ASSIGN} is a literal value, such as a string, a number, a reference to a table, a list, a literal example, another code block---with or without arguments---or the results of evaluating a code block. Here are examples of passing values by reference: @table @asis @item table A table named with a @samp{NAME} keyword. @example #+NAME: example-table | 1 | | 2 | | 3 | | 4 | #+NAME: table-length #+BEGIN_SRC emacs-lisp :var table=example-table (length table) #+END_SRC #+RESULTS: table-length : 4 @end example When passing a table, you can treat specially the row, or the column, containing labels for the columns, or the rows, in the table. @cindex @samp{colnames}, header argument The @samp{colnames} header argument accepts @samp{yes}, @samp{no}, or @samp{nil} values. The default value is @samp{nil}: if an input table has column names---because the second row is a horizontal rule---then Org removes the column names, processes the table, puts back the column names, and then writes the table to the results block. Using @samp{yes}, Org does the same to the first row, even if the initial table does not contain any horizontal rule. When set to @samp{no}, Org does not pre-process column names at all. @example #+NAME: less-cols | a | |---| | b | | c | #+BEGIN_SRC python :var tab=less-cols :colnames nil return [[val + '*' for val in row] for row in tab] #+END_SRC #+RESULTS: | a | |----| | b* | | c* | @end example @cindex @samp{rownames}, header argument Similarly, the @samp{rownames} header argument can take two values: @samp{yes} or @samp{no}. When set to @samp{yes}, Org removes the first column, processes the table, puts back the first column, and then writes the table to the results block. The default is @samp{no}, which means Org does not pre-process the first column. Note that Emacs Lisp code blocks ignore @samp{rownames} header argument because of the ease of table-handling in Emacs. @example #+NAME: with-rownames | one | 1 | 2 | 3 | 4 | 5 | | two | 6 | 7 | 8 | 9 | 10 | #+BEGIN_SRC python :var tab=with-rownames :rownames yes return [[val + 10 for val in row] for row in tab] #+END_SRC #+RESULTS: | one | 11 | 12 | 13 | 14 | 15 | | two | 16 | 17 | 18 | 19 | 20 | @end example @item list A simple named list. @example #+NAME: example-list - simple - not - nested - list #+BEGIN_SRC emacs-lisp :var x=example-list (print x) #+END_SRC #+RESULTS: | simple | list | @end example Note that only the top level list items are passed along. Nested list items are ignored. @item code block without arguments A code block name, as assigned by @samp{NAME} keyword from the example above, optionally followed by parentheses. @example #+BEGIN_SRC emacs-lisp :var length=table-length() (* 2 length) #+END_SRC #+RESULTS: : 8 @end example @item code block with arguments A code block name, as assigned by @samp{NAME} keyword, followed by parentheses and optional arguments passed within the parentheses. @example #+NAME: double #+BEGIN_SRC emacs-lisp :var input=8 (* 2 input) #+END_SRC #+RESULTS: double : 16 #+NAME: squared #+BEGIN_SRC emacs-lisp :var input=double(input=1) (* input input) #+END_SRC #+RESULTS: squared : 4 @end example @item literal example A literal example block named with a @samp{NAME} keyword. @example #+NAME: literal-example #+BEGIN_EXAMPLE A literal example on two lines #+END_EXAMPLE #+NAME: read-literal-example #+BEGIN_SRC emacs-lisp :var x=literal-example (concatenate #'string x " for you.") #+END_SRC #+RESULTS: read-literal-example : A literal example : on two lines for you. @end example @end table Indexing variable values enables referencing portions of a variable. Indexes are 0 based with negative values counting backwards from the end. If an index is separated by commas then each subsequent section indexes as the next dimension. Note that this indexing occurs @emph{before} other table-related header arguments are applied, such as @samp{hlines}, @samp{colnames} and @samp{rownames}. The following example assigns the last cell of the first row the table @samp{example-table} to the variable @samp{data}: @example #+NAME: example-table | 1 | a | | 2 | b | | 3 | c | | 4 | d | #+BEGIN_SRC emacs-lisp :var data=example-table[0,-1] data #+END_SRC #+RESULTS: : a @end example Two integers separated by a colon reference a range of variable values. In that case the entire inclusive range is referenced. For example the following assigns the middle three rows of @samp{example-table} to @samp{data}. @example #+NAME: example-table | 1 | a | | 2 | b | | 3 | c | | 4 | d | | 5 | 3 | #+BEGIN_SRC emacs-lisp :var data=example-table[1:3] data #+END_SRC #+RESULTS: | 2 | b | | 3 | c | | 4 | d | @end example To pick the entire range, use an empty index, or the single character @samp{*}. @samp{0:-1} does the same thing. Example below shows how to reference the first column only. @example #+NAME: example-table | 1 | a | | 2 | b | | 3 | c | | 4 | d | #+BEGIN_SRC emacs-lisp :var data=example-table[,0] data #+END_SRC #+RESULTS: | 1 | 2 | 3 | 4 | @end example Index referencing can be used for tables and code blocks. Index referencing can handle any number of dimensions. Commas delimit multiple dimensions, as shown below. @example #+NAME: 3D #+BEGIN_SRC emacs-lisp '(((1 2 3) (4 5 6) (7 8 9)) ((10 11 12) (13 14 15) (16 17 18)) ((19 20 21) (22 23 24) (25 26 27))) #+END_SRC #+BEGIN_SRC emacs-lisp :var data=3D[1,,1] data #+END_SRC #+RESULTS: | 11 | 14 | 17 | @end example Note that row names and column names are not removed prior to variable indexing. You need to take them into account, even when @samp{colnames} or @samp{rownames} header arguments remove them. Emacs lisp code can also set the values for variables. To differentiate a value from Lisp code, Org interprets any value starting with @samp{(}, @samp{[}, @samp{'} or @samp{`} as Emacs Lisp code. The result of evaluating that code is then assigned to the value of that variable. The following example shows how to reliably query and pass the file name of the Org mode buffer to a code block using headers. We need reliability here because the file's name could change once the code in the block starts executing. @example #+BEGIN_SRC sh :var filename=(buffer-file-name) :exports both wc -w $filename #+END_SRC @end example Note that values read from tables and lists are not mistakenly evaluated as Emacs Lisp code, as illustrated in the following example. @example #+NAME: table | (a b c) | #+HEADER: :var data=table[0,0] #+BEGIN_SRC perl $data #+END_SRC #+RESULTS: : (a b c) @end example @anchor{Using sessions} @subheading Using sessions @cindex using sessions in code blocks @cindex @samp{session}, header argument Two code blocks can share the same environment. The @samp{session} header argument is for running multiple source code blocks under one session. Org runs code blocks with the same session name in the same interpreter process. @table @asis @item @samp{none} Default. Each code block gets a new interpreter process to execute. The process terminates once the block is evaluated. @item @var{STRING} Any string besides @samp{none} turns that string into the name of that session. For example, @samp{:session STRING} names it @samp{STRING}. If @samp{session} has no value, then the session name is derived from the source language identifier. Subsequent blocks with the same source code language use the same session. Depending on the language, state variables, code from other blocks, and the overall interpreted environment may be shared. Some interpreted languages support concurrent sessions when subsequent source code language blocks change session names. @end table Only languages that provide interactive evaluation can have session support. Not all languages provide this support, such as C and ditaa. Even languages, such as Python and Haskell, that do support interactive evaluation impose limitations on allowable language constructs that can run interactively. Org inherits those limitations for those code blocks running in a session. @anchor{Choosing a working directory} @subheading Choosing a working directory @cindex working directory, in a code block @cindex @samp{dir}, header argument @cindex @samp{mkdirp}, header argument The @samp{dir} header argument specifies the default directory during code block execution. If it is absent, then the directory associated with the current buffer is used. In other words, supplying @samp{:dir DIRECTORY} temporarily has the same effect as changing the current directory with @kbd{M-x cd @key{RET} DIRECTORY}, and then not setting @samp{dir}. Under the surface, @samp{dir} simply sets the value of the Emacs variable @code{default-directory}. Setting @samp{mkdirp} header argument to a non-@code{nil} value creates the directory, if necessary. For example, to save the plot file in the @samp{Work/} folder of the home directory---notice tilde is expanded: @example #+BEGIN_SRC R :file myplot.png :dir ~/Work matplot(matrix(rnorm(100), 10), type="l") #+END_SRC @end example To evaluate the code block on a remote machine, supply a remote directory name using Tramp syntax. For example: @example #+BEGIN_SRC R :file plot.png :dir /scp:dand@@yakuba.princeton.edu: plot(1:10, main=system("hostname", intern=TRUE)) #+END_SRC @end example Org first captures the text results as usual for insertion in the Org file. Then Org also inserts a link to the remote file, thanks to Emacs Tramp. Org constructs the remote path to the file name from @samp{dir} and @code{default-directory}, as illustrated here: @example [[file:/scp:dand@@yakuba.princeton.edu:/home/dand/plot.png][plot.png]] @end example When @samp{dir} is used with @samp{session}, Org sets the starting directory for a new session. But Org does not alter the directory of an already existing session. Do not use @samp{dir} with @samp{:exports results} or with @samp{:exports both} to avoid Org inserting incorrect links to remote files. That is because Org does not expand @code{default directory} to avoid some underlying portability issues. @anchor{Inserting headers and footers} @subheading Inserting headers and footers @cindex headers, in code blocks @cindex footers, in code blocks @cindex @samp{prologue}, header argument The @samp{prologue} header argument is for appending to the top of the code block for execution, like a reset instruction. For example, you may use @samp{:prologue "reset"} in a Gnuplot code block or, for every such block: @lisp (add-to-list 'org-babel-default-header-args:gnuplot '((:prologue . "reset"))) @end lisp @cindex @samp{epilogue}, header argument Likewise, the value of the @samp{epilogue} header argument is for appending to the end of the code block for execution. @node Evaluating Code Blocks @section Evaluating Code Blocks @cindex code block, evaluating @cindex source code, evaluating @cindex @samp{RESULTS}, keyword A note about security: With code evaluation comes the risk of harm. Org safeguards by prompting for user's permission before executing any code in the source block. To customize this safeguard, or disable it, see @ref{Code Evaluation Security}. @anchor{How to evaluate source code} @subheading How to evaluate source code Org captures the results of the code block evaluation and inserts them in the Org file, right after the code block. The insertion point is after a newline and the @samp{RESULTS} keyword. Org creates the @samp{RESULTS} keyword if one is not already there. By default, Org enables only Emacs Lisp code blocks for execution. See @ref{Languages} to enable other languages. @kindex C-c C-c @kindex C-c C-v e @findex org-babel-execute-src-block Org provides many ways to execute code blocks. @kbd{C-c C-c} or @kbd{C-c C-v e} with the point on a code block@footnote{The option @code{org-babel-no-eval-on-ctrl-c-ctrl-c} can be used to remove code evaluation from the @kbd{C-c C-c} key binding.} calls the @code{org-babel-execute-src-block} function, which executes the code in the block, collects the results, and inserts them in the buffer. @cindex @samp{CALL}, keyword @vindex org-babel-inline-result-wrap By calling a named code block@footnote{Actually, the constructs @samp{call_()} and @samp{src_@{@}} are not evaluated when they appear in a keyword (see @ref{In-buffer Settings}).} from an Org mode buffer or a table. Org can call the named code blocks from the current Org mode buffer or from the ``Library of Babel'' (see @ref{Library of Babel}). The syntax for @samp{CALL} keyword is: @example #+CALL: () #+CALL: []() @end example The syntax for inline named code blocks is: @example ... call_() ... ... call_[]()[] ... @end example When inline syntax is used, the result is wrapped based on the variable @code{org-babel-inline-result-wrap}, which by default is set to @code{"=%s="} to produce verbatim text suitable for markup. @table @asis @item @samp{} This is the name of the code block (see @ref{Structure of Code Blocks}) to be evaluated in the current document. If the block is located in another file, start @samp{} with the file name followed by a colon. For example, in order to execute a block named @samp{clear-data} in @samp{file.org}, you can write the following: @example #+CALL: file.org:clear-data() @end example @item @samp{} Org passes arguments to the code block using standard function call syntax. For example, a @samp{#+CALL:} line that passes @samp{4} to a code block named @samp{double}, which declares the header argument @samp{:var n=2}, would be written as: @example #+CALL: double(n=4) @end example @noindent Note how this function call syntax is different from the header argument syntax. @item @samp{} Org passes inside header arguments to the named code block using the header argument syntax. Inside header arguments apply to code block evaluation. For example, @samp{[:results output]} collects results printed to stdout during code execution of that block. Note how this header argument syntax is different from the function call syntax. @item @samp{} End header arguments affect the results returned by the code block. For example, @samp{:results html} wraps the results in a @samp{#+BEGIN_EXPORT html} block before inserting the results in the Org buffer. @end table @anchor{Limit code block evaluation} @subheading Limit code block evaluation @cindex @samp{eval}, header argument @cindex control code block evaluation The @samp{eval} header argument can limit evaluation of specific code blocks and @samp{CALL} keyword. It is useful for protection against evaluating untrusted code blocks by prompting for a confirmation. @table @asis @item @samp{never} or @samp{no} Org never evaluates the source code. @item @samp{query} Org prompts the user for permission to evaluate the source code. @item @samp{never-export} or @samp{no-export} Org does not evaluate the source code when exporting, yet the user can evaluate it interactively. @item @samp{query-export} Org prompts the user for permission to evaluate the source code during export. @end table If @samp{eval} header argument is not set, then Org determines whether to evaluate the source code from the @code{org-confirm-babel-evaluate} variable (see @ref{Code Evaluation Security}). @anchor{Cache results of evaluation} @subheading Cache results of evaluation @cindex @samp{cache}, header argument @cindex cache results of code evaluation The @samp{cache} header argument is for caching results of evaluating code blocks. Caching results can avoid re-evaluating a code block that have not changed since the previous run. To benefit from the cache and avoid redundant evaluations, the source block must have a result already present in the buffer, and neither the header arguments---including the value of @samp{var} references---nor the text of the block itself has changed since the result was last computed. This feature greatly helps avoid long-running calculations. For some edge cases, however, the cached results may not be reliable. The caching feature is best for when code blocks are pure functions, that is functions that return the same value for the same input arguments (see @ref{Environment of a Code Block}), and that do not have side effects, and do not rely on external variables other than the input arguments. Functions that depend on a timer, file system objects, and random number generators are clearly unsuitable for caching. A note of warning: when @samp{cache} is used in a session, caching may cause unexpected results. When the caching mechanism tests for any source code changes, it does not expand noweb style references (see @ref{Noweb Reference Syntax}). The @samp{cache} header argument can have one of two values: @samp{yes} or @samp{no}. @table @asis @item @samp{no} Default. No caching of results; code block evaluated every time. @item @samp{yes} Whether to run the code or return the cached results is determined by comparing the SHA1 hash value of the combined code block and arguments passed to it. This hash value is packed on the @samp{#+RESULTS:} line from previous evaluation. When hash values match, Org does not evaluate the code block. When hash values mismatch, Org evaluates the code block, inserts the results, recalculates the hash value, and updates @samp{#+RESULTS:} line. @end table In this example, both functions are cached. But @samp{caller} runs only if the result from @samp{random} has changed since the last run. @example #+NAME: random #+BEGIN_SRC R :cache yes runif(1) #+END_SRC #+RESULTS[a2a72cd647ad44515fab62e144796432793d68e1]: random 0.4659510825295 #+NAME: caller #+BEGIN_SRC emacs-lisp :var x=random :cache yes x #+END_SRC #+RESULTS[bec9c8724e397d5df3b696502df3ed7892fc4f5f]: caller 0.254227238707244 @end example @node Results of Evaluation @section Results of Evaluation @cindex code block, results of evaluation @cindex source code, results of evaluation @cindex @samp{results}, header argument How Org handles results of a code block execution depends on many header arguments working together. The primary determinant, however, is the @samp{results} header argument. It accepts four classes of options. Each code block can take only one option per class: @table @asis @item Collection For how the results should be collected from the code block; @item Type For which type of result the code block will return; affects how Org processes and inserts results in the Org buffer; @item Format For the result; affects how Org processes results; @item Handling For inserting results once they are properly formatted. @end table @anchor{Collection} @subheading Collection Collection options specify the results. Choose one of the options; they are mutually exclusive. @table @asis @item @samp{value} Default for most Babel libraries@footnote{Actually, the constructs @samp{call_()} and @samp{src_@{@}} are not evaluated when they appear in a keyword (see @ref{In-buffer Settings}).}. Functional mode. Org gets the value by wrapping the code in a function definition in the language of the source block. That is why when using @samp{:results value}, code should execute like a function and return a value. For languages like Python, an explicit @code{return} statement is mandatory when using @samp{:results value}. Result is the value returned by the last statement in the code block. When evaluating the code block in a session (see @ref{Environment of a Code Block}), Org passes the code to an interpreter running as an interactive Emacs inferior process. Org gets the value from the source code interpreter's last statement output. Org has to use language-specific methods to obtain the value. For example, from the variable @code{_} in Ruby, and the value of @code{.Last.value} in R@. @item @samp{output} Scripting mode. Org passes the code to an external process running the interpreter. Org returns the contents of the standard output stream as text results. When using a session, Org passes the code to the interpreter running as an interactive Emacs inferior process. Org concatenates any text output from the interpreter and returns the collection as a result. @end table @anchor{Type} @subheading Type Type tells what result types to expect from the execution of the code block. Choose one of the options; they are mutually exclusive. The default behavior is to automatically determine the result type. @table @asis @item @samp{table} @itemx @samp{vector} Interpret the results as an Org table. If the result is a single value, create a table with one row and one column. Usage example: @samp{:results value table}. @cindex @samp{hlines}, header argument In-between each table row or below the table headings, sometimes results have horizontal lines, which are also known as ``hlines''. The @samp{hlines} argument with the default @samp{no} value strips such lines from the input table. For most code, this is desirable, or else those @samp{hline} symbols raise unbound variable errors. A @samp{yes} accepts such lines, as demonstrated in the following example. @example #+NAME: many-cols | a | b | c | |---+---+---| | d | e | f | |---+---+---| | g | h | i | #+NAME: no-hline #+BEGIN_SRC python :var tab=many-cols :hlines no return tab #+END_SRC #+RESULTS: no-hline | a | b | c | | d | e | f | | g | h | i | #+NAME: hlines #+BEGIN_SRC python :var tab=many-cols :hlines yes return tab #+END_SRC #+RESULTS: hlines | a | b | c | |---+---+---| | d | e | f | |---+---+---| | g | h | i | @end example @item @samp{list} Interpret the results as an Org list. If the result is a single value, create a list of one element. @item @samp{scalar} @itemx @samp{verbatim} Interpret literally and insert as quoted text. Do not create a table. Usage example: @samp{:results value verbatim}. @item @samp{file} Interpret as a filename. Save the results of execution of the code block to that file, then insert a link to it. You can control both the filename and the description associated to the link. @cindex @samp{file}, header argument @cindex @samp{output-dir}, header argument Org first tries to generate the filename from the value of the @samp{file} header argument and the directory specified using the @samp{output-dir} header arguments. If @samp{output-dir} is not specified, Org assumes it is the current directory. @example #+BEGIN_SRC asymptote :results value file :file circle.pdf :output-dir img/ size(2cm); draw(unitcircle); #+END_SRC @end example @cindex @samp{file-ext}, header argument If @samp{file} header argument is missing, Org generates the base name of the output file from the name of the code block, and its extension from the @samp{file-ext} header argument. In that case, both the name and the extension are mandatory. @example #+name: circle #+BEGIN_SRC asymptote :results value file :file-ext pdf size(2cm); draw(unitcircle); #+END_SRC @end example @cindex @samp{file-desc}, header argument The @samp{file-desc} header argument defines the description (see @ref{Link Format}) for the link. If @samp{file-desc} is present but has no value, the @samp{file} value is used as the link description. When this argument is not present, the description is omitted. @cindex @samp{sep}, header argument By default, Org assumes that a table written to a file has TAB-delimited output. You can choose a different separator with the @samp{sep} header argument. @cindex @samp{file-mode}, header argument The @samp{file-mode} header argument defines the file permissions. To make it executable, use @samp{:file-mode (identity #o755)}. @example #+BEGIN_SRC shell :results file :file script.sh :file-mode (identity #o755) echo "#!/bin/bash" echo "echo Hello World" #+END_SRC @end example @end table @anchor{Format} @subheading Format Format pertains to the type of the result returned by the code block. Choose one of the options; they are mutually exclusive. The default follows from the type specified above. @table @asis @item @samp{code} Result enclosed in a code block. Useful for parsing. Usage example: @samp{:results value code}. @item @samp{drawer} Result wrapped in a @samp{RESULTS} drawer. Useful for containing @samp{raw} or @samp{org} results for later scripting and automated processing. Usage example: @samp{:results value drawer}. @item @samp{html} Results enclosed in a @samp{BEGIN_EXPORT html} block. Usage example: @samp{:results value html}. @item @samp{latex} Results enclosed in a @samp{BEGIN_EXPORT latex} block. Usage example: @samp{:results value latex}. @item @samp{link} @itemx @samp{graphics} When used along with @samp{file} type, the result is a link to the file specified in @samp{:file} header argument. However, unlike plain @samp{file} type, nothing is written to the disk. The block is used for its side-effects only, as in the following example: @example #+begin_src shell :results file link :file "download.tar.gz" wget -c "http://example.com/download.tar.gz" #+end_src @end example @item @samp{org} Results enclosed in a @samp{BEGIN_SRC org} block. For comma-escape, either @kbd{@key{TAB}} in the block, or export the file. Usage example: @samp{:results value org}. @item @samp{pp} Result converted to pretty-print source code. Enclosed in a code block. Languages supported: Emacs Lisp, Python, and Ruby. Usage example: @samp{:results value pp}. @item @samp{raw} Interpreted as raw Org mode. Inserted directly into the buffer. Aligned if it is a table. Usage example: @samp{:results value raw}. @end table @cindex @samp{wrap}, header argument The @samp{wrap} header argument unconditionally marks the results block by appending strings to @samp{#+BEGIN_} and @samp{#+END_}. If no string is specified, Org wraps the results in a @samp{#+BEGIN_results} @dots{} @samp{#+END_results} block. It takes precedent over the @samp{results} value listed above. E.g., @example #+BEGIN_SRC emacs-lisp :results html :wrap EXPORT markdown "Welcome back to the 90's" #+END_SRC #+RESULTS: #+BEGIN_EXPORT markdown Welcome back to the 90's #+END_EXPORT @end example @anchor{Handling} @subheading Handling Handling options after collecting the results. @table @asis @item @samp{silent} Do not insert results in the Org mode buffer, but echo them in the minibuffer. Usage example: @samp{:results output silent}. @item @samp{replace} Default. Insert results in the Org buffer. Remove previous results. Usage example: @samp{:results output replace}. @item @samp{append} Append results to the Org buffer. Latest results are at the bottom. Does not remove previous results. Usage example: @samp{:results output append}. @item @samp{prepend} Prepend results to the Org buffer. Latest results are at the top. Does not remove previous results. Usage example: @samp{:results output prepend}. @end table @anchor{Post-processing} @subheading Post-processing @cindex @samp{post}, header argument @cindex @samp{*this*}, in @samp{post} header argument The @samp{post} header argument is for post-processing results from block evaluation. When @samp{post} has any value, Org binds the results to @code{*this*} variable for easy passing to @samp{var} header argument specifications (see @ref{Environment of a Code Block}). That makes results available to other code blocks, or even for direct Emacs Lisp code execution. The following two examples illustrate @samp{post} header argument in action. The first one shows how to attach an @samp{ATTR_LATEX} keyword using @samp{post}. @example #+NAME: attr_wrap #+BEGIN_SRC sh :var data="" :var width="\\textwidth" :results output echo "#+ATTR_LATEX: :width $width" echo "$data" #+END_SRC #+HEADER: :file /tmp/it.png #+BEGIN_SRC dot :post attr_wrap(width="5cm", data=*this*) :results drawer digraph@{ a -> b; b -> c; c -> a; @} #+end_src #+RESULTS: :RESULTS: #+ATTR_LATEX :width 5cm [[file:/tmp/it.png]] :END: @end example The second example shows use of @samp{colnames} header argument in @samp{post} to pass data between code blocks. @example #+NAME: round-tbl #+BEGIN_SRC emacs-lisp :var tbl="" fmt="%.3f" (mapcar (lambda (row) (mapcar (lambda (cell) (if (numberp cell) (format fmt cell) cell)) row)) tbl) #+end_src #+BEGIN_SRC R :colnames yes :post round-tbl[:colnames yes](*this*) set.seed(42) data.frame(foo=rnorm(1)) #+END_SRC #+RESULTS: | foo | |-------| | 1.371 | @end example @node Exporting Code Blocks @section Exporting Code Blocks @cindex code block, exporting @cindex source code, exporting It is possible to export the @emph{code} of code blocks, the @emph{results} of code block evaluation, @emph{both} the code and the results of code block evaluation, or @emph{none}. Org defaults to exporting @emph{code} for most languages. For some languages, such as ditaa, Org defaults to @emph{results}. To export just the body of code blocks, see @ref{Literal Examples}. To selectively export sub-trees of an Org document, see @ref{Exporting}. @cindex @samp{exports}, header argument The @samp{exports} header argument is to specify if that part of the Org file is exported to, say, HTML or @LaTeX{} formats. @table @asis @item @samp{code} The default. The body of code is included into the exported file. Example: @samp{:exports code}. @item @samp{results} The results of evaluation of the code is included in the exported file. Example: @samp{:exports results}. @item @samp{both} Both the code and results of evaluation are included in the exported file. Example: @samp{:exports both}. @item @samp{none} Neither the code nor the results of evaluation is included in the exported file. Whether the code is evaluated at all depends on other options. Example: @samp{:exports none}. @end table @vindex org-export-use-babel To stop Org from evaluating code blocks to speed exports, use the header argument @samp{:eval never-export} (see @ref{Evaluating Code Blocks}). To stop Org from evaluating code blocks for greater security, set the @code{org-export-use-babel} variable to @code{nil}, but understand that header arguments will have no effect. Turning off evaluation comes in handy when batch processing. For example, markup languages for wikis, which have a high risk of untrusted code. Stopping code block evaluation also stops evaluation of all header arguments of the code block. This may not be desirable in some circumstances. So during export, to allow evaluation of just the header arguments but not any code evaluation in the source block, set @samp{:eval never-export} (see @ref{Evaluating Code Blocks}). Org never evaluates code blocks in commented sub-trees when exporting (see @ref{Comment Lines}). On the other hand, Org does evaluate code blocks in sub-trees excluded from export (see @ref{Export Settings}). @node Extracting Source Code @section Extracting Source Code @cindex tangling @cindex source code, extracting @cindex code block, extracting source code Extracting source code from code blocks is a basic task in literate programming. Org has features to make this easy. In literate programming parlance, documents on creation are @emph{woven} with code and documentation, and on export, the code is tangled for execution by a computer. Org facilitates weaving and tangling for producing, maintaining, sharing, and exporting literate programming documents. Org provides extensive customization options for extracting source code. When Org tangles code blocks, it expands, merges, and transforms them. Then Org recomposes them into one or more separate files, as configured through the options. During this tangling process, Org expands variables in the source code, and resolves any noweb style references (see @ref{Noweb Reference Syntax}). @anchor{Header arguments} @subheading Header arguments @cindex @samp{tangle}, header argument The @samp{tangle} header argument specifies if the code block is exported to source file(s). @table @asis @item @samp{yes} Export the code block to source file. The file name for the source file is derived from the name of the Org file, and the file extension is derived from the source code language identifier. Example: @samp{:tangle yes}. @item @samp{no} The default. Do not extract the code in a source code file. Example: @samp{:tangle no}. @item @var{FILENAME} Export the code block to source file whose file name is derived from any string passed to the @samp{tangle} header argument. Org derives the file name as being relative to the directory of the Org file's location. Example: @samp{:tangle FILENAME}. @end table @cindex @samp{mkdirp}, header argument The @samp{mkdirp} header argument creates parent directories for tangled files if the directory does not exist. A @samp{yes} value enables directory creation whereas @samp{no} inhibits it. @cindex @samp{comments}, header argument The @samp{comments} header argument controls inserting comments into tangled files. These are above and beyond whatever comments may already exist in the code block. @table @asis @item @samp{no} The default. Do not insert any extra comments during tangling. @item @samp{link} Wrap the code block in comments. Include links pointing back to the place in the Org file from where the code was tangled. @item @samp{yes} Kept for backward compatibility; same as @samp{link}. @item @samp{org} Nearest headline text from Org file is inserted as comment. The exact text that is inserted is picked from the leading context of the source block. @item @samp{both} Includes both @samp{link} and @samp{org} options. @item @samp{noweb} Includes @samp{link} option, expands noweb references (see @ref{Noweb Reference Syntax}), and wraps them in link comments inside the body of the code block. @end table @cindex @samp{padline}, header argument The @samp{padline} header argument controls insertion of newlines to pad source code in the tangled file. @table @asis @item @samp{yes} Default. Insert a newline before and after each code block in the tangled file. @item @samp{no} Do not insert newlines to pad the tangled code blocks. @end table @cindex @samp{shebang}, header argument The @samp{shebang} header argument can turn results into executable script files. By setting it to a string value---for example, @samp{:shebang "#!/bin/bash"}---Org inserts that string as the first line of the tangled file that the code block is extracted to. Org then turns on the tangled file's executable permission. @cindex @samp{tangle-mode}, header argument The @samp{tangle-mode} header argument specifies what permissions to set for tangled files by @code{set-file-modes}. For example, to make a read-only tangled file, use @samp{:tangle-mode (identity #o444)}. To make it executable, use @samp{:tangle-mode (identity #o755)}. It also overrides executable permission granted by @samp{shebang}. When multiple source code blocks tangle to a single file with different and conflicting @samp{tangle-mode} header arguments, Org's behavior is undefined. @cindex @samp{no-expand}, header argument By default Org expands code blocks during tangling. The @samp{no-expand} header argument turns off such expansions. Note that one side-effect of expansion by @code{org-babel-expand-src-block} also assigns values (see @ref{Environment of a Code Block}) to variables. Expansions also replace noweb references with their targets (see @ref{Noweb Reference Syntax}). Some of these expansions may cause premature assignment, hence this option. This option makes a difference only for tangling. It has no effect when exporting since code blocks for execution have to be expanded anyway. @anchor{Functions} @subheading Functions @table @asis @item @code{org-babel-tangle} @findex org-babel-tangle @kindex C-c C-v t Tangle the current file. Bound to @kbd{C-c C-v t}. With prefix argument only tangle the current code block. @item @code{org-babel-tangle-file} @findex org-babel-tangle-file @kindex C-c C-v f Choose a file to tangle. Bound to @kbd{C-c C-v f}. @end table @anchor{Hooks (1)} @subheading Hooks @table @asis @item @code{org-babel-post-tangle-hook} @vindex org-babel-post-tangle-hook This hook is run from within code files tangled by @code{org-babel-tangle}, making it suitable for post-processing, compilation, and evaluation of code in the tangled files. @end table @anchor{Jumping between code and Org} @subheading Jumping between code and Org @findex org-babel-tangle-jump-to-org Debuggers normally link errors and messages back to the source code. But for tangled files, we want to link back to the Org file, not to the tangled source file. To make this extra jump, Org uses @code{org-babel-tangle-jump-to-org} function with two additional source code block header arguments: @enumerate @item Set @samp{padline} to true---this is the default setting. @item Set @samp{comments} to @samp{link}, which makes Org insert links to the Org file. @end enumerate @node Languages @section Languages @cindex babel, languages @cindex source code, languages @cindex code block, languages Code blocks in the following languages are supported. @multitable @columnfractions 0.25 0.25 0.25 0.20 @headitem Language @tab Identifier @tab Language @tab Identifier @item Asymptote @tab @samp{asymptote} @tab Lisp @tab @samp{lisp} @item Awk @tab @samp{awk} @tab Lua @tab @samp{lua} @item C @tab @samp{C} @tab MATLAB @tab @samp{matlab} @item C++ @tab @samp{C++}@footnote{C++ language is handled in @samp{ob-C.el}. Even though the identifier for such source blocks is @samp{C++}, you activate it by loading the C language.} @tab Mscgen @tab @samp{mscgen} @item Clojure @tab @samp{clojure} @tab Objective Caml @tab @samp{ocaml} @item CSS @tab @samp{css} @tab Octave @tab @samp{octave} @item D @tab @samp{D}@footnote{D language is handled in @samp{ob-C.el}. Even though the identifier for such source blocks is @samp{D}, you activate it by loading the C language.} @tab Org mode @tab @samp{org} @item ditaa @tab @samp{ditaa} @tab Oz @tab @samp{oz} @item Emacs Calc @tab @samp{calc} @tab Perl @tab @samp{perl} @item Emacs Lisp @tab @samp{emacs-lisp} @tab Plantuml @tab @samp{plantuml} @item Eshell @tab @samp{eshell} @tab Processing.js @tab @samp{processing} @item Fortran @tab @samp{fortran} @tab Python @tab @samp{python} @item Gnuplot @tab @samp{gnuplot} @tab R @tab @samp{R} @item GNU Screen @tab @samp{screen} @tab Ruby @tab @samp{ruby} @item Graphviz @tab @samp{dot} @tab Sass @tab @samp{sass} @item Haskell @tab @samp{haskell} @tab Scheme @tab @samp{scheme} @item Java @tab @samp{java} @tab Sed @tab @samp{sed} @item Javascript @tab @samp{js} @tab shell @tab @samp{sh} @item @LaTeX{} @tab @samp{latex} @tab SQL @tab @samp{sql} @item Ledger @tab @samp{ledger} @tab SQLite @tab @samp{sqlite} @item Lilypond @tab @samp{lilypond} @tab Vala @tab @samp{vala} @end multitable Additional documentation for some languages is at @uref{https://orgmode.org/worg/org-contrib/babel/languages.html}. @vindex org-babel-load-languages By default, only Emacs Lisp is enabled for evaluation. To enable or disable other languages, customize the @code{org-babel-load-languages} variable either through the Emacs customization interface, or by adding code to the init file as shown next. In this example, evaluation is disabled for Emacs Lisp, and enabled for R@. @lisp (org-babel-do-load-languages 'org-babel-load-languages '((emacs-lisp . nil) (R . t))) @end lisp Note that this is not the only way to enable a language. Org also enables languages when loaded with @code{require} statement. For example, the following enables execution of Clojure code blocks: @lisp (require 'ob-clojure) @end lisp @node Editing Source Code @section Editing Source Code @cindex code block, editing @cindex source code, editing @kindex C-c ' Use @kbd{C-c '} to edit the current code block. It opens a new major mode edit buffer containing the body of the source code block, ready for any edits. Use @kbd{C-c '} again to close the buffer and return to the Org buffer. @kindex C-x C-s @vindex org-edit-src-auto-save-idle-delay @cindex auto-save, in code block editing @kbd{C-x C-s} saves the buffer and updates the contents of the Org buffer. Set @code{org-edit-src-auto-save-idle-delay} to save the base buffer after a certain idle delay time. Set @code{org-edit-src-turn-on-auto-save} to auto-save this buffer into a separate file using Auto-save mode. While editing the source code in the major mode, the Org Src minor mode remains active. It provides these customization variables as described below. For even more variables, look in the customization group @code{org-edit-structure}. @table @asis @item @code{org-src-lang-modes} @vindex org-src-lang-modes If an Emacs major-mode named @code{-mode} exists, where @var{} is the language identifier from code block's header line, then the edit buffer uses that major mode. Use this variable to arbitrarily map language identifiers to major modes. @item @code{org-src-window-setup} @vindex org-src-window-setup For specifying Emacs window arrangement when the new edit buffer is created. @item @code{org-src-preserve-indentation} @cindex indentation, in code blocks @vindex org-src-preserve-indentation Default is @code{nil}. Source code is indented. This indentation applies during export or tangling, and depending on the context, may alter leading spaces and tabs. When non-@code{nil}, source code is aligned with the leftmost column. No lines are modified during export or tangling, which is very useful for white-space sensitive languages, such as Python. @item @code{org-src-ask-before-returning-to-edit-buffer} @vindex org-src-ask-before-returning-to-edit-buffer When @code{nil}, Org returns to the edit buffer without further prompts. The default prompts for a confirmation. @end table @vindex org-src-fontify-natively @vindex org-src-block-faces Set @code{org-src-fontify-natively} to non-@code{nil} to turn on native code fontification in the @emph{Org} buffer. Fontification of code blocks can give visual separation of text and code on the display page. To further customize the appearance of @code{org-block} for specific languages, customize @code{org-src-block-faces}. The following example shades the background of regular blocks, and colors source blocks only for Python and Emacs Lisp languages. @lisp (require 'color) (set-face-attribute 'org-block nil :background (color-darken-name (face-attribute 'default :background) 3)) (setq org-src-block-faces '(("emacs-lisp" (:background "#EEE2FF")) ("python" (:background "#E5FFB8")))) @end lisp @node Noweb Reference Syntax @section Noweb Reference Syntax @cindex code block, noweb reference @cindex syntax, noweb @cindex source code, noweb reference @cindex @samp{noweb-ref}, header argument Source code blocks can include references to other source code blocks, using a noweb@footnote{For noweb literate programming details, see @uref{http://www.cs.tufts.edu/~nr/noweb/}.} style syntax: @example <> @end example @noindent where @var{CODE-BLOCK-ID} refers to either the @samp{NAME} of a single source code block, or a collection of one or more source code blocks sharing the same @samp{noweb-ref} header argument (see @ref{Using Header Arguments}). Org can replace such references with the source code of the block or blocks being referenced, or, in the case of a single source code block named with @samp{NAME}, with the results of an evaluation of that block. @cindex @samp{noweb}, header argument The @samp{noweb} header argument controls expansion of noweb syntax references. Expansions occur when source code blocks are evaluated, tangled, or exported. @table @asis @item @samp{no} Default. No expansion of noweb syntax references in the body of the code when evaluating, tangling, or exporting. @item @samp{yes} Expansion of noweb syntax references in the body of the code block when evaluating, tangling, or exporting. @item @samp{tangle} Expansion of noweb syntax references in the body of the code block when tangling. No expansion when evaluating or exporting. @item @samp{no-export} Expansion of noweb syntax references in the body of the code block when evaluating or tangling. No expansion when exporting. @item @samp{strip-export} Expansion of noweb syntax references in the body of the code block when expanding prior to evaluating or tangling. Removes noweb syntax references when exporting. @item @samp{eval} Expansion of noweb syntax references in the body of the code block only before evaluating. @end table In the most simple case, the contents of a single source block is inserted within other blocks. Thus, in following example, @example #+NAME: initialization #+BEGIN_SRC emacs-lisp (setq sentence "Never a foot too far, even.") #+END_SRC #+BEGIN_SRC emacs-lisp :noweb yes <> (reverse sentence) #+END_SRC @end example @noindent the second code block is expanded as @example #+BEGIN_SRC emacs-lisp :noweb yes (setq sentence "Never a foot too far, even.") (reverse sentence) #+END_SRC @end example You may also include the contents of multiple blocks sharing a common @samp{noweb-ref} header argument, which can be set at the file, sub-tree, or code block level. In the example Org file shown next, the body of the source code in each block is extracted for concatenation to a pure code file when tangled. @example #+BEGIN_SRC sh :tangle yes :noweb yes :shebang #!/bin/sh <> #+END_SRC * the mount point of the fullest disk :PROPERTIES: :header-args: :noweb-ref fullest-disk :END: ** query all mounted disks #+BEGIN_SRC sh df \ #+END_SRC ** strip the header row #+BEGIN_SRC sh |sed '1d' \ #+END_SRC ** output mount point of fullest disk #+BEGIN_SRC sh |awk '@{if (u < +$5) @{u = +$5; m = $6@}@} END @{print m@}' #+END_SRC @end example @cindex @samp{noweb-sep}, header argument By default a newline separates each noweb reference concatenation. To use a different separator, edit the @samp{noweb-sep} header argument. Alternatively, Org can include the results of evaluation of a single code block rather than its body. Evaluation occurs when parentheses, possibly including arguments, are appended to the code block name, as shown below. @example <> @end example Note that in this case, a code block name set by @samp{NAME} keyword is required; the reference set by @samp{noweb-ref} will not work when evaluation is desired. Here is an example that demonstrates how the exported content changes when noweb style references are used with parentheses versus without. Given: @example #+NAME: some-code #+BEGIN_SRC python :var num=0 :results output :exports none print(num*10) #+END_SRC @end example @noindent this code block: @example #+BEGIN_SRC text :noweb yes <> #+END_SRC @end example @noindent expands to: @example print(num*10) @end example Below, a similar noweb style reference is used, but with parentheses, while setting a variable @samp{num} to 10: @example #+BEGIN_SRC text :noweb yes <> #+END_SRC @end example @noindent Note that the expansion now contains the results of the code block @samp{some-code}, not the code block itself: @example 100 @end example Noweb insertions honor prefix characters that appear before the noweb syntax reference. This behavior is illustrated in the following example. Because the @samp{<>} noweb reference appears behind the SQL comment syntax, each line of the expanded noweb reference is commented. With: @example #+NAME: example #+BEGIN_SRC text this is the multi-line body of example #+END_SRC @end example @noindent this code block: @example #+BEGIN_SRC sql :noweb yes ---<> #+END_SRC @end example @noindent expands to: @example #+BEGIN_SRC sql :noweb yes ---this is the ---multi-line body of example #+END_SRC @end example Since this change does not affect noweb replacement text without newlines in them, inline noweb references are acceptable. This feature can also be used for management of indentation in exported code snippets. With: @example #+NAME: if-true #+BEGIN_SRC python :exports none print('do things when true') #+end_src #+name: if-false #+begin_src python :exports none print('do things when false') #+end_src @end example @noindent this code block: @example #+begin_src python :noweb yes :results output if true: <> else: <> #+end_src @end example @noindent expands to: @example if true: print('do things when true') else: print('do things when false') @end example When in doubt about the outcome of a source code block expansion, you can preview the results with the following command: @table @asis @item @kbd{C-c C-v v} or @kbd{C-c C-v C-v} (@code{org-babel-expand-src-block}) @findex org-babel-expand-src-block @kindex C-c C-v v @kindex C-c C-v C-v Expand the current source code block according to its header arguments and pop open the results in a preview buffer. @end table @node Library of Babel @section Library of Babel @cindex babel, library of @cindex source code, library @cindex code block, library The ``Library of Babel'' is a collection of code blocks. Like a function library, these code blocks can be called from other Org files. A collection of useful code blocks is available on @uref{https://orgmode.org/worg/library-of-babel.html, Worg}. For remote code block evaluation syntax, see @ref{Evaluating Code Blocks}. @kindex C-c C-v i @findex org-babel-lob-ingest For any user to add code to the library, first save the code in regular code blocks of an Org file, and then load the Org file with @code{org-babel-lob-ingest}, which is bound to @kbd{C-c C-v i}. @node Key bindings and Useful Functions @section Key bindings and Useful Functions @cindex code block, key bindings Many common Org mode key sequences are re-bound depending on the context. Active key bindings in code blocks: @kindex C-c C-c @findex org-babel-execute-src-block @kindex C-c C-o @findex org-babel-open-src-block-result @kindex M-UP @findex org-babel-load-in-session @kindex M-DOWN @findex org-babel-pop-to-session @multitable @columnfractions 0.2 0.55 @headitem Key binding @tab Function @item @kbd{C-c C-c} @tab @code{org-babel-execute-src-block} @item @kbd{C-c C-o} @tab @code{org-babel-open-src-block-result} @item @kbd{M-@key{UP}} @tab @code{org-babel-load-in-session} @item @kbd{M-@key{DOWN}} @tab @code{org-babel-pop-to-session} @end multitable Active key bindings in Org mode buffer: @kindex C-c C-v p @kindex C-c C-v C-p @kindex C-c C-v n @kindex C-c C-v C-n @kindex C-c C-v e @kindex C-c C-v C-e @kindex C-c C-v o @kindex C-c C-v C-o @kindex C-c C-v v @kindex C-c C-v C-v @kindex C-c C-v u @kindex C-c C-v C-u @kindex C-c C-v g @kindex C-c C-v C-g @kindex C-c C-v r @kindex C-c C-v C-r @kindex C-c C-v b @kindex C-c C-v C-b @kindex C-c C-v s @kindex C-c C-v C-s @kindex C-c C-v d @kindex C-c C-v C-d @kindex C-c C-v t @kindex C-c C-v C-t @kindex C-c C-v f @kindex C-c C-v C-f @kindex C-c C-v c @kindex C-c C-v C-c @kindex C-c C-v j @kindex C-c C-v C-j @kindex C-c C-v l @kindex C-c C-v C-l @kindex C-c C-v i @kindex C-c C-v C-i @kindex C-c C-v I @kindex C-c C-v C-I @kindex C-c C-v z @kindex C-c C-v C-z @kindex C-c C-v a @kindex C-c C-v C-a @kindex C-c C-v h @kindex C-c C-v C-h @kindex C-c C-v x @kindex C-c C-v C-x @findex org-babel-previous-src-block @findex org-babel-next-src-block @findex org-babel-execute-maybe @findex org-babel-open-src-block-result @findex org-babel-expand-src-block @findex org-babel-goto-src-block-head @findex org-babel-goto-named-src-block @findex org-babel-goto-named-result @findex org-babel-execute-buffer @findex org-babel-execute-subtree @findex org-babel-demarcate-block @findex org-babel-tangle @findex org-babel-tangle-file @findex org-babel-check-src-block @findex org-babel-insert-header-arg @findex org-babel-load-in-session @findex org-babel-lob-ingest @findex org-babel-view-src-block-info @findex org-babel-switch-to-session-with-code @findex org-babel-sha1-hash @findex org-babel-describe-bindings @findex org-babel-do-key-sequence-in-edit-buffer @multitable @columnfractions 0.45 0.55 @headitem Key binding @tab Function @item @kbd{C-c C-v p} or @kbd{C-c C-v C-p} @tab @code{org-babel-previous-src-block} @item @kbd{C-c C-v n} or @kbd{C-c C-v C-n} @tab @code{org-babel-next-src-block} @item @kbd{C-c C-v e} or @kbd{C-c C-v C-e} @tab @code{org-babel-execute-maybe} @item @kbd{C-c C-v o} or @kbd{C-c C-v C-o} @tab @code{org-babel-open-src-block-result} @item @kbd{C-c C-v v} or @kbd{C-c C-v C-v} @tab @code{org-babel-expand-src-block} @item @kbd{C-c C-v u} or @kbd{C-c C-v C-u} @tab @code{org-babel-goto-src-block-head} @item @kbd{C-c C-v g} or @kbd{C-c C-v C-g} @tab @code{org-babel-goto-named-src-block} @item @kbd{C-c C-v r} or @kbd{C-c C-v C-r} @tab @code{org-babel-goto-named-result} @item @kbd{C-c C-v b} or @kbd{C-c C-v C-b} @tab @code{org-babel-execute-buffer} @item @kbd{C-c C-v s} or @kbd{C-c C-v C-s} @tab @code{org-babel-execute-subtree} @item @kbd{C-c C-v d} or @kbd{C-c C-v C-d} @tab @code{org-babel-demarcate-block} @item @kbd{C-c C-v t} or @kbd{C-c C-v C-t} @tab @code{org-babel-tangle} @item @kbd{C-c C-v f} or @kbd{C-c C-v C-f} @tab @code{org-babel-tangle-file} @item @kbd{C-c C-v c} or @kbd{C-c C-v C-c} @tab @code{org-babel-check-src-block} @item @kbd{C-c C-v j} or @kbd{C-c C-v C-j} @tab @code{org-babel-insert-header-arg} @item @kbd{C-c C-v l} or @kbd{C-c C-v C-l} @tab @code{org-babel-load-in-session} @item @kbd{C-c C-v i} or @kbd{C-c C-v C-i} @tab @code{org-babel-lob-ingest} @item @kbd{C-c C-v I} or @kbd{C-c C-v C-I} @tab @code{org-babel-view-src-block-info} @item @kbd{C-c C-v z} or @kbd{C-c C-v C-z} @tab @code{org-babel-switch-to-session-with-code} @item @kbd{C-c C-v a} or @kbd{C-c C-v C-a} @tab @code{org-babel-sha1-hash} @item @kbd{C-c C-v h} or @kbd{C-c C-v C-h} @tab @code{org-babel-describe-bindings} @item @kbd{C-c C-v x} or @kbd{C-c C-v C-x} @tab @code{org-babel-do-key-sequence-in-edit-buffer} @end multitable @node Batch Execution @section Batch Execution @cindex code block, batch execution @cindex source code, batch execution Org mode features, including working with source code facilities can be invoked from the command line. This enables building shell scripts for batch processing, running automated system tasks, and expanding Org mode's usefulness. The sample script shows batch processing of multiple files using @code{org-babel-tangle}. @example #!/bin/sh # Tangle files with Org mode # emacs -Q --batch --eval " (progn (require 'ob-tangle) (dolist (file command-line-args-left) (with-current-buffer (find-file-noselect file) (org-babel-tangle)))) " "$@@" @end example @node Miscellaneous @chapter Miscellaneous @menu * Completion:: @kbd{M-@key{TAB}} guesses completions. * Structure Templates:: Quick insertion of structural elements. * Speed Keys:: Electric commands at the beginning of a headline. * Clean View:: Getting rid of leading stars in the outline. * Execute commands in the active region:: Execute commands on multiple items in Org or agenda view. * Dynamic Headline Numbering:: Display and update outline numbering. * The Very Busy @kbd{C-c C-c} Key:: When in doubt, press @kbd{C-c C-c}. * In-buffer Settings:: Overview of keywords. * Org Syntax:: Formal description of Org's syntax. * Documentation Access:: Read documentation about current syntax. * Escape Character:: Prevent Org from interpreting your writing. * Code Evaluation Security:: Org files evaluate in-line code. * Interaction:: With other Emacs packages. * TTY Keys:: Using Org on a tty. * Protocols:: External access to Emacs and Org. * Org Crypt:: Encrypting Org files. * Org Mobile:: Viewing and capture on a mobile device. @end menu @node Completion @section Completion @cindex completion, of @TeX{} symbols @cindex completion, of TODO keywords @cindex completion, of dictionary words @cindex completion, of option keywords @cindex completion, of tags @cindex completion, of property keys @cindex completion, of link abbreviations @cindex @TeX{} symbol completion @cindex TODO keywords completion @cindex dictionary word completion @cindex option keyword completion @cindex tag completion @cindex link abbreviations, completion of Org has in-buffer completions. Unlike minibuffer completions, which are useful for quick command interactions, Org's in-buffer completions are more suitable for content creation in Org documents. Type one or more letters and invoke the hot key to complete the text in-place. Depending on the context and the keys, Org offers different types of completions. No minibuffer is involved. Such mode-specific hot keys have become an integral part of Emacs and Org provides several shortcuts. @table @asis @item @kbd{M-@key{TAB}} @kindex M-TAB Complete word at point. @itemize @item At the beginning of an empty headline, complete TODO keywords. @item After @samp{\}, complete @TeX{} symbols supported by the exporter. @item After @samp{:} in a headline, complete tags. Org deduces the list of tags from the @samp{TAGS} in-buffer option (see @ref{Setting Tags}), the variable @code{org-tag-alist}, or from all tags used in the current buffer. @item After @samp{:} and not in a headline, complete property keys. The list of keys is constructed dynamically from all keys used in the current buffer. @item After @samp{[[}, complete link abbreviations (see @ref{Link Abbreviations}). @item After @samp{[[*}, complete headlines in the current buffer so that they can be used in search links like: @samp{[[*find this headline]]} @item After @samp{#+}, complete the special keywords like @samp{TYP_TODO} or file-specific @samp{OPTIONS}. After option keyword is complete, pressing @kbd{M-@key{TAB}} again inserts example settings for this keyword. @item After @samp{STARTUP} keyword, complete startup items. @item When point is anywhere else, complete dictionary words using Ispell. @end itemize @end table @node Structure Templates @section Structure Templates @cindex template insertion @cindex insertion, of templates With just a few keystrokes, it is possible to insert empty structural blocks, such as @samp{#+BEGIN_SRC} @dots{} @samp{#+END_SRC}, or to wrap existing text in such a block. @table @asis @item @kbd{C-c C-,} (@code{org-insert-structure-template}) @findex org-insert-structure-template @kindex C-c C-, Prompt for a type of block structure, and insert the block at point. If the region is active, it is wrapped in the block. First prompts the user for keys, which are used to look up a structure type from the variable below. If the key is @kbd{@key{TAB}}, @kbd{@key{RET}}, or @kbd{@key{SPC}}, the user is prompted to enter a block type. @end table @vindex org-structure-template-alist Available structure types are defined in @code{org-structure-template-alist}, see the docstring for adding or changing values. @cindex Tempo @cindex template expansion @cindex insertion, of templates @vindex org-tempo-keywords-alist Org Tempo expands snippets to structures defined in @code{org-structure-template-alist} and @code{org-tempo-keywords-alist}. For example, @kbd{< s @key{TAB}} creates a code block. Enable it by customizing @code{org-modules} or add @samp{(require 'org-tempo)} to your Emacs init file@footnote{For more information, please refer to the commentary section in @samp{org-tempo.el}.}. @multitable @columnfractions 0.1 0.9 @item @kbd{a} @tab @samp{#+BEGIN_EXPORT ascii} @dots{} @samp{#+END_EXPORT} @item @kbd{c} @tab @samp{#+BEGIN_CENTER} @dots{} @samp{#+END_CENTER} @item @kbd{C} @tab @samp{#+BEGIN_COMMENT} @dots{} @samp{#+END_COMMENT} @item @kbd{e} @tab @samp{#+BEGIN_EXAMPLE} @dots{} @samp{#+END_EXAMPLE} @item @kbd{E} @tab @samp{#+BEGIN_EXPORT} @dots{} @samp{#+END_EXPORT} @item @kbd{h} @tab @samp{#+BEGIN_EXPORT html} @dots{} @samp{#+END_EXPORT} @item @kbd{l} @tab @samp{#+BEGIN_EXPORT latex} @dots{} @samp{#+END_EXPORT} @item @kbd{q} @tab @samp{#+BEGIN_QUOTE} @dots{} @samp{#+END_QUOTE} @item @kbd{s} @tab @samp{#+BEGIN_SRC} @dots{} @samp{#+END_SRC} @item @kbd{v} @tab @samp{#+BEGIN_VERSE} @dots{} @samp{#+END_VERSE} @end multitable @node Speed Keys @section Speed Keys @cindex speed keys Single keystrokes can execute custom commands in an Org file when point is on a headline. Without the extra burden of a meta or modifier key, Speed Keys can speed navigation or execute custom commands. Besides faster navigation, Speed Keys may come in handy on small mobile devices that do not have full keyboards. Speed Keys may also work on TTY devices known for their problems when entering Emacs key chords. @vindex org-use-speed-commands By default, Org has Speed Keys disabled. To activate Speed Keys, set the variable @code{org-use-speed-commands} to a non-@code{nil} value. To trigger a Speed Key, point must be at the beginning of an Org headline, before any of the stars. @vindex org-speed-commands-user @findex org-speed-command-help Org comes with a pre-defined list of Speed Keys. To add or modify Speed Keys, customize the variable, @code{org-speed-commands-user}. For more details, see the variable's docstring. With Speed Keys activated, @kbd{M-x org-speed-command-help}, or @kbd{?} when point is at the beginning of an Org headline, shows currently active Speed Keys, including the user-defined ones. @node Clean View @section A Cleaner Outline View @cindex hiding leading stars @cindex dynamic indentation @cindex odd-levels-only outlines @cindex clean outline view Org's outline with stars and no indents can look cluttered for short documents. For @emph{book-like} long documents, the effect is not as noticeable. Org provides an alternate stars and indentation scheme, as shown on the right in the following table. It displays only one star and indents text to line up with the heading: @example * Top level headline | * Top level headline ** Second level | * Second level *** Third level | * Third level some text | some text *** Third level | * Third level more text | more text * Another top level headline | * Another top level headline @end example Org can achieve this in two ways, (1) by just displaying the buffer in this way without changing it, or (2) by actually indenting every line in the desired amount with hard spaces and hiding leading stars. @menu * Org Indent Mode:: * Hard indentation:: @end menu @node Org Indent Mode @subsection Org Indent Mode @cindex Indent mode @findex org-indent-mode To display the buffer in the indented view, activate Org Indent minor mode, using @kbd{M-x org-indent-mode}. Text lines that are not headlines are prefixed with virtual spaces to vertically align with the headline text@footnote{Org Indent mode also sets @code{wrap-prefix} correctly for indenting and wrapping long lines of headlines or text. This minor mode also handles Visual Line mode and directly applied settings through @code{word-wrap}.}. @vindex org-indent-indentation-per-level To make more horizontal space, the headlines are shifted by two characters. Configure @code{org-indent-indentation-per-level} variable for a different number. @vindex org-indent-mode-turns-on-hiding-stars @vindex org-indent-mode-turns-off-org-adapt-indentation By default, Org Indent mode turns off @code{org-adapt-indentation} and does hide leading stars by locally setting @code{org-hide-leading-stars} to @code{t}: only one star on each headline is visible, the rest are masked with the same font color as the background. If you want to customize this default behavior, see @code{org-indent-mode-turns-on-hiding-stars} and @code{org-indent-mode-turns-off-org-adapt-indentation}. @vindex org-startup-indented To globally turn on Org Indent mode for all files, customize the variable @code{org-startup-indented}. To control it for individual files, use @samp{STARTUP} keyword as follows: @example #+STARTUP: indent #+STARTUP: noindent @end example @node Hard indentation @subsection Hard indentation It is possible to use hard spaces to achieve the indentation instead, if the bare ASCII file should have the indented look also outside Emacs@footnote{This works, but requires extra effort. Org Indent mode is more convenient for most applications.}. With Org's support, you have to indent all lines to line up with the outline headers. You would use these settings@footnote{@code{org-adapt-indentation} can also be set to @samp{'headline-data}, in which case only data lines below the headline will be indented.}: @lisp (setq org-adapt-indentation t org-hide-leading-stars t org-odd-levels-only t) @end lisp @table @asis @item @emph{Indentation of text below headlines} (@code{org-adapt-indentation}) @vindex org-adapt-indentation The first setting modifies paragraph filling, line wrapping, and structure editing commands to preserving or adapting the indentation as appropriate. @item @emph{Hiding leading stars} (@code{org-hide-leading-stars}) @vindex org-hide-leading-stars @vindex org-hide, face The second setting makes leading stars invisible by applying the face @code{org-hide} to them. For per-file preference, use these file @samp{STARTUP} options: @example #+STARTUP: hidestars #+STARTUP: showstars @end example @item @emph{Odd levels} (@code{org-odd-levels-only}) @vindex org-odd-levels-only The third setting makes Org use only odd levels, 1, 3, 5, @dots{}, in the outline to create more indentation. On a per-file level, control this with: @example #+STARTUP: odd #+STARTUP: oddeven @end example To convert a file between single and double stars layouts, use @kbd{M-x org-convert-to-odd-levels} and @kbd{M-x org-convert-to-oddeven-levels}. @end table @node Execute commands in the active region @section Execute commands in the active region @vindex org-loop-over-headlines-in-active-region When in an Org buffer and the region is active, some commands will apply to all the subtrees in the active region. For example, hitting @kbd{C-c C-s} when multiple headlines are within the active region will successively prompt you for a new schedule date and time. To disable this, set the option @code{org-loop-over-headlines-in-active-region} to non-@code{t}, activate the region and run the command normally. @vindex org-agenda-loop-over-headlines-in-active-region @code{org-agenda-loop-over-headlines-in-active-region} is the equivalent option of the agenda buffer, where you can also use @ref{Bulk remote editing selected entries, , bulk editing of selected entries}. Not all commands can loop in the active region and what subtrees or headlines are considered can be refined: see the docstrings of these options for more details. @node Dynamic Headline Numbering @section Dynamic Headline Numbering @cindex Org Num mode @cindex number headlines The Org Num minor mode, toggled with @kbd{M-x org-num-mode}, displays outline numbering on top of headlines. It also updates it automatically upon changes to the structure of the document. @vindex org-num-max-level @vindex org-num-skip-tags @vindex org-num-skip-commented @vindex org-num-skip-unnumbered By default, all headlines are numbered. You can limit numbering to specific headlines according to their level, tags, @samp{COMMENT} keyword, or @samp{UNNUMBERED} property. Set @code{org-num-max-level}, @code{org-num-skip-tags}, @code{org-num-skip-commented}, @code{org-num-skip-unnumbered}, or @code{org-num-skip-footnotes} accordingly. @vindex org-num-skip-footnotes If @code{org-num-skip-footnotes} is non-@code{nil}, footnotes sections (see @ref{Creating Footnotes}) are not numbered either. @vindex org-num-face @vindex org-num-format-function You can control how the numbering is displayed by setting @code{org-num-face} and @code{org-num-format-function}. @vindex org-startup-numerated You can also turn this mode globally for all Org files by setting the option @code{org-startup-numerated} to @samp{t}, or locally on a file by using @samp{#+startup: num}. @node The Very Busy @kbd{C-c C-c} Key @section The Very Busy @kbd{C-c C-c} Key @kindex C-c C-c @cindex @kbd{C-c C-c}, overview The @kbd{C-c C-c} key in Org serves many purposes depending on the context. It is probably the most over-worked, multi-purpose key combination in Org. Its uses are well documented throughout this manual, but here is a consolidated list for easy reference. @itemize @item If column view (see @ref{Column View}) is on, exit column view. @item If any highlights shown in the buffer from the creation of a sparse tree, or from clock display, remove such highlights. @item If point is in one of the special @samp{KEYWORD} lines, scan the buffer for these lines and update the information. Also reset the Org file cache used to temporary store the contents of URLs used as values for keywords like @samp{SETUPFILE}. @item If point is inside a table, realign the table. @item If point is on a @samp{TBLFM} keyword, re-apply the formulas to the entire table. @item If the current buffer is a capture buffer, close the note and file it. With a prefix argument, also jump to the target location after saving the note. @item If point is on a @samp{<<>>}, update radio targets and corresponding links in this buffer. @item If point is on a property line or at the start or end of a property drawer, offer property commands. @item If point is at a footnote reference, go to the corresponding definition, and @emph{vice versa}. @item If point is on a statistics cookie, update it. @item If point is in a plain list item with a checkbox, toggle the status of the checkbox. @item If point is on a numbered item in a plain list, renumber the ordered list. @item If point is on the @samp{#+BEGIN} line of a dynamic block, the block is updated. @item If point is at a timestamp, fix the day name in the timestamp. @end itemize @node In-buffer Settings @section Summary of In-Buffer Settings @cindex in-buffer settings @cindex special keywords In-buffer settings start with @samp{#+}, followed by a keyword, a colon, and then a word for each setting. Org accepts multiple settings on the same line. Org also accepts multiple lines for a keyword. This manual describes these settings throughout. A summary follows here. @cindex refresh set-up @kbd{C-c C-c} activates any changes to the in-buffer settings. Closing and reopening the Org file in Emacs also activates the changes. @table @asis @item @samp{#+ARCHIVE: %s_done::} @cindex @samp{ARCHIVE}, keyword @vindex org-archive-location Sets the archive location of the agenda file. The corresponding variable is @code{org-archive-location}. @item @samp{#+CATEGORY} @cindex @samp{CATEGORY}, keyword Sets the category of the agenda file, which applies to the entire document. @item @samp{#+COLUMNS: %25ITEM ...} @cindex @samp{COLUMNS}, property Set the default format for columns view. This format applies when columns view is invoked in locations where no @samp{COLUMNS} property applies. @item @samp{#+CONSTANTS: name1=value1 ...} @cindex @samp{CONSTANTS}, keyword @vindex org-table-formula-constants @vindex org-table-formula Set file-local values for constants that table formulas can use. This line sets the local variable @code{org-table-formula-constants-local}. The global version of this variable is @code{org-table-formula-constants}. @item @samp{#+FILETAGS: :tag1:tag2:tag3:} @cindex @samp{FILETAGS}, keyword Set tags that all entries in the file inherit from, including the top-level entries. @item @samp{#+LINK: linkword replace} @cindex @samp{LINK}, keyword @vindex org-link-abbrev-alist Each line specifies one abbreviation for one link. Use multiple @samp{LINK} keywords for more, see @ref{Link Abbreviations}. The corresponding variable is @code{org-link-abbrev-alist}. @item @samp{#+PRIORITIES: highest lowest default} @cindex @samp{PRIORITIES}, keyword @vindex org-priority-highest @vindex org-priority-lowest @vindex org-priority-default This line sets the limits and the default for the priorities. All three must be either letters A--Z or numbers 0--9. The highest priority must have a lower ASCII number than the lowest priority. @item @samp{#+PROPERTY: Property_Name Value} @cindex @samp{PROPERTY}, keyword This line sets a default inheritance value for entries in the current buffer, most useful for specifying the allowed values of a property. @item @samp{#+SETUPFILE: file} @cindex @samp{SETUPFILE}, keyword The setup file or a URL pointing to such file is for additional in-buffer settings. Org loads this file and parses it for any settings in it only when Org opens the main file. If URL is specified, the contents are downloaded and stored in a temporary file cache. @kbd{C-c C-c} on the settings line parses and loads the file, and also resets the temporary file cache. Org also parses and loads the document during normal exporting process. Org parses the contents of this document as if it was included in the buffer. It can be another Org file. To visit the file---not a URL---use @kbd{C-c '} while point is on the line with the file name. @item @samp{#+STARTUP:} @cindex @samp{STARTUP}, keyword Startup options Org uses when first visiting a file. @vindex org-startup-folded The first set of options deals with the initial visibility of the outline tree. The corresponding variable for global default settings is @code{org-startup-folded} with a default value of @code{showeverything}. @multitable {aaaaaaaaaaaaaaaa} {aaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaa} @item @samp{overview} @tab Top-level headlines only. @item @samp{content} @tab All headlines. @item @samp{showall} @tab No folding on any entry. @item @samp{showeverything} @tab Show even drawer contents. @end multitable @vindex org-startup-indented Dynamic virtual indentation is controlled by the variable @code{org-startup-indented}@footnote{Note that Org Indent mode also sets the @code{wrap-prefix} property, such that Visual Line mode (or purely setting @code{word-wrap}) wraps long lines, including headlines, correctly indented.}. @multitable {aaaaaaaaaa} {aaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaa} @item @samp{indent} @tab Start with Org Indent mode turned on. @item @samp{noindent} @tab Start with Org Indent mode turned off. @end multitable @vindex org-startup-numerated Dynamic virtual numeration of headlines is controlled by the variable @code{org-startup-numerated}. @multitable {aaaaaaa} {aaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaa} @item @samp{num} @tab Start with Org num mode turned on. @item @samp{nonum} @tab Start with Org num mode turned off. @end multitable @vindex org-startup-align-all-tables Aligns tables consistently upon visiting a file. The corresponding variable is @code{org-startup-align-all-tables} with @code{nil} as default value. @multitable {aaaaaaaaa} {aaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaa} @item @samp{align} @tab Align all tables. @item @samp{noalign} @tab Do not align tables on startup. @end multitable @vindex org-startup-shrink-all-tables Shrink table columns with a width cookie. The corresponding variable is @code{org-startup-shrink-all-tables} with @code{nil} as default value. @vindex org-startup-with-inline-images When visiting a file, inline images can be automatically displayed. The corresponding variable is @code{org-startup-with-inline-images}, with a default value @code{nil} to avoid delays when visiting a file. @multitable {aaaaaaaaaaaaaaaa} {aaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaa} @item @samp{inlineimages} @tab Show inline images. @item @samp{noinlineimages} @tab Do not show inline images on startup. @end multitable @vindex org-log-done @vindex org-log-note-clock-out @vindex org-log-repeat Logging the closing and reopening of TODO items and clock intervals can be configured using these options (see variables @code{org-log-done}, @code{org-log-note-clock-out}, and @code{org-log-repeat}). @multitable {aaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaa} {aaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaa} @item @samp{logdone} @tab Record a timestamp when an item is marked as done. @item @samp{lognotedone} @tab Record timestamp and a note when DONE@. @item @samp{nologdone} @tab Do not record when items are marked as done. @item @samp{logrepeat} @tab Record a time when reinstating a repeating item. @item @samp{lognoterepeat} @tab Record a note when reinstating a repeating item. @item @samp{nologrepeat} @tab Do not record when reinstating repeating item. @item @samp{lognoteclock-out} @tab Record a note when clocking out. @item @samp{nolognoteclock-out} @tab Do not record a note when clocking out. @item @samp{logreschedule} @tab Record a timestamp when scheduling time changes. @item @samp{lognotereschedule} @tab Record a note when scheduling time changes. @item @samp{nologreschedule} @tab Do not record when a scheduling date changes. @item @samp{logredeadline} @tab Record a timestamp when deadline changes. @item @samp{lognoteredeadline} @tab Record a note when deadline changes. @item @samp{nologredeadline} @tab Do not record when a deadline date changes. @item @samp{logrefile} @tab Record a timestamp when refiling. @item @samp{lognoterefile} @tab Record a note when refiling. @item @samp{nologrefile} @tab Do not record when refiling. @end multitable @vindex org-hide-leading-stars @vindex org-odd-levels-only Here are the options for hiding leading stars in outline headings, and for indenting outlines. The corresponding variables are @code{org-hide-leading-stars} and @code{org-odd-levels-only}, both with a default setting @code{nil} (meaning @samp{showstars} and @samp{oddeven}). @multitable {aaaaaaaaaaa} {aaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaa} @item @samp{hidestars} @tab Make all but one of the stars starting a headline invisible. @item @samp{showstars} @tab Show all stars starting a headline. @item @samp{indent} @tab Virtual indentation according to outline level. @item @samp{noindent} @tab No virtual indentation according to outline level. @item @samp{odd} @tab Allow only odd outline levels (1, 3, @dots{}). @item @samp{oddeven} @tab Allow all outline levels. @end multitable @vindex org-put-time-stamp-overlays @vindex org-time-stamp-overlay-formats To turn on custom format overlays over timestamps (variables @code{org-put-time-stamp-overlays} and @code{org-time-stamp-overlay-formats}), use: @multitable {aaaaaaaaaaaa} {aaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaa} @item @samp{customtime} @tab Overlay custom time format. @end multitable @vindex constants-unit-system The following options influence the table spreadsheet (variable @code{constants-unit-system}). @multitable {aaaaaaaaaa} {aaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaa} @item @samp{constcgs} @tab @samp{constants.el} should use the c-g-s unit system. @item @samp{constSI} @tab @samp{constants.el} should use the SI unit system. @end multitable @vindex org-footnote-define-inline @vindex org-footnote-auto-label @vindex org-footnote-auto-adjust To influence footnote settings, use the following keywords. The corresponding variables are @code{org-footnote-define-inline}, @code{org-footnote-auto-label}, and @code{org-footnote-auto-adjust}. @multitable {aaaaaaaaaaaa} {aaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaa} @item @samp{fninline} @tab Define footnotes inline. @item @samp{fnnoinline} @tab Define footnotes in separate section. @item @samp{fnlocal} @tab Define footnotes near first reference, but not inline. @item @samp{fnprompt} @tab Prompt for footnote labels. @item @samp{fnauto} @tab Create @samp{[fn:1]}-like labels automatically (default). @item @samp{fnconfirm} @tab Offer automatic label for editing or confirmation. @item @samp{fnadjust} @tab Automatically renumber and sort footnotes. @item @samp{nofnadjust} @tab Do not renumber and sort automatically. @end multitable @vindex org-hide-block-startup To hide blocks on startup, use these keywords. The corresponding variable is @code{org-hide-block-startup}. @multitable {aaaaaaaaaaaaaa} {aaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaa} @item @samp{hideblocks} @tab Hide all begin/end blocks on startup. @item @samp{nohideblocks} @tab Do not hide blocks on startup. @end multitable @vindex org-pretty-entities The display of entities as UTF-8 characters is governed by the variable @code{org-pretty-entities} and the keywords @multitable {aaaaaaaaaaaaaaaa} {aaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaa} @item @samp{entitiespretty} @tab Show entities as UTF-8 characters where possible. @item @samp{entitiesplain} @tab Leave entities plain. @end multitable @item @samp{#+TAGS: TAG1(c1) TAG2(c2)} @cindex @samp{TAGS}, keyword @vindex org-tag-alist These lines (several such lines are allowed) specify the valid tags in this file, and (potentially) the corresponding @emph{fast tag selection} keys. The corresponding variable is @code{org-tag-alist}. @item @samp{#+TODO:} @itemx @samp{#+SEQ_TODO:} @itemx @samp{#+TYP_TODO:} @cindex @samp{SEQ_TODO}, keyword @cindex @samp{TODO}, keyword @cindex @samp{TYP_TODO}, keyword @vindex org-todo-keywords These lines set the TODO keywords and their interpretation in the current file. The corresponding variable is @code{org-todo-keywords}. @end table @node Org Syntax @section Org Syntax A reference document providing a formal description of Org's syntax is available as @uref{https://orgmode.org/worg/dev/org-syntax.html, a draft on Worg}, written and maintained by Nicolas Goaziou. It defines Org's core internal concepts such as ``headlines'', ``sections'', ``affiliated keywords'', ``(greater) elements'' and ``objects''. Each part of an Org document belongs to one of the previous categories. To explore the abstract structure of an Org buffer, run this in a buffer: @example M-: (org-element-parse-buffer) @end example @noindent It outputs a list containing the buffer's content represented as an abstract structure. The export engine relies on the information stored in this list. Most interactive commands---e.g., for structure editing---also rely on the syntactic meaning of the surrounding context. @cindex syntax checker @cindex linter @findex org-lint You can probe the syntax of your documents with the command @example M-x org-lint @end example @noindent It runs a number of checks to find common mistakes. It then displays their location in a dedicated buffer, along with a description and a ``trust level'', since false-positive are possible. From there, you can operate on the reports with the following keys: @multitable @columnfractions 0.22 0.78 @item @kbd{C-j}, @kbd{@key{TAB}} @tab Display the offending line @item @kbd{@key{RET}} @tab Move point to the offending line @item @kbd{g} @tab Check the document again @item @kbd{h} @tab Hide all reports from the same checker @item @kbd{i} @tab Also remove them from all subsequent checks @item @kbd{S} @tab Sort reports by the column at point @end multitable @node Documentation Access @section Context Dependent Documentation @cindex documentation @cindex Info @findex org-info-find-node @kindex C-c C-x I @kbd{C-c C-x I} in an Org file tries to open a suitable section of the Org manual depending on the syntax at point. For example, using it on a headline displays ``Document Structure'' section. @kbd{q} closes the Info window. @node Escape Character @section Escape Character @cindex escape character @cindex zero width space You may sometimes want to write text that looks like Org syntax, but should really read as plain text. Org may use a specific escape character in some situations, i.e., a backslash in macros (see @ref{Macro Replacement}) and links (see @ref{Link Format}), or a comma in source and example blocks (see @ref{Literal Examples}). In the general case, however, we suggest to use the zero width space. You can insert one with any of the following: @example C-x 8 zero width space C-x 8 200B @end example For example, in order to write @samp{[[1,2]]} as-is in your document, you may write instead @example [X[1,2]] @end example where @samp{X} denotes the zero width space character. @node Code Evaluation Security @section Code Evaluation and Security Issues Unlike plain text, running code comes with risk. Each source code block, in terms of risk, is equivalent to an executable file. Org therefore puts a few confirmation prompts by default. This is to alert the casual user from accidentally running untrusted code. For users who do not run code blocks or write code regularly, Org's default settings should suffice. However, some users may want to tweak the prompts for fewer interruptions. To weigh the risks of automatic execution of code blocks, here are some details about code evaluation. Org evaluates code in the following circumstances: @table @asis @item @emph{Source code blocks} Org evaluates source code blocks in an Org file during export. Org also evaluates a source code block with the @kbd{C-c C-c} key chord. Users exporting or running code blocks must load files only from trusted sources. Be wary of customizing variables that remove or alter default security measures. @defopt org-confirm-babel-evaluate When @code{t}, Org prompts the user for confirmation before executing each code block. When @code{nil}, Org executes code blocks without prompting the user for confirmation. When this option is set to a custom function, Org invokes the function with these two arguments: the source code language and the body of the code block. The custom function must return either a @code{t} or @code{nil}, which determines if the user is prompted. Each source code language can be handled separately through this function argument. @end defopt For example, here is how to execute ditaa code blocks without prompting: @lisp (defun my-org-confirm-babel-evaluate (lang body) (not (string= lang "ditaa"))) ;don't ask for ditaa (setq org-confirm-babel-evaluate #'my-org-confirm-babel-evaluate) @end lisp @item @emph{Following @samp{shell} and @samp{elisp} links} Org has two link types that can directly evaluate code (see @ref{External Links}). Because such code is not visible, these links have a potential risk. Org therefore prompts the user when it encounters such links. The customization variables are: @defopt org-link-shell-confirm-function Function that prompts the user before executing a shell link. @end defopt @defopt org-link-elisp-confirm-function Function that prompts the user before executing an Emacs Lisp link. @end defopt @item @emph{Formulas in tables} Formulas in tables (see @ref{The Spreadsheet}) are code that is evaluated either by the Calc interpreter, or by the Emacs Lisp interpreter. @end table @node Interaction @section Interaction with Other Packages @cindex packages, interaction with other Org's compatibility and the level of interaction with other Emacs packages are documented here. @menu * Cooperation:: Packages Org cooperates with. * Conflicts:: Packages that lead to conflicts. @end menu @node Cooperation @subsection Packages that Org cooperates with @table @asis @item @samp{calc.el} by Dave Gillespie @cindex @file{calc.el} Org uses the Calc package for implementing spreadsheet functionality in its tables (see @ref{The Spreadsheet}). Org also uses Calc for embedded calculations. See @ref{Embedded Mode,GNU Emacs Calc Manual,,calc,}. @item @samp{constants.el} by Carsten Dominik @cindex @file{constants.el} @vindex org-table-formula-constants Org can use names for constants in formulas in tables. Org can also use calculation suffixes for units, such as @samp{M} for @samp{Mega}. For a standard collection of such constants, install the @samp{constants} package. Install version 2.0 of this package, available at @uref{http://www.astro.uva.nl/~dominik/Tools}. Org checks if the function @code{constants-get} has been autoloaded. Installation instructions are in the file @samp{constants.el}. @item @samp{cdlatex.el} by Carsten Dominik @cindex @file{cdlatex.el} Org mode can make use of the CD@LaTeX{} package to efficiently enter @LaTeX{} fragments into Org files. See @ref{CD@LaTeX{} mode}. @item @samp{imenu.el} by Ake Stenhoff and Lars Lindberg @cindex @file{imenu.el} Imenu creates dynamic menus based on an index of items in a file. Org mode supports Imenu menus. Enable it with a mode hook as follows: @lisp (add-hook 'org-mode-hook (lambda () (imenu-add-to-menubar "Imenu"))) @end lisp @vindex org-imenu-depth By default the index is two levels deep---you can modify the depth using the option @code{org-imenu-depth}. @item @samp{speedbar.el} by Eric@tie{}M@.@tie{}Ludlam @cindex @file{speedbar.el} Speedbar package creates a special Emacs frame for displaying files and index items in files. Org mode supports Speedbar; users can drill into Org files directly from the Speedbar. The @kbd{<} in the Speedbar frame tweaks the agenda commands to that file or to a subtree. @item @samp{table.el} by Takaaki Ota @cindex table editor, @file{table.el} @cindex @file{table.el} Complex ASCII tables with automatic line wrapping, column- and row-spanning, and alignment can be created using the Emacs table package by Takaaki Ota. Org mode recognizes such tables and exports them properly. @kbd{C-c '} to edit these tables in a special buffer, much like Org's code blocks. Because of interference with other Org mode functionality, Takaaki Ota tables cannot be edited directly in the Org buffer. @table @asis @item @kbd{C-c '} (@code{org-edit-special}) @kindex C-c ' @findex org-edit-special Edit a @samp{table.el} table. Works when point is in a @samp{table.el} table. @item @kbd{C-c ~​} (@code{org-table-create-with-table.el}) @kindex C-c ~ @findex org-table-create-with-table.el Insert a @samp{table.el} table. If there is already a table at point, this command converts it between the @samp{table.el} format and the Org mode format. See the documentation string of the command @code{org-convert-table} for the restrictions under which this is possible. @end table @end table @node Conflicts @subsection Packages that conflict with Org mode @cindex shift-selection @vindex org-support-shift-select In Emacs, shift-selection combines motions of point with shift key to enlarge regions. Emacs sets this mode by default. This conflicts with Org's use of @kbd{S-} commands to change timestamps, TODO keywords, priorities, and item bullet types, etc. Since @kbd{S-} commands outside of specific contexts do not do anything, Org offers the variable @code{org-support-shift-select} for customization. Org mode accommodates shift selection by (i) making it available outside of the special contexts where special commands apply, and (ii) extending an existing active region even if point moves across a special context. @table @asis @item @samp{cua.el} by Kim@tie{}F@.@tie{}Storm @cindex @file{cua.el} @vindex org-replace-disputed-keys Org key bindings conflict with @kbd{S-} keys used by CUA mode. For Org to relinquish these bindings to CUA mode, configure the variable @code{org-replace-disputed-keys}. When set, Org moves the following key bindings in Org files, and in the agenda buffer---but not during date selection. @multitable @columnfractions 0.4 0.4 @item @kbd{S-@key{UP}} @result{} @kbd{M-p} @tab @kbd{S-@key{DOWN}} @result{} @kbd{M-n} @item @kbd{S-@key{LEFT}} @result{} @kbd{M--} @tab @kbd{S-@key{RIGHT}} @result{} @kbd{M-+} @item @kbd{C-S-@key{LEFT}} @result{} @kbd{M-S--} @tab @kbd{C-S-@key{RIGHT}} @result{} @kbd{M-S-+} @end multitable @vindex org-disputed-keys Yes, these are unfortunately more difficult to remember. If you want to have other replacement keys, look at the variable @code{org-disputed-keys}. @item @samp{ecomplete.el} by Lars Magne Ingebrigtsen @cindex @file{ecomplete.el} Ecomplete provides ``electric'' address completion in address header lines in message buffers. Sadly Orgtbl mode cuts Ecomplete's power supply: no completion happens when Orgtbl mode is enabled in message buffers while entering text in address header lines. If one wants to use ecomplete one should @emph{not} follow the advice to automagically turn on Orgtbl mode in message buffers (see @ref{Orgtbl Mode}), but instead---after filling in the message headers---turn on Orgtbl mode manually when needed in the messages body. @item @samp{filladapt.el} by Kyle Jones @cindex @file{filladapt.el} Org mode tries to do the right thing when filling paragraphs, list items and other elements. Many users reported problems using both @samp{filladapt.el} and Org mode, so a safe thing to do is to disable filladapt like this: @lisp (add-hook 'org-mode-hook 'turn-off-filladapt-mode) @end lisp @item @samp{viper.el} by Michael Kifer @cindex @file{viper.el} @kindex C-c / Viper uses @kbd{C-c /} and therefore makes this key not access the corresponding Org mode command @code{org-sparse-tree}. You need to find another key for this command, or override the key in @code{viper-vi-global-user-map} with @lisp (define-key viper-vi-global-user-map "C-c /" 'org-sparse-tree) @end lisp @item @samp{windmove.el} by Hovav Shacham @cindex @file{windmove.el} This package also uses the @kbd{S-} keys, so everything written in the paragraph above about CUA mode also applies here. If you want to make the windmove function active in locations where Org mode does not have special functionality on @kbd{S-}, add this to your configuration: @lisp ;; Make windmove work in Org mode: (add-hook 'org-shiftup-final-hook 'windmove-up) (add-hook 'org-shiftleft-final-hook 'windmove-left) (add-hook 'org-shiftdown-final-hook 'windmove-down) (add-hook 'org-shiftright-final-hook 'windmove-right) @end lisp @item @samp{yasnippet.el} @cindex @file{yasnippet.el} The way Org mode binds the @kbd{@key{TAB}} key (binding to @code{[tab]} instead of @code{"\t"}) overrules YASnippet's access to this key. The following code fixed this problem: @lisp (add-hook 'org-mode-hook (lambda () (setq-local yas/trigger-key [tab]) (define-key yas/keymap [tab] 'yas/next-field-or-maybe-expand))) @end lisp The latest version of YASnippet does not play well with Org mode. If the above code does not fix the conflict, start by defining the following function: @lisp (defun yas/org-very-safe-expand () (let ((yas/fallback-behavior 'return-nil)) (yas/expand))) @end lisp Then, tell Org mode to use that function: @lisp (add-hook 'org-mode-hook (lambda () (make-variable-buffer-local 'yas/trigger-key) (setq yas/trigger-key [tab]) (add-to-list 'org-tab-first-hook 'yas/org-very-safe-expand) (define-key yas/keymap [tab] 'yas/next-field))) @end lisp @end table @node TTY Keys @section Using Org on a TTY @cindex tty key bindings Org provides alternative key bindings for TTY and modern mobile devices that cannot perform movement commands on point and key bindings with modifier keys. Some of these workarounds may be more cumbersome than necessary. Users should look into customizing these further based on their usage needs. For example, the normal @kbd{S-} for editing timestamp might be better with @kbd{C-c .} chord. @multitable @columnfractions 0.2 0.28 0.15 0.21 @headitem Default @tab Alternative 1 @tab Speed key @tab Alternative 2 @item @kbd{S-@key{TAB}} @tab @kbd{C-u @key{TAB}} @tab @kbd{C} @tab @item @kbd{M-@key{LEFT}} @tab @kbd{C-c C-x l} @tab @kbd{l} @tab @kbd{Esc @key{LEFT}} @item @kbd{M-S-@key{LEFT}} @tab @kbd{C-c C-x L} @tab @kbd{L} @tab @item @kbd{M-@key{RIGHT}} @tab @kbd{C-c C-x r} @tab @kbd{r} @tab @kbd{Esc @key{RIGHT}} @item @kbd{M-S-@key{RIGHT}} @tab @kbd{C-c C-x R} @tab @kbd{R} @tab @item @kbd{M-@key{UP}} @tab @kbd{C-c C-x u} @tab @tab @kbd{Esc @key{UP}} @item @kbd{M-S-@key{UP}} @tab @kbd{C-c C-x U} @tab @kbd{U} @tab @item @kbd{M-@key{DOWN}} @tab @kbd{C-c C-x d} @tab @tab @kbd{Esc @key{DOWN}} @item @kbd{M-S-@key{DOWN}} @tab @kbd{C-c C-x D} @tab @kbd{D} @tab @item @kbd{S-@key{RET}} @tab @kbd{C-c C-x c} @tab @tab @item @kbd{M-@key{RET}} @tab @kbd{C-c C-x m} @tab @tab @kbd{Esc @key{RET}} @item @kbd{M-S-@key{RET}} @tab @kbd{C-c C-x M} @tab @tab @item @kbd{S-@key{LEFT}} @tab @kbd{C-c @key{LEFT}} @tab @tab @item @kbd{S-@key{RIGHT}} @tab @kbd{C-c @key{RIGHT}} @tab @tab @item @kbd{S-@key{UP}} @tab @kbd{C-c @key{UP}} @tab @tab @item @kbd{S-@key{DOWN}} @tab @kbd{C-c @key{DOWN}} @tab @tab @item @kbd{C-S-@key{LEFT}} @tab @kbd{C-c C-x @key{LEFT}} @tab @tab @item @kbd{C-S-@key{RIGHT}} @tab @kbd{C-c C-x @key{RIGHT}} @tab @tab @end multitable @node Protocols @section Protocols for External Access @cindex protocols, for external access Org protocol is a tool to trigger custom actions in Emacs from external applications. Any application that supports calling external programs with an URL as argument may be used with this functionality. For example, you can configure bookmarks in your web browser to send a link to the current page to Org and create a note from it using capture (see @ref{Capture}). You can also create a bookmark that tells Emacs to open the local source file of a remote website you are browsing. @cindex Org protocol, set-up @cindex Installing Org protocol In order to use Org protocol from an application, you need to register @samp{org-protocol://} as a valid scheme-handler. External calls are passed to Emacs through the @samp{emacsclient} command, so you also need to ensure an Emacs server is running. More precisely, when the application calls @example emacsclient org-protocol://PROTOCOL?key1=val1&key2=val2 @end example @noindent Emacs calls the handler associated to @var{PROTOCOL} with argument @samp{(:key1 val1 :key2 val2)}. @cindex protocol, new protocol @cindex defining new protocols Org protocol comes with three predefined protocols, detailed in the following sections. Configure @code{org-protocol-protocol-alist} to define your own. @menu * The @code{store-link} protocol:: Store a link, push URL to kill-ring. * The @code{capture} protocol:: Fill a buffer with external information. * The @code{open-source} protocol:: Edit published contents. @end menu @node The @code{store-link} protocol @subsection The @code{store-link} protocol @cindex store-link protocol @cindex protocol, store-link Using the @code{store-link} handler, you can copy links, to that they can be inserted using @kbd{M-x org-insert-link} or yanking. More precisely, the command @example emacsclient org-protocol://store-link?url=URL&title=TITLE @end example @noindent stores the following link: @example [[URL][TITLE]] @end example In addition, @var{URL} is pushed on the kill-ring for yanking. You need to encode @var{URL} and @var{TITLE} if they contain slashes, and probably quote those for the shell. To use this feature from a browser, add a bookmark with an arbitrary name, e.g., @samp{Org: store-link} and enter this as @emph{Location}: @example javascript:location.href='org-protocol://store-link?url='+ encodeURIComponent(location.href); @end example @node The @code{capture} protocol @subsection The @code{capture} protocol @cindex capture protocol @cindex protocol, capture Activating the ``capture'' handler pops up a @samp{Capture} buffer in Emacs, using acapture template. @example emacsclient org-protocol://capture?template=X?url=URL?title=TITLE?body=BODY @end example To use this feature, add a bookmark with an arbitrary name, e.g., @samp{Org: capture}, and enter this as @samp{Location}: @example javascript:location.href='org-protocol://capture?template=x'+ '&url='+encodeURIComponent(window.location.href)+ '&title='+encodeURIComponent(document.title)+ '&body='+encodeURIComponent(window.getSelection()); @end example @vindex org-protocol-default-template-key The capture template to be used can be specified in the bookmark (like @samp{X} above). If unspecified, the template key is set in the variable @code{org-protocol-default-template-key}. The following template placeholders are available: @example %:link The URL %:description The webpage title %:annotation Equivalent to [[%:link][%:description]] %i The selected text @end example @node The @code{open-source} protocol @subsection The @code{open-source} protocol @cindex open-source protocol @cindex protocol, open-source The @code{open-source} handler is designed to help with editing local sources when reading a document. To that effect, you can use a bookmark with the following location: @example javascript:location.href='org-protocol://open-source?&url='+ encodeURIComponent(location.href) @end example @vindex org-protocol-project-alist The variable @code{org-protocol-project-alist} maps URLs to local file names, by stripping URL parameters from the end and replacing the @code{:base-url} with @code{:working-directory} and @code{:online-suffix} with @code{:working-suffix}. For example, assuming you own a local copy of @samp{https://orgmode.org/worg/} contents at @samp{/home/user/worg}, you can set @code{org-protocol-project-alist} to the following @lisp (setq org-protocol-project-alist '(("Worg" :base-url "https://orgmode.org/worg/" :working-directory "/home/user/worg/" :online-suffix ".html" :working-suffix ".org"))) @end lisp @noindent If you are now browsing @samp{https://orgmode.org/worg/org-contrib/org-protocol.html} and find a typo or have an idea about how to enhance the documentation, simply click the bookmark and start editing. @cindex rewritten URL in open-source protocol @cindex protocol, open-source rewritten URL However, such mapping may not always yield the desired results. Suppose you maintain an online store located at @samp{http://example.com/}. The local sources reside in @samp{/home/user/example/}. It is common practice to serve all products in such a store through one file and rewrite URLs that do not match an existing file on the server. That way, a request to @samp{http://example.com/print/posters.html} might be rewritten on the server to something like @samp{http://example.com/shop/products.php/posters.html.php}. The @code{open-source} handler probably cannot find a file named @samp{/home/user/example/print/posters.html.php} and fails. Such an entry in @code{org-protocol-project-alist} may hold an additional property @code{:rewrites}. This property is a list of cons cells, each of which maps a regular expression to a path relative to the @code{:working-directory}. Now map the URL to the path @samp{/home/user/example/products.php} by adding @code{:rewrites} rules like this: @lisp (setq org-protocol-project-alist '(("example.com" :base-url "http://example.com/" :working-directory "/home/user/example/" :online-suffix ".php" :working-suffix ".php" :rewrites (("example.com/print/" . "products.php") ("example.com/$" . "index.php"))))) @end lisp @noindent Since @samp{example.com/$} is used as a regular expression, it maps @samp{http://example.com/}, @samp{https://example.com}, @samp{http://www.example.com/} and similar to @samp{/home/user/example/index.php}. The @code{:rewrites} rules are searched as a last resort if and only if no existing file name is matched. @cindex protocol, open-source, set-up mapping @cindex mappings in open-source protocol @findex org-protocol-create @findex org-protocol-create-for-org Two functions can help you filling @code{org-protocol-project-alist} with valid contents: @code{org-protocol-create} and @code{org-protocol-create-for-org}. The latter is of use if you're editing an Org file that is part of a publishing project. @node Org Crypt @section Org Crypt Org Crypt encrypts the text of an entry, but not the headline, or properties. Behind the scene, it uses the Emacs EasyPG library to encrypt and decrypt files. @vindex org-crypt-tag-matcher Any text below a headline that has a @samp{crypt} tag is automatically encrypted when the file is saved. To use a different tag, customize the @code{org-crypt-tag-matcher} setting. Here is a suggestion for Org Crypt settings in Emacs init file: @lisp (require 'org-crypt) (org-crypt-use-before-save-magic) (setq org-tags-exclude-from-inheritance '("crypt")) (setq org-crypt-key nil) ;; GPG key to use for encryption ;; Either the Key ID or set to nil to use symmetric encryption. (setq auto-save-default nil) ;; Auto-saving does not cooperate with org-crypt.el: so you need to ;; turn it off if you plan to use org-crypt.el quite often. Otherwise, ;; you'll get an (annoying) message each time you start Org. ;; To turn it off only locally, you can insert this: ;; ;; # -*- buffer-auto-save-file-name: nil; -*- @end lisp It's possible to use different keys for different headings by specifying the respective key as property @samp{CRYPTKEY}, e.g.: @example * Totally secret :crypt: :PROPERTIES: :CRYPTKEY: 0x0123456789012345678901234567890123456789 :END: @end example Excluding the @samp{crypt} tag from inheritance prevents already encrypted text from being encrypted again. @node Org Mobile @section Org Mobile @cindex smartphone Org Mobile is a protocol for synchronizing Org files between Emacs and other applications, e.g., on mobile devices. It enables offline-views and capture support for an Org mode system that is rooted on a ``real'' computer. The external application can also record changes to existing entries. This appendix describes Org's support for agenda view formats compatible with Org Mobile. It also describes synchronizing changes, such as to notes, between the mobile application and the computer. To change tags and TODO states in the mobile application, first customize the variables @code{org-todo-keywords}, @code{org-tag-alist} and @code{org-tag-persistent-alist}. These should cover all the important tags and TODO keywords, even if Org files use only some of them. Though the mobile application is expected to support in-buffer settings, it is required to understand TODO states @emph{sets} (see @ref{Per-file keywords}) and @emph{mutually exclusive} tags (see @ref{Setting Tags}) only for those set in these variables. @menu * Setting up the staging area:: For the mobile device. * Pushing to the mobile application:: Uploading Org files and agendas. * Pulling from the mobile application:: Integrating captured and flagged items. @end menu @node Setting up the staging area @subsection Setting up the staging area @vindex org-mobile-directory The mobile application needs access to a file directory on a server@footnote{For a server to host files, consider using a WebDAV server, such as @uref{https://nextcloud.com, Nextcloud}. Additional help is at this @uref{https://orgmode.org/worg/org-faq.html#mobileorg_webdav, FAQ entry}.} to interact with Emacs. Pass its location through the @code{org-mobile-directory} variable. If you can mount that directory locally just set the variable to point to that directory: @lisp (setq org-mobile-directory "~/orgmobile/") @end lisp Alternatively, by using TRAMP (see @ref{Top,TRAMP User Manual,,tramp,}), @code{org-mobile-directory} may point to a remote directory accessible through, for example, SSH, SCP, or DAVS: @lisp (setq org-mobile-directory "/davs:user@@remote.host:/org/webdav/") @end lisp @vindex org-mobile-encryption With a public server, consider encrypting the files. Org also requires OpenSSL installed on the local computer. To turn on encryption, set the same password in the mobile application and in Emacs. Set the password in the variable @code{org-mobile-use-encryption}@footnote{If Emacs is configured for safe storing of passwords, then configure the variable @code{org-mobile-encryption-password}; please read the docstring of that variable.}. Note that even after the mobile application encrypts the file contents, the file name remains visible on the file systems of the local computer, the server, and the mobile device. @node Pushing to the mobile application @subsection Pushing to the mobile application @findex org-mobile-push @vindex org-mobile-files The command @code{org-mobile-push} copies files listed in @code{org-mobile-files} into the staging area. Files include agenda files (as listed in @code{org-agenda-files}). Customize @code{org-mobile-files} to add other files. File names are staged with paths relative to @code{org-directory}, so all files should be inside this directory@footnote{Symbolic links in @code{org-directory} need to have the same name as their targets.}. Push creates a special Org file @samp{agendas.org} with custom agenda views defined by the user@footnote{While creating the agendas, Org mode forces @samp{ID} properties on all referenced entries, so that these entries can be uniquely identified if Org Mobile flags them for further action. To avoid setting properties configure the variable @code{org-mobile-force-id-on-agenda-items} to @code{nil}. Org mode then relies on outline paths, assuming they are unique.}. Finally, Org writes the file @samp{index.org}, containing links to other files. The mobile application reads this file first from the server to determine what other files to download for agendas. For faster downloads, it is expected to only read files whose checksums@footnote{Checksums are stored automatically in the file @samp{checksums.dat}.} have changed. @node Pulling from the mobile application @subsection Pulling from the mobile application @findex org-mobile-pull The command @code{org-mobile-pull} synchronizes changes with the server. More specifically, it first pulls the Org files for viewing. It then appends captured entries and pointers to flagged or changed entries to the file @samp{mobileorg.org} on the server. Org ultimately integrates its data in an inbox file format, through the following steps: @enumerate @item @vindex org-mobile-inbox-for-pull Org moves all entries found in @samp{mobileorg.org}@footnote{The file will be empty after this operation.} and appends them to the file pointed to by the variable @code{org-mobile-inbox-for-pull}. It should reside neither in the staging area nor on the server. Each captured entry and each editing event is a top-level entry in the inbox file. @item @cindex @samp{FLAGGED}, tag After moving the entries, Org processes changes to the shared files. Some of them are applied directly and without user interaction. Examples include changes to tags, TODO state, headline and body text. Entries requiring further action are tagged as @samp{FLAGGED}. Org marks entries with problems with an error message in the inbox. They have to be resolved manually. @item Org generates an agenda view for flagged entries for user intervention to clean up. For notes stored in flagged entries, Org displays them in the echo area when point is on the corresponding agenda item. @table @asis @item @kbd{?} Pressing @kbd{?} displays the entire flagged note in another window. Org also pushes it to the kill ring. To store flagged note as a normal note, use @kbd{? z C-y C-c C-c}. Pressing @kbd{?} twice does these things: first it removes the @samp{FLAGGED} tag; second, it removes the flagged note from the property drawer; third, it signals that manual editing of the flagged entry is now finished. @end table @end enumerate @kindex ? @r{(Agenda dispatcher)} From the agenda dispatcher, @kbd{?} returns to the view to finish processing flagged entries. Note that these entries may not be the most recent since the mobile application searches files that were last pulled. To get an updated agenda view with changes since the last pull, pull again. @node Hacking @appendix Hacking @cindex hacking This appendix describes some ways a user can extend the functionality of Org. @menu * Hooks: Hooks (2). How to reach into Org's internals. * Add-on Packages:: Available extensions. * Adding Hyperlink Types:: New custom link types. * Adding Export Back-ends:: How to write new export back-ends. * Tables in Arbitrary Syntax:: Orgtbl for LaTeX and other programs. * Dynamic Blocks:: Automatically filled blocks. * Special Agenda Views:: Customized views. * Speeding Up Your Agendas:: Tips on how to speed up your agendas. * Extracting Agenda Information:: Post-processing agenda information. * Using the Property API:: Writing programs that use entry properties. * Using the Mapping API:: Mapping over all or selected entries. @end menu @node Hooks (2) @appendixsec Hooks @cindex hooks Org has a large number of hook variables for adding functionality. This appendix illustrates using a few. A complete list of hooks with documentation is maintained by the Worg project at @uref{https://orgmode.org/worg/doc.html#hooks}. @node Add-on Packages @appendixsec Add-on Packages @cindex add-on packages Various authors wrote a large number of add-on packages for Org. These packages are not part of Emacs, but they are distributed as contributed packages with the separate release available at @uref{https://orgmode.org}. See the @samp{contrib/README} file in the source code directory for a list of contributed files. Worg page with more information is at: @uref{https://orgmode.org/worg/org-contrib/}. @node Adding Hyperlink Types @appendixsec Adding Hyperlink Types @cindex hyperlinks, adding new types Org has many built-in hyperlink types (see @ref{Hyperlinks}), and an interface for adding new link types. The following example shows the process of adding Org links to Unix man pages, which look like this @example [[man:printf][The printf manual]] @end example @noindent The following @samp{ol-man.el} file implements it @lisp ;;; ol-man.el - Support for links to man pages in Org mode (require 'ol) (org-link-set-parameters "man" :follow #'org-man-open :export #'org-man-export :store #'org-man-store-link) (defcustom org-man-command 'man "The Emacs command to be used to display a man page." :group 'org-link :type '(choice (const man) (const woman))) (defun org-man-open (path _) "Visit the manpage on PATH. PATH should be a topic that can be thrown at the man command." (funcall org-man-command path)) (defun org-man-store-link () "Store a link to a man page." (when (memq major-mode '(Man-mode woman-mode)) ;; This is a man page, we do make this link. (let* ((page (org-man-get-page-name)) (link (concat "man:" page)) (description (format "Man page for %s" page))) (org-link-store-props :type "man" :link link :description description)))) (defun org-man-get-page-name () "Extract the page name from the buffer name." ;; This works for both `Man-mode' and `woman-mode'. (if (string-match " \\(\\S-+\\)\\*" (buffer-name)) (match-string 1 (buffer-name)) (error "Cannot create link to this man page"))) (defun org-man-export (link description format _) "Export a man page link from Org files." (let ((path (format "http://man.he.net/?topic=%s§ion=all" link)) (desc (or description link))) (pcase format (`html (format "%s" path desc)) (`latex (format "\\href@{%s@}@{%s@}" path desc)) (`texinfo (format "@@uref@{%s,%s@}" path desc)) (`ascii (format "%s (%s)" desc path)) (t path)))) (provide ol-man) ;;; ol-man.el ends here @end lisp @noindent To activate links to man pages in Org, enter this in the Emacs init file: @lisp (require 'ol-man) @end lisp @noindent A review of @samp{ol-man.el}: @enumerate @item First, @samp{(require 'ol)} ensures that @samp{ol.el} is loaded. @item @findex org-link-set-parameters @vindex org-link-parameters Then @code{org-link-set-parameters} defines a new link type with @samp{man} prefix and associates functions for following, exporting and storing such links. See the variable @code{org-link-parameters} for a complete list of possible associations. @item The rest of the file implements necessary variables and functions. For example, @code{org-man-store-link} is responsible for storing a link when @code{org-store-link} (see @ref{Handling Links}) is called from a buffer displaying a man page. It first checks if the major mode is appropriate. If check fails, the function returns @code{nil}, which means it isn't responsible for creating a link to the current buffer. Otherwise the function makes a link string by combining the @samp{man:} prefix with the man topic. It also provides a default description. The function @code{org-insert-link} can insert it back into an Org buffer later on. @end enumerate @node Adding Export Back-ends @appendixsec Adding Export Back-ends @cindex Export, writing back-ends Org's export engine makes it easy for writing new back-ends. The framework on which the engine was built makes it easy to derive new back-ends from existing ones. @findex org-export-define-backend @findex org-export-define-derived-backend The two main entry points to the export engine are: @code{org-export-define-backend} and @code{org-export-define-derived-backend}. To grok these functions, see @samp{ox-latex.el} for an example of defining a new back-end from scratch, and @samp{ox-beamer.el} for an example of deriving from an existing engine. For creating a new back-end from scratch, first set its name as a symbol in an alist consisting of elements and export functions. To make the back-end visible to the export dispatcher, set @code{:menu-entry} keyword. For export options specific to this back-end, set the @code{:options-alist}. For creating a new back-end from an existing one, set @code{:translate-alist} to an alist of export functions. This alist replaces the parent back-end functions. For complete documentation, see @uref{https://orgmode.org/worg/dev/org-export-reference.html, the Org Export Reference on Worg}. @node Tables in Arbitrary Syntax @appendixsec Tables in Arbitrary Syntax @cindex tables, in other modes @cindex lists, in other modes @cindex Orgtbl mode Due to Org's success in handling tables with Orgtbl, a frequently requested feature is the use of Org's table functions in other modes, e.g., @LaTeX{}. This would be hard to do in a general way without complicated customization nightmares. Moreover, that would take Org away from its simplicity roots that Orgtbl has proven. There is, however, an alternate approach to accomplishing the same. This approach involves implementing a custom @emph{translate} function that operates on a native Org @emph{source table} to produce a table in another format. This strategy would keep the excellently working Orgtbl simple and isolate complications, if any, confined to the translate function. To add more alien table formats, we just add more translate functions. Also the burden of developing custom translate functions for new table formats is in the hands of those who know those formats best. @menu * Radio tables:: Sending and receiving radio tables. * A @LaTeX{} example:: Step by step, almost a tutorial. * Translator functions:: Copy and modify. @end menu @node Radio tables @appendixsubsec Radio tables @cindex radio tables Radio tables are target locations for translated tables that are not near their source. Org finds the target location and inserts the translated table. The key to finding the target location is the magic words @samp{BEGIN/END RECEIVE ORGTBL}. They have to appear as comments in the current mode. If the mode is C, then: @example /* BEGIN RECEIVE ORGTBL table_name */ /* END RECEIVE ORGTBL table_name */ @end example At the location of source, Org needs a special line to direct Orgtbl to translate and to find the target for inserting the translated table. For example: @cindex @samp{ORGTBL}, keyword @example #+ORGTBL: SEND table_name translation_function arguments ... @end example @noindent @samp{table_name} is the table's reference name, which is also used in the receiver lines, and the @samp{translation_function} is the Lisp function that translates. This line, in addition, may also contain alternating key and value arguments at the end. The translation function gets these values as a property list. A few standard parameters are already recognized and acted upon before the translation function is called: @table @asis @item @samp{:skip N} Skip the first N lines of the table. Hlines do count; include them if they are to be skipped. @item @samp{:skipcols (n1 n2 ...)} List of columns to be skipped. First Org automatically discards columns with calculation marks and then sends the table to the translator function, which then skips columns as specified in @samp{skipcols}. @end table To keep the source table intact in the buffer without being disturbed when the source file is compiled or otherwise being worked on, use one of these strategies: @itemize @item Place the table in a block comment. For example, in C mode you could wrap the table between @samp{/*} and @samp{*/} lines. @item Put the table after an ``end'' statement. For example @code{\bye} in @TeX{} and @code{\end@{document@}} in @LaTeX{}. @item Comment and un-comment each line of the table during edits. The @kbd{M-x orgtbl-toggle-comment} command makes toggling easy. @end itemize @node A @LaTeX{} example @appendixsubsec A @LaTeX{} example of radio tables @cindex @LaTeX{}, and Orgtbl mode To wrap a source table in @LaTeX{}, use the @samp{comment} environment provided by @samp{comment.sty}@footnote{@uref{https://www.ctan.org/pkg/comment}}. To activate it, put @code{\usepackage@{comment@}} in the document header. Orgtbl mode inserts a radio table skeleton@footnote{By default this works only for @LaTeX{}, HTML, and Texinfo. Configure the variable @code{orgtbl-radio-table-templates} to install templates for other modes.} with the command @kbd{M-x orgtbl-insert-radio-table}, which prompts for a table name. For example, if @samp{salesfigures} is the name, the template inserts: @example % BEGIN RECEIVE ORGTBL salesfigures % END RECEIVE ORGTBL salesfigures \begin@{comment@} #+ORGTBL: SEND salesfigures orgtbl-to-latex | | | \end@{comment@} @end example @vindex LaTeX-verbatim-environments @noindent The line @samp{#+ORGTBL: SEND} tells Orgtbl mode to use the function @code{orgtbl-to-latex} to convert the table to @LaTeX{} format, then insert the table at the target (receive) location named @samp{salesfigures}. Now the table is ready for data entry. It can even use spreadsheet features@footnote{If the @samp{TBLFM} keyword contains an odd number of dollar characters, this may cause problems with Font Lock in @LaTeX{} mode. As shown in the example you can fix this by adding an extra line inside the @samp{comment} environment that is used to balance the dollar expressions. If you are using AUC@TeX{} with the font-latex library, a much better solution is to add the @samp{comment} environment to the variable @code{LaTeX-verbatim-environments}.}: @example % BEGIN RECEIVE ORGTBL salesfigures % END RECEIVE ORGTBL salesfigures \begin@{comment@} #+ORGTBL: SEND salesfigures orgtbl-to-latex | Month | Days | Nr sold | per day | |-------+------+---------+---------| | Jan | 23 | 55 | 2.4 | | Feb | 21 | 16 | 0.8 | | March | 22 | 278 | 12.6 | #+TBLFM: $4=$3/$2;%.1f % $ (optional extra dollar to keep Font Lock happy, see footnote) \end@{comment@} @end example After editing, @kbd{C-c C-c} inserts the translated table at the target location, between the two marker lines. For hand-made custom tables, note that the translator needs to skip the first two lines of the source table. Also the command has to @emph{splice} out the target table without the header and footer. @example \begin@{tabular@}@{lrrr@} Month & \multicolumn@{1@}@{c@}@{Days@} & Nr.\ sold & per day\\ % BEGIN RECEIVE ORGTBL salesfigures % END RECEIVE ORGTBL salesfigures \end@{tabular@} % \begin@{comment@} #+ORGTBL: SEND salesfigures orgtbl-to-latex :splice t :skip 2 | Month | Days | Nr sold | per day | |-------+------+---------+---------| | Jan | 23 | 55 | 2.4 | | Feb | 21 | 16 | 0.8 | | March | 22 | 278 | 12.6 | #+TBLFM: $4=$3/$2;%.1f \end@{comment@} @end example The @LaTeX{} translator function @code{orgtbl-to-latex} is already part of Orgtbl mode and uses a @samp{tabular} environment to typeset the table and marks horizontal lines with @code{\hline}. For additional parameters to control output, see @ref{Translator functions}: @table @asis @item @samp{:splice BOOLEAN} When @{@{@{var(BOOLEAN@}@}@} is non-@code{nil}, return only table body lines; i.e., not wrapped in @samp{tabular} environment. Default is @code{nil}. @item @samp{:fmt FMT} Format string to warp each field. It should contain @samp{%s} for the original field value. For example, to wrap each field value in dollar symbol, you could use @samp{:fmt "$%s$"}. Format can also wrap a property list with column numbers and formats, for example @samp{:fmt (2 "$%s$" 4 "%s\\%%")}. In place of a string, a function of one argument can be used; the function must return a formatted string. @item @samp{:efmt EFMT} Format numbers as exponentials. The spec should have @samp{%s} twice for inserting mantissa and exponent, for example @samp{"%s\\times10^@{%s@}"}. This may also be a property list with column numbers and formats, for example @samp{:efmt (2 "$%s\\times10^@{%s@}$" 4 "$%s\\cdot10^@{%s@}$")}. After @var{EFMT} has been applied to a value, @var{FMT}---see above---is also applied. Functions with two arguments can be supplied instead of strings. By default, no special formatting is applied. @end table @node Translator functions @appendixsubsec Translator functions @cindex HTML, and Orgtbl mode @cindex translator function @findex orgtbl-to-csv @findex orgtbl-to-tsv @findex orgtbl-to-latex @findex orgtbl-to-html @findex orgtbl-to-texinfo @findex orgtbl-to-unicode @findex orgtbl-to-orgtbl @findex orgtbl-to-generic Orgtbl mode has built-in translator functions: @code{orgtbl-to-csv} (comma-separated values), @code{orgtbl-to-tsv} (TAB-separated values), @code{orgtbl-to-latex}, @code{orgtbl-to-html}, @code{orgtbl-to-texinfo}, @code{orgtbl-to-unicode} and @code{orgtbl-to-orgtbl}. They use the generic translator, @code{orgtbl-to-generic}, which delegates translations to various export back-ends. Properties passed to the function through the @samp{ORGTBL SEND} line take precedence over properties defined inside the function. For example, this overrides the default @LaTeX{} line endings, @code{\\}, with @code{\\[2mm]}: @example #+ORGTBL: SEND test orgtbl-to-latex :lend " \\\\[2mm]" @end example For a new language translator, define a converter function. It can be a generic function, such as shown in this example. It marks a beginning and ending of a table with @samp{!BTBL!} and @samp{!ETBL!}; a beginning and ending of lines with @samp{!BL!} and @samp{!EL!}; and uses a TAB for a field separator: @lisp (defun orgtbl-to-language (table params) "Convert the orgtbl-mode TABLE to language." (orgtbl-to-generic table (org-combine-plists '(:tstart "!BTBL!" :tend "!ETBL!" :lstart "!BL!" :lend "!EL!" :sep "\t") params))) @end lisp @noindent The documentation for the @code{orgtbl-to-generic} function shows a complete list of parameters, each of which can be passed through to @code{orgtbl-to-latex}, @code{orgtbl-to-texinfo}, and any other function using that generic function. For complicated translations the generic translator function could be replaced by a custom translator function. Such a custom function must take two arguments and return a single string containing the formatted table. The first argument is the table whose lines are a list of fields or the symbol @code{hline}. The second argument is the property list consisting of parameters specified in the @samp{#+ORGTBL: SEND} line. Please share your translator functions by posting them to the Org users mailing list, at @email{emacs-orgmode@@gnu.org}. @node Dynamic Blocks @appendixsec Dynamic Blocks @cindex dynamic blocks Org supports @emph{dynamic blocks} in Org documents. They are inserted with begin and end markers like any other code block, but the contents are updated automatically by a user function. @kindex C-c C-x x @findex org-dynamic-block-insert-dblock You can insert a dynamic block with @code{org-dynamic-block-insert-dblock}, which is bound to @kbd{C-c C-x x} by default. For example, @kbd{C-c C-x x c l o c k t a b l e @key{RET}} inserts a table that updates the work time (see @ref{Clocking Work Time}). Dynamic blocks can have names and function parameters. The syntax is similar to source code block specifications: @example #+BEGIN: myblock :parameter1 value1 :parameter2 value2 ... ... #+END: @end example These commands update dynamic blocks: @table @asis @item @kbd{C-c C-x C-u} (@code{org-dblock-update}) @kindex C-c C-x C-u @findex org-dblock-update Update dynamic block at point. @item @kbd{C-u C-c C-x C-u} @kindex C-u C-c C-x C-u Update all dynamic blocks in the current file. @end table Before updating a dynamic block, Org removes content between the @samp{BEGIN} and @samp{END} markers. Org then reads the parameters on the @samp{BEGIN} line for passing to the writer function as a plist. The previous content of the dynamic block becomes erased from the buffer and appended to the plist under @code{:content}. The syntax for naming a writer function with a dynamic block labeled @samp{myblock} is: @code{org-dblock-write:myblock}. The following is an example of a dynamic block and a block writer function that updates the time when the function was last run: @example #+BEGIN: block-update-time :format "on %m/%d/%Y at %H:%M" ... #+END: @end example @noindent The dynamic block's writer function: @lisp (defun org-dblock-write:block-update-time (params) (let ((fmt (or (plist-get params :format) "%d. %m. %Y"))) (insert "Last block update at: " (format-time-string fmt)))) @end lisp To keep dynamic blocks up-to-date in an Org file, use the function, @code{org-update-all-dblocks} in hook, such as @code{before-save-hook}. The @code{org-update-all-dblocks} function does not run if the file is not in Org mode. @findex org-narrow-to-block Dynamic blocks, like any other block, can be narrowed with @code{org-narrow-to-block}. @node Special Agenda Views @appendixsec Special Agenda Views @cindex agenda views, user-defined @vindex org-agenda-skip-function @vindex org-agenda-skip-function-global Org provides a special hook to further limit items in agenda views: @code{agenda}, @code{agenda*}@footnote{The @code{agenda*} view is the same as @code{agenda} except that it only considers @emph{appointments}, i.e., scheduled and deadline items that have a time specification @samp{[h]h:mm} in their time-stamps.}, @code{todo}, @code{alltodo}, @code{tags}, @code{tags-todo}, @code{tags-tree}. Specify a custom function that tests inclusion of every matched item in the view. This function can also skip as much as is needed. For a global condition applicable to agenda views, use the @code{org-agenda-skip-function-global} variable. Org uses a global condition with @code{org-agenda-skip-function} for custom searching. This example defines a function for a custom view showing TODO items with @samp{waiting} status. Manually this is a multi-step search process, but with a custom view, this can be automated as follows: The custom function searches the subtree for the @samp{waiting} tag and returns @code{nil} on match. Otherwise it gives the location from where the search continues. @lisp (defun my-skip-unless-waiting () "Skip trees that are not waiting" (let ((subtree-end (save-excursion (org-end-of-subtree t)))) (if (re-search-forward ":waiting:" subtree-end t) nil ; tag found, do not skip subtree-end))) ; tag not found, continue after end of subtree @end lisp To use this custom function in a custom agenda command: @lisp (org-add-agenda-custom-command '("b" todo "PROJECT" ((org-agenda-skip-function 'my-skip-unless-waiting) (org-agenda-overriding-header "Projects waiting for something: ")))) @end lisp @vindex org-agenda-overriding-header Note that this also binds @code{org-agenda-overriding-header} to a more meaningful string suitable for the agenda view. @vindex org-odd-levels-only @vindex org-agenda-skip-function Search for entries with a limit set on levels for the custom search. This is a general approach to creating custom searches in Org. To include all levels, use @samp{LEVEL>0}@footnote{Note that, for @code{org-odd-levels-only}, a level number corresponds to order in the hierarchy, not to the number of stars.}. Then to selectively pick the matched entries, use @code{org-agenda-skip-function}, which also accepts Lisp forms, such as @code{org-agenda-skip-entry-if} and @code{org-agenda-skip-subtree-if}. For example: @table @asis @item @samp{(org-agenda-skip-entry-if 'scheduled)} Skip current entry if it has been scheduled. @item @samp{(org-agenda-skip-entry-if 'notscheduled)} Skip current entry if it has not been scheduled. @item @samp{(org-agenda-skip-entry-if 'deadline)} Skip current entry if it has a deadline. @item @samp{(org-agenda-skip-entry-if 'scheduled 'deadline)} Skip current entry if it has a deadline, or if it is scheduled. @item @samp{(org-agenda-skip-entry-if 'todo '("TODO" "WAITING"))} Skip current entry if the TODO keyword is TODO or WAITING@. @item @samp{(org-agenda-skip-entry-if 'todo 'done)} Skip current entry if the TODO keyword marks a DONE state. @item @samp{(org-agenda-skip-entry-if 'timestamp)} Skip current entry if it has any timestamp, may also be deadline or scheduled. @item @samp{(org-agenda-skip-entry-if 'regexp "regular expression")} Skip current entry if the regular expression matches in the entry. @item @samp{(org-agenda-skip-entry-if 'notregexp "regular expression")} Skip current entry unless the regular expression matches. @item @samp{(org-agenda-skip-subtree-if 'regexp "regular expression")} Same as above, but check and skip the entire subtree. @end table The following is an example of a search for @samp{waiting} without the special function: @lisp (org-add-agenda-custom-command '("b" todo "PROJECT" ((org-agenda-skip-function '(org-agenda-skip-subtree-if 'regexp ":waiting:")) (org-agenda-overriding-header "Projects waiting for something: ")))) @end lisp @node Speeding Up Your Agendas @appendixsec Speeding Up Your Agendas @cindex agenda views, optimization Some agenda commands slow down when the Org files grow in size or number. Here are tips to speed up: @itemize @item Reduce the number of Org agenda files to avoid slowdowns due to hard drive accesses. @item Reduce the number of DONE and archived headlines so agenda operations that skip over these can finish faster. @item Do not dim blocked tasks: @vindex org-agenda-dim-blocked-tasks @lisp (setq org-agenda-dim-blocked-tasks nil) @end lisp @item Stop preparing agenda buffers on startup: @vindex org-startup-folded @vindex org-agenda-inhibit-startup @lisp (setq org-agenda-inhibit-startup t) @end lisp @item Disable tag inheritance for agendas: @vindex org-agenda-show-inherited-tags @vindex org-agenda-use-tag-inheritance @lisp (setq org-agenda-use-tag-inheritance nil) @end lisp @end itemize These options can be applied to selected agenda views. For more details about generation of agenda views, see the docstrings for the relevant variables, and this @uref{https://orgmode.org/worg/agenda-optimization.html, dedicated Worg page} for agenda optimization. @node Extracting Agenda Information @appendixsec Extracting Agenda Information @cindex agenda, pipe @cindex scripts, for agenda processing Org provides commands to access agendas through Emacs batch mode. Through this command-line interface, agendas are automated for further processing or printing. @vindex org-agenda-custom-commands @findex org-batch-agenda @code{org-batch-agenda} creates an agenda view in ASCII and outputs to standard output. This command takes one string parameter. When string consists of a single character, Org uses it as a key to @code{org-agenda-custom-commands}. These are the same ones available through the agenda dispatcher (see @ref{Agenda Dispatcher}). This example command line directly prints the TODO list to the printer: @example emacs -batch -l ~/.emacs -eval '(org-batch-agenda "t")' | lpr @end example When the string parameter length is two or more characters, Org matches it with tags/TODO strings. For example, this example command line prints items tagged with @samp{shop}, but excludes items tagged with @samp{NewYork}: @example emacs -batch -l ~/.emacs \ -eval '(org-batch-agenda "+shop-NewYork")' | lpr @end example @noindent An example showing on-the-fly parameter modifications: @example emacs -batch -l ~/.emacs \ -eval '(org-batch-agenda "a" \ org-agenda-span (quote month) \ org-agenda-include-diary nil \ org-agenda-files (quote ("~/org/project.org")))' \ | lpr @end example @noindent which produces an agenda for the next 30 days from just the @samp{~/org/projects.org} file. @findex org-batch-agenda-csv For structured processing of agenda output, use @code{org-batch-agenda-csv} with the following fields: @table @asis @item category The category of the item @item head The headline, without TODO keyword, TAGS and PRIORITY @item type The type of the agenda entry, can be @multitable {aaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaa} {aaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaa} @item @code{todo} @tab selected in TODO match @item @code{tagsmatch} @tab selected in tags match @item @code{diary} @tab imported from diary @item @code{deadline} @tab a deadline @item @code{scheduled} @tab scheduled @item @code{timestamp} @tab appointment, selected by timestamp @item @code{closed} @tab entry was closed on date @item @code{upcoming-deadline} @tab warning about nearing deadline @item @code{past-scheduled} @tab forwarded scheduled item @item @code{block} @tab entry has date block including date @end multitable @item todo The TODO keyword, if any @item tags All tags including inherited ones, separated by colons @item date The relevant date, like @samp{2007-2-14} @item time The time, like @samp{15:00-16:50} @item extra String with extra planning info @item priority-l The priority letter if any was given @item priority-n The computed numerical priority @end table If the selection of the agenda item was based on a timestamp, including those items with @samp{DEADLINE} and @samp{SCHEDULED} keywords, then Org includes date and time in the output. If the selection of the agenda item was based on a timestamp (or deadline/scheduled), then Org includes date and time in the output. Here is an example of a post-processing script in Perl. It takes the CSV output from Emacs and prints with a checkbox: @example #!/usr/bin/perl # define the Emacs command to run $cmd = "emacs -batch -l ~/.emacs -eval '(org-batch-agenda-csv \"t\")'"; # run it and capture the output $agenda = qx@{$cmd 2>/dev/null@}; # loop over all lines foreach $line (split(/\n/,$agenda)) @{ # get the individual values ($category,$head,$type,$todo,$tags,$date,$time,$extra, $priority_l,$priority_n) = split(/,/,$line); # process and print print "[ ] $head\n"; @} @end example @node Using the Property API @appendixsec Using the Property API @cindex API, for properties @cindex properties, API Here is a description of the functions that can be used to work with properties. @defun org-entry-properties &optional pom which Get all properties of the entry at point-or-marker @var{POM}. This includes the TODO keyword, the tags, time strings for deadline, scheduled, and clocking, and any additional properties defined in the entry. The return value is an alist. Keys may occur multiple times if the property key was used several times. @var{POM} may also be @code{nil}, in which case the current entry is used. If @var{WHICH} is @code{nil} or @code{all}, get all properties. If @var{WHICH} is @code{special} or @code{standard}, only get that subclass. @end defun @vindex org-use-property-inheritance @findex org-insert-property-drawer @defun org-entry-get pom property &optional inherit Get value of @var{PROPERTY} for entry at point-or-marker @var{POM}. By default, this only looks at properties defined locally in the entry. If @var{INHERIT} is non-@code{nil} and the entry does not have the property, then also check higher levels of the hierarchy. If @var{INHERIT} is the symbol @code{selective}, use inheritance if and only if the setting of @code{org-use-property-inheritance} selects @var{PROPERTY} for inheritance. @end defun @defun org-entry-delete pom property Delete the property @var{PROPERTY} from entry at point-or-marker @var{POM}. @end defun @defun org-entry-put pom property value Set @var{PROPERTY} to @var{VALUES} for entry at point-or-marker POM@. @end defun @defun org-buffer-property-keys &optional include-specials Get all property keys in the current buffer. @end defun @defun org-insert-property-drawer Insert a property drawer for the current entry. Also @end defun @defun org-entry-put-multivalued-property pom property &rest values Set @var{PROPERTY} at point-or-marker @var{POM} to @var{VALUES}. @var{VALUES} should be a list of strings. They are concatenated, with spaces as separators. @end defun @defun org-entry-get-multivalued-property pom property Treat the value of the property @var{PROPERTY} as a whitespace-separated list of values and return the values as a list of strings. @end defun @defun org-entry-add-to-multivalued-property pom property value Treat the value of the property @var{PROPERTY} as a whitespace-separated list of values and make sure that @var{VALUE} is in this list. @end defun @defun org-entry-remove-from-multivalued-property pom property value Treat the value of the property @var{PROPERTY} as a whitespace-separated list of values and make sure that @var{VALUE} is @emph{not} in this list. @end defun @defun org-entry-member-in-multivalued-property pom property value Treat the value of the property @var{PROPERTY} as a whitespace-separated list of values and check if @var{VALUE} is in this list. @end defun @defopt org-property-allowed-value-functions Hook for functions supplying allowed values for a specific property. The functions must take a single argument, the name of the property, and return a flat list of allowed values. If @samp{:ETC} is one of the values, use the values as completion help, but allow also other values to be entered. The functions must return @code{nil} if they are not responsible for this property. @end defopt @node Using the Mapping API @appendixsec Using the Mapping API @cindex API, for mapping @cindex mapping entries, API Org has sophisticated mapping capabilities to find all entries satisfying certain criteria. Internally, this functionality is used to produce agenda views, but there is also an API that can be used to execute arbitrary functions for each or selected entries. The main entry point for this API is: @defun org-map-entries func &optional match scope &rest skip Call @var{FUNC} at each headline selected by @var{MATCH} in @var{SCOPE}. @var{FUNC} is a function or a Lisp form. With point positioned at the beginning of the headline, call the function without arguments. Org returns an alist of return values of calls to the function. To avoid preserving point, Org wraps the call to @var{FUNC} in @code{save-excursion} form. After evaluation, Org moves point to the end of the line that was just processed. Search continues from that point forward. This may not always work as expected under some conditions, such as if the current sub-tree was removed by a previous archiving operation. In such rare circumstances, Org skips the next entry entirely when it should not. To stop Org from such skips, make @var{FUNC} set the variable @code{org-map-continue-from} to a specific buffer position. @var{MATCH} is a tags/property/TODO match. Org iterates only matched headlines. Org iterates over all headlines when @var{MATCH} is @code{nil} or @code{t}. @var{SCOPE} determines the scope of this command. It can be any of: @table @asis @item @code{nil} The current buffer, respecting the restriction, if any. @item @code{tree} The subtree started with the entry at point. @item @code{region} The entries within the active region, if any. @item @code{file} The current buffer, without restriction. @item @code{file-with-archives} The current buffer, and any archives associated with it. @item @code{agenda} All agenda files. @item @code{agenda-with-archives} All agenda files with any archive files associated with them. @item list of filenames If this is a list, all files in the list are scanned. @end table @noindent The remaining arguments are treated as settings for the scanner's skipping facilities. Valid arguments are: @table @asis @item @code{archive} Skip trees with the @samp{ARCHIVE} tag. @item @code{comment} Skip trees with the COMMENT keyword. @item function or Lisp form @vindex org-agenda-skip-function Used as value for @code{org-agenda-skip-function}, so whenever the function returns @code{t}, @var{FUNC} is called for that entry and search continues from the point where the function leaves it. @end table @end defun The mapping routine can call any arbitrary function, even functions that change meta data or query the property API (see @ref{Using the Property API}). Here are some handy functions: @defun org-todo &optional arg Change the TODO state of the entry. See the docstring of the functions for the many possible values for the argument @var{ARG}. @end defun @defun org-priority &optional action Change the priority of the entry. See the docstring of this function for the possible values for @var{ACTION}. @end defun @defun org-toggle-tag tag &optional onoff Toggle the tag @var{TAG} in the current entry. Setting @var{ONOFF} to either @code{on} or @code{off} does not toggle tag, but ensure that it is either on or off. @end defun @defun org-promote Promote the current entry. @end defun @defun org-demote Demote the current entry. @end defun This example turns all entries tagged with @samp{TOMORROW} into TODO entries with keyword @samp{UPCOMING}. Org ignores entries in comment trees and archive trees. @lisp (org-map-entries '(org-todo "UPCOMING") "+TOMORROW" 'file 'archive 'comment) @end lisp The following example counts the number of entries with TODO keyword @samp{WAITING}, in all agenda files. @lisp (length (org-map-entries t "/+WAITING" 'agenda)) @end lisp @node History and Acknowledgments @appendix History and Acknowledgments @anchor{From Carsten} @appendixsec From Carsten Org was born in 2003, out of frustration over the user interface of the Emacs Outline mode. I was trying to organize my notes and projects, and using Emacs seemed to be the natural way to go. However, having to remember eleven different commands with two or three keys per command, only to hide and show parts of the outline tree, that seemed entirely unacceptable to me. Also, when using outlines to take notes, I constantly wanted to restructure the tree, organizing it parallel to my thoughts and plans. @emph{Visibility cycling} and @emph{structure editing} were originally implemented in the package @samp{outline-magic.el}, but quickly moved to the more general @samp{org.el}. As this environment became comfortable for project planning, the next step was adding @emph{TODO entries}, basic @emph{timestamps}, and @emph{table support}. These areas highlighted the two main goals that Org still has today: to be a new, outline-based, plain text mode with innovative and intuitive editing features, and to incorporate project planning functionality directly into a notes file. Since the first release, literally thousands of emails to me or to the @email{emacs-orgmode@@gnu.org, mailing list} have provided a constant stream of bug reports, feedback, new ideas, and sometimes patches and add-on code. Many thanks to everyone who has helped to improve this package. I am trying to keep here a list of the people who had significant influence in shaping one or more aspects of Org. The list may not be complete, if I have forgotten someone, please accept my apologies and let me know. Before I get to this list, a few special mentions are in order: @table @asis @item Bastien Guerry Bastien has written a large number of extensions to Org (most of them integrated into the core by now), including the @LaTeX{} exporter and the plain list parser. His support during the early days was central to the success of this project. Bastien also invented Worg, helped establishing the Web presence of Org, and sponsored hosting costs for the orgmode.org website. Bastien stepped in as maintainer of Org between 2011 and 2013, at a time when I desperately needed a break. @item Eric Schulte and Dan Davison Eric and Dan are jointly responsible for the Org Babel system, which turns Org into a multi-language environment for evaluating code and doing literate programming and reproducible research. This has become one of Org's killer features that define what Org is today. @item John Wiegley John has contributed a number of great ideas and patches directly to Org, including the attachment system (@samp{org-attach.el}), integration with Apple Mail (@samp{org-mac-message.el}), hierarchical dependencies of TODO items, habit tracking (@samp{org-habits.el}), and encryption (@samp{org-crypt.el}). Also, the capture system is really an extended copy of his great @samp{remember.el}. @item Sebastian Rose Without Sebastian, the HTML/XHTML publishing of Org would be the pitiful work of an ignorant amateur. Sebastian has pushed this part of Org onto a much higher level. He also wrote @samp{org-info.js}, a JavaScript program for displaying webpages derived from Org using an Info-like or a folding interface with single-key navigation. @end table See below for the full list of contributions! Again, please let me know what I am missing here! @anchor{From Bastien} @appendixsec From Bastien I (Bastien) have been maintaining Org between 2011 and 2013. This appendix would not be complete without adding a few more acknowledgments and thanks. I am first grateful to Carsten for his trust while handing me over the maintainership of Org. His unremitting support is what really helped me getting more confident over time, with both the community and the code. When I took over maintainership, I knew I would have to make Org more collaborative than ever, as I would have to rely on people that are more knowledgeable than I am on many parts of the code. Here is a list of the persons I could rely on, they should really be considered co-maintainers, either of the code or the community: @table @asis @item Eric Schulte Eric is maintaining the Babel parts of Org. His reactivity here kept me away from worrying about possible bugs here and let me focus on other parts. @item Nicolas Goaziou Nicolas is maintaining the consistency of the deepest parts of Org. His work on @samp{org-element.el} and @samp{ox.el} has been outstanding, and it opened the doors for many new ideas and features. He rewrote many of the old exporters to use the new export engine, and helped with documenting this major change. More importantly (if that's possible), he has been more than reliable during all the work done for Org 8.0, and always very reactive on the mailing list. @item Achim Gratz Achim rewrote the building process of Org, turning some @emph{ad hoc} tools into a flexible and conceptually clean process. He patiently coped with the many hiccups that such a change can create for users. @item Nick Dokos The Org mode mailing list would not be such a nice place without Nick, who patiently helped users so many times. It is impossible to overestimate such a great help, and the list would not be so active without him. @end table I received support from so many users that it is clearly impossible to be fair when shortlisting a few of them, but Org's history would not be complete if the ones above were not mentioned in this manual. @anchor{List of Contributions} @appendixsec List of Contributions @itemize @item Russell Adams came up with the idea for drawers. @item Thomas Baumann wrote @samp{ol-bbdb.el} and @samp{ol-mhe.el}. @item Christophe Bataillon created the great unicorn logo that we use on the Org mode website. @item Alex Bochannek provided a patch for rounding timestamps. @item Jan Böcker wrote @samp{ol-docview.el}. @item Brad Bozarth showed how to pull RSS feed data into Org files. @item Tom Breton wrote @samp{org-choose.el}. @item Charles Cave's suggestion sparked the implementation of templates for Remember, which are now templates for capture. @item Pavel Chalmoviansky influenced the agenda treatment of items with specified time. @item Gregory Chernov patched support for Lisp forms into table calculations and improved XEmacs compatibility, in particular by porting @samp{nouline.el} to XEmacs. @item Sacha Chua suggested copying some linking code from Planner. @item Baoqiu Cui contributed the DocBook exporter. @item Eddward DeVilla proposed and tested checkbox statistics. He also came up with the idea of properties, and that there should be an API for them. @item Nick Dokos tracked down several nasty bugs. @item Kees Dullemond used to edit projects lists directly in HTML and so inspired some of the early development, including HTML export. He also asked for a way to narrow wide table columns. @item Thomas@tie{}S@.@tie{}Dye contributed documentation on Worg and helped integrating the Org Babel documentation into the manual. @item Christian Egli converted the documentation into Texinfo format, inspired the agenda, patched CSS formatting into the HTML exporter, and wrote @samp{org-taskjuggler.el}. @item David Emery provided a patch for custom CSS support in exported HTML agendas. @item Nic Ferrier contributed mailcap and XOXO support. @item Miguel@tie{}A@.@tie{}Figueroa-Villanueva implemented hierarchical checkboxes. @item John Foerch figured out how to make incremental search show context around a match in a hidden outline tree. @item Raimar Finken wrote @samp{org-git-line.el}. @item Mikael Fornius works as a mailing list moderator. @item Austin Frank works as a mailing list moderator. @item Eric Fraga drove the development of Beamer export with ideas and testing. @item Barry Gidden did proofreading the manual in preparation for the book publication through Network Theory Ltd. @item Niels Giesen had the idea to automatically archive DONE trees. @item Nicolas Goaziou rewrote much of the plain list code. @item Kai Grossjohann pointed out key-binding conflicts with other packages. @item Brian Gough of Network Theory Ltd publishes the Org mode manual as a book. @item Bernt Hansen has driven much of the support for auto-repeating tasks, task state change logging, and the clocktable. His clear explanations have been critical when we started to adopt the Git version control system. @item Manuel Hermenegildo has contributed various ideas, small fixes and patches. @item Phil Jackson wrote @samp{ol-irc.el}. @item Scott Jaderholm proposed footnotes, control over whitespace between folded entries, and column view for properties. @item Matt Jones wrote MobileOrg Android. @item Tokuya Kameshima wrote @samp{org-wl.el} and @samp{org-mew.el}. @item Shidai Liu (``Leo'') asked for embedded @LaTeX{} and tested it. He also provided frequent feedback and some patches. @item Matt Lundin has proposed last-row references for table formulas and named invisible anchors. He has also worked a lot on the FAQ@. @item David Maus wrote @samp{org-atom.el}, maintains the issues file for Org, and is a prolific contributor on the mailing list with competent replies, small fixes and patches. @item Jason@tie{}F@.@tie{}McBrayer suggested agenda export to CSV format. @item Max Mikhanosha came up with the idea of refiling. @item Dmitri Minaev sent a patch to set priority limits on a per-file basis. @item Stefan Monnier provided a patch to keep the Emacs Lisp compiler happy. @item Richard Moreland wrote MobileOrg for the iPhone. @item Rick Moynihan proposed allowing multiple TODO sequences in a file and being able to quickly restrict the agenda to a subtree. @item Todd Neal provided patches for links to Info files and Elisp forms. @item Greg Newman refreshed the unicorn logo into its current form. @item Tim O'Callaghan suggested in-file links, search options for general file links, and tags. @item Osamu Okano wrote @samp{orgcard2ref.pl}, a Perl program to create a text version of the reference card. @item Takeshi Okano translated the manual and David O'Toole's tutorial into Japanese. @item Oliver Oppitz suggested multi-state TODO items. @item Scott Otterson sparked the introduction of descriptive text for links, among other things. @item Pete Phillips helped during the development of the TAGS feature, and provided frequent feedback. @item Martin Pohlack provided the code snippet to bundle character insertion into bundles of 20 for undo. @item T@.@tie{}V@.@tie{}Raman reported bugs and suggested improvements. @item Matthias Rempe (Oelde) provided ideas, Windows support, and quality control. @item Paul Rivier provided the basic implementation of named footnotes. He also acted as mailing list moderator for some time. @item Kevin Rogers contributed code to access VM files on remote hosts. @item Frank Ruell solved the mystery of the @samp{keymapp nil} bug, a conflict with @samp{allout.el}. @item Jason Riedy generalized the send-receive mechanism for Orgtbl tables with extensive patches. @item Philip Rooke created the Org reference card, provided lots of feedback, developed and applied standards to the Org documentation. @item Christian Schlauer proposed angular brackets around links, among other things. @item Paul Sexton wrote @samp{org-ctags.el}. @item Tom Shannon's @samp{organizer-mode.el} inspired linking to VM/BBDB/Gnus. @item Ilya Shlyakhter proposed the Archive Sibling, line numbering in literal examples, and remote highlighting for referenced code lines. @item Stathis Sideris wrote the @samp{ditaa.jar} ASCII to PNG converter that is now packaged into Org's @samp{contrib/} directory. @item Daniel Sinder came up with the idea of internal archiving by locking subtrees. @item Dale Smith proposed link abbreviations. @item James TD Smith has contributed a large number of patches for useful tweaks and features. @item Adam Spiers asked for global linking commands, inspired the link extension system, added support for Mairix, and proposed the mapping API@. @item Ulf Stegemann created the table to translate special symbols to HTML, @LaTeX{}, UTF-8, Latin-1 and ASCII@. @item Andy Stewart contributed code to @samp{ol-w3m.el}, to copy HTML content with links transformation to Org syntax. @item David O'Toole wrote @samp{org-publish.el} and drafted the manual chapter about publishing. @item Jambunathan@tie{}K@.@tie{}contributed the ODT exporter. @item Sebastien Vauban reported many issues with @LaTeX{} and Beamer export and enabled source code highlighting in Gnus. @item Stefan Vollmar organized a video-recorded talk at the Max-Planck-Institute for Neurology. He also inspired the creation of a concept index for HTML export. @item Jürgen Vollmer contributed code generating the table of contents in HTML output. @item Samuel Wales has provided important feedback and bug reports. @item Chris Wallace provided a patch implementing the @samp{QUOTE} block. @item David Wainberg suggested archiving, and improvements to the linking system. @item Carsten Wimmer suggested some changes and helped fix a bug in linking to Gnus. @item Roland Winkler requested additional key bindings to make Org work on a TTY@. @item Piotr Zielinski wrote @samp{org-mouse.el}, proposed agenda blocks and contributed various ideas and code snippets. @item Marco Wahl wrote @samp{ol-eww.el}. @end itemize @node GNU Free Documentation License @appendix GNU Free Documentation License @center Version 1.3, 3 November 2008 @display Copyright @copyright{} 2000, 2001, 2002, 2007, 2008 Free Software Foundation, Inc. @uref{https://fsf.org/} Everyone is permitted to copy and distribute verbatim copies of this license document, but changing it is not allowed. @end display @enumerate 0 @item PREAMBLE The purpose of this License is to make a manual, textbook, or other functional and useful document @dfn{free} in the sense of freedom: to assure everyone the effective freedom to copy and redistribute it, with or without modifying it, either commercially or noncommercially. Secondarily, this License preserves for the author and publisher a way to get credit for their work, while not being considered responsible for modifications made by others. This License is a kind of ``copyleft'', which means that derivative works of the document must themselves be free in the same sense. It complements the GNU General Public License, which is a copyleft license designed for free software. We have designed this License in order to use it for manuals for free software, because free software needs free documentation: a free program should come with manuals providing the same freedoms that the software does. But this License is not limited to software manuals; it can be used for any textual work, regardless of subject matter or whether it is published as a printed book. We recommend this License principally for works whose purpose is instruction or reference. @item APPLICABILITY AND DEFINITIONS This License applies to any manual or other work, in any medium, that contains a notice placed by the copyright holder saying it can be distributed under the terms of this License. Such a notice grants a world-wide, royalty-free license, unlimited in duration, to use that work under the conditions stated herein. The ``Document'', below, refers to any such manual or work. Any member of the public is a licensee, and is addressed as ``you''. You accept the license if you copy, modify or distribute the work in a way requiring permission under copyright law. A ``Modified Version'' of the Document means any work containing the Document or a portion of it, either copied verbatim, or with modifications and/or translated into another language. A ``Secondary Section'' is a named appendix or a front-matter section of the Document that deals exclusively with the relationship of the publishers or authors of the Document to the Document's overall subject (or to related matters) and contains nothing that could fall directly within that overall subject. (Thus, if the Document is in part a textbook of mathematics, a Secondary Section may not explain any mathematics.) The relationship could be a matter of historical connection with the subject or with related matters, or of legal, commercial, philosophical, ethical or political position regarding them. The ``Invariant Sections'' are certain Secondary Sections whose titles are designated, as being those of Invariant Sections, in the notice that says that the Document is released under this License. If a section does not fit the above definition of Secondary then it is not allowed to be designated as Invariant. The Document may contain zero Invariant Sections. If the Document does not identify any Invariant Sections then there are none. The ``Cover Texts'' are certain short passages of text that are listed, as Front-Cover Texts or Back-Cover Texts, in the notice that says that the Document is released under this License. A Front-Cover Text may be at most 5 words, and a Back-Cover Text may be at most 25 words. A ``Transparent'' copy of the Document means a machine-readable copy, represented in a format whose specification is available to the general public, that is suitable for revising the document straightforwardly with generic text editors or (for images composed of pixels) generic paint programs or (for drawings) some widely available drawing editor, and that is suitable for input to text formatters or for automatic translation to a variety of formats suitable for input to text formatters. A copy made in an otherwise Transparent file format whose markup, or absence of markup, has been arranged to thwart or discourage subsequent modification by readers is not Transparent. An image format is not Transparent if used for any substantial amount of text. A copy that is not ``Transparent'' is called ``Opaque''. Examples of suitable formats for Transparent copies include plain ASCII without markup, Texinfo input format, @LaTeX{} input format, SGML or XML using a publicly available DTD, and standard-conforming simple HTML, PostScript or PDF designed for human modification. Examples of transparent image formats include PNG, XCF and JPG@. Opaque formats include proprietary formats that can be read and edited only by proprietary word processors, SGML or XML for which the DTD and/or processing tools are not generally available, and the machine-generated HTML, PostScript or PDF produced by some word processors for output purposes only. The ``Title Page'' means, for a printed book, the title page itself, plus such following pages as are needed to hold, legibly, the material this License requires to appear in the title page. For works in formats which do not have any title page as such, ``Title Page'' means the text near the most prominent appearance of the work's title, preceding the beginning of the body of the text. The ``publisher'' means any person or entity that distributes copies of the Document to the public. A section ``Entitled XYZ'' means a named subunit of the Document whose title either is precisely XYZ or contains XYZ in parentheses following text that translates XYZ in another language. (Here XYZ stands for a specific section name mentioned below, such as ``Acknowledgements'', ``Dedications'', ``Endorsements'', or ``History''.) To ``Preserve the Title'' of such a section when you modify the Document means that it remains a section ``Entitled XYZ'' according to this definition. The Document may include Warranty Disclaimers next to the notice which states that this License applies to the Document. These Warranty Disclaimers are considered to be included by reference in this License, but only as regards disclaiming warranties: any other implication that these Warranty Disclaimers may have is void and has no effect on the meaning of this License. @item VERBATIM COPYING You may copy and distribute the Document in any medium, either commercially or noncommercially, provided that this License, the copyright notices, and the license notice saying this License applies to the Document are reproduced in all copies, and that you add no other conditions whatsoever to those of this License. You may not use technical measures to obstruct or control the reading or further copying of the copies you make or distribute. However, you may accept compensation in exchange for copies. If you distribute a large enough number of copies you must also follow the conditions in section 3. You may also lend copies, under the same conditions stated above, and you may publicly display copies. @item COPYING IN QUANTITY If you publish printed copies (or copies in media that commonly have printed covers) of the Document, numbering more than 100, and the Document's license notice requires Cover Texts, you must enclose the copies in covers that carry, clearly and legibly, all these Cover Texts: Front-Cover Texts on the front cover, and Back-Cover Texts on the back cover. Both covers must also clearly and legibly identify you as the publisher of these copies. The front cover must present the full title with all words of the title equally prominent and visible. You may add other material on the covers in addition. Copying with changes limited to the covers, as long as they preserve the title of the Document and satisfy these conditions, can be treated as verbatim copying in other respects. If the required texts for either cover are too voluminous to fit legibly, you should put the first ones listed (as many as fit reasonably) on the actual cover, and continue the rest onto adjacent pages. If you publish or distribute Opaque copies of the Document numbering more than 100, you must either include a machine-readable Transparent copy along with each Opaque copy, or state in or with each Opaque copy a computer-network location from which the general network-using public has access to download using public-standard network protocols a complete Transparent copy of the Document, free of added material. If you use the latter option, you must take reasonably prudent steps, when you begin distribution of Opaque copies in quantity, to ensure that this Transparent copy will remain thus accessible at the stated location until at least one year after the last time you distribute an Opaque copy (directly or through your agents or retailers) of that edition to the public. It is requested, but not required, that you contact the authors of the Document well before redistributing any large number of copies, to give them a chance to provide you with an updated version of the Document. @item MODIFICATIONS You may copy and distribute a Modified Version of the Document under the conditions of sections 2 and 3 above, provided that you release the Modified Version under precisely this License, with the Modified Version filling the role of the Document, thus licensing distribution and modification of the Modified Version to whoever possesses a copy of it. In addition, you must do these things in the Modified Version: @enumerate A @item Use in the Title Page (and on the covers, if any) a title distinct from that of the Document, and from those of previous versions (which should, if there were any, be listed in the History section of the Document). You may use the same title as a previous version if the original publisher of that version gives permission. @item List on the Title Page, as authors, one or more persons or entities responsible for authorship of the modifications in the Modified Version, together with at least five of the principal authors of the Document (all of its principal authors, if it has fewer than five), unless they release you from this requirement. @item State on the Title page the name of the publisher of the Modified Version, as the publisher. @item Preserve all the copyright notices of the Document. @item Add an appropriate copyright notice for your modifications adjacent to the other copyright notices. @item Include, immediately after the copyright notices, a license notice giving the public permission to use the Modified Version under the terms of this License, in the form shown in the Addendum below. @item Preserve in that license notice the full lists of Invariant Sections and required Cover Texts given in the Document's license notice. @item Include an unaltered copy of this License. @item Preserve the section Entitled ``History'', Preserve its Title, and add to it an item stating at least the title, year, new authors, and publisher of the Modified Version as given on the Title Page. If there is no section Entitled ``History'' in the Document, create one stating the title, year, authors, and publisher of the Document as given on its Title Page, then add an item describing the Modified Version as stated in the previous sentence. @item Preserve the network location, if any, given in the Document for public access to a Transparent copy of the Document, and likewise the network locations given in the Document for previous versions it was based on. These may be placed in the ``History'' section. You may omit a network location for a work that was published at least four years before the Document itself, or if the original publisher of the version it refers to gives permission. @item For any section Entitled ``Acknowledgements'' or ``Dedications'', Preserve the Title of the section, and preserve in the section all the substance and tone of each of the contributor acknowledgements and/or dedications given therein. @item Preserve all the Invariant Sections of the Document, unaltered in their text and in their titles. Section numbers or the equivalent are not considered part of the section titles. @item Delete any section Entitled ``Endorsements''. Such a section may not be included in the Modified Version. @item Do not retitle any existing section to be Entitled ``Endorsements'' or to conflict in title with any Invariant Section. @item Preserve any Warranty Disclaimers. @end enumerate If the Modified Version includes new front-matter sections or appendices that qualify as Secondary Sections and contain no material copied from the Document, you may at your option designate some or all of these sections as invariant. To do this, add their titles to the list of Invariant Sections in the Modified Version's license notice. These titles must be distinct from any other section titles. You may add a section Entitled ``Endorsements'', provided it contains nothing but endorsements of your Modified Version by various parties---for example, statements of peer review or that the text has been approved by an organization as the authoritative definition of a standard. You may add a passage of up to five words as a Front-Cover Text, and a passage of up to 25 words as a Back-Cover Text, to the end of the list of Cover Texts in the Modified Version. Only one passage of Front-Cover Text and one of Back-Cover Text may be added by (or through arrangements made by) any one entity. If the Document already includes a cover text for the same cover, previously added by you or by arrangement made by the same entity you are acting on behalf of, you may not add another; but you may replace the old one, on explicit permission from the previous publisher that added the old one. The author(s) and publisher(s) of the Document do not by this License give permission to use their names for publicity for or to assert or imply endorsement of any Modified Version. @item COMBINING DOCUMENTS You may combine the Document with other documents released under this License, under the terms defined in section 4 above for modified versions, provided that you include in the combination all of the Invariant Sections of all of the original documents, unmodified, and list them all as Invariant Sections of your combined work in its license notice, and that you preserve all their Warranty Disclaimers. The combined work need only contain one copy of this License, and multiple identical Invariant Sections may be replaced with a single copy. If there are multiple Invariant Sections with the same name but different contents, make the title of each such section unique by adding at the end of it, in parentheses, the name of the original author or publisher of that section if known, or else a unique number. Make the same adjustment to the section titles in the list of Invariant Sections in the license notice of the combined work. In the combination, you must combine any sections Entitled ``History'' in the various original documents, forming one section Entitled ``History''; likewise combine any sections Entitled ``Acknowledgements'', and any sections Entitled ``Dedications''. You must delete all sections Entitled ``Endorsements.'' @item COLLECTIONS OF DOCUMENTS You may make a collection consisting of the Document and other documents released under this License, and replace the individual copies of this License in the various documents with a single copy that is included in the collection, provided that you follow the rules of this License for verbatim copying of each of the documents in all other respects. You may extract a single document from such a collection, and distribute it individually under this License, provided you insert a copy of this License into the extracted document, and follow this License in all other respects regarding verbatim copying of that document. @item AGGREGATION WITH INDEPENDENT WORKS A compilation of the Document or its derivatives with other separate and independent documents or works, in or on a volume of a storage or distribution medium, is called an ``aggregate'' if the copyright resulting from the compilation is not used to limit the legal rights of the compilation's users beyond what the individual works permit. When the Document is included in an aggregate, this License does not apply to the other works in the aggregate which are not themselves derivative works of the Document. If the Cover Text requirement of section 3 is applicable to these copies of the Document, then if the Document is less than one half of the entire aggregate, the Document's Cover Texts may be placed on covers that bracket the Document within the aggregate, or the electronic equivalent of covers if the Document is in electronic form. Otherwise they must appear on printed covers that bracket the whole aggregate. @item TRANSLATION Translation is considered a kind of modification, so you may distribute translations of the Document under the terms of section 4. Replacing Invariant Sections with translations requires special permission from their copyright holders, but you may include translations of some or all Invariant Sections in addition to the original versions of these Invariant Sections. You may include a translation of this License, and all the license notices in the Document, and any Warranty Disclaimers, provided that you also include the original English version of this License and the original versions of those notices and disclaimers. In case of a disagreement between the translation and the original version of this License or a notice or disclaimer, the original version will prevail. If a section in the Document is Entitled ``Acknowledgements'', ``Dedications'', or ``History'', the requirement (section 4) to Preserve its Title (section 1) will typically require changing the actual title. @item TERMINATION You may not copy, modify, sublicense, or distribute the Document except as expressly provided under this License. Any attempt otherwise to copy, modify, sublicense, or distribute it is void, and will automatically terminate your rights under this License. However, if you cease all violation of this License, then your license from a particular copyright holder is reinstated (a) provisionally, unless and until the copyright holder explicitly and finally terminates your license, and (b) permanently, if the copyright holder fails to notify you of the violation by some reasonable means prior to 60 days after the cessation. Moreover, your license from a particular copyright holder is reinstated permanently if the copyright holder notifies you of the violation by some reasonable means, this is the first time you have received notice of violation of this License (for any work) from that copyright holder, and you cure the violation prior to 30 days after your receipt of the notice. Termination of your rights under this section does not terminate the licenses of parties who have received copies or rights from you under this License. If your rights have been terminated and not permanently reinstated, receipt of a copy of some or all of the same material does not give you any rights to use it. @item FUTURE REVISIONS OF THIS LICENSE The Free Software Foundation may publish new, revised versions of the GNU Free Documentation License from time to time. Such new versions will be similar in spirit to the present version, but may differ in detail to address new problems or concerns. See @uref{https://www.gnu.org/copyleft/}. Each version of the License is given a distinguishing version number. If the Document specifies that a particular numbered version of this License ``or any later version'' applies to it, you have the option of following the terms and conditions either of that specified version or of any later version that has been published (not as a draft) by the Free Software Foundation. If the Document does not specify a version number of this License, you may choose any version ever published (not as a draft) by the Free Software Foundation. If the Document specifies that a proxy can decide which future versions of this License can be used, that proxy's public statement of acceptance of a version permanently authorizes you to choose that version for the Document. @item RELICENSING ``Massive Multiauthor Collaboration Site'' (or ``MMC Site'') means any World Wide Web server that publishes copyrightable works and also provides prominent facilities for anybody to edit those works. A public wiki that anybody can edit is an example of such a server. A ``Massive Multiauthor Collaboration'' (or ``MMC'') contained in the site means any set of copyrightable works thus published on the MMC site. ``CC-BY-SA'' means the Creative Commons Attribution-Share Alike 3.0 license published by Creative Commons Corporation, a not-for-profit corporation with a principal place of business in San Francisco, California, as well as future copyleft versions of that license published by that same organization. ``Incorporate'' means to publish or republish a Document, in whole or in part, as part of another Document. An MMC is ``eligible for relicensing'' if it is licensed under this License, and if all works that were first published under this License somewhere other than this MMC, and subsequently incorporated in whole or in part into the MMC, (1) had no cover texts or invariant sections, and (2) were thus incorporated prior to November 1, 2008. The operator of an MMC Site may republish an MMC contained in the site under CC-BY-SA on the same site at any time before August 1, 2009, provided the MMC is eligible for relicensing. @end enumerate @page @anchor{ADDENDUM How to use this License for your documents} @appendixsec ADDENDUM: How to use this License for your documents To use this License in a document you have written, include a copy of the License in the document and put the following copyright and license notices just after the title page: @example Copyright (C) YEAR YOUR NAME. Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.3 or any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with no Invariant Sections, no Front-Cover Texts, and no Back-Cover Texts. A copy of the license is included in the section entitled ``GNU Free Documentation License''. @end example If you have Invariant Sections, Front-Cover Texts and Back-Cover Texts, replace the ``with@dots{}Texts.''@tie{}line with this: @example with the Invariant Sections being LIST THEIR TITLES, with the Front-Cover Texts being LIST, and with the Back-Cover Texts being LIST. @end example If you have Invariant Sections without Cover Texts, or some other combination of the three, merge those two alternatives to suit the situation. If your document contains nontrivial examples of program code, we recommend releasing these examples in parallel under your choice of free software license, such as the GNU General Public License, to permit their use in free software. @node Main Index @chapter Main Index @printindex cp @node Key Index @chapter Key Index @printindex ky @node Command and Function Index @chapter Command and Function Index @printindex fn @node Variable Index @chapter Variable Index This is not a complete index of variables and faces, only the ones that are mentioned in the manual. For a more complete list, use @kbd{M-x org-customize} and then click yourself through the tree. @printindex vr @bye